Ga 800
Ga 800
Ga 800
PDF
This Page Intentionally Blank
i.1 Receiving.................................................................................................................... 12
i.2 Using the Product Safely........................................................................................ 14
i.1 Receiving
These instructions contain the information necessary to use the product correctly. Read and understand the safety
information and precautions before you start to use the product.
◆ Document Use
This document is for maintenance and troubleshooting of installed Yaskawa GA800 drives. It is intended for use by
those familiar with maintenance and troubleshooting of variable frequency drives. This document does not contain
information to support repairs beyond fan and control board replacement components for Yaskawa GA800 drives. For
more information about the GA800 drive, refer to the GA800 Technical Manual (SIEPC*********).
Yaskawa Technical Support
• repair@yaskawa.com
• Toll Free - 1.800.927.5292
• Direct - 1.847.887.7457
• Option 2 for Technical Support, then option 1 for Drive Support
Before You Call....
Please have the following information available:
• Model and spec number of the unit
• Serial Number
• Failure Information (fault and alarm codes, descriptions)
• Application which the product is used on
• Length of time in service
◆ Glossary
Phrase Definition
AOLV/PM Advanced Open Loop Vector Control for Permanent Magnet Motors
HD Heavy Duty
ND Normal Duty
PM motor Permanent Magnet Synchronous Motor (generic name for IPM motors and SPM motors)
DANGER
This signal word identifies a hazard that will cause serious injury or death if you do not prevent it.
WARNING
This signal word identifies a hazard that can cause death or serious injuries if you do not prevent it.
CAUTION
Identifies a hazardous situation, which, if not avoided, can cause minor or moderate injury.
NOTICE
This signal word identifies a property damage message that is not related to personal injury.
◆ Section Safety
General Precautions
• Some figures in the instructions include options and drives without covers or safety shields to more clearly show the inside of the drive. Replace covers and shields before operation.
Use options and drives only as specified by the instructions.
• The figures in this manual are examples only. All figures do not apply to all products included in this manual.
• Yaskawa can change the products, specifications, and content of the instructions without notice to make the product and/or the instructions better.
• If you damage or lose these instructions, contact a Yaskawa representative or the nearest Yaskawa sales office on the rear cover of the manual, and tell them the document number
on the front cover to order new copies.
DANGER
Do not ignore the safety messages in this manual.
If you ignore the safety messages in this manual, it will cause serious injury or death. The manufacturer is not
responsible for injuries or damage to equipment.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not examine, connect, or disconnect wiring on an energized drive. Before servicing, disconnect
all power to the equipment and wait for the time specified on the warning label at a minimum. The
internal capacitor stays charged after the drive is de-energized. The charge indicator LED
extinguishes when the DC bus voltage decreases below 50 Vdc. When all indicators are OFF,
remove the covers before measuring for dangerous voltages to make sure that the drive is safe.
If you do work on the drive when it is energized, it will cause serious injury or death from electrical shock.
WARNING
Crush Hazard
Test the system to make sure that the drive operates safely after you wire the drive and set
parameters.
If you do not test the system, it can cause damage to equipment or serious injury or death.
Sudden Movement Hazard
Before you do a test run, make sure that the setting values for virtual input and output function
parameters are correct. Virtual input and output functions can have different default settings and
operation than wired input and output functions.
Incorrect function settings can cause serious injury or death.
Remove all personnel and objects from the area around the drive, motor, and machine and attach
covers, couplings, shaft keys, and machine loads before you energize the drive.
If personnel are too close or if there are missing parts, it can cause serious injury or death.
Examine the I/O signals and internal sequence with the engineer who made the DriveWorksEZ
program before you operate the drive.
If you do not know how the drive will operate, it can cause serious injury or death. When you use DriveWorksEZ to
make custom programming, the drive I/O terminal functions change from factory settings and the drive will not
operate as written in this manual.
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not modify the drive body or drive circuitry.
Modifications to drive body and circuitry can cause serious injury or death, will cause damage to the drive, and will
void the warranty. Yaskawa is not responsible for modifications of the product made by the user.
Only let approved personnel install, wire, maintain, examine, replace parts, and repair the drive.
If personnel are not approved, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the drive is energized.
If you touch the internal components of an energized drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
After the drive blows a fuse or trips a GFCI, do not immediately energize the drive or operate
peripheral devices. Wait for the time specified on the warning label at a minimum and make sure
that all indicators are OFF. Then check the wiring and peripheral device ratings to find the cause of
the problem. If you do not know the cause of the problem, contact Yaskawa before you energize the
drive or peripheral devices.
If you do not fix the problem before you operate the drive or peripheral devices, it can cause serious injury or death.
Damage to Equipment
Do not apply incorrect voltage to the main circuit of the drive. Operate the drive in the specified
range of the input voltage on the drive nameplate.
Voltages that are higher than the permitted nameplate tolerance can cause damage to the drive.
Fire Hazard
Install sufficient branch circuit short circuit protection as specified by applicable codes and this
manual. The drive is suitable for circuits that supply not more than 100,000 RMS symmetrical
amperes, 240 Vac maximum (200 V Class), 480 Vac maximum (400 V Class).
Incorrect branch circuit short circuit protection can cause serious injury or death.
CAUTION
Crush Hazard
Tighten terminal cover screws and hold the case safely when you move the drive.
If the drive or covers fall, it can cause moderate injury.
NOTICE
Use an inverter-duty motor or vector-duty motor with reinforced insulation and windings applicable
for use with an AC drive.
If the motor does not have the correct insulation, it can cause a short circuit or ground fault from insulation
deterioration.
Damage to Equipment
When you touch the drive and circuit boards, make sure that you observe correct electrostatic
discharge (ESD) procedures.
If you do not follow procedures, it can cause ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Do not do a withstand voltage test or use a megohmmeter or megger insulation tester on the drive.
These tests can cause damage to the drive.
Do not operate a drive or connected equipment that has damaged or missing parts.
You can cause damage to the drive and connected equipment.
Do not use steam or other disinfectants to fumigate wood for packaging the drive. Use alternative
methods, for example heat treatment, before you package the components.
Gas from wood packaging fumigated with halogen disinfectants, for example fluorine, chlorine, bromine, iodine or
DOP gas (phthalic acid ester), can cause damage to the drive.
A - Warning label
◆ Cybersecurity
This product is designed to connect and communicate information and data through a network interface. It is the sole
responsibility of the customer to provide and continuously guarantee a secure connection between the product and the
customer's network or if applicable, any other network. The customer must establish and maintain the appropriate
measures (such as, but not limited to, the installation of firewalls, the application of authentication measures, the
encryption of data, the installation of antivirus programs, etc.) to protect the product, the network, its system and the
interface against all types of security breaches, unauthorized access, interference, intrusion, leakage and/or theft of
data or information. Yaskawa and its affiliates are not responsible for damages and/or losses related to such security
breaches, any unauthorized access, interference, intrusion, leakage and/or theft of data or information.
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
The motor will run after you de-energize the drive. PM motors can generate induced voltage to the
terminal of the motor after you de-energize the drive.
If you touch a motor that is moving or energized, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not operate the drive when covers are missing. Replace covers and shields before you operate
the drive. Use the drive only as specified by the instructions.
Some figures in this section include drives without covers or safety shields to more clearly show the inside of the
drive. If covers or safety shields are missing from the drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
If you do not ground the equipment correctly, it can cause serious injury or death if you touch the motor case.
Only let approved personnel install, wire, maintain, examine, replace parts, and repair the drive.
If personnel are not approved, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not wear loose clothing or jewelry when you do work on the drive. Tighten loose clothing and
remove all metal objects, for example watches or rings.
Loose clothing can catch on the drive and jewelry can conduct electricity and cause serious injury or death.
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
Connections that are too loose or too tight can cause incorrect operation and damage to the drive. Incorrect
connections can also cause death or serious injury from fire.
Damage to Equipment
Do not apply incorrect voltage to the main circuit of the drive. Operate the drive in the specified
range of the input voltage on the drive nameplate.
Voltages that are higher than the permitted nameplate tolerance can cause damage to the drive.
Fire Hazard
Do not put flammable or combustible materials on top of the drive and do not install the drive near
flammable or combustible materials. Attach the drive to metal or other noncombustible material.
Flammable and combustible materials can start a fire and cause serious injury or death.
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not modify the drive body or drive circuitry.
Modifications to drive body and circuitry can cause serious injury or death, will cause damage to the drive, and will
void the warranty. Yaskawa is not responsible for modifications of the product made by the user.
Sudden Movement Hazard
Make sure that you align the phase order for the drive and motor when you connect the motor to
drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3.
If the phase order is incorrect, it can cause the motor to run in reverse. If the motor accidentally runs in reverse, it
can cause serious injury or death.
CAUTION
Burn Hazard
Do not touch a hot drive heatsink. De-energize the drive, wait for a minimum of 15 minutes, then
make sure that the heatsink is cool before you replace the cooling fans.
If you touch a hot drive heatsink, it can burn you.
NOTICE
Damage to Equipment
When you touch the drive and circuit boards, make sure that you observe correct electrostatic
discharge (ESD) procedures.
If you do not follow procedures, it can cause ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Use the instructions in this manual to replace the cooling fans. When you do maintenance on the
fans, replace all the fans to increase product life.
If you install the fans incorrectly, it can cause damage to the drive.
Make sure that all connections are correct after you install the drive and connect peripheral
1.2 Inspection
Power electronics have limited life and can show changes in performance and deterioration of performance after years
of use in usual conditions. To help prevent these problems, it is important to do preventive maintenance and regular
inspection, and replace parts on the drive.
Drives contain different types of power electronics, for example power transistors, semiconductors, capacitors,
resistors, fans, and relays. The electronics in the drive are necessary for correct motor control.
Follow the inspection lists in this chapter as a part of a regular maintenance program.
Note:
Examine the drive one time each year at a minimum.
The operating conditions, environmental conditions, and use conditions will have an effect on the examination frequency for connected
equipment.
Examine the drive more frequently if you use the drive in bad conditions or in these conditions:
• High ambient temperatures
• Frequent starting and stopping
• Changes in the AC power supply or load
• Too much vibration or shock loading
• Dust, metal dust, salt, sulfuric acid, or chlorine atmospheres
• Unsatisfactory storage conditions.
Examine the cooling fans, circulation fans, and circuit • Check for a clogged or dirty fan.
board cooling fans. • Use the performance life monitor to check for correct fan operation.
Make sure that the drive output current is not more • Check for a load that is too heavy.
Load than the motor or drive rating for an extended period of
time. • Check the correct motor parameter settings.
DANGER! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not examine, connect, or disconnect wiring on an energized drive. Before servicing,
disconnect all power to the equipment and wait for the time specified on the warning label at a minimum. The internal capacitor
stays charged after the drive is de-energized. The charge indicator LED extinguishes when the DC bus voltage decreases below 50
Vdc. When all indicators are OFF, remove the covers before measuring for dangerous voltages to make sure that the drive is safe. If
you do work on the drive when it is energized, it will cause serious injury or death from electrical shock.
Table 1.2 Main Circuit Periodic Inspection Checklist
Inspection Area Inspection Points Corrective Action Checked
• Examine equipment for discoloration from too • Replace damaged components as necessary.
much heat or deterioration. • The drive does not have many serviceable parts and it could be necessary to
• Examine for damaged parts. replace the drive.
Dynamic Braking Examine the insulation for discoloration from too If there is discoloration in the option, check to make sure that the wiring is not
Option much heat. damaged. A small quantity of discoloration is not a problem.
Diodes, IGBT (Power Examine for dust or other unwanted material collected Use a vacuum cleaner to remove unwanted particles and dust without touching the
Transistor) on the surface. components.
Operation Check Check for increased vibration or unusual noise. Stop the motor and contact approved maintenance personnel as necessary.
1.3 Maintenance
The drive Maintenance Monitors keep track of component wear and tell the user when the end of the estimated
performance life is approaching. The Maintenance Monitors prevent the need to shut down the full system for
unexpected problems. Users can set alarm notifications for the maintenance periods for these drive components:
• Cooling fan
• Electrolytic Capacitor
• Soft charge bypass relay
• IGBT
Contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative for more information about part replacement.
◆ Replaceable Parts
DANGER! Electrical Shock Hazard. Do not examine, connect, or disconnect wiring on an energized drive. Before servicing,
disconnect all power to the equipment and wait for the time specified on the warning label at a minimum. The internal capacitor
stays charged after the drive is de-energized. The charge indicator LED extinguishes when the DC bus voltage decreases below 50
Vdc. When all indicators are OFF, remove the covers before measuring for dangerous voltages to make sure that the drive is safe. If
you do work on the drive when it is energized, it will cause serious injury or death from electrical shock.
You can replace these parts of the drive:
• Control circuit terminal board
• Cooling fan, circulation fan
• Keypad
Note:
Make sure that you use a keypad that has a flash number of 1004 or later. Keypads that have a flash number of 1003 or earlier will not show
characters correctly.
If there is a failure in the main circuit, replace the drive.
If the drive is in the warranty period, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative before you replace parts.
Yaskawa reserves the right to replace or repair the drive as specified by the Yaskawa warranty policy.
*1 If there is damage to parts that you cannot repair or replace, replace the drive.
Note:
These conditions are provided for the purpose of replacing parts to maintain performance. Unsatisfactory conditions or heavy use will make 1
it necessary for you to replace some parts more frequently than other parts. Performance life estimate is based on the yearly average of these
use conditions.
• Ambient Temperature Setting
–IP20/UL Open Type: 40 °C (104 °F)
–IP00/UL Open Type: 40 °C (104 °F)
–IP20/UL Type 1: 30 °C (86 °F)
–IP55/UL Type 12 Heatsink External Mounting; front side: 40 °C (104 °F)
–IP55/UL Type 12 Heatsink External Mounting; back side: 30 °C (86 °F)
• Load factor
80%
• Operating rate
24 hours a day
U4-03 Shows the total operation time of fans as 0 to 99999 hours. After this value is 99999, the drive automatically resets it
to 0.
Cooling fan
U4-04 Shows the total fan operation time as a percentage of the specified maintenance period.
U4-05 Electrolytic Capacitor Shows the total capacitor usage time as a percentage of the specified maintenance period.
U4-06 Soft charge bypass relay Shows the number of times the drive is energized as a percentage of the performance life of the inrush circuit.
U4-07 IGBT Shows the percentage of the maintenance period for the IGBTs.
Cooling Fan The cooling fan is at 90% of its expected Replace the cooling fan, then set o4-03 = 0 [Fan Operation
LT-1
Maintenance Time performance life. Time Setting = 0 h] to reset the cooling fan operation time.
LT-4 IGBT Maintenance The IGBT is at 50% of its expected performance Check the load, carrier frequency, and output frequency.
Time (50%) life.
IGBT Maintenance The IGBT is at 90% of its expected performance Replace the IGBT or the drive.
TrPC Time (90%) life. 10
◆ Related Parameters
Replace the component, then set o4-03, o4-05, o4-07, and o4-09 [Maintenance Setting] = 0 to reset the Maintenance
Monitor. If these parameters are not reset after the corresponding parts have been replaced, the Maintenance Monitor
function will continue to count down the performance life from the value that was reached with the old part. If the
Maintenance Monitor is not reset, the drive will not have the correct value of the performance life for the new
component.
Note:
The maintenance period changes for different operating environments.
Table 1.10 Maintenance Setting Parameters
No. Name Function
o4-03 Fan Operation Time Setting Sets the value from which to start the cumulative drive cooling fan operation time in 10-hour units.
Note:
When o4-03 = 30, the drive will count the operation time for the cooling fan from 300 hours and U4-03
[Cooling Fan Ope Time] will show 300 h.
o4-05 Capacitor Maintenance Setting Sets the value from which to start the count for the main circuit capacitor maintenance period as a percentage.
o4-07 Softcharge Relay Maintenance Set Sets as a percentage the value from which to start the count for the soft charge bypass relay maintenance time.
o4-09 IGBT Maintenance Setting Sets the value from which to start the count for the IGBT maintenance period as a percentage.
2004 - 2012 - - - -
Table 1.12 Cooling Fans and Circulation Fans (Three-Phase 400 V Class)
Circuit Board Cooling
Model Cooling Fan Circulation Fan Procedure Ref.
Fan
4002 - 4005 - - - - -
4075 - 4168 35
2 - - Procedure D
T103 - T168
4208 - 4302 37
2 - - Procedure E
T208 - T302
4371
2 1 - Procedure F 40
T371
4414
3 1 - Procedure F 40
T414
4477 - 4605
2 1 2 Procedure G 46
T477 - T605
4720
3 1 2 Procedure H 54
T720
■ Fan Removal
1. To remove the fan finger guard from the drive, push the hooks on the left and right sides of it and pull up.
A - Cooling fan
Figure 1.2 Remove the Cooling Fan
■ Fan Installation
2. Align the notch on the fan with the pin on the drive and install the cooling fan in the drive.
Figure 1.5 Put the Cable and Connector in the Drive Recess
*1 Make sure that the cable and connector are in the correct space.
4. Insert the fan finger guard straight until the hooks click into place.
■ Fan Removal
1. To remove the fan finger guard from the drive, push the hook on the back side of the fan finger guard and pull
up.
A - Cooling fans
Figure 1.8 Remove the Cooling Fans
2. Align the notches on the fans with the pins on the drive and install the cooling fans in the drive.
Figure 1.11 Put the Cables and Connectors in the Drive Recess
*1 Make sure that the cables and connectors are in the correct space.
4. Hold the fan finger guard at an angle and put the connector tabs on the fan finger guard into the holes on the
drive.
5. Push the hook on the back side of the fan finger guard and click it into place on the drive.
■ Fan Removal
1. To remove the fan finger guard from the drive, push the hooks on the left and right sides of it and pull up.
A - Cooling fans
Figure 1.15 Remove the Cooling Fans
■ Fan Installation
Reverse the removal procedure for fan installation.
1. Connect the relay connectors between the drive and cooling fans.
Figure 1.18 Put the Cables and Connectors in the Drive Recess
*1 Make sure that the cables and connectors are in the correct space.
4. Insert the fan finger guard straight until the hooks click into place.
■ Fan Removal
1. To remove the fan finger guard from the drive, push the hooks on the left and right sides of it and pull up.
A - Cooling fans
■ Fan Installation
Reverse the removal procedure for fan installation.
1. Connect the relay connectors between the drive and cooling fans.
Figure 1.24 Put the Cables and Connectors in the Drive Recess
*1 Make sure that the cables and connectors are in the correct space.
4. Push the hooks on the left and right sides of the fan finger guard and click it into place on the drive.
■ Fan Removal
1. To remove the fan finger guard from the drive, push the tabs on the left and right sides of it and pull up the
back side of the guard.
A - Cooling fans
Figure 1.27 Remove the Cooling Fans
■ Fan Installation
Reverse the removal procedure for fan installation.
1. Connect the relay connectors between the drive and cooling fans.
2. Align the notches on the fans with the pins on the drive and install the cooling fans in the drive.
Figure 1.30 Put the Cables and Connectors in the Drive Recess
5. Push the hooks on the left and right sides of the fan finger guard and click it into place on the drive.
■ Fan Removal
1. To remove the fan finger guards from the drive, push the hook on the back side of each guard and pull up.
A - Cooling fans
Figure 1.34 Remove the Cooling Fans
■ Fan Installation
Reverse the removal procedure for fan installation.
1. Connect the relay connectors between the drive and cooling fans.
Figure 1.37 Put the Cables and Connectors in the Drive Recess
*1 Make sure that the cables and connectors are in the correct space.
4. Hold the fan finger guards at an angle and put the connector tabs on the fan finger guards into the holes on
the drive.
Note:
When you install the cooling fans, make sure that you do not pinch cables between the fan finger guards and the drive.
5. Push the hooks on the back side of the fan finger guards and click them into place on the drive.
A - Circulation fan
1. Connect the relay connector between the drive and circulation fan.
1
A - Clamp
■ Fan Removal
1. Remove the drive cover.
CAUTION! Crush Hazard. Loosen the cover screws. Do not fully remove them. If you fully remove the cover screws, the
terminal cover can fall and cause moderate injury.
4. Remove the fan unit and the slide panel at the same time.
■ Fan Installation
Reverse the removal procedure for fan installation.
1. Connect the relay connectors on the fan unit base to the cooling fans and the circulation fan.
A - Screws
Figure 1.60 Slide the Circuit Board Cooling Fan Units
■ Fan Removal
1. Remove the drive cover.
CAUTION! Crush Hazard. Loosen the cover screws. Do not fully remove them. If you fully remove the cover screws, the
terminal cover can fall and cause moderate injury.
2. Unplug the fan cables from the fan connectors.
■ Fan Installation
Reverse the removal procedure for fan installation.
1. Connect the relay connectors on the fan unit base to the cooling fans and the circulation fan.
A - Screws
Note:
Make sure that you do not pinch cables between the circuit board cooling fan and the fan unit base.
A - Control circuit terminal block B - Control circuit terminal block fastening screw
• If you use power tools to tighten the terminal screws, use a low speed setting (300 to 400 r/min). Failure to obey can
cause damage to the terminal screws.
• Users can purchase wiring tools from Yaskawa. Contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative for more
information.
• Wire gauges on existing drive models to be replaced may not match wire gauge ranges on new drives. Contact
Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative for more information about the connection procedures.
• Do not tighten the terminal screws at an angle of 5 degrees or more. Failure to obey can cause damage to the
terminal screws.
• If you damage a terminal screw, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
A - Cable clamp
TSD-M 3NM
M4 Bit SF-BIT-SL 1,0X4,0-70 PHOENIX CONTACT (1.2 - 3 N∙m -
(10.6 - 26.6 lbf∙in))
Wire Gauge ≤
25 mm2 Wire Gauge ≤
(AWG 10):
TSD-M 3NM 25 mm2
(AWG 10): -
(1.2 - 3 N∙m
M5 *1 Bit SF-BIT-SL 1,2X6,5-70 PHOENIX CONTACT (10.6 - 26.6 lbf∙in))
Wire Gauge ≥
Wire Gauge ≥ 30 mm2
30 mm2 (AWG 8):
(AWG 8): - 4.1 - 4.5 N∙m
(36.3 - 39.8 lbf∙in) *2 *3
5 - 9 N∙m
Bit SF-BIT-HEX 5-50 PHOENIX CONTACT -
(44.3 - 79.9 lbf∙in) *2 *3
M6
Bit SF-BIT-SL 1,2X6,5-70 PHOENIX CONTACT - 3 - 3.5 N∙m
(26.6 - 31.0 lbf∙in) *2 *3
8 - 12 N∙m
M8 Bit SF-BIT-HEX 6-50 PHOENIX CONTACT - (70.8 - 106.2 lbf∙in) *2
*3
12 - 14 N∙m
M10 Bit SF-BIT-HEX 8-50 PHOENIX CONTACT - (106.2 - 123.9 lbf∙in) *2
*3
*1 When wiring drive models 2056, 4089, and smaller, select the correct tools for the wire gauge.
*2 Use 6.35 mm (0.25 in) bit socket holder.
*3 Use a torque wrench that can apply this torque measurement range.
1. Pull the wiring cover away from the drive to remove it.
Note:
6-Phase/12-pulse drives (models: Txxx) do not have the wiring covers.
A B
5. Check the terminal sign that you wired and use a nipper as shown in Figure 1.92 to clip the specified cutaway
section of the wiring cover.
Note:
6-Phase/12-pulse drives (models: Txxx) do not have the wiring covers.
A - Guides
Figure 1.94 Put the Terminal Block into the Connector
2. Use M3 screws to safety the terminal block.
Tighten the screws to a correct tightening torque:
• M3 screws: 0.5 N∙m to 0.6 N∙m (4.4 lbf∙in to 5.3 lbf∙in)
A - Battery
◆ Storage Location
• Temperature and Humidity
When you store the drive for approximately one month, for example during shipping, you can put the drive in a
location where the temperature is -20 °C to +70 °C (-4 °F to +158 °F). Correctly package and store the drive during
shipping to prevent vibration and impact damage.
Do not put the drive in direct sunlight or where there will be condensation or ice. Put the drive in a location where
the relative humidity is 95% or less.
• Dust and Oil Mist
Do not keep the drive locations with dust or oil mist. For example, cement factories and cotton mills.
• Corrosive Gas
Do not keep the drive in locations with corrosive gas. For example, chemical plants, refineries, and sewage plants.
• Salt Damage
Do not keep the drive in salty locations. For example, locations near the ocean, and salt damage-designated
locations.
Do not keep the drive in unsatisfactory locations. Keep all drives in storage rooms that are safe from unsatisfactory
elements.
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate the drive when covers are missing. Replace covers and shields before you operate
the drive. Use the drive only as specified by the instructions.
Some figures in this section include drives without covers or safety shields to more clearly show the inside of the
drive. If covers or safety shields are missing from the drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
Always ground the motor-side grounding terminal.
If you do not ground the equipment correctly, it can cause serious injury or death if you touch the motor case.
After the drive blows a fuse or trips a GFCI, do not immediately energize the drive or operate
peripheral devices. Wait for the time specified on the warning label at a minimum and make sure
that all indicators are OFF. Then check the wiring and peripheral device ratings to find the cause of
the problem. If you do not know the cause of the problem, contact Yaskawa before you energize the
drive or peripheral devices.
If you do not fix the problem before you operate the drive or peripheral devices, it can cause serious injury or death.
Only let approved personnel install, wire, maintain, examine, replace parts, and repair the drive.
If personnel are not approved, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not wear loose clothing or jewelry when you do work on the drive. Tighten loose clothing and
remove all metal objects, for example watches or rings.
Loose clothing can catch on the drive and jewelry can conduct electricity and cause serious injury or death.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the drive is energized.
If you touch the internal components of an energized drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not modify the drive body or drive circuitry.
Modifications to drive body and circuitry can cause serious injury or death, will cause damage to the drive, and will
void the warranty. Yaskawa is not responsible for modifications of the product made by the user.
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
Connections that are too loose or too tight can cause incorrect operation and damage to the drive. Incorrect
connections can also cause death or serious injury from fire.
Tighten screws at an angle in the specified range shown in this manual.
If you tighten the screws at an angle not in the specified range, you can have loose connections that can cause
damage to the terminal block or start a fire and cause serious injury or death.
Damage to Equipment
Do not apply incorrect voltage to the main circuit of the drive. Operate the drive in the specified
range of the input voltage on the drive nameplate.
Voltages that are higher than the permitted nameplate tolerance can cause damage to the drive.
WARNING
Fire Hazard
Do not put flammable or combustible materials on top of the drive and do not install the drive near
flammable or combustible materials. Attach the drive to metal or other noncombustible material.
Flammable and combustible materials can start a fire and cause serious injury or death.
Crush Hazard
Wear eye protection when you do work on the drive.
If you do not use correct safety equipment, it can cause serious injury or death.
Use a crane or hoist to move large drives when necessary.
If you try to move a large drive without a crane or hoist, it can cause serious injury or death.
NOTICE
Damage to Equipment
When you touch the drive and circuit boards, make sure that you observe correct electrostatic
discharge (ESD) procedures.
If you do not follow procedures, it can cause ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Do not break the electrical connection between the drive and the motor when the drive is
outputting voltage.
Incorrect equipment sequencing can cause damage to the drive.
Make sure that all connections are correct after you install the drive and connect peripheral
devices.
Incorrect connections can cause damage to the drive.
Note:
Do not use unshielded wire for control wiring. Use shielded, twisted-pair wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Unshielded wire can cause electrical interference and unsatisfactory system performance.
Troubleshooting
2
Faults • The keypad shows the fault code and and ALM/ERR of the LED Status Ring illuminate continuously.
• The drive shuts off output, and the motor coasts to a stop. Some faults let the user select a motor stopping method.
• Fault relay output MA-MC will turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF.
The drive will not operate until you clear the fault with a Fault Reset and the drive goes back to usual status.
When the drive detects a minor fault or an alarm, it will cause these conditions:
• The keypad shows the alarm code and and ALM/ERR on the LED Status Ring flash.
Minor Faults/Alarms • The drive will continue to operate the motor. Some alarms let the user select a motor stopping method.
• If the drive detects a minor fault, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will switch ON.
If you do not set parameters H2-01 to H2-03 , the drive will not trigger MFDO terminals when it detects a minor fault.
• The drive will not output a minor fault signal when it detects an alarm.
It is not necessary to do Fault Reset.
An error occurs when parameter settings do not agree or a parameter combination is incorrect. The drive will not operate until
you set the parameters correctly.
When the drive detects an operation error, these conditions will result:
Operation Errors
• The keypad shows the error code.
• Multi-function outputs do not output an alarm signal.
Find the parameters that caused the error and correct the settings.
An error occurs when you use the keypad for a backup, restore, or verify operation.
When the drive detects a copy function error, it will cause these conditions:
Copy Function Errors • The keypad shows the error code.
• Multi-function outputs do not output an alarm signal.
Push a key on the keypad to clear the error. Remove the cause of the error and try the backup, restore, or verify operation again.
Troubleshooting
CPF01 Control Circuit Error Illuminated Fault 85
CPF02 (0083)
Control Circuit Error Illuminated Fault 85, 85
CPF03 (0084)
CPF06 (0087) Control Circuit Error (EEPROM memory Data Error) Illuminated Fault 85
CPF07 (0088)
CPF08 (0089)
Control Circuit Error Illuminated Fault 85, 86 2
CPF10 (009B) - CPF14 (008F) Control Circuit Error Illuminated Fault 86 - 86
CPF16 (0091) - CPF23 (0098) Control Circuit Error Illuminated Fault 86, 87
CPF24 (0099) Control Circuit Error (Drive Unit Signal Fault) Illuminated Fault 87
CPF26 (009B) - CPF39 (00A8) Control Circuit Error Illuminated Fault 87, 89
Er-25 HighFreq Inject Param Tuning Err Flashing Auto-Tuning Error 134
Troubleshooting
FbH (0041) Excessive PID Feedback Illuminated Fault 93
oFA03 (0104) - oFA06 (0107) Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port (CN5-A) Illuminated Fault 97, 97
oFA10 (0111)
Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port (CN5-A) Illuminated Fault 97, 97
oFA11 (0112)
oFA12 (0113) - oFA17 (0118) Option Card Connection Error (CN5-A) Illuminated Fault 97 - 98
oFA30 (0131) - oFA43 (013E) Communication Option Card Connection Error (CN5-A) Illuminated Fault 98 - 100
oFb00 (0201) Option Not Compatible with Port Illuminated Fault 100
oFb03 (0204) - oFb11 (0212) Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port (CN5-B) Illuminated Fault 100 - 101
oFb12 (0213) - oFb17 (0218) Option Card Connection Error (CN5-B) Illuminated Fault 101 - 102
oFC00 (0301) Option Not Compatible with Port Illuminated Fault 102
oFC03 (0304) - oFC11 (0312) Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port (CN5-C) Illuminated Fault 102 - 103
oFC12 (0313) - oFC17 (0318) Option Card Connection Error (CN5-C) Illuminated Fault 103 - 103
oFC50 (0351) - oFC55 (0356) Option Card Error Occurred at Option Port (CN5-C) Illuminated Fault 103 - 104
oH4 (0020) Motor Overheat Fault (PTC Input) Illuminated Fault 105
oPE01 Drive Capacity Setting Fault Flashing Parameter Setting Error 124
oPE02 Parameter Range Setting Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 124
oPE03 Multi-Function Input Setting Err Flashing Parameter Setting Error 124
oPE05 Run Cmd/Freq Ref Source Sel Err Flashing Parameter Setting Error 125
oPE06 Control Method Selection Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 126
oPE07 Analog Input Selection Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 126
oPE09 PID Control Selection Fault Flashing Parameter Setting Error 127
oPE10 V/f Data Setting Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 127
oPE11 Carrier Frequency Setting Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 128
oPE13 Pulse Monitor Selection Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 128
oPE15 Torque Control Setting Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 128
oPE16 Energy Saving Constants Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 128
oPE18 Online Tuning Param Setting Err Flashing Parameter Setting Error 128
oPE33 Digital Output Selection Error Flashing Parameter Setting Error 129
Troubleshooting
rdEr Error Reading Data - Backup Function Runtime Error 135
vAEr Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch - Backup Function Runtime Error 136
2.4 Fault
This section gives information about some of the causes and possible solutions of faults. You must use the Fault Reset
operation to remove the fault before you can operate the drive. Use the information in this table to remove the cause
of the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bAT Keypad Battery Low Voltage The keypad battery voltage is low. Replace the keypad battery.
Note:
Use o4-24 [bAT Detection Selection] to enable/disable bAT detection.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bCE Bluetooth Communication Fault The smartphone or tablet with DriveWizard Mobile Use the smartphone or tablet 10 m (32.8 ft) or nearer to the keypad.
installed is too far from the keypad. Note:
bCE can occur when the smartphone or tablet is 10 m (32.8 ft)
or nearer to the keypad depending on the specifications of the
smartphone or tablet.
Radio waves from a different device are causing Make sure that no device around the keypad uses the same radio
interference with communications between the bandwidth (2400 MHz to 2480 MHz), and prevent radio
smartphone or tablet and keypad. interference.
Note:
• The drive detects this error when you use the Bluetooth LCD keypad and operate the drive with a smartphone or tablet.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Set the stopping method for this fault in o2-27 [bCE Detection Selection].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
boL BrakingTransistor Overload Fault The duty cycle of the braking transistor is high (the • Install a braking unit (CDBR-series).
regeneration power or repetition frequency is high). • Install a regenerative converter.
• Increase the deceleration time.
You enabled the protective function for the braking Set L8-55 = 0 [Internal DB TransistorProtection = Disable].
transistor when you have a regenerative converter.
The braking transistor in the drive is broken. Replace the entire drive.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bUS Option Communication Error The drive did not receive a signal from the controller. Correct wiring errors.
There is a short-circuit in the communications cable • Repair short circuits and connect cables.
or the communications cable is not connected. • Replace the defective communications cable.
Electrical interference caused a communication data • Examine the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground
error. wiring, and decrease the effects of electrical interference.
• Make sure that a magnetic contactor is not the source of the
electrical interference, then use a Surge Protective Device if
necessary.
• Use only the recommended cables or other shielded line. Ground
Troubleshooting
the shield on the controller side or the drive input power side.
• Separate the communication wiring from drive power lines, and
install a noise filter to the input side of the power supply for
communication.
• Decrease the effects of electrical interference from the controller.
The option is incorrectly installed to the drive. Correctly install the option to the drive.
The option is damaged. If the fault continues and the wiring is correct, replace the option.
2
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the Run command or frequency reference is assigned to the option card.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this error, the drive will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in F6-01 [Communication Error Selection].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CE Modbus Communication Error The communications cable wiring is incorrect. Correct wiring errors.
There is a short circuit in the communications cable • Repair short circuits and connect cables.
or the communications cable is not connected. • Replace the defective communications cable.
Electrical interference caused a communication data • Examine the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground
error. wiring, and decrease the effects of electrical interference.
• Make sure that a magnetic contactor is not the source of the
electrical interference, then use a Surge Protective Device if
necessary.
• Use only the recommended cables or other shielded line. Ground
the shield on the controller side or the drive input power side.
• Separate the communication wiring from drive power lines, and
install a noise filter to the input side of the power supply for
communication.
• Decrease the effects of electrical interference from the controller.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it does not correctly receive control data for the CE detection time set to H5-09 [CE Detection Time].
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this error, the drive will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in H5-04 [Communication Error Stop Method].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CF Control Fault Motor parameters are set incorrectly Correctly set the motor parameters and do Auto-Tuning again.
When A1-02 = 4 [Control Method Selection = When Rotational Auto-Tuning changes or the installation
Advanced Open Loop Vector], the drive takes long to environment changes, make sure that you do Line-to-Line
ramp to stop because of these settings: Resistance Tuning and set L8-20 = 0 [Control Fault & Step Out
• The torque limit setting is too low. Detect = Disabled].
• L3-11 = 1 [Overvoltage Suppression Select = Note:
Enabled]. After you set L8-20 = 0, do test runs and examine the drive to
• d5-01 = 1 [Torque Control Selection = Torque make sure that it starts and stops correctly.
Control].
The torque limit setting is too low. Adjust L7-01 to L7-04 [Torque Limit].
The load inertia is too large. • Adjust C1-02, C1-04, C1-06, and C1-08 [Deceleration Times].
• Set the frequency reference to the minimum output frequency,
and stop the Run command when the drive stops deceleration.
The drive is trying to ramp to stop a machine that Correctly set b1-03 [Stopping Method Selection].
cannot do ramp to stop or on a machine for which
deceleration is not necessary.
The motor and drive are connected incorrectly. Correct wiring errors.
Line-to-line Resistance Tuning is not done. Do Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance.
The drive received a Run command while the motor • Examine the sequence and input the Run command after the
was coasting. motor fully stops.
• Set b3-01 = 1 [Speed Search at Start Selection = Enabled].
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the torque reference is more than the torque limit for 3 seconds or longer while the drive ramps to stop.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CoF Current Offset Fault The drive starts operation while the induced voltage • Make a sequence that does not restart operation when induced
stays in the motor (during coasting to a stop or after voltage stays in the motor.
fast deceleration). • Set b3-01 = 1 [Speed Search at Start Selection = Enabled].
• Use Speed Search from Fmax or Fref [H1-xx = 61, 62] to do a
speed search through one of the external terminals.
Note:
When controlling the PM motor, External Speed Search
commands 1 and 2 operate the same.
CP1 Comparator 1 Limit Fault The monitor value set in H2-20 [Comparator 1 Examine the monitor value and remove the cause of the fault.
Monitor Selection] was in the range of H2-21
[Comparator 1 Lower Limit] and H2-22
[Comparator 1 Upper Limit].
Note:
• The drive detects this error when the terminal is set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 66 [MFDO Function Selection = Comparator1].
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Set the stopping method for this fault in H2-33 [Comparator1 Protection Selection].
CP2 Comparator 2 Limit Fault The monitor value set in H2-26 [Comparator 2 Examine the monitor value and remove the cause of the fault.
Monitor Selection] was outside the range of H2-27
[Comparator 2 Lower Limit] and H2-28
[Comparator 2 Upper Limit].
Note:
• The drive detects this error when the terminal is set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 67 [MFDO Function Selection = Comparator2].
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Set the stopping method for this fault in H2-35 [Comparator2 Protection Selection].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF00 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF01 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF02 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF03 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF06 Control Circuit Error (EEPROM The drive power supply was de-energized while a Set A1-03 = 2220, 3330 [Initialize Parameters = 2-Wire
memory Data Error) communication option entered a parameter Write Initialization, 3-Wire Initialization] and initialize the drive.
command.
Troubleshooting
information about how to replace the control board, contact
Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if there is an error in the data written to the drive EEPROM.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
2
CPF07 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
CPF08 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF10 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF11 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF12 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF13 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF14 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF16 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF17 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
CPF18 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF19 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF20 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF21 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF22 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF23 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Troubleshooting
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF24 Control Circuit Error (Drive Unit A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
Signal Fault) • If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
2
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF26 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
CPF27 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF28 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF29 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF30 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF31 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF32 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF33 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF34 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
CPF35 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF36 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF37 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF38 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CPF39 Control Circuit Error A drive hardware problem occurred. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dEv Speed Deviation The load is too heavy. Decrease the load.
Acceleration and deceleration times are set too short. Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Time].
The dEv detection level settings are incorrect. Adjust F1-10 [Speed Deviation Detection Level] and F1-11 [Speed
Deviation Detect DelayTime].
Troubleshooting
The load is locked up. Examine the machine.
The holding brake is stopping the motor. Release the holding brake.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the difference between the detected speed and the speed reference is more than the setting of F1-10 for longer than F1-11.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this error, the drive will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in F1-04 [Speed Deviation Detection Select].
2
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dv1 Z Pulse Fault The encoder option card or the encoder on the motor 1. Repair wiring errors and connect disconnected wires. Correctly
side is damaged. ground the shielded wire of the encoder cable.
2. Re-energize the drive
The encoder cable is disconnected or wired
incorrectly. 3. If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it does not detect a Z pulse during one motor rotation.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
dv2 Z Pulse Noise Fault Detection Noise interference along the encoder cable. Isolate the encoder cable from the drive output line or a different
source of electrical interference.
The encoder cable is disconnected or wired Examine for wiring errors or disconnected wires in the encoder
incorrectly. cable, and repair problems. Correctly ground the shielded wire of
the encoder cable.
The drive is operating a motor with 24 or more poles • Set F1-46 = 1 [dv2 Detection Method Selection =
at zero speed. MechanicalAngle Detection Method].
• Increase F1-17 [Deviation 2 Detection Selection].
• Increase F1-47 [Deviation 2 Detection Level].
Note:
If you change the setting of F1-47, the sensitivity of detection
for dv2 can decrease.
The PG option or the encoder on the motor side is Repair the wiring and re-energize the drive, then replace the PG
damaged. option or the encoder if the problem continues.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it detects more than one Z pulse per rotation for the number of rotations set in F1-17 [Deviation 2 Detection Selection].
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dv3 Inversion Detection E5-11 [Encoder Z-Pulse Offset] is set incorrectly. Correctly set the value for Δθ to E5-11 as specified by the values on
the motor nameplate.
There is a new encoder or the motor rotation direction Do Z Pulse Offset Tuning.
changed.
An external force on the load side rotated the motor. • Make sure that the motor is rotating in the correct direction.
• Find and repair problems on the load side that cause the motor to
rotate from the load side.
Noise interference along the encoder cable. Correctly ground the shielded wire of the encoder cable.
The encoder cable is disconnected or wired Examine for wiring errors or disconnected wires in the encoder
incorrectly. cable, and repair problems.
The setting for F1-05 [Encoder 1 Rotation Selection] Correctly connect the motor wiring for each phase (U, V, W).
is the opposite of the direction of motor rotation.
The drive incorrectly detected the motor magnetic When U6-57 [PolePolarityDeterVal] < 819, increase n8-84
pole position. [Polarity Detection Current]. Consult the motor manufacturer for
information about maximum setting values.
n8-84 [Polarity Detection Current] is too low. Increase n8-84 from the default. Consult the motor manufacturer for
information about maximum setting values.
Pole Position Detection failed. If you are using an IPM motor, do High Frequency Injection Auto-
Tuning.
The PG option or the encoder on the motor side is Repair the wiring and re-energize the drive, then replace the PG
damaged. option card or the PG if the problem continues.
The drive incorrectly detected the motor magnetic When U6-57 [PolePolarityDeterVal] < 819, set n8-84 [Polarity
pole position. Detection Current > default setting.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if:
–the torque reference and acceleration are in opposite directions.
–the speed reference and actual motor speed are more than 30% different for the number of times set to F1-18 [Deviation 3 Detection Selection].
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dv4 Inversion Prevention Detection An external force on the load side rotated the motor. • Make sure that the motor is rotating in the correct direction.
• Find and repair problems on the load side that cause the motor to
rotate from the load side.
• Disable detection of this fault for applications that rotate the
motor from the load side in the opposite direction of the speed
reference. The drive will not detect this fault if F1-19 = 0
[Deviation 4 Detection Selection = Disabled].
E5-11 [Encoder Z-Pulse Offset] is set incorrectly. Correctly set the value for Δθ to E5-11 as specified by the values on
the motor nameplate.
There is a new encoder or the motor rotation direction Do Z Pulse Offset Tuning.
changed.
Noise interference along the encoder cable. Correctly ground the shielded wire of the encoder cable.
The encoder cable is disconnected or wired Examine for wiring errors or disconnected wires in the encoder
incorrectly. cable, and repair problems.
The drive incorrectly detected the motor magnetic If the value for U6-57 [PolePolarityDeterVal] is lower than 819,
pole position. increase the value set in n8-84 [Polarity Detection Current].
Consult the motor manufacturer for information about maximum
setting values.
The setting of n8-84 [Polarity Detection Current] is Increase the n8-84 setting from the default. Consult the motor
too low. manufacturer for information about maximum setting values.
Pole Position Detection failed. If you are using an IPM motor, do High Frequency Injection Auto-
Tuning.
The PG option card or the encoder on the motor side Repair the wiring and re-energize the drive, then replace the PG
is damaged. option card or the PG if the problem continues.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the pulses in the opposite direction of the speed reference are more than the value set in F1-19.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dv7 Polarity Judge Timeout There is a disconnection in the motor coil winding. Measure the motor line-to-line resistance and replace the motor if a
coil is disconnected.
The screws on the drive output terminals are loose. Tighten the terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it cannot detect polarity in a pre-set length of time.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dWF1 EEPROM Memory DWEZ Data There is an error in the EEPROM peripheral circuit. • Re-energize the drive.
Error • If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
There is a problem with the EEPROM data. Set A1-03 = 2220, 3330 [Initialize Parameters = 2-Wire
Initialization, 3-Wire Initialization] to initialize the drive, then
upload the DriveWorksEZ project to the drive again.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if there is an error in the DriveWorksEZ program that was saved to EEPROM.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dWF2 DriveWorksEZ Fault 2 There was a fault in the DriveWorksEZ program. Examine the DriveWorksEZ program and remove the cause of the
fault. This is not a drive fault.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dWF3 DriveWorksEZ Fault 3 There was a fault in the DriveWorksEZ program. Examine the DriveWorksEZ program and remove the cause of the
fault. This is not a drive fault.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dWFL DriveWorksEZ Fault There was a fault in the DriveWorksEZ program. Examine the DriveWorksEZ program and remove the cause of the
fault. This is not a drive fault.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Troubleshooting
E5 MECHATROLINK Watchdog Timer The drive detected a watchdog circuit exception while Examine the MECHATROLINK cable connection. If this error
Err it received data from the controller. occurs frequently, examine the wiring and decrease the effects of
electrical interference as specified by these manuals:
• MECHATROLINK-II Installation Guide (MECHATROLINK
Members Association, manual number MMATDEP011)
• MECHATROLINK-III Installation Manual (MECHATROLINK
Members Association, publication number MMATDEP018)
Note:
2
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the stop method set in F6-25 [MECHATROLINK Watchdog Error Sel].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF0 Option Card External Fault The communication option received an external fault 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
from the controller. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input from the controller.
A programming error occurred on the controller side. Examine the operation of the controller program.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the alarm function on the external device side is operating.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the stop method set in F6-03 [Comm External Fault (EF0) Select].
EF1 External Fault (Terminal S1) MFDI terminal S1 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S1.
External Fault [H1-01 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S1, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF2 External Fault (Terminal S2) MFDI terminal S2 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S2.
External Fault [H1-02 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S2, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF3 External Fault (Terminal S3) MFDI terminal S3 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S3.
External Fault [H1-03 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S3, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF4 External Fault (Terminal S4) MFDI terminal S4 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S4.
External Fault [H1-04 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S4, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF5 External Fault (Terminal S5) MFDI terminal S5 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S5.
External Fault [H1-05 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S5, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF6 External Fault (Terminal S6) MFDI terminal S6 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S6.
External Fault [H1-06 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S6, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
EF7 External Fault (Terminal S7) MFDI terminal S7 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S7.
External Fault [H1-07 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S7, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF8 External Fault (Terminal S8) MFDI terminal S8 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S8.
External Fault [H1-08 = 20 to 2B] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S8, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Err EEPROM Write Error There was a problem with the EEPROM hardware. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. Contact
Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative to replace the
board.
Electrical interference corrupted the data while it was • Push ENTER Key.
writing to the EEPROM of the drive. • Set the parameters again.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
FAn Internal Fan Fault The circulation fan stopped operating correctly. • Examine circulation fan operation.
• Re-energize the drive.
• Examine U4-03 [Cooling Fan Ope Time] and U4-04 [Cool Fan
Maintenance]. If there is damage to the circulation fan or if the
performance life of the fan is expired, replace the fan.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
FAn1 Drive Cooling Fan Fault The cooling fan stopped operating correctly. • Examine cooling fan operation.
• Re-energize the drive.
• Examine U4-03 [Cooling Fan Ope Time] and U4-04 [Cool Fan
Maintenance]. If the performance life of the cooling fan is
expired or if there is damage to the fan, replace the fan.
Troubleshooting
• Examine U4-03 [Cooling Fan Ope Time] and U4-04 [Cool Fan
Maintenance]. If there is damage to the circulation fan or if the
performance life of the fan is expired, replace the fan.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
FbH Excessive PID Feedback The FbH detection level is set incorrectly. Adjust b5-36 [PID High Feedback Detection Lvl] and b5-37 [PID
High Feedback Detection Time].
2
There is a problem with the PID feedback wiring. Correct errors with the PID control wiring.
The feedback sensor is not operating correctly. Examine the sensors on the control device side.
A fault occurred in the feedback input circuit of the Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
drive. replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the PID feedback input is more than the level set in b5-36 for longer than b5-37.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the stop method set in b5-12 [Feedback Loss Detection Select].
FbL PID Feedback Loss The FbL detection level is set incorrectly. Adjust b5-13 [PID Feedback Loss Detection Lvl] and b5-14 [PID
Feedback Loss Detection Time].
There is a problem with the PID feedback wiring. Correct errors with the PID control wiring.
The feedback sensor is not operating correctly. Examine the sensors on the control device side.
A fault occurred in the feedback input circuit of the Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
drive. replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the PID feedback input is more than the level set in b5-13 for longer than b5-14.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the stop method set in b5-12 [Feedback Loss Detection Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
GF Ground Fault Overheating caused damage to the motor or the motor Measure the motor insulation resistance, and replace the motor if
insulation is not satisfactory. there is electrical conduction or unserviceable insulation.
The motor main circuit cable is contacting ground to • Examine the motor main circuit cable for damage, and repair
make a short circuit. short circuits.
• Measure the resistance between the motor main circuit cable and
the ground terminal. If there is electrical conduction, replace the
cable.
An increase in the stray capacitance of the cable and • If the wiring length of the cable is more than 100 m, decrease the
the ground terminal caused an increase in the leakage carrier frequency.
current. • Decrease the stray capacitance.
There was a problem with the drive hardware. Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if a current short to ground was more than 50% of rated current on the output side of the drive.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• L5-08 [Fault Reset Enable Select Grp2] disables the Auto Restart function.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
HLCE High Level Communication Errors Communication data error occurred between the Examine the wiring between the option and the master drive and
option and the master drive when you use Gateway remove the cause of the fault.
function.
The master drive detects oFxxx and the slave drive
detects HLCE.
LF Output Phase Loss The motor main circuit cable is disconnected. Connect motor main circuit cable wiring. Correct wiring errors in
the main circuit drive input power.
There is a disconnection in the motor coil winding. If a coil is disconnected, measure the motor Line-to-Line Resistance
and replace the motor.
The screws on the drive output terminals are loose. Tighten the terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
The rated output current of the motor is less than 5% Examine the drive capacity or the motor output to be applied.
of the drive rated current.
You are trying to use a single-phase motor. The drive cannot operate a single-phase motor.
LF2 Output Current Imbalance Phase loss occurred in the wiring on the output side Examine for wiring errors or disconnected wires on the output side
of the drive. of the drive, and repair problems.
The output terminal screws of the drive are loose. Tighten the terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
There is not balance between the three phases of the • Measure the Line-to-Line Resistance for each motor phase and
PM motor impedance. make sure that resistance is equal in the three phases, and that all
wires are connected correctly.
• Replace the motor.
LSo Low Speed Motor Step-Out The motor code set incorrectly. • Set E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection] correctly as specified by
the motor.
• For specialized motors, refer to the motor test report and set E5-
xx correctly.
An external force on the load side caused the motor to Find and repair problems on the load side that cause the motor to
move at start. rotate from the load side.
The drive incorrectly detected the motor magnetic • Set b3-01 = 1 [Speed Search at Start Selection = Enabled].
pole position. • If the value for U6-57 [PolePolarityDeterVal] is lower than 819,
increase the value set in n8-84 [Polarity Detection Current].
Consult the motor manufacturer for information about maximum
setting values.
The setting of n8-84 [Polarity Detection Current] is Increase the n8-84 setting from the default. Consult the motor
too low. manufacturer for information about maximum setting values.
Incorrect values set in L8-93 [Low Speed Pull-out Increase the values set in L8-93 to L8-95.
DetectionTime], L8-94 [Low Speed Pull-out Detect
Level], and L8-95 [Low Speed Pull-out Amount].
The drive incorrectly detected the motor magnetic If you are using an IPM motor, do High Frequency Injection Auto-
pole position. Tuning.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if it detects step-out while running at low speed.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• LSo is a protective function that stops the motor and stops the reverse run if a motor without a motor code incorrectly detects the initial polarity. To quickly detect motor reversal,
decrease the values set in L8-93 to L8-95 to a range in which the drive does not malfunction.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
nSE Node Setup Error The H1-xx = 47 [Node Setup (CANopen)] terminal Stop the drive when the Node Setup function is in use.
was activated during run.
oC Overcurrent The load is too heavy. • Measure the current flowing into the motor.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity model if the current
value is more than the drive rated current.
• Decrease the load or replace with a larger drive to prevent
sudden changes in the current level.
Troubleshooting
Overheating caused damage to the motor or the motor Measure the motor insulation resistance, and replace the motor if
insulation is not satisfactory. there is electrical conduction or unserviceable insulation.
The motor main circuit cable is contacting ground to • Examine the motor main circuit cable for damage, and repair
make a short circuit. short circuits.
• Measure the resistance between the motor main circuit cable and
the ground terminal. If there is electrical conduction, replace the
cable. 2
A short circuit or ground fault on the drive output • Make sure that there is not a short circuit in terminal B1 and
side caused damage to the output transistor of the terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3. Make sure that there is not a
drive. short circuit in terminals - and terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3.
• If there is a short circuit, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
The acceleration time is too short. • Calculate the torque necessary during acceleration related to the
load inertia and the specified acceleration time.
• Increase the values set in C1-01, C1-03, C1-05, or C1-07
[Acceleration Times] to get the necessary torque.
• Increase the values set in C2-01 to C2-04 [S-Curve
Characteristics] to get the necessary torque.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
The drive is trying to operate a specialized motor or a • Examine the motor nameplate, the motor, and the drive to make
motor that is larger than the maximum applicable sure that the drive rated current is larger than the motor rated
motor output of the drive. current.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
A magnetic contactor was switched at the output. Set the operation sequence to not turn ON or OFF the magnetic
contactor while the drive is outputting voltage.
The V/f pattern settings are incorrect. • Examine the ratios between the V/f pattern frequency and
voltage. Decrease the voltage if it is too high compared to the
frequency.
• Adjust E1-04 to E1-10 [V/f Pattern Parameters]. For motor 2,
adjust E3-04 to E3-10.
The torque compensation gain is too large. Decrease the value set in C4-01 [Torque Compensation Gain] to
make sure that the motor does not stall.
Electrical interference caused a problem. Examine the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground
wiring, and decrease the effects of electrical interference.
The gain during overexcitation operation is too large. • Find the time when the fault occurs.
• If the fault occurs at the same time as overexcitation operation,
decrease the value set in n3-13 [OverexcitationBraking (OEB)
Gain] and consider the motor flux saturation.
The drive received a Run command while the motor • Examine the sequence and input the Run command after the
was coasting. motor fully stops.
• Set b3-01 = 1 [Speed Search at Start Selection = Enabled] or set
H1-xx = 61, 62 [Speed Search from Fmax or Fref] to input speed
search commands from the MFDI terminals.
In PM Control Methods, the setting of the motor code • Enter the correct motor code to E5-01 [PM Motor Code
is incorrect. Selection] as specified by the PM motor.
• For specialized motors, refer to the motor test report and set E5-
xx [PM Motor Settings] correctly.
If the drive detects the fault at start or in the low • Set E5-xx [PM Motor Parameters] correctly or do Rotational
speed range (10% or less) and n8-57 = 1 [HFI Auto-Tuning.
Overlap Selection = Enabled] for PM Control • Decrease the value of n8-41 [HFI P Gain] in 0.5 unit increments.
methods, the high frequency injection gain is too
high. Note:
Set n8-41 > 0.0 for an ordinary IPM motor.
The current flowing in the motor is more than the Correct the value set in L8-27.
value set in L8-27 [Overcurrent Detection Gain] for
PM Control Methods.
The control method is set incorrectly for the motor. Set A1-02 [Control Method Selection] correctly.
The motor main circuit cable is too long. Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
Speed search does not complete at start when you set When E9-01 = 0 [Motor Type Selection = Induction (IM)], set b3-
A1-02 = 8 [EZ Vector Control] and use an induction 24 = 2 [Speed Search Method Selection = Current Detection Speed
motor. Search].
An overcurrent occurred during overexcitation • Decrease the value set in n3-13 [OverexcitationBraking (OEB)
deceleration. Gain].
• Decrease the value set in n3-21 [HSB Current Suppression
Level].
Note:
• This fault occurs if the drive sensors detect a drive output current more than the specified overcurrent detection level.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA00 Option Not Compatible with Port The option connected to connector CN5-A is not Connect the option to the correct connector.
compatible. Note:
Encoder options are not compatible with connector CN5-A.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA01 Option Fault/Connection Error The option card connected to connector CN5-A is not 1. De-energize the drive.
compatible. 2. Refer to the option card manual and correctly connect the
option card to the connector on the drive.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFA02 Duplicate Options The same option cards or the same type of option Connect the option card to the correct connector.
cards are connected to connectors CN5-A, B, and C. Note:
Use connectors CN5-C and CN5-B to connect two encoder
option cards.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA03 Diagnostic Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA04 Flash Write Mode A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA05 Option A/D Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA06 Option Communication Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA10 Option RAM Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Troubleshooting
oFA11 Option Ope Mode Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions 2
oFA12 Drive Receive CRC Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFA13 Drive Receive Frame Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA14 Drive Receive Abort Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA15 Option Receive CRC Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA16 Option Receive Frame Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA17 Option Receive Abort Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA30 COM ID Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA31 Type Code Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA32 SUM Check Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFA33 Option Receive Time Over A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA34 Memobus Time Over A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA35 Drive Receive Time Over 1 A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA36 CI Check Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA37 Drive Receive Time Over 2 A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA38 Control Reference Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Troubleshooting
oFA39 Drive Receive Time Over 3 A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions 2
oFA40 CtrlResSel 1Err A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFA41 Drive Receive Time Over 4 A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA42 CtrlResSel 2Err A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFA43 Drive Receive Time Over 5 A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb00 Option Not Compatible with Port The option connected to connector CN5-B is not Connect the option to the correct connector.
compatible. Note:
DO-A3, AO-A3, PG-B3, and PG-X3 options can connect to
connector CN5-B. To connect only one PG option card, use the
CN5-C connector.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb01 Option Fault/Connection Error The option card connected to connector CN5-B was 1. De-energize the drive.
changed during operation. 2. Refer to the option card manual and correctly connect the
option card to the connector on the drive.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb02 Duplicate Options The same option cards or the same type of option Connect the option card to the correct connector.
cards are connected to connectors CN5-A, B, and C.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb03 Diagnostic Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb04 Flash Write Mode A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb05 Option A/D Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFb06 Option Communication Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb10 Option RAM Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb11 Option Ope Mode Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb12 Drive Receive CRC Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb13 Drive Receive Frame Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFb14 Drive Receive Abort Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Troubleshooting
oFb15 Option Receive CRC Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions 2
oFb16 Option Receive Frame Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFb17 Option Receive Abort Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC00 Option Not Compatible with Port The option connected to connector CN5-C is not Connect the option to the correct connector.
compatible. Note:
AI-A3, DI-A3, and communication options cannot be connected
to the CN5-C connector.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC01 Option Fault/Connection Error The option card connected to connector CN5-C was 1. De-energize the drive.
changed during operation. 2. Refer to the option card manual and correctly connect the
option card to the connector on the drive.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC02 Duplicate Options The same option cards or the same type of option Connect the option card to the correct connector.
cards are connected to connectors CN5-A, B, and C.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC03 Diagnostic Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC04 Flash Write Mode A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC05 Option A/D Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC06 Option Card Error Occurred at A fault occurred in the option. 1. De-energize the drive.
Option Port (CN5-C) 2. Make sure that the option is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. Re-energize the drive. If the problem continues, replace the
option.
You re-energized the drive when: 1. De-energize the drive main circuit power supply and the
• There is an encoder option installed the drive external 24 V power supply to terminals PS-AC.
• The drive main circuit power supply is energized 2. After the keypad display goes out, energize the drive main
circuit power supply again.
• There is an external 24 V power supply connected
to terminals PS-AC. 3. Supply the external 24 V power to terminals PS-AC.
When you use an encoder, de-energize the drive main circuit power
supply.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFC10 Option RAM Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC11 Option Ope Mode Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC12 Drive Receive CRC Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC13 Drive Receive Frame Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC14 Drive Receive Abort Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC15 Option Receive CRC Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Troubleshooting
oFC16 Option Receive Frame Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions 2
oFC17 Option Receive Abort Error A fault occurred in the option card. 1. De-energize the drive.
2. Make sure that the option card is correctly connected to the
connector.
3. If the problem continues, replace the option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC50 EncOp A/D CnvErr A fault occurred in the option card. Refer to the manual for the PG-RT3 or PG-F3 option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
oFC51 EncOpAnlgCrctErr A fault occurred in the option card. Refer to the manual for the PG-RT3 or PG-F3 option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC52 Enc Com Timeout A fault occurred in the option card. Refer to the manual for the PG-RT3 or PG-F3 option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC53 Enc Com Data Flt A fault occurred in the option card. Refer to the manual for the PG-RT3 or PG-F3 option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC54 Encoder Error A fault occurred in the option card. Refer to the manual for the PG-RT3 or PG-F3 option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oFC55 Resolver Error A fault occurred in the option card. Refer to the manual for the PG-RT3 or PG-F3 option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oH Heatsink Overheat The ambient temperature is high and the heatsink • Measure the ambient temperature.
temperature of the drive is more than the value set in • Increase the airflow in the control panel.
L8-02 [Overheat Alarm Level].
• Install a cooling device (cooling fan or air conditioner) to lower
the ambient temperature.
• Remove objects near the drive that are producing too much heat.
The internal cooling fan of the drive stopped. 1. Use the procedures in this manual to replace the cooling fan.
2. Set o4-03 = 0 [Fan Operation Time Setting = 0 h].
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the heatsink temperature of the drive is more than the value set in L8-02.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L8-03 [Overheat Pre-Alarm Selection].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oH1 Heatsink Overheat The ambient temperature is high and the heatsink • Measure the ambient temperature.
temperature of the drive is more than the oH1 • Increase the airflow in the control panel.
detection level.
• Install a cooling device (cooling fan or air conditioner) to lower
the ambient temperature.
• Remove objects near the drive that are producing too much heat.
oH3 Motor Overheat (PTC Input) The thermistor wiring that detects motor temperature Correct wiring errors.
is defective.
A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault
Example: The machine is locked.
The motor has overheated. • Check the load level, acceleration/deceleration time, and motor
start/stop frequency (cycle time).
• Decrease the load.
• Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Times].
• Set E2-01 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)] correctly to the value
specified by the motor nameplate.
• Make sure that the motor cooling system is operating correctly,
and repair or replace it if it is damaged.
• Adjust E1-04 to E1-10 [V/f Pattern Parameters]. For motor 2,
adjust E3-04 to E3-10. Decrease the values set in E1-08 [Mid
Point A Voltage] and E1-10 [Minimum Output Voltage].
Note:
If the values set in E1-08 and E1-10 are too low, the overload
tolerance will decrease at low speeds.
Note:
• When H3-02, H3-10, or H3-06 = E [MFAI Function Selection = Motor Temperature (PTC Input)], the drive detects this fault if the motor overheat signal entered to an analog
input terminal A1, A2, or A3 is more than the alarm detection level.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L1-03 [Motor Thermistor oH Alarm Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oH4 Motor Overheat Fault (PTC Input) The motor has overheated. • Check the load level, acceleration/deceleration time, and motor
start/stop frequency (cycle time).
• Decrease the load.
• Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Times].
• Set E2-01 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)] correctly to the value
specified by the motor nameplate.
• Make sure that the motor cooling system is operating correctly,
and repair or replace it if it is damaged.
• Adjust E1-04 to E1-10 [V/f Pattern Parameters]. For motor 2,
adjust E3-04 to E3-10. Decrease the values set in E1-08 [Mid
Point A Voltage] and E1-10 [Minimum Output Voltage].
Note:
If the values set in E1-08 and E1-10 are too low, the overload
tolerance will decrease at low speeds.
Note:
• When H3-02, H3-10, or H3-06 = E [MFAI Function Selection = Motor Temperature (PTC Input)], the drive detects this fault if the motor overheat signal entered to an analog
input terminal A1, A2, or A3 is more than the alarm detection level.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL1 Motor Overload The load is too heavy. Decrease the load.
Note:
Reset oL1 when U4-16 [Motor oL1 Level] < 100.
The acceleration/deceleration times or cycle times are • Examine the acceleration/deceleration times and the motor start/
too short. stop frequencies (cycle times).
• Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Times].
Overload occurred while running at low speed. • Decrease the load when running at low speed.
Troubleshooting
• Increase the motor speed.
• If the motor is run frequently at low speeds, replace the motor
with a larger motor or use a drive-dedicated motor.
Note:
For general-purpose motors, overload can occur while running
at low speed when operating at below the rated current.
L1-01 [Motor Overload (oL1) Protection] is set Set L1-01 in as specified by the motor qualities for a drive-dedicated
incorrectly. motor. 2
The V/f pattern does not fit the motor qualities. • Examine the ratios between the V/f pattern frequency and
voltage. Decrease the voltage if it is too high compared to the
frequency.
• Adjust E1-04 to E1-10 [V/f Pattern Parameters]. For motor 2,
adjust E3-04 to E3-10. Decrease the values set in E1-08 [Mid
Point A Voltage] and E1-10 [Minimum Output Voltage].
Note:
If the values set in E1-08 and E1-10 are too low, the overload
tolerance will decrease at low speeds.
E1-06 [Base Frequency] is set incorrectly. Set E1-06 to the rated frequency shown on the motor nameplate.
One drive is operating more than one motor. Set L1-01 = 0 [Motor Overload (oL1) Protection = Disabled],
connect thermal overload relay to each motor to prevent damage to
the motor.
The electronic thermal protector qualities and the • Examine the motor qualities and set L1-01 [Motor Overload
motor overload properties do not align. (oL1) Protection] correctly.
• Connect a thermal overload relay to the motor.
The electronic thermal protector is operating at an Set E2-01 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)] correctly to the value
incorrect level. specified by the motor nameplate.
There is increased motor loss from overexcitation • Lower the value set in n3-13 [OverexcitationBraking (OEB)
operation. Gain].
• Set L3-04 ≠ 4 [Stall Prevention during Decel ≠ Overexcitation/
High Flux].
• Set n3-23 = 0 [Overexcitation Braking Operation = Disabled].
The speed search-related parameters are set • Examine the settings for all speed search related parameters.
incorrectly. • Adjust b3-03 [Speed Search Deceleration Time].
• Set b3-24 = 1 [Speed Search Method Selection = Speed
Estimation] after Auto-Tuning.
Phase loss in the input power supply is causing the Make sure that there is no phase loss, and repair problems.
output current to change.
Overload occurred during overexcitation deceleration. • Decrease the value set in n3-13 [OverexcitationBraking (OEB)
Gain].
• Decrease the value set in n3-21 [HSB Current Suppression
Level].
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the electronic thermal protector of the drive started the motor overload protection.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• L5-07 [Fault Reset Enable Select Grp1] disables the Auto Restart function.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL2 Drive Overload The load is too large. Decrease the load.
The acceleration/deceleration times or cycle times are • Examine the acceleration/deceleration times and the motor start/
too short. stop frequencies (cycle times).
• Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Times].
The V/f pattern does not fit the motor qualities. • Examine the ratios between the V/f pattern frequency and
voltage. Decrease the voltage if it is too high compared to the
frequency.
• Adjust E1-04 to E1-10 [V/f Pattern Parameters]. Decrease the
values set in E1-08 [Mid Point A Voltage] and E1-10 [Minimum
Output Voltage]. For motor 2, adjust E3-04 to E3-10.
Note:
If the values set in E1-08 and E1-10 are too low, the overload
tolerance will decrease at low speeds.
The drive capacity is too small. Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
Overload occurred while running at low speed. • Decrease the load when running at low speed.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
• Decrease the value set in C6-02 [Carrier Frequency Selection].
The torque compensation gain is too large. Decrease the value set in C4-01 [Torque Compensation Gain] to
make sure that the motor does not stall.
The speed search-related parameters are set • Examine the settings for all speed search-related parameters.
incorrectly. • Adjust b3-03 [Speed Search Deceleration Time].
• Set b3-24 = 1 [Speed Search Method Selection = Speed
Estimation] after Auto-Tuning.
Phase loss in the input power supply is causing the • Correct errors with the wiring for main circuit drive input power.
output current to change. • Make sure that there is no phase loss, and repair problems.
Overload occurred during overexcitation deceleration. • Decrease the value set in n3-13 [OverexcitationBraking (OEB)
Gain].
• Decrease the value set in n3-21 [HSB Current Suppression
Level].
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the electronic thermal protector of the drive started the drive overload protection.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• L5-07 [Fault Reset Enable Select Grp1] disables the Auto Restart function.
oL3 Overtorque Detection 1 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: The machine is locked.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-02 [Torque Detection Level 1] and L6-03 [Torque
Detection Time 1] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the drive output current is more than the level set in L6-02 for longer than L6-03.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-01 [Torque Detection Selection 1].
• L5-07 [Fault Reset Enable Select Grp1] disables the Auto Restart function.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL4 Overtorque Detection 2 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: The machine is locked.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-05 [Torque Detection Level 2] and L6-06 [Torque
Detection Time 2] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the drive output current is more than the level set in L6-05 for longer than L6-06.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-04 [Torque Detection Selection 2].
• L5-07 [Fault Reset Enable Select Grp1] disables the Auto Restart function.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL5 Mechanical Weakening Detection 1 The drive detected overtorque as specified by the Do a deterioration diagnostic test on the machine side.
conditions for mechanical weakening detection set in
L6-08 [Mechanical Fatigue Detect Select].
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-08.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL7 High Slip Braking Overload The load inertia is too large. • Decrease deceleration times in C1-02, C1-04, C1-06, and C1-08
[Deceleration Times] for applications that do not use High Slip
An external force on the load side rotated the motor. Braking.
• Use a braking resistor to decrease the deceleration time.
Something is preventing deceleration on the load
side.
The value set in n3-04 [HSB Overload Time] is too • Increase the value set in n3-04.
small. • Connect a thermal overload relay to the motor, and set n3-04 =
1200 s (maximum value).
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the output frequency is constant for longer than n3-04.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oPr Keypad Connection Fault The keypad is not securely connected to the Examine the connection between the keypad and the drive.
connector on the drive.
The connection cable between the drive and the • Remove the keypad and then reconnect it.
keypad is disconnected. • Replace the cable if damaged.
Troubleshooting
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if these conditions are correct:
–o2-06 = 1 [Keypad Disconnect Detection = Enabled].
–b1-02 = 0 [Run Command Selection 1 = Keypad], or the drive is operating in LOCAL Mode with the keypad.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oS Overspeed There is overshoot. • Decrease C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1] and increase C5-02
[ASR Integral Time 1].
2
• Adjust the pulse train gain with H6-02 to H6-05 [Pulse Train
Input Setting Parameters].
There is an incorrect number of PG pulses set in the Set H6-02 [Terminal RP Frequency Scaling] to the pulse train
drive. frequency during 100% reference (maximum motor rotation speed).
The oS detection level is set incorrectly. Adjust F1-08 [Overspeed Detection Level] and F1-09 [Overspeed
Detection Delay Time].
If the drive detects the fault at start or in the low • Set E5-xx [PM Motor Parameters] correctly or do Rotational
speed range (10% or less) and n8-57 = 1 [HFI Auto-Tuning.
Overlap Selection = Enabled] for PM Control • Decrease the value of n8-41 [HFI P Gain] in 0.5 unit increments.
methods, the high frequency injection gain is too
high. Note:
Set n8-41 > 0.0 for IPM motors.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the motor speed is more than the value set in F1-08 for longer than F1-09.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in F1-03 [Overspeed Detection Selection].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
ov Overvoltage The deceleration time is too short and too much • Set L3-04 = 1 [Stall Prevention during Decel = General
regenerative energy is flowing back into the drive. Purpose].
• Increase the values set in C1-02, C1-04, C1-06, or C1-08
[Deceleration Times].
• Connect a dynamic braking option to the drive.
• Perform Deceleration Rate Tuning.
The acceleration time is too short. • Make sure that sudden drive acceleration does not cause the
fault.
• Increase the values set in C1-01, C1-03, C1-05, or C1-07
[Acceleration Times].
• Increase the value set in C2-02 [S-Curve Time @ End of Accel].
• Set L3-11 = 1 [Overvoltage Suppression Select = Enabled].
The braking load is too large. Connect a dynamic braking option to the drive.
There are surge voltages in the input power supply. Connect a DC link choke to the drive.
Note:
If you turn the phase advancing capacitors ON and OFF and use
thyristor converters in the same power supply system, there can
be surge voltages that irregularly increase the input voltage.
The drive output cable or motor is shorted to ground 1. Examine the motor main circuit cable, terminals, and motor
(the current short to ground is charging the main terminal box, and then remove ground faults.
circuit capacitor of the drive through the power 2. Re-energize the drive.
supply).
The speed search-related parameters are set • Examine the settings for all speed search related parameters.
incorrectly (this fault also occurs during recovery • Set b3-19 ≠ 0 [Speed Search Restart Attempts ≠ 0 times].
from momentary power loss and after Auto Restarts).
• Adjust b3-03 [Speed Search Deceleration Time].
• Do Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance and set
b3-24 = 1 [Speed Search Method Selection = Speed Estimation].
The power supply voltage is too high. Decrease the power supply voltage to match the drive rated voltage.
The braking resistor or braking resistor unit wiring is Correct wiring errors in the connection to the braking resistor or
incorrect. braking resistor unit.
The encoder cable is disconnected or wired Examine for wiring errors or disconnected wires in the encoder
incorrectly. cable, and repair problems.
Noise interference along the encoder cable. Isolate the encoder cable from the drive output line or a different
source of electrical interference.
Electrical interference caused a drive malfunction. • Examine the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground
wiring, and decrease the effects of electrical interference.
• Make sure that a magnetic contactor is not the source of the
electrical interference, then use a Surge Protective Device if
necessary.
The load inertia is set incorrectly. • Examine the load inertia settings with KEB, overvoltage
suppression, or stall prevention during deceleration.
• Adjust L3-25 [Load Inertia Ratio] to match the qualities of the
machine.
The Short Circuit Braking function used in OLV/PM Connect a braking resistor to the drive.
control method.
Speed Search at Start does not complete correctly Set b3-24 = 2 [Speed Search Method Selection = Current Detection
when: 2].
• A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZOLV]
• E9-01 = 0 [Motor Type Selection = Induction
(IM)]
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the DC bus voltage is more than the ov detection level while the drive is running.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• For 200 V class drives, the detection level of ov is approximately 410 V. For 400 V class drives, the detection level is approximately 820 V.
• L5-08 [Fault Reset Enable Select Grp2] disables the Auto Restart function.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
PE1 PLC Fault 1 The communication option detected a fault. Refer to the manual for the communication option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
PE2 PLC Fault 2 The communication option detected a fault. Refer to the manual for the communication option card.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
PF Input Phase Loss There is a phase loss in the drive input power. Correct errors with the wiring for main circuit drive input power.
There is loose wiring in the drive input power Tighten the terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
terminals.
The drive input power voltage is changing too much. • Examine the input power for problems.
• Make the drive input power stable.
• If the input power supply is good, examine the magnetic
contactor on the main circuit side for problems.
There is unsatisfactory balance between voltage • Examine the input power for problems.
phases. • Make the drive input power stable.
• Set L8-05 = 0 [Input Phase Loss Protection Sel = Disabled].
The main circuit capacitors have become • Examine the capacitor maintenance time in monitor U4-05
unserviceable. [CapacitorMaintenance]. If U4-05 is more than 90%, replace the
control board or the drive. For information about replacing the
control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
• If drive input power is correct and the fault stays, replace the
control board or the drive. For information about replacing the
control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the DC bus voltage changes irregularly without regeneration.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Use L8-05 to enable and disable PF detection.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
PGo Encoder (PG) Feedback Loss The encoder cable is disconnected or wired Examine for wiring errors or disconnected wires in the encoder
Troubleshooting
incorrectly. cable, and repair problems.
The encoder is not receiving power. Examine the encoder power supply.
The holding brake is stopping the motor. Release the holding brake.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it does not receive the speed detection pulse signal from the encoder in the detection time set in F1-14 [Encoder Open-Circuit Detect Time].
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in F1-02 [PG Open Circuit Detection Select].
2
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
PGoH Encoder (PG) Hardware Fault The encoder cable is disconnected. Connect any disconnected wires in the encoder cable.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Parameter F1-20 [Encoder 1 PCB Disconnect Detect] or F1-36 [Encoder 2 PCB Disconnect Detect] enables and disables PGoH detection.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in F1-02 [PG Open Circuit Detection Select].
rF Braking Resistor Fault The resistance of the dynamic braking option that is Use a dynamic braking option that fits the model and duty rating of
connected to the drive is too low. the drive.
rH Braking Resistor Overheat The deceleration time is too short and excessive • Check the load level, deceleration time, and speed.
regenerative energy is flowing back into the drive. • Decrease the load.
• Increase the values set in C1-02, C1-04, C1-06, or C1-08
[Deceleration Times].
• Use a dynamic braking option that lets you use more power.
The braking load is too heavy. • Calculate the braking load and braking power again, and
decrease the braking load.
• Use a braking resistor that improves braking power.
The braking resistor is not sufficient. Use the braking resistor specifications to select a sufficient braking
resistor.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the braking resistor overheat protective function is active.
• The magnitude of the braking load causes the braking resistor overheat alarm, NOT the surface temperature. If the duty cycle is higher than the braking resistor rating, the drive
will show the alarm.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Parameter L8-01 enables and disables rH detection.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
rr Dynamic Braking Transistor Fault The drive control circuit is damaged. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
There is a malfunction in the internal braking information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
transistor of the drive. or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
SC Short Circuit/IGBT Failure Overheating caused damage to the motor or the motor Measure the motor insulation resistance, and replace the motor if
insulation is not satisfactory. there is electrical conduction or unserviceable insulation.
The motor main circuit cable is contacting ground to • Examine the motor main circuit cable for damage, and repair
make a short circuit. short circuits.
• Measure the resistance between the motor main circuit cable and
the ground terminal. If there is electrical conduction, replace the
cable.
A short circuit or ground fault on the drive output • Make sure that there is not a short circuit in terminal B1 and
side caused damage to the output transistor of the terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3. Make sure that there is not a
drive. short circuit in terminals - and terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3.
• If there is a short circuit, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
SCF Safety Circuit Fault The safety circuit is broken. Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
SEr Speed Search Retries Exceeded The speed search-related parameters are set • Decrease b3-10 [Speed Estimation Detection Gain].
incorrectly. • Increase b3-17 [Speed Est Retry Current Level].
• Increase b3-18 [Speed Est Retry Detection Time].
• Do Auto-Tuning again.
The motor is coasting in the opposite direction of the Set b3-14 = 1 [Bi-directional Speed Search = Enabled].
Run command.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the number of speed search restarts is more than b3-19 [Speed Search Restart Attempts].
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
STPo Motor Step-Out Detected The motor code is set incorrectly for PM Control • Set E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection] correctly as specified by
Methods. the motor.
• For specialized motors, refer to the motor test report and set E5-
xx correctly.
The load is too large. • Increase the value set in n8-55 [Motor to Load Inertia Ratio].
• Increase the value set in n8-51 [Pull-in Current @ Acceleration].
If the drive detects STPo during deceleration when increasing the
value set in n8-51, set the value of n8-79 [Pull-in Current @
Deceleration] lower than n8-51.
• Decrease the load.
• Replace the drive and motor with larger capacity models.
The load inertia is too large. Increase the value set in n8-55.
The acceleration/deceleration times are too short. • Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Times].
• Increase the value set in C2-01 [S-Curve Time @ Start of Accel].
SvE Zero Servo Fault The value set in the torque limit is too small. Adjust torque limit-related parameters L7-01 to L7-04.
Noise interference along the encoder cable Isolate the encoder cable from the drive output line or a different
source of electrical interference.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if motor rotation position moves during Zero Servo.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
TiM Keypad Time Not Set There is a battery in the keypad, but the date and time Use the keypad to set the date and time.
are not set.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Parameter o4-24 [bAT Detection Selection] enables and disables TiM detection.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Troubleshooting
UL3 Undertorque Detection 1 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: There is a broken pulley belt.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-02 [Torque Detection Level 1] and L6-03 [Torque
Detection Time 1] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the drive output current is less than the level set in L6-02 for longer than L6-03.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
2
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-01 [Torque Detection Selection 1].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
UL4 Undertorque Detection 2 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: There is a broken pulley belt.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-05 [Torque Detection Level 2] and L6-06 [Torque
Detection Time 2] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the drive output current is less than the level set in L6-05 for longer than L6-06.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-04 [Torque Detection Selection 2].
UL5 Mechanical Weakening Detection 2 The drive detected undertorque as specified by the Examine the machine for deterioration.
conditions for mechanical weakening detection set in
L6-08 [Mechanical Fatigue Detect Select].
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-08.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Uv1 DC Bus Undervoltage There is a phase loss in the drive input power. Correct errors with the wiring for main circuit drive input power.
There is loose wiring in the drive input power Tighten the terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
terminals.
The drive input power voltage is changing too much. • Examine the input power for problems.
• Make the drive input power stable.
• If the input power supply is good, examine the magnetic
contactor on the main circuit side for problems.
The main circuit capacitors have become Examine the capacitor maintenance time in monitor U4-05
unserviceable. [CapacitorMaintenance]. If U4-05 is more than 90%, replace the
control board or the drive. For information about replacing the
control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
The relay or contactor on the soft-charge bypass relay U4-06 [PreChargeRelayMainte] shows the performance life of the
is damaged. soft-charge bypass relay. If U4-06 is more than 90%, replace the
board or the drive. For information about replacing the board,
contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the DC bus voltage decreases below the level set in L2-05 [Undervoltage Detection Lvl (Uv1)] while the drive is running.
• The Uv1 detection level is approximately 190 V for a 200 V class drives. The detection level is approximately 380 V for 400 V class drives. The detection level is approximately
350 V when E1-01 [Input AC Supply Voltage] < 400.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for this fault.
• L5-08 [Fault Reset Enable Select Grp2] disables the Auto Restart function.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Uv2 Control Power Undervoltage The value set in L2-02 [Power Loss Ride Through Connect the momentary power loss recovery unit to the drive.
Time] increased and the momentary power loss
recovery unit is not connected to the drive.
There was a problem with the drive hardware. • Re-energize the drive.
• If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive. For
information about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the control power supply voltage decreases.
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for this fault.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Uv3 Soft Charge Answerback Fault The relay or contactor on the soft-charge bypass relay • Re-energize the drive.
is damaged. • If the fault stays, replace the control board or the drive.
• Check monitor U4-06 [PreChargeRelayMainte] shows the
performance life of the soft-charge bypass relay. If U4-06 is
more than 90%, replace the board or the drive. For information
about replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your
nearest sales representative.
Note:
• Do a Fault Reset to clear the fault.
• Fault trace is not available for these faults.
AEr Station Address Setting Error The node address for the communication option is not • For CC-Link communication, set F6-10 [CC-Link Node Address]
in the permitted setting range. correctly.
• For MECHATROLINK communication, set F6-20
[MECHATROLINK Station Address] correctly.
• For CANopen communication, set F6-35 [CANopen Node ID
Selection] correctly.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bAT Keypad Battery Low Voltage The keypad battery voltage is low. Replace the keypad battery.
Note:
• If detected, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will switch ON.
• Set o4-24 [bAT Detection Selection] to enable/disable bAT detection.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bb Baseblock An external baseblock command was entered through Examine the external sequence and timing of the baseblock
one of the MFDI terminals Sx, and the drive output command input.
stopped as shown by an external baseblock command.
Note:
The drive will not output a minor fault signal for this alarm.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bCE Bluetooth Communication Error The smartphone or tablet with DriveWizard Mobile Use the smartphone or tablet 10 m (32.8 ft.) or nearer to the keypad.
installed is too far from the keypad. Note:
bCE can occur when the smartphone or tablet is 10 m (32.8 ft)
or nearer to the keypad depending on the specifications of the
smartphone or tablet.
Radio waves from a different device are causing Make sure that no device around the keypad uses the same radio
interference with communications between the bandwidth (2400 MHz to 2480 MHz), and prevent radio
smartphone or tablet and keypad. interference.
Note:
• The drive detects this error when you use the Bluetooth LCD keypad to operate the drive from a smartphone or tablet.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Selection = Alarm] will activate.
• Parameter o2-27 [bCE Detection Selection] enables and disables bCE detection.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
boL Braking Transistor Overload The duty cycle of the braking transistor is high (the • Install a braking unit (CDBR series).
regeneration power or repetition frequency is high). • Install a regenerative converter.
• Increase the deceleration time.
You enabled the protective function for the braking Set L8-55 = 0 [Internal DB TransistorProtection = Disable].
transistor when you have a regenerative converter.
Troubleshooting
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bUS Option Communication Error The communications cable wiring is incorrect. Correct wiring errors.
There is a short-circuit in the communications cable • Repair short circuits and connect cables.
or the communications cable is not connected. • Replace the defective communications cable.
2
Electrical interference caused a communication data • Examine the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground
error. wiring, and decrease the effects of electrical interference.
• Make sure that a magnetic contactor is not the source of the
electrical interference, then use a Surge Protective Device if
necessary.
• Use only the recommended cables or other shielded line. Ground
the shield on the controller side or the drive input power side.
• Separate the communication wiring from drive power lines, and
install a noise filter to the input side of the power supply for
communication.
• Decrease the effects of electrical interference from the controller.
The option card is incorrectly installed to the drive. Correctly install the option card to the drive.
The option card is damaged. If the alarm continues and the wiring is correct, replace the option
card.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the Run command or frequency reference is assigned to the option card.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in F6-01 [Communication Error Selection].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
bUSy Busy You set the drive to use MEMOBUS/Modbus Use MEMOBUS/Modbus communications to enter the enter
communications to change parameters, but you used command, then use the keypad to change the parameter.
the keypad to change parameters.
You tried to change a parameter while the drive was Wait until the process is complete.
changing setting.
CALL Serial Comm Transmission Error The communications cable wiring is incorrect. Correct wiring errors.
There is a short circuit in the communications cable • Repair the short-circuited or disconnected portion of the cable.
or the communications cable is not connected. • Replace the defective communications cable.
A programming error occurred on the controller side. Examine communications at start-up and correct programming
errors.
The termination resistor setting for MEMOBUS/ On the last drive in a MEMOBUS/Modbus network, set DIP switch
Modbus communications is incorrect. S2 to the ON position to enable the termination resistor.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it does not correctly receive control data from the controller when energizing the drive.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CE Modbus Communication Error The communications cable wiring is incorrect. Correct wiring errors.
There is a short circuit in the communications cable • Repair short circuits and connect cables.
or the communications cable is not connected. • Replace the defective communications cable.
Electrical interference caused a communication data • Examine the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground
error. wiring, and decrease the effects of electrical interference.
• Make sure that a magnetic contactor is not the source of the
electrical interference, then use a Surge Protective Device if
necessary.
• Use only the recommended cables or other shielded line. Ground
the shield on the controller side or the drive input power side.
• Separate the communication wiring from drive power lines, and
install a noise filter to the input side of the power supply for
communication.
• Decrease the effects of electrical interference from the controller.
The communication protocol is not compatible. • Examine the values set in H5-xx.
• Examine the settings on the controller side and correct the
difference in communication conditions.
The value set in H5-09 [CE Detection Time] is too • Change the controller software settings.
small for the communications cycle. • Increase the value set in H5-09.
The controller software or hardware is causing a Examine the controller and remove the cause of the problem.
communication problem.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it does not correctly receive control data for the CE detection time set to H5-09.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in H5-04 [Communication Error Stop Method].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CP1 Comparator 1 Limit Error The monitor value set in H2-20 [Comparator 1 Examine the monitor value and remove the cause of the error.
Monitor Selection] was in the range of H2-21
[Comparator 1 Lower Limit] and H2-22
[Comparator 1 Upper Limit].
Note:
• The drive detects this error when the terminal is assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 66 [MFDO Function Select = Comparator1].
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• H2-33 [Comparator1 Protection Selection] enables and disables CP1 detection.
CP2 Comparator 2 Limit Error The monitor value set in H2-26 [Comparator 2 Examine the monitor value and remove the cause of the error.
Monitor Selection] was outside the range of H2-27
[Comparator 2 Lower Limit] and H2-28
[Comparator 2 Upper Limit].
Note:
• The drive detects this error when the terminal is assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 67 [MFDO Function Select = Comparator2].
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• H2-35 [Comparator2 Protection Selection] enables and disables CP2 detection.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CrST Cannot Reset The drive received a fault reset command when a Run Turn off the Run command then de-energize and re-energize the
command was active. drive.
CyC MECHATROLINK The communications cycle setting of the controller is Set the communications cycle of the controller in the permitted
CommCycleSettingErr not in the permitted range of the MECHATROLINK range of the MECHATROLINK interface option.
interface option.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
CyPo Cycle Power to Accept Changes Although F6-15 = 1 [Comm. Option Parameters Re-energize the drive to update the communication option
Reload = Reload Now], the drive does not update the parameters.
communication option parameters.
dEv Speed Deviation The load is too heavy Decrease the load.
Acceleration and deceleration times are set too short. Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Time].
The dEv detection level settings are incorrect. Adjust F1-10 [Speed Deviation Detection Level] and F1-11 [Speed
Deviation Detect DelayTime].
The holding brake is stopping the motor. Release the holding brake.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the difference between the detected speed and the speed reference is more than the setting of F1-10 for longer than F1-11.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, the drive will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in F1-04 [Speed Deviation Detection Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dnE Drive Disabled A terminal set for H1-xx = 6A [Drive Enable] turned Examine the operation sequence.
OFF.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dWA2 DriveWorksEZ Alarm 2 There was an error in the DriveWorksEZ program. Examine the DriveWorksEZ program and remove the cause of the
error. This is not a drive fault.
Note:
Troubleshooting
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dWA3 DriveWorksEZ Alarm 3 There was an error in the DriveWorksEZ program. Examine the DriveWorksEZ program and remove the cause of the
error. This is not a drive fault.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
2
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
dWAL DriveWorksEZ Alarm There was an error in the DriveWorksEZ program. Examine the DriveWorksEZ program and remove the cause of the
error. This is not a drive fault.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
E5 MECHATROLINK Watchdog Timer The drive detected a watchdog circuit exception while Examine the MECHATROLINK cable connection. If this error
Err it received data from the controller. occurs frequently, examine the wiring and decrease the effects of
electrical interference as specified by these manuals:
• MECHATROLINK-II Installation Guide (MECHATROLINK
Members Association, manual number MMATDEP011)
• MECHATROLINK-III Installation Manual (MECHATROLINK
Members Association, publication number MMATDEP018)
Note:
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the stop method set in F6-25 [MECHATROLINK Watchdog Error Sel].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF FWD/REV Run Command Input A forward command and a reverse command were Examine the forward and reverse command sequence and correct
Error input at the same time for longer than 0.5 s. the problem.
Note:
• If the drive detects EF, the motor will ramp to stop.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF0 Option Card External Fault The communication option card received an external 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
fault from the controller. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input from the controller.
Programming error occurred on the controller side. Examine the operation of the controller program.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the alarm function on the external device side is operating.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• Set the stopping method for this fault in F6-03 [Comm External Fault (EF0) Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF1 External Fault (Terminal S1) MFDI terminal S1 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S1.
External Fault [H1-01 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S1, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF2 External Fault (Terminal S2) MFDI terminal S2 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S2.
External Fault [H1-02 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S2, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF3 External Fault (Terminal S3) MFDI terminal S3 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S3.
External Fault [H1-03 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S3, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF4 External Fault (Terminal S4) MFDI terminal S4 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S4.
External Fault [H1-04 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S4, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF5 External Fault (Terminal S5) MFDI terminal S5 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S5.
External Fault [H1-05 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S5, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF6 External Fault (Terminal S6) MFDI terminal S6 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S6.
External Fault [H1-06 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S6, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF7 External Fault (Terminal S7) MFDI terminal S7 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S7.
External Fault [H1-07 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S7, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EF8 External Fault (Terminal S8) MFDI terminal S8 caused an external fault through an 1. Find the device that caused the external fault and remove the
external device. cause.
2. Clear the external fault input in the MFDI.
The wiring is incorrect. Correctly connect the signal line to MFDI terminal S8.
External Fault [H1-08 = 2C to 2F] is set to MFDI Correctly set the MFDI.
terminal S8, but the terminal is not in use.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Troubleshooting
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
EP24v External Power 24V Supply The voltage of the main circuit power supply • Examine the main circuit power supply.
decreased, and the 24 V power supply is supplying • Turn ON the main circuit power supply to run the drive.
power to the drive.
Note:
• Set o2-26 [Ext. Power 24V Supply Display] to enable or disable EP24v detection.
• The drive will not output an alarm signal for this alarm.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
2
FAn Internal Fan Fault The circulation fan stopped operating correctly. • Examine circulation fan operation.
• Re-energize the drive.
• Examine U4-03 [Cooling Fan Ope Time] and U4-04 [Cool Fan
Maintenance]. If there is damage to the circulation fan or if the
performance life of the fan is expired, replace the fan.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Selection = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
FbH Excessive PID Feedback The FbH detection level is set incorrectly. Adjust b5-36 [PID High Feedback Detection Lvl] and b5-37 [PID
High Feedback Detection Time].
There is a problem with the PID feedback wiring. Correct errors with the PID control wiring.
The feedback sensor is not operating correctly. Examine the sensors on the control device side.
A fault occurred in the feedback input circuit of the Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
drive. replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the PID feedback input is more than the level set in b5-36 for longer than b5-37.
• If detected, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the stop method set in b5-12 [Feedback Loss Detection Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
FbL PID Feedback Loss The FbL detection level is set incorrectly. Adjust b5-13 [PID Feedback Loss Detection Lvl] and b5-14 [PID
Feedback Loss Detection Time].
There is a problem with the PID feedback wiring. Correct errors with the PID control wiring.
The feedback sensor is not operating correctly. Examine the sensors on the control device side.
A fault occurred in the feedback input circuit of the Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
drive. replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the PID feedback input is lower than the level set in b5-13 for longer than b5-14.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the stop method set in b5-12 [Feedback Loss Detection Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
HCA High Current Alarm The load is too heavy. • Decrease the load for applications with repetitive starts and
stops.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
The acceleration time is too short. • Calculate the torque necessary during acceleration related to the
load inertia and the specified acceleration time.
• Increase the values set in C1-01, C1-03, C1-05, or C1-07
[Acceleration Times] until you get the necessary torque.
• Increase the values set in C2-01 to C2-04 [S-Curve
Characteristics] until you get the necessary torque.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
The drive is trying to operate a specialized motor or a • Examine the motor nameplate, the motor, and the drive to make
motor that is larger than the maximum applicable sure that the drive rated current is larger than the motor rated
motor output of the drive. current.
• Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
The current level temporarily increased because of If speed search or Auto Restart cause an increase in current, the
speed search after a momentary power loss or while drive can temporarily show this alarm. The time that the drive
trying to Auto Restart. shows the alarm is short. No more steps are necessary to clear the
alarm.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the drive output current is more than the overcurrent alarm level (150% of the rated current).
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
L24v Loss of External Power 24 Supply The voltage of the backup 24 V power supply has • Examine the external 24 V power supply for disconnected wires
decreased. The main circuit power supply is operating and wiring errors and repair the problems.
correctly. • Examine the external 24 V power supply for problems.
Note:
• Set o2-23 [External 24V Powerloss Detection] to enable or disable L24v detection.
• The drive will not output an alarm signal for this alarm.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
LoG Com Error / Abnormal SD card There is not a micro SD in the keypad. Put a micro SD card in the keypad.
• The drive is connected to USB. Set o5-01 = 0 [Log Start/Stop Selection = OFF].
• The number of log communication files is more
than 1000.
• The micro SD card does not have available
memory space.
• The line number data in a log communication file
is not correct.
• A communication error between the keypad and
drive occurred during a log communication.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 6A [MFDO Function Selection = Data Logger Error] will activate.
LT-1 Cooling Fan Maintenance Time The cooling fan is at 90% of its expected performance 1. Replace the cooling fan.
life. 2. Set o4-03 = 0 [Fan Operation Time Setting = 0 h] to reset the
cooling fan operation time.
Note:
When the estimated performance life is expired, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 2F [MFDO Function Selection = Maintenance Notification] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
LT-2 Capacitor Maintenance Time The capacitors for the main circuit and control circuit Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
are at 90% of expected performance life. replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
When the estimated performance life is expired, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 2F [MFDO Function Select = Maintenance Notification] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
LT-3 SoftChargeBypassRelay MainteTime The soft charge bypass relay is at 90% of its expected Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
performance life. replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
When the estimated performance life is expired, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 2F [MFDO Function Select = Maintenance Notification] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
LT-4 IGBT Maintenance Time (50%) The IGBT is at 50% of its expected performance life. Check the load, carrier frequency, and output frequency.
Note:
When the estimated performance life is expired, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 2F [MFDO Function Select = Maintenance Notification] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oH Heatsink Overheat The ambient temperature is high and the heatsink • Measure the ambient temperature.
temperature is more than the L8-02 [Overheat Alarm • Increase the airflow around the drive.
Level].
• Install a cooling device (cooling fan or air conditioner) to lower
the ambient temperature.
• Remove objects near the drive that are producing too much heat.
There is not sufficient airflow around the drive. • Give the drive the correct installation space as shown in the
manual.
• Make sure that there is sufficient circulation around the control
panel.
• Examine the drive for dust or other unwanted materials that
could clog the cooling fan.
• Remove unwanted materials that prevent air circulation.
The internal cooling fan or fans have stopped. 1. Use the procedures in this manual to replace the cooling fan.
2. Set o4-03 = 0 [Fan Operation Time Setting = 0 h] to reset the
cooling fan operation time.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the heatsink temperature of the drive is more than L8-02.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• Set the stopping method for this fault in L8-03 [Overheat Pre-Alarm Selection].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oH2 External Overheat (H1-XX=B) An external device sent an oH2. 1. Find the external device that output the overheat alarm.
Troubleshooting
2. Remove the cause of the problem.
3. Clear the Overheat Alarm (oH2) [H1-xx = B] that was set to
MFDI terminals S1 to S6.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-02 = 10 [MFDO Function Selection = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oH3 Motor Overheat (PTC Input) The thermistor wiring that detects motor temperature Correct wiring errors. 2
is defective.
A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault
Example: The machine is locked.
The motor has overheated. • Check the load level, acceleration/deceleration time, and motor
start/stop frequency (cycle time).
• Decrease the load.
• Increase the values set in C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Times].
• Set E2-01 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)] correctly to the value
specified by the motor nameplate.
• Make sure that the motor cooling system is operating correctly,
and repair or replace it if it is damaged.
• Adjust E1-04 to E1-10 [V/f Pattern Parameters]. For motor 2,
adjust E3-04 to E3-10. Decrease the values set in E1-08 [Mid
Point A Voltage] and E1-10 [Minimum Output Voltage].
Note:
If the values set in E1-08 and E1-10 are too low, the overload
tolerance will decrease at low speeds.
Note:
• When H3-02, H3-10, or H3-06 = E [MFAI Function Selection = Motor Temperature (PTC Input)], the drive detects this fault if the motor overheat signal entered to an analog
input terminal A1, A2, or A3 is more than the alarm detection level.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in L1-03 [Motor Thermistor oH Alarm Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL3 Overtorque 1 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: The machine is locked.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-02 [Torque Detection Level 1] and L6-03 [Torque
Detection Time 1] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this fault if the drive output current is more than the level set in L6-02 for longer than L6-03.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• Set the conditions that trigger the minor fault using L6-01 [Torque Detection Selection 1].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL4 Overtorque 2 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: The machine is locked.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-05 [Torque Detection Level 2] and L6-06 [Torque
Detection Time 2] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the drive output current is more than the level set in L6-05 for longer than L6-06.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• Set the conditions that trigger the minor fault using L6-04 [Torque Detection Selection 2].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oL5 Mechanical Weakening Detection 1 The drive detected overtorque as specified by the Do a deterioration diagnostic test on the machine side.
conditions for mechanical weakening detection set in
L6-08 [Mechanical Fatigue Detect Select].
Note:
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this minor fault, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-08.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oS Overspeed There is overshoot. • Decrease C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1] and increase C5-02
[ASR Integral Time 1].
• Use H6-02 to H6-05 [Pulse Train Input Setting Parameters] to
adjust the pulse train gain.
There is an incorrect number of PG pulses set in the Set H6-02 [Terminal RP Frequency Scaling] to the pulse train
drive. frequency during 100% reference (maximum motor rotation speed).
The oS detection level is set incorrectly. Adjust F1-08 [Overspeed Detection Level] and F1-09 [Overspeed
Detection Delay Time].
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the motor speed is more than the value set in F1-08 for longer than F1-09.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in F1-03 [Overspeed Detection Selection].
ov Overvoltage There are surge voltages in the input power supply. Connect a DC link choke to the drive.
Note:
If you turn the phase advancing capacitors ON and OFF and use
thyristor converters in the same power supply system, there can
be surge voltages that irregularly increase the input voltage.
The drive output cable or motor is shorted to ground. 1. Examine the motor main circuit cable, terminals, and motor
(The current short to ground is charging the main terminal box, and then remove ground faults.
circuit capacitor of the drive through the power 2. Re-energize the drive.
supply.)
The power supply voltage is too high. Decrease the power supply voltage to match the drive rated voltage.
Electrical interference caused a drive malfunction. • Examine the control circuit lines, main circuit lines, and ground
wiring, and decrease the effects of electrical interference.
• Make sure that a magnetic contactor is not the source of the
electrical interference, then use a Surge Protective Device if
necessary.
• Set L5-01 ≠ 0 [Number of Auto-Restart Attempts ≠ 0 times].
The drive detects ov [Overvoltage] when: • Increase the value set in n2-03 [Automatic Freq Regulator Time
• The acceleration completes 2] in 50 ms increments.
• The deceleration starts Note:
• The load changes suddenly Make sure that you set n2-02 ≤ n2-03. When you adjust n2-03,
you must also increase the C4-06 [Motor 2 Torque Comp Delay
Time] value by same ratio.
• Increase C4-06 in 10 ms increments.
Note:
Make sure that you set C4-02 ≤ C4-06. When you adjust C4-06,
you must also increase the n2-03 value by same ratio.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the DC bus voltage is more than the ov detection level when there is no Run command (while the drive is stopped).
• The ov detection level is approximately 410 V with 200 V class drives. The detection level is approximately 820 V for 400 V class drives.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
ovEr Too Many Parameters Changed You tried to change more than 150 parameters. Make sure that parameters that do not have an effect on drive
operation are at their default settings.
Note:
• You can change 150 parameters maximum.
• If you change parameters that have dependencies, the drive
can detect ovEr when the number of changed parameters is
fewer than 150.
PASS Modbus Communication Test The MEMOBUS/Modbus communications test is The PASS display will turn off after communications test mode is
complete. cleared.
PF Input Phase Loss There is a phase loss in the drive input power. Correct all wiring errors with the main circuit power supply.
Loose wiring in the input power terminals. Tighten the screws to the correct tightening torque.
The drive input power voltage is changing too much. • Examine the supply voltage for problems.
• Make the drive input power stable.
Troubleshooting
Unsatisfactory balance between voltage phases. • Examine the supply voltage for problems.
• Make the drive input power stable.
• If the supply voltage is good, examine the magnetic contactor on
the main circuit side for problems.
The main circuit capacitors have become • Examine the capacitor maintenance time in monitor U4-05
unserviceable. [CapacitorMaintenance].
• If U4-05 is more than 90%, replace the capacitor. Contact
2
Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative for more
information.
PGo Encoder (PG) Feedback Loss The encoder cable is disconnected or wired Examine for wiring errors or disconnected wires in the encoder
incorrectly. cable, and repair problems.
The encoder is not receiving power. Examine the encoder power supply.
The holding brake is stopping the motor. Release the holding brake.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if it does not receive the speed detection pulse signal from the encoder in the detection time set in F1-14 [Encoder Open-Circuit Detect Time].
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in F1-02 [PG Open Circuit Detection Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
PGoH Encoder (PG) Hardware Fault The encoder cable is disconnected. Correct any disconnected wires in the encoder cable.
Note:
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will activate.
• Parameters F1-20 [Encoder 1 PCB Disconnect Detect] or F1-36 [Encoder 2 PCB Disconnect Detect] enable and disable PGoH detection.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the stopping method set in F1-02 [PG Open Circuit Detection Select].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
rUn Motor Switch during Run The drive received a Motor 2 Selection [H1-xx = 16] Make sure that the drive receives the Motor 2 Selection while the
during run. drive is stopped.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
SE Modbus Test Mode Error MEMOBUS/Modbus communications self- Stop the drive and do MEMOBUS/Modbus communications self-
diagnostics [H1-xx = 67] was done while the drive diagnostics.
was running.
Note:
If detected, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
STo Safe Torque OFF Safe Disable inputs H1-HC and H2-HC are open. • Make sure that the Safe Disable signal is input from an external
source to terminal H1-HC and H2-HC.
• When the Safe Disable function is not in use, use a jumper to
connect terminals H1-HC and H2-HC.
There is internal damage to the two Safe Disable Replace the board or the drive. Contact Yaskawa or your nearest
channels. sales representative to replace the board.
Note:
• The drive will not output an alarm signal for this alarm.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 21 [MFDO Function Select = Safe Torque OFF] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
SToF Safe Torque OFF One of the two terminals H1-HC or H2-HC received • Make sure that the Safe Disable signal is input from an external
the Safe Disable input signal. source to terminals H1-HC or H2-HC.
• When the Safe Disable function is not in use, use a jumper to
The Safe Disable input signal is wired incorrectly. connect terminals H1-HC and H2-HC.
There is internal damage to one Safe Disable channel. Replace the board or the drive. For information about replacing the
control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Selection = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
TiM Keypad Time Not Set You put a battery in the keypad, but you have not set Set the date and time with the keypad.
the date and time.
Note:
• Parameter o4-24 [bAT Detection Selection] enables and disables TiM detection.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Selection = Alarm] will activate.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
TrPC IGBT Maintenance Time (90%) The IGBT is at 90% of its expected performance life. Replace the IGBT or the drive. Contact Yaskawa or your nearest
sales representative for more information.
Note:
If the drive detects this error, the terminal set to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Selection = Alarm] will activate.
UL3 Undertorque Detection 1 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: There is a broken pulley belt.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-02 [Torque Detection Level 1] and L6-03 [Torque
Detection Time 1] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the drive output current is less than the level set in L6-02 for longer than L6-03.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-01 [Torque Detection Selection 1].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
UL4 Undertorque Detection 2 A fault occurred on the machine. Examine the machine and remove the cause of the fault.
Example: There is a broken pulley belt.
The parameters are incorrect for the load. Adjust L6-05 [Torque Detection Level 2] and L6-06 [Torque
Detection Time 2] settings.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if the drive output current is less than the level set in L6-05 for longer than L6-06.
• If detected, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-04 [Torque Detection Selection 2].
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
UL5 Mechanical Weakening Detection 2 The drive detected undertorque as specified by the Examine the machine for deterioration.
conditions for mechanical weakening detection set in
L6-08 [Mechanical Fatigue Detect Select].
Note:
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON.
• If the drive detects this error, it will operate the motor as specified by the Stopping Method set in L6-08.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
Uv Undervoltage The drive input power voltage is changing too much. • Examine the input power for problems.
• Make the drive input power stable.
• If the input power supply is good, examine the magnetic
contactor on the main circuit side for problems.
There is a phase loss in the drive input power. Correct errors with the wiring for main circuit drive input power.
There is loose wiring in the drive input power Tighten the terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
terminals.
The main circuit capacitors have become Examine the capacitor maintenance time in monitor U4-05
unserviceable. [CapacitorMaintenance]. If U4-05 is more than 90%, replace the
control board or the drive. For information about replacing the
control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
The drive input power transformer is too small and • Check for an alarm when a molded-case circuit breaker, Leakage
voltage drops when the power is switched on. Breaker (ELCB, GFCI, or RCM/RCD) (with overcurrent
protective function), or magnetic contactor is ON.
• Check the capacity of the drive power supply transformer.
Air inside the drive is too hot. Check the ambient temperature of the drive.
The Charge LED is broken. Replace the control board or the entire drive. For information about
Troubleshooting
replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Note:
• The drive detects this error if one of these conditions is correct when the Run command has not been input (while the drive is stopped).
–The DC bus voltage < L2-05 [Undervoltage Detection Lvl (Uv1)].
–The Contactor that prevents inrush current in the drive was opened.
–There is low voltage in the control drive input power.
• If the drive detects this error, the terminal assigned to H2-01 to H2-03 = 10 [MFDO Function Select = Alarm] will be ON. 2
oPE01 Drive Capacity Setting Error The value set in o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection] Set o2-04 to the correct value.
does not agree with the drive model.
oPE02 Parameter Range Setting Error Parameter settings are not in the applicable setting
range. 1. Push to show U1-18 [oPE Fault Parameter], and find
parameters that are not in the applicable setting range.
2. Correct the parameter settings.
Note:
• If more than one error occurs at the same time, other oPExx
errors have priority over oPE02.
Set E2-01 ≤ E2-03 [Motor Rated Current (FLA) ≤ Make sure that E2-01 > E2-03.
Motor No-Load Current]. Note:
If it is necessary to set E2-01 < E2-03, first lower the value set
in E2-03, and then set E2-01.
oPE03 Multi-Function Input Setting Err The settings for these parameters do not agree: Correct the parameter settings.
• F3-10 to F3-25 [Terminal D1 to DF Function
Selection]
• H1-01 to H1-08 [Terminals S1 to S8 Function
Selection]
• H7-01 to H7-04 [Virtual Multi-Function Inputs 1
to 4]
The settings for the standby mode function do not Correct the parameter settings.
agree:
• b8-50 = 0 [Standby Mode Selection = Disabled]
and H2-xx = 65 [MFDO Function Select =
Standby Output]
• b8-50 = 1 [Enabled] and H2-xx ≠ 65
The settings for MFDIs overlap. Set the parameters correctly to prevent MFDI function overlap.
Note:
This does not include H1-xx = 20 to 2F [MFDI
Function Select = External Fault] and
[Reserved].
These pairs of MFDI functions are not set to Digital Set the MFDI pairs.
Inputs (H1-xx, F3-10 to F3-25, and H7-01 to H7-04)
at the same time:
• Setting values 10 [Up Command] and 11 [Down
Command]
• Setting values 75 [Up 2 Command] and 76 [Down
2 Command]
• Setting values 42 [Run Command (2-Wire
Sequence 2)] and 43 [FWD/REV (2-Wire Sequence
2)]
A minimum of two of these MFDI combinations are Remove the function settings that are not in use.
set to Digital Inputs (H1-xx, F3-10 to F3-25, and H7-
01 to H7-04) at the same time:
• Setting values 10 [Up Command] and 11 [Down
Command]
• Setting values 75 [Up 2 Command] and 76 [Down
2 Command]
• Setting value A [Accel/Decel Ramp Hold]
• Setting value 1E [Reference Sample Hold]
• Setting values 44 to 46 [Add Offset Frequency 1 to
3 (d7-01 to d7-03)]
The parameter settings are enabled at the same time. • Set b5-01 = 0 [Disabled].
• b5-01 [PID Mode Setting] • Remove the function Up/Down command settings.
• H1-xx = 10 [Up Command]
• H1-xx = 11 [Down Command]
These commands are set in Digital Inputs (H1-xx, F3- Remove the function settings that are not in use.
10 to F3-25, and H7-01 to H7-04) at the same time:
• Setting values 61 [Speed Search from Fmax] and
62 [Speed Search from Fref]
• Setting values 65, 66, 7A, 7B [KEB Ride-Thru 1 or
2 Activate] and 68 [High Slip Braking (HSB)
Activate]
• Setting values 16 [Motor 2 Selection] and 1A
[Accel/Decel Time Selection 2]
• Setting values 65, 66 [KEB Ride-Thru 1 Activate]
and 7A, 7B [KEB Ride-Thru 2 Activate]
• Setting values 40, 41 [Forward RUN (2-Wire),
Reverse RUN (2-Wire)] and 42, 43 [Run
Command (2-Wire Sequence 2), FWD/REV (2-
Wire Sequence 2)]
• Setting values 60 [DC Injection Braking
Command] and 6A [Drive Enable]
• Setting values 16 [Motor 2 Selection] and 75, 76
[Up 2 Command, Down 2 Command]
Settings for N.C. and N.O. input [H1-xx] for these Remove one of the function settings.
functions were selected at the same time:
• Setting value 15 [Fast Stop (N.O.)]
• Setting value 17 [Fast Stop (N.C.)]
These settings were entered while H1-xx = 2 Connect an input option card to the drive.
[External Reference 1/2 Selection]:
• b1-15 = 3 [Option PCB] or b1-16 = 3 [Run
Command Selection 2 = Option PCB]
• No option card is connected to the drive.
These parameters are set at the same time: Correct the parameter settings.
• H1-xx ≠ 6A [Drive Enable]
• H2-xx = 38 [Drive Enabled]
These parameters are set at the same time: Correct the parameter settings.
• H6-01 ≠ 3 [PG Speed Feedback (V/F Control)]
• H1-xx = 7E [Reverse Rotation Identifier]
These parameters are set at the same time: Remove one of the function settings.
• H1-xx = 75/76 [Up 2 /Down 2 Command]
• H3-01, H3-05, H3-09 = 1 [Terminal A1, A2, A3
Troubleshooting
Signal Level Select = -10 to +10V (Bipolar
Reference)]
These parameters are set at the same time: Remove one of the function settings.
• H1-xx = 62 [Speed Search from Fref]
• H5-22 = 1 [Speed Search from MODBUS =
Enabled]
oPE05 Run Cmd/Freq Ref Source Sel Err The setting to assign the Run command or frequency Correct the parameter settings.
reference to an option card or the pulse train input is
incorrect.
The following parameters are set at the same time: Set H6-01 = 0.
• b1-01 = 4 [Pulse Train Input]
• H6-01 ≠ 0 [Terminal RP Pulse Train Function ≠
Frequency Reference]
The following parameters are set at the same time: Set F3-03 = 2 [16-bit].
• F3-01 = 6 [Digital Input Function Selection =
BCD (5-digit), 0.01 Hz]
• F3-03 = 0, 1 [Digital Input Data Length Select =
8-bit, 12-bit]
These parameters are set and there is an AI-A3 option Correct the parameter settings.
card connected to the drive:
• H1-xx = 2 [External Reference 1/2 Selection]
• b1-15 = 3 [Frequency Reference Selection 2 =
Option PCB]
• F2-01 = 0 [Analog Input Function Selection = 3
Independent Channels]
oPE06 Control Method Selection Error A1-02 = 1, 3, or 7 [Control Method Selection = CL- • Connect an encoder option to the drive.
V/f, CLV, CLV/PM] is set, but there is no encoder • Set A1-02 correctly.
option connected to the drive.
You supplied external 24 V power to terminals PS- 1. De-energize the drive main circuit power supply and the
AC when: external 24 V power supply to terminals PS-AC.
• There is an encoder option installed to the drive 2. After the keypad display goes out, energize the drive main
• The drive main circuit power supply is de- circuit power supply again.
energized 3. Supply the external 24 V power to terminals PS-AC.
When you use an encoder option, energize the drive main circuit
power supply.
oPE07 Analog Input Selection Error The settings for H3-02, H3-06, and H3-10 [MFAI Set H3-02, H3-06, H3-10, and H7-30 correctly to prevent overlap.
Function Select] and H7-30 [Virtual Analog Input Note:
Selection] overlap.
It is possible to set these functions to multiple analog input
terminals at the same time:
• Setting value 0 [Frequency Reference]
• Setting values F and 1F [Not Used]
The following parameters are set at the same time: Remove the function settings that are not in use.
• H3-02, H3-06, H3-10, H7-30 = B [PID Feedback]
• H6-01 = 1 [Terminal RP Pulse Train Function =
PID Feedback Value]
oPE08 Parameter Selection Error You set a function that is not compatible with the
control method set in A1-02 [Control Method 1. Push to show U1-18 [oPE Fault Parameter], and find
Selection]. parameters that are not in the applicable setting range.
2. Correct the parameter settings.
Note:
If more than one error occurs at the same time, other oPExx
errors have priority over oPE02.
When A1-02 = 2 [Control Method Selection = OLV], • Set n2-02 < n2-03.
you used these parameter settings: • Set C4-02 < C4-06.
• n2-02 > n2-03 [Automatic Freq Regulator Time 1
> Automatic Freq Regulator Time 2]
• C4-02 > C4-06 [Torque Compensation Delay
Time > Motor 2 Torque Comp Delay Time]
When A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], Correct the parameter settings.
you used these parameter settings: Note:
• H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse Train Function = You cannot use Speed Feedback (V/F Control) with the Motor
Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] Switch function.
• H1-xx = 16 [MFDI Function Select = Motor 2
Selection]
When A1-02 = 5 [PM Open Loop Vector], you set • Set E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection] correctly as specified by
E5-02 to E5-07 [PM Motor Parameters] = 0. the motor.
• For specialized motors, refer to the motor test report and set E5-
xx correctly.
When A1-02 = 5 to 7 [Control Methods for PM Set E5-09 or E5-24 to the correct value.
Motors], you used these parameter settings:
• E5-09 = 0.0 [PM Back-EMF Vpeak (mV/(rad/s))
= 0.0 mV/(rad/s)]
• E5-24 = 0.0 [PM Back-EMF L-L Vrms (mV/rpm)
= 0.0 mV/min-1]
When A1-02 = 5 to 7, you set E5-09 ≠ 0 and E5-24 ≠ Set E5-09 = 0 or E5-24 = 0.
0.
When A1-02 = 6 [PM Advanced Open Loop Vector], Correct the parameter settings.
you used these parameter settings:
• n8-57 = 0 [HFI Overlap Selection = Disabled]
• You set E1-09 [Minimum Output Frequency] < the
5% value of E1-06.
When A1-02 = 6, you set these parameters: Correct the parameter settings.
• n8-35 = 0 [Initial Pole Detection Method = Pull-
in]
• n8-57 = 1 [Enabled]
When A1-02 = 8 [EZOLV], you used these parameter When E9-01 = 1 or 2, set b3-24 = 1 [Speed Estimation].
settings:
• E9-01 = 1, 2 [Motor Type Selection = Permanent
Magnet (PM), Synchronous Reluctance (SynRM)]
• b3-24 = 2 [Speed Search Method Selection =
Current Detection 2]
oPE09 PID Control Selection Fault These parameters are set at the same time: • Set b5-15 ≠ 0.0.
• b5-15 ≠ 0.0 [PID Sleep Function Start Level ≠ 0.0 • Set b1-03 = 0, 1 [Ramp to Stop, Coast to Stop].
Hz]
• b1-03 = 2, 3 [Stopping Method Selection = DC
Injection Braking to Stop, Coast to Stop with
Timer]
These parameters are set at the same time: Correct the parameter settings.
• b5-01 = 1, 2 [Enabled (Standard), Enabled (D =
Feedforward)]
• d2-02 ≠ 0.0 [Frequency Reference Lower Limit ≠
0.0%]
These parameters are set at the same time: Correct the parameter settings.
• b5-01 = 1, 2 [Enabled (Standard), Enabled (D =
Feedforward)]
Troubleshooting
• b5-11 = 1 [PID Output Reverse Selection =
Negative Output Accepted]
These parameters are set at the same time: Correct the parameter settings.
• b5-01 = 3, 4 [Trim (Fref+PID Out, D = Fdbk),
Trim (Fref+PID Out, D = FeedFwd)]
• d2-02 ≠ 0.0 has been set.
Note: 2
The drive detects this error if the PID control function selection is incorrect.
(When b5-01 = 1 to 4 [PID Mode Setting = PID Control Enabled])
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
oPE10 V/f Data Setting Error The parameters that set the V/f pattern do not satisfy Set the parameters correctly to satisfy the conditions.
these conditions:
• For motor 1: E1-09 ≤ E1-07 < E1-06 ≤ E1-11 ≤
E1-04 [Minimum Output Frequency ≤ Mid Point A
Frequency < Base Frequency ≤ Mid Point B
Frequency ≤ Maximum Output Frequency]
• For motor 2: E3-09 ≤ E3-07 < E3-06 ≤ E3-11 ≤
E3-04 [Minimum Output Frequency ≤ Mid Point A
Frequency < Base Frequency ≤ Mid Point B
Frequency ≤ Maximum Output Frequency]
oPE11 Carrier Frequency Setting Error These parameters are set at the same time: Set C6-02 to C6-05 correctly.
• C6-05 > 6 [Carrier Freq Proportional Gain > 6]
• C6-04 > C6-03 [Carrier Frequency Lower Limit
> Carrier Frequency Upper Limit]
Note:
When C6-05 < 7, C6-04 becomes disabled. The
drive sets the carrier frequency to the value set to
C6-03.
C6-02 to C6-05 settings are not in the applicable
setting range.
oPE13 Pulse Monitor Selection Error H6-06 = 101, 102, 105, or 116 [Terminal MP Set H6-06 correctly.
Monitor Selection = Frequency Reference, Output
Frequency, Motor Speed, Output Frequency after Soft
Starter] has not been set when H6-07 = 0 [Terminal
MP Frequency Scaling = 0 Hz].
oPE15 Torque Control Setting Error More than one parameter is selecting torque control at Correct the parameter settings.
the same time.
• d5-01 = 1 [Torque Control Selection = Torque
Control]
• H1-xx = 71 [MFDI Function Select = Torque
Control]
Droop control and Feed Forward control are enabled Correct the parameter settings.
at the same time that torque control is selected.
• d5-01 = 1 or H1-xx = 71
• b7-01 ≠ 0.0 [Droop Control Gain ≠ 0.0%] or n5-
01 = 1 [Feed Forward Control Selection =
Enabled]
KEB Ride-Thru 2 (N.O., N.C.) is enabled at the same Correct the parameter settings.
time that torque control is selected.
• d5-01 = 1 or H1-xx = 71
• H1-xx = 7A [KEB Ride-Thru 2 Activate (N.C.)] or
H1-xx = 7b [KEB Ride-Thru 2 Activate (N.O.)]
After a momentary power loss, drive operation will Correct the parameter settings.
enable KEB when torque control is selected.
• d5-01 = 1 or H1-xx = 71
• L2-01 = 3, 4, 5 [Power Loss Ride Through Select
= Kinetic Energy Backup: L2-02, Kinetic Energy
Backup: CPU Power, or Kinetic Energy Backup:
DecelStop]
oPE16 Energy Saving Constants Error The Energy Saving parameters are not set in the Make sure that E5-xx is set correctly as specified by the motor
applicable setting range. nameplate data.
oPE18 Online Tuning Param Setting Err The parameters that control online tuning are set Set E2-02, E2-03, and E2-06 correctly.
incorrectly. In OLV control, one of these parameters
was set when n6-01 = 2 [Online Tuning Selection =
Voltage Correction Tuning]:
• E2-02 [Motor Rated Slip] is set to 30% of the
default setting or lower.
• E2-06 [Motor Leakage Inductance] is set to 50%
of the default setting or lower.
• E2-03 = 0 [Motor No-Load Current = 0 A] has
been set.
oPE20 PG-F3 Setting Error The value set in F1-01 [Encoder 1 Pulse Count • Examine the F1-01 value and the number of encoder pulses.
(PPR)] does not agree with the number of encoder • Set F1-01 correctly.
pulses.
The calculation encoder signal frequency at Decrease the value set for E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency] and
maximum speed is more than 20 kHz. make sure that the output frequency of the encoder is not more than
20 kHz.
oPE33 Digital Output Selection Error These two parameters are set at the same time: Clear the H2-01 to H2-03 = 1xx [Inverse output of xx] settings.
• H2-60 ≠ F [Term M1-M2 Secondary Function ≠ Note:
Not Used] It is not possible to set H2-01 to H2-03 = 1xx [Inverse output of
• H2-01 = 1xx [Term M1-M2 Function Selection = xx] when using output functions for logic operations (H2-60,
Inverse output of xx] H2-63, H2-66 ≠ F).
These parameter pairs are set incorrectly: • Set parameters H2-21 ≤ H2-22.
• H2-21 [Comparator 1 Lower Limit] > H2-22 • Set parameters H2-27 ≤ H2-28.
[Comparator 1 Upper Limit]
• H2-27 [Comparator 2 Lower Limit] > H2-28
[Comparator 2 Upper Limit]
Troubleshooting
2
End1 Excessive Rated Voltage Setting The torque reference was more than 20% during • Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
Auto-Tuning or the no-load current that was • Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
measured after Auto-Tuning is more than 80%. data.
• If you can uncouple the motor and load, remove the motor from
the machine and do Rotational Auto-Tuning again.
• If you cannot uncouple the motor and load, use the results from
Auto-Tuning.
End2 Iron Core Saturation Coefficient The motor nameplate data entered during Auto- • Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
Tuning is incorrect. • Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
Auto-Tuning results were not in the applicable • Examine and repair damaged motor wiring.
parameter setting range, and E2-07 or E2-08 [Motor • If you can uncouple the motor and load, remove the motor from
Saturation Coefficient 2] have temporary values. the machine and do Rotational Auto-Tuning again.
End3 Rated Current Setting Alarm The rated current value is incorrect. Do Auto-Tuning again and set the correct rated current shown on the
motor nameplate.
End4 Adjusted Slip Calculation Error The Auto-Tuning results were not in the applicable • Make sure the input motor nameplate data is correct.
parameter setting range. • Do Rotational Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor
nameplate data.
The motor rated slip that was measured after
Stationary Auto-Tuning was 0.2 Hz or lower. • If you cannot uncouple the motor and load, do Stationary Auto-
Tuning 2.
The motor rated slip that was measured after
compensation with E2-08 [Motor Saturation
Coefficient 2] is not in the applicable range.
End5 Resistance Tuning Error The Auto-Tuning results of the Line-to-Line • Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
Resistance were not in the applicable range. • Examine and repair damaged motor wiring.
End6 Leakage Inductance Alarm The Auto-Tuning results were not in the applicable Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct, and do
parameter setting range. Auto-Tuning again.
A1-02 [Control Method Selection] setting is not • Examine the value set in A1-02.
applicable. • Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct, and do
Auto-Tuning again.
End7 No-Load Current Alarm The Auto-Tuning results of the motor no-load current Examine and repair damaged motor wiring.
value were not in the applicable range.
Auto-Tuning results were less than 5% of the motor Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct, and do
rated current. Auto-Tuning again.
End8 HFI Alarm • Inductance saliency ratio (E5-07/E5-06) is too • Set the correct value on the motor nameplate E5-xx [PM motor
small. parameters] or do Stationary/Rotational Auto-Tuning, and then
• The drive cannot find the n8-36 [HFI Frequency do High Frequency Injection Tuning again.
Level for L Tuning] value. • When it is necessary to set n8-35 = 1 [Initial Pole Detection
Method = High Frequency Injection] or n8-57 = 1 [HFI Overlap
Selection = Enabled], make sure that there is no unusual noise in
the low speed range (10% or less) and that the motor does not
rotate in reverse at start.
If there is unusual noise in the low speed range (10% or less),
increase n8-41 in increments of 0.5. Set n8-41 > 0.0 for IPM
motors.
Note:
If the drive detects End8, it will automatically set n8-35 =0
[Pull-in] and n8-57 = 0 [Disabled]. Do not change the settings
unless necessary.
End9 Initial Pole Detection Alarm The drive cannot calculate the correct value for n8-84 • Set the correct value on the motor nameplate E5-xx [PM motor
[Polarity Detection Current] during High Frequency parameters] or do Stationary/Rotational Auto-Tuning, and then
Injection Tuning. do High Frequency Injection Tuning again.
• When n8-35 = 1 [Initial Pole Detection Method = High
Frequency Injection] or n8-57 = 1 [HFI Overlap Selection =
Enabled], make sure that the motor does not rotate in reverse at
start.
If there is unusual noise in the low speed range (10% or less),
increase n8-41 in increments of 0.5. Set n8-41 > 0.0 for IPM
motors.
Note:
If the drive detects End9, it will automatically set n8-35 =0
[Pull-in] and n8-57 = 0 [Disabled]. Do not change the settings
unless necessary.
Er-01 Motor Data Error The motor nameplate data entered during Auto- • Make sure that the motor nameplate data is correct.
Tuning is incorrect. • Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
The combination of the motor rated power and motor • Examine the combination of drive capacity and motor output.
rated current do not match. • Do Auto-Tuning again, and correctly set the motor rated power
and motor rated current.
The combination of the motor rated current that was • Examine the motor rated current and the no-load current.
entered during Auto-Tuning and E2-03 [Motor No- • Set E2-03 correctly.
Load Current] do not match.
• Do Auto-Tuning again, and correctly set the motor rated current.
The combination of the setting values of Motor Base Do Auto-Tuning again, and correctly set the Motor Base Frequency
Frequency and Motor Base Speed do not match. and Motor Base Speed.
Er-02 Drive in an Alarm State The motor nameplate data entered during Auto- • Make sure that the motor nameplate data entered in Auto-Tuning
Tuning is incorrect. is correct.
• Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
You did Auto-Tuning while the drive had a minor Clear the minor fault or alarm and do Auto-Tuning again.
fault or alarm.
Troubleshooting
There is a defective motor cable or cable connection. Examine and repair motor wiring.
Er-03 STOP Button was Pressed Auto-Tuning did not complete correctly. Do Auto-Tuning again.
During Auto-Tuning, was pushed.
Er-04 Line-to-Line Resistance Error The Auto-Tuning results were not in the applicable • Examine and repair motor wiring.
parameter setting range. • Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational Auto-
Tuning again.
Auto-Tuning did not complete in a pre-set length of
time.
The motor nameplate data entered during Auto- • Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
Tuning is incorrect. • Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
Er-05 No-Load Current Error The Auto-Tuning results were not in the applicable • Examine and repair motor wiring.
parameter setting range. • Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational Auto-
Tuning again.
Auto-Tuning did not complete in a pre-set length of
time.
The motor nameplate data entered during Auto- • Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
Tuning is incorrect. • Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
Rotational Auto-Tuning was done with a load that • Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational Auto-
was more than 30% of the rating connected to the Tuning again.
motor. • If you cannot uncouple the motor and load, make sure that the
load is less than 30% of the motor rating. If a mechanical brake
is installed in the motor, release the brake during Rotational
Auto-Tuning.
Er-08 Rated Slip Error The motor nameplate data entered during Auto- • Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
Tuning is incorrect. • Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
Auto-Tuning did not complete in a pre-set length of • Examine and repair the motor wiring.
time. • If the motor and machine are connected during Rotational Auto-
Tuning, decouple the motor from the machinery.
The Auto-Tuning results were not in the applicable
parameter setting range.
Rotational Auto-Tuning was done with a load that • Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational Auto-
was more than 30% of the rating connected to the Tuning again.
motor. • If you cannot uncouple the motor and load, make sure that the
load is less than 30% of the motor rating. If a mechanical brake
is installed in the motor, release the brake during Rotational
Auto-Tuning.
Er-09 Acceleration Error The motor did not accelerate for the specified 1. Increase the value set in C1-01 [Acceleration Time 1].
acceleration time. 2. Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational
Auto-Tuning again.
The value of L7-01 or L7-02 [Forward/Reverse Increase the value set in L7-01 or L7-02.
Torque Limit] is small.
Rotational Auto-Tuning was done with a load that • Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational Auto-
was more than 30% of the rating connected to the Tuning again.
motor. • If you cannot uncouple the motor and load, make sure that the
load is less than 30% of the motor rating. If a mechanical brake
is installed in the motor, release the brake during Rotational
Auto-Tuning.
Er-10 Motor Direction Error There is defective drive and motor wiring. Examine and repair motor wiring.
There is defective drive and encoder wiring. Examine and repair the wiring to the encoder.
The direction of the motor and the setting of F1-05 Set F1-05 correctly.
[PG 1 Rotation Selection] are opposite.
The machine pulled the motor to rotate in the Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational Auto-
opposite direction. Tuning again.
Er-11 Motor Speed Error The torque reference during acceleration is too high • Increase the value set in C1-01 [Acceleration Time 1].
(100%). • Disconnect the machine from the motor and do Rotational Auto-
Tuning again.
Er-12 Current Detection Error There is a phase loss in the drive input power. (U/T1, Examine and repair motor wiring.
V/T2, W/T3)
The current exceeded the current rating of the drive. • Check the motor wiring for any short circuits between the wires.
• Check and turn ON any magnetic contactors used between
The output current is too low. motors.
• Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest
sales representative.
You tried Auto-Tuning without a motor connected to Connect the motor and do Auto-Tuning.
the drive.
There was a current detection signal error. Replace the control board or the drive. For information about
replacing the control board, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales
representative.
Er-13 Leakage Inductance Alarm The motor rated current value is incorrect. Correctly set the rated current indicated on the motor nameplate and
perform Auto-Tuning again.
The drive could not complete tuning for leakage Examine and repair motor wiring.
inductance in fewer than 300 seconds.
Er-14 Motor Speed Error 2 The motor speed was more than two times the Decrease the value set in C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1].
amplitude of speed reference during Inertia Tuning.
Er-15 Torque Saturation Error During Inertia Tuning, the output torque was more • Increase the value set in L7-01 to L7-04 [Torque Limit] as much
than the value set in L7-01 to L7-04 [Torque Limit]. as possible.
• Decrease the values set for the frequency and amplitude of the
test signals used when doing inertia tuning. First, decrease the
test signal amplitude, and then do Inertia Tuning. If the error
continues, decrease the test signal frequency and do Inertia
Tuning again.
Er-16 Inertia ID Error The inertia found by the drive was too small or too • Decrease the values set for the frequency and amplitude of the
large during Inertia Tuning (10% or less, or 50000% test signals used when doing inertia tuning. First, decrease the
or more). test signal amplitude, and then do Inertia Tuning. If the error
continues, decrease the test signal frequency and do Inertia
Tuning again
• Correctly set the motor inertia as specified by the motor, and do
Inertia Tuning again.
Er-17 Reverse Prohibited Error b1-04 = 1 [Reverse Operation Selection = Reverse 1. Enable reverse in the target machine.
Disabled] 2. Set b1-04 = 0 [Reverse Enabled].
Note: 3. Do Inertia Tuning again.
You cannot do Inertia Tuning if the drive cannot
rotate the motor in reverse.
Er-18 Back EMF Error The result of the induced voltage tuning was not in 1. Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
Troubleshooting
the applicable range. 2. Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
Er-19 PM Inductance Error The Auto-Tuning results of the PM motor inductance 1. Make sure that the input motor nameplate data is correct.
were not in the applicable range. 2. Do Auto-Tuning again and correctly set the motor nameplate
data.
Er-21 Z Pulse Correction Error The motor is wired incorrectly. 1. Repair motor and encoder wiring errors.
2. Do Z Pulse Offset Tuning again.
The encoder is wired incorrectly.
You did Auto-Tuning on a coasting motor. 1. Wait for the motor to fully stop.
2. Do Z Pulse Offset Tuning again.
The setting for the direction of the encoder motor 1. Set the direction of motor rotation of the encoder in F1-05
rotation is incorrect. [Encoder 1 Rotation Selection] correctly.
2. Do Z Pulse Offset Tuning again.
The number of encoder pulses is incorrect. 1. Set the number of encoder pulses in F1-01 [Encoder 1 Pulse
Count (PPR)] correctly.
2. Do Z Pulse Offset Tuning again.
The motor Inertia is too large. Increase the value set in n8-02 [Pole Alignment Current Level].
Parameter b1-04 = 1 [Reverse Operation Selection = • If the machine prevents reverse rotation, disconnect the motor
Reverse Disabled] and you did Z Pulse Offset from the machinery, set b1-04 = 0 [Reverse Enabled], then do Z
Tuning. Pulse Offset Tuning. When tuning is complete, set b1-04 = 1
[Reverse Disabled].
• If the machine does not prevent reverse rotation, set b1-04 = 0
and do Z Pulse Offset Tuning.
The motor vibrates during tuning. • Increase the values set in n8-03 [Pole Position Detection Time]
and n8-04 [Pole Alignment Time].
• Decrease the value set in n8-02 [Pole Alignment Current Level].
The encoder is damaged. • Examine the signal output from the encoder.
• Replace the encoder.
Er-25 HighFreq Inject Param Tuning Err The motor data is incorrect. Do Stationary Auto-Tuning again.
Note:
If the drive detects Er-25 after doing Stationary Auto-Tuning,
the motor may not be able to use high frequency injection
control. Contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative
for more information.
Drive and Keypad mismatch. Detection of inconsistency between the Normally displayed The drive detected the connection of a
Should the parameters be drive and keypad keypad from a different drive. Select [Yes]
to copy parameters backed up in the keypad
restored? to the connected drive.
Restore Restore from keypad Restoring parameters Flashing The parameters stored in the keypad have
been restored to the drive.
End Backup/restore/verify operation ended Normally displayed The parameter backup, restore, or verify
normally operation ended normally.
Backup Backup from Drive Backing up parameters Flashing The parameters stored in the drive are being
backed up to the keypad.
Verify Keypad & Drive Verifying parameters Flashing The parameter settings stored in the keypad
and the parameter settings in the drive match
or are being compared.
CPyE Error Writing Data Parameter restore did not end correctly. Restore the parameters.
CSEr Control Mode Mismatch The keypad is broken. Replace the keypad.
dFPS Drive Model Mismatch You tried to restore parameters to a different drive 1. Examine the drive model that you used to back up the
model than the one that you backed up. parameters.
2. Restore the parameters.
iFEr Keypad Communication Error There was a communications error between the Examine the connector or cable connection.
keypad and the drive.
Troubleshooting
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
ndAT Error Received Data The parameter settings for model and specifications 1. Make sure that drive model and the value set in o2-04 [Drive
(power supply voltage and capacity) are different Model (KVA) Selection] agree.
between the keypad and the drive. 2. Restore the parameters.
The parameters are not stored in the keypad. 1. Connect a keypad that has the correct parameters.
2. Restore the parameters.
2
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
PWEr DWEZ Password Mismatch The password set in the backup operation with qx-xx Set the DWEZ PC software password supplied by Yaskawa for the
[DriveWorksEZ Parameters] and rx-xx DWEZ program user ID downloaded to the drive.
[DriveWorksEZ Connections] is incorrect.
Note:
U8-11 and U8-12 [DWEZ Versions 1 and 2] show the user ID of the DWEZ program.
Code Name Causes Possible Solutions
rdEr Error Reading Data You tried to back up the data when o3-02 = 0 [Copy Set o3-02 = 1 [Enabled] and back up again.
Allowed Selection = Disabled].
vAEr Voltage Class, Capacity Mismatch The power supply specifications or drive capacity 1. Make sure that drive model and the value set in o2-04 [Drive
parameter settings are different between the keypad Model (KVA) Selection] agree.
and the drive. 2. Restore the parameters.
vFyE Parameters do not Match The parameters that are backed up in the keypad and 1. Restore or backup the parameter again.
the parameters in the drive are not the same. 2. Verify the parameters.
◆ Fault Reset
If a fault occurs, you must remove the cause of the fault and re-energize the drive. Table 2.3 lists the different
methods to reset the drive after a fault.
Table 2.3 Fault Reset Methods
Methods Description
Method 1 While the keypad is showing the fault or alarm code, push (Reset) or on the keypad.
Switch ON the MFDI terminal set to H1-xx = 14 [MFDI Function Select = Fault Reset].
Troubleshooting
Note:
The default setting for H1-04 [Terminal S4 Function Selection] is 14 [Fault Reset].
Method 2
Method 3
Note:
If the drive receives a Run command from a communication option or control circuit terminal, the drive will not reset the fault. Remove the
Run command then try to clear the fault. If you do a fault reset when the drive has a Run command, the keypad will show minor fault CrST
[Remove RUN Command to Reset].
◆ Typical Problems
Symptom Ref.
The Motor Does Not Rotate after You Enter a Run Command 140
The Motor Rotates in the Opposite Direction from the Run Command 141
The Motor Stalls during Acceleration or Accel/Decel Time Is Too Long 142
The Drive Frequency Reference Is Different than the Controller Frequency Reference Command 143
There Is Too Much Motor Oscillation and the Rotation Is Irregular 143
Deceleration Takes Longer than Expected when You Enable Dynamic Braking 143
There Is Audible Noise from the Drive or Motor Cables when You Energize the Drive 144
The Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (GFCI) Trips During Run 144
Motor Rotation Causes Unexpected Audible Noise from Connected Machinery 144
Troubleshooting
The Motor Rotates after You Shut Off Drive Output 145
2
◆ The Parameter Settings Will Not Change
Causes Possible Solutions
The drive is operating the motor (the drive is in Drive Mode). Stop the drive and change to Programming Mode.
Parameter A1-01 = 0 [Access Level Selection = Operation Only]. Set A1-01 = 2 [Access Level Selection = Advanced Level] or A1-01 = 3 [Expert Level].
Parameter H1-xx = 1B [MFDI Function Select = Programming Lockout]. Activate the terminals to which H1-xx = 1B is set, and then change the parameters.
You entered an incorrect password in A1-04 [Password]. • Enter the correct password to A1-04 again.
• If you forgot the password, set the password again with A1-04 and A1-05 [Password Setting].
Note:
If you set the password, you cannot change these parameters until the password aligns:
• A1-01 [Access Level Selection]
• A1-02 [Control Method Selection]
• A1-03 [Initialize Parameters]
• A1-06 [Application Preset]
• A1-07 [DriveWorksEZ Function Selection]
• A2-01 to A2-32 [User Parameter 1 to User Parameter 32]
The drive detected Uv [Undervoltage]. • View U1-07 [DC Bus Voltage] to see the power supply voltage.
• Examine the main circuit wiring.
The drive is not in Drive Mode. 1. Make sure that the keypad shows [Rdy].
2. If the keypad does not show [Rdy], go back to the Home screen.
The drive received a fast stop command. Turn off the fast stop input signal.
The settings for the source that supplies the Run command are incorrect. Set b1-02 [Run Command Selection 1] correctly.
The frequency reference source is set incorrectly. Set b1-01 [Frequency Reference Selection 1] correctly.
There is defective wiring in the control circuit terminals. • Correctly wire the drive control circuit terminals.
• View U1-10 [Input Terminal Status] for input terminal status.
The settings for voltage input and current input of the master frequency Examine these analog input terminal signal level settings:
reference are incorrect. • Terminal A1: DIP switch S1-1 and H3-01 [Terminal A1 Signal Level Select]
• Terminal A2: DIP switch S1-2 and H3-09 [Terminal A2 Signal Level Select]
• Terminal A3: DIP switch S4, S1-3 and H3-05 [Terminal A3 Signal Level Select]
The selection for the sinking/sourcing mode and the internal/external power • For sinking mode, close the circuit between terminals SC-SP with a wire jumper.
supply is incorrect. • For sourcing mode, close the circuit between terminals SC-SN with a wire jumper.
• For external power supply, remove the wire jumper.
The MFAI setting is incorrect. • Make sure that the functions set to the MFAI are correct. The frequency reference is 0 when H3-
02, H3-10, H3-06 = 1 [MFAI Function Select = Frequency Gain] and voltage (current) is not
input.
• View U1-13 to U1-15 [Terminal A1, A2, A3 Input Voltage] to see if the analog input values set to
terminals A1, A2, and A3 are applicable.
When you push during operation, the drive will ramp to stop. Set o2-02 = 0 [STOP Key
The 2-wire sequence and 3-wire sequence are set incorrectly. • Set one of the parameters H1-03 to H1-08 [Terminals S3 to S8 Function Select] to 0 [3-Wire
Sequence] to enable the 3-wire sequence.
• If a 2-wire sequence is necessary, make sure that H1-03 to H1-08 ≠ 0.
◆ The Motor Rotates in the Opposite Direction from the Run Command
Causes Possible Solutions
The phase wiring between the drive and motor is incorrect. • Examine the wiring between the drive and motor.
• Connect drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 in the correct sequence to agree with
motor terminals U, V, and W.
• Switch two motor cables U, V, and W to reverse motor direction.
The forward direction for the motor is set incorrectly. • Connect drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 in the correct sequence to agree with
motor terminals U, V, and W.
• Switch two motor cables U, V, and W to reverse motor direction.
The signal connections for forward run and reverse run on the drive control Correctly wire the control circuit.
circuit terminals and control panel side are incorrect.
The motor is running at almost 0 Hz and the Speed Search estimated the speed Set b3-14 = 0 [Bi-directional Speed Search = Disabled], then the drive will only do speed search in
to be in the opposite direction. the specified direction.
The drive will not let the motor rotate in reverse. Set b1-04 = 0 [Reverse Operation Selection = Reverse Enabled].
The drive did not receive a Reverse run signal and 3-Wire sequence is selected. Activate the terminals to which H1-xx = 0 [3-Wire Sequence] is set, and then enable reverse
operation.
Troubleshooting
drive parameters.
The motor is running continuously at a very low speed. • Change the run speed.
• Use a drive-dedicated motor.
The drive is operating in a vector control mode, but Auto-Tuning has not been • Do Auto-Tuning.
done. • Calculate motor parameter and set motor parameters.
• Set A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f Control].
2
The voltage insulation between motor phases is not sufficient. • Use a motor with a voltage tolerance that is higher than the maximum voltage surge.
• Use a drive-dedicated motor that is rated for use with AC drives for applications that use a motor
on drives rated higher than 400 V class.
• Install an AC reactor on the output side of the drive and set C6-02 = 1 [Carrier Frequency
Selection = 2.0 kHz].
Note:
When the motor is connected to the drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3, surges occur
between the drive switching and the motor coils. These surges can be three times the drive input
power supply voltage (600 V for a 200 V class drive, 1200 V for a 400 V class drive).
The air around the motor is too hot. • Measure the ambient temperature.
• Decrease the temperature in the area until it is in the specified temperature range.
The desired Auto-Tuning mode is not available for the selected control mode. Change the motor control method with parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection].
The drive and motor system reached the torque limit or current suppression will • Decrease the load.
not let the drive accelerate. • Use a larger motor.
Note:
Although the drive has a Stall Prevention function and a Torque Compensation Limit function,
accelerating too fast or trying to drive a load that is too large can exceed the limits of the motor.
The acceleration time setting is too short. Check the values set in C1-01, C1-03, C1-05, or C1-07 [Acceleration Time] and set them to
applicable values.
The frequency reference is low. • Examine E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency] and increase the setting if it is set too low.
• Examine U1-01 [Frequency Reference] for the correct frequency reference.
• Examine the multi-function input terminals to see if a frequency reference signal switch has been
set.
• Examine the low gain level set in H3-03, H3-11, H3-07 [Terminal A1, A2, A3 Gain Setting] if you
use MFAI.
The frequency reference is set incorrectly. When H3-02, H3-10, H3-06 = 1 [MFAI Function Select = Frequency Gain] are set, see if voltage
(current) has been set.
• Check the values set in H3-02, H3-10, and H3-06.
• Use U1-13 to U1-15 [Terminal A1, A2, A3 Input Voltage] to make sure that the analog input
values set to terminals A1, A2, and A3 are applicable.
The motor characteristics and drive parameter settings are not compatible. • Set the correct V/f pattern to agree with the characteristics of the motor.
• Examine the V/f pattern set in E1-03 [V/f Pattern Selection].
• Perform Rotational Auto-Tuning.
The drive is operating in vector control mode, but Auto-Tuning is not • Do Auto-Tuning.
completed. • Calculate motor data and reset motor parameters.
• Set A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f Control].
Parameter A1-02 = 4 [Control Method Selection = Advanced Open Loop Increase the value set in n4-65 [Flux Estimate Response@High Freq] in 0.1-unit increments.
Vector] and the speed estimation response is too slow.
The Stall Prevention level during acceleration setting is too low. Increase the value set in L3-02 [Stall Prevent Level during Accel].
Note:
If the L3-02 value is too low, the acceleration time can be unsatisfactorily long.
The Stall Prevention level during run setting is too low. Increase the value set in L3-06 [Stall Prevent Level during Run].
Note:
If the L3-06 value is too low, speed will decrease while the drive outputs torque.
Drive reached the limitations of the V/f motor control method. • When the motor cable is longer than 50 m (164 ft.), do Auto-Tuning for line-to-line resistance.
• Set the V/f pattern to “High Starting Torque”.
• Use a Vector Control method.
Note:
V/f control method does not provide high torque at low speeds.
The analog input gain and bias for the frequency reference input are set Examine the gain and bias settings for the analog inputs that set the frequency reference.
incorrectly. • Terminal A1: H3-03 [Terminal A1 Gain Setting], H3-04 [Terminal A1 Bias Setting]
• Terminal A2: H3-11 [Terminal A2 Gain Setting], H3-12 [Terminal A2 Bias Setting]
• Terminal A3: H3-07 [Terminal A3 Gain Setting], H3-08 [Terminal A3 Bias Setting]
The drive is receiving frequency bias signals from analog input terminals A1 to • Examine parameters H3-02, H3-10, H3-06 [MFAI Function Select]. If two or more of these
A3 and the sum of all signals makes the frequency reference. parameters are set to 0, change the settings.
• Use U1-13 to U1-15 [Terminal A1, A2, A3 Input Voltage] to make sure that the analog input
values set to terminals A1, A2, and A3 are applicable.
The motor rotates faster than the frequency reference at low speed. • Decrease the value set in n4-70 [Speed Command Comp @ Low Freq] in increments of 0.1 Hz.
Note:
If you set the value too low, the motor can rotate in reverse.
• Set E1-09 > 0 [Minimum Output Frequency].
Note:
• The recommended setting for E1-09 is 0.5 Hz.
• When frequency reference < E1-09, the drive output will turn OFF.
PID control is enabled. If PID control is not necessary, set b5-01 = 0 [PID Mode Setting = Disabled].
Note:
When PID control is enabled, the drive adjusts the output frequency as specified by the target
value. The drive will only accelerate to the maximum output frequency set in E1-04 [Maximum
Output Frequency] while PID control is active.
E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection] is set incorrectly. Refer to “Motor Performance Fine-Tuning” in the technical manual.
The drive is operating the motor at more than the specified speed control range. Examine the speed control range and adjust the speed.
The motor is hunting. Adjust these parameters to have the largest effect:
• n8-55 [Motor to Load Inertia Ratio]
• n8-45 [Speed Feedback Detection Gain]
• C4-02 [Torque Compensation Delay Time]
Hunting occurs at start. Increase the value set in C2-01 [S-Curve Time @ Start of Accel].
Too much current is flowing through the drive. Set E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection] correctly as specified by the motor. For special-purpose
motors, enter the correct value to E5-xx as specified by the motor test report.
Operation is not stable when n8-57 = 1 [HFI Overlap Selection = Enabled]. • Do High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning.
• Decrease the value set in n8-41 [HFI P Gain] in increments of 0.5.
Note:
Set n8-41 > 0.0 for IPM motors.
Troubleshooting
◆ There Is Too Much Motor Oscillation and the Rotation Is Irregular
Causes Possible Solutions
Unsatisfactory balance of motor phases. • Make sure that the drive input power voltage supplies stable power.
• Set L8-05 = 0 [Input Phase Loss Protect Select = Disabled].
The stall prevention during deceleration setting is incorrect. • Examine the setting for L3-04 [Decel Stall Prevention Selection].
• When the drive has a dynamic braking option installed, set L3-04 = 0 [Disabled].
• If the drive detects ov [Overvoltage], set L3-04 = 3 [General Purpose w/ DB resistor].
The deceleration time setting is too long. Set C1-02, C1-04, C1-06, or C1-08 [Deceleration Times] to applicable values.
The drive and motor system reached the torque limit. • Examine the values set in L7-01 to L7-04 [Torque Limit] and increase them if necessary.
Note:
If the torque limit is enabled, deceleration time can increase because the drive cannot output
more torque than the limit.
• If H3-02, H3-10, H3-06 = 10, 11, 12, 15 [MFAI Function Select = Torque Limit] has been set,
examine the settings for the MFAIs.
• Examine the values set in H3-02, H3-10, and H3-06.
• Use U1-13 to U1-15 [Terminal A1, A2, A3 Input Voltage] to make sure that the analog input
values set to terminals A1, A2, and A3 are applicable.
The load is more than the internal torque limit as specified by the drive rated Replace the drive with a larger capacity model.
current.
◆ There Is Audible Noise from the Drive or Motor Cables when You Energize the
Drive
Causes Possible Solutions
The relay switching in the drive is making too much noise. • Use C6-02 [Carrier Frequency Selection] to decrease the carrier frequency.
• Connect a noise filter to the input side of the drive power supply.
• Connect a noise filter to the output side of the drive.
• Isolate the control circuit wiring from the main circuit wiring.
• Use a metal cable gland to wire the drive.
• Shield the periphery of the drive with metal.
• Make sure that the drive and motor are grounded correctly.
• Make sure that ground faults have not occurred in the wiring or motor.
There is too much leakage current from the drive. • Increase the GFCI sensitivity or use GFCI with a higher threshold.
• Use C6-02 [Carrier Frequency Selection] to decrease the carrier frequency.
• Decrease the length of the cable used between the drive and the motor.
• Install a noise filter or AC reactor on the output side of the drive. Set C6-02 = 1 [2.0 kHz] when
connecting an AC reactor.
• Disable the internal EMC filter.
The carrier frequency and the resonant frequency of the connected machinery • Adjust C6-02 to C6-05 [Carrier Frequency].
are the same. • Set C6-02 = 1 to 6 [Carrier Frequency Selection = Frequency other than Swing PWM].
Note:
If C6-02 = 7 to A [Carrier Frequency Selection = Swing PWM], the drive will not know if the
noise comes from the drive or the machine.
The drive output frequency and the resonant frequency of the connected • Adjust d3-01 to d3-04 [Jump Frequency].
machinery are the same. • Put the motor on a rubber pad to decrease vibration.
The frequency reference is assigned to an external source, and there is electrical Make sure that electrical interference does not have an effect on the signal lines.
interference in the signal. • Isolate control circuit wiring from main circuit wiring.
• Use twisted-pair cables or shielded wiring for the control circuit.
• Increase the value of H3-13 [Analog Input FilterTime Constant].
The cable between the drive and motor is too long. • Do Auto-Tuning.
• Make the wiring as short as possible.
The PID parameters are not sufficiently adjusted. Adjust b5-xx [PID control].
The detection level and the target value do not agree. Use H3-03, H3-11, H3-07 [Terminal A1, A2, A3 Gain Setting] to adjust PID target and feedback
signal scaling.
Note:
PID control keeps the difference between the target value and detection value at 0. Set the input
level for the values relative to each other.
Reverse drive output frequency and speed detection. When output frequency Set b5-09 = 1 [PID Output Level Selection = Reverse output (reverse acting)].
increases, the sensor detects a speed decrease.
The control method was changed after doing Auto-Tuning. Do Auto-Tuning again.
Troubleshooting
DC Injection Braking is too low and the drive cannot decelerate correctly. • Increase the value set in b2-02 [DC Injection Braking Current].
• Increase the value set in b2-04 [DC Inject Braking Time at Stop].
The stopping method makes the drive coast to stop. Set b1-03 = 0 or 2 [Stopping Method Selection = Ramp to Stop, DC Injection Braking to Stop].
The frequency reference is in the Jump frequency range. Adjust d3-01 to d3-03 [Jump Frequency 1 to 3] and d3-04 [Jump Frequency Width].
Note:
Enabling the Jump frequency prevents the drive from outputting the frequencies specified in the
Jump range.
The upper limit for the frequency reference has been exceeded. Set E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency] and d2-01 [Frequency Reference Upper Limit] to the best
values for the application.
Note:
This calculation supplies the upper value for the output frequency:
E1-04 × d2-01 / 100
A large load triggered Stall Prevention function during acceleration. • Decrease the load.
• Adjust L3-02 [Stall Prevent Level during Accel].
L3-01 = 3 [Stall Prevent Select duringAccel = ILim Mode] has been set. 1. Check whether the V/f pattern and motor parameter settings are appropriate, and set them
correctly.
2. If this does not solve the problem, and it is not necessary to limit the current level of stall during
acceleration, adjust L3-02.
3. If this does not solve the problem, set L3-01 = 1 [Enabled].
The motor is rotating at this speed: • Set b1-21 = 1 [CLV Start Selection = Accept Run command at any speed].
b2-01 [DC Injection/Zero SpeedThreshold] ≤ Motor Speed < E1-09 [Minimum • Set E1-09 < b2-01.
Output Frequency]
100% of the rated output current of the drive was exceeded while operating at • If the sound is coming from the motor, set L8-38 = 0 [Carrier Frequency Reduction = Disabled].
low speeds. • If oL2 [Drive Overloaded] occurs frequently after setting L8-38 = 0, replace the drive with a
high-capacity drive.
The drive did not receive a Run command after applying power. • Examine the sequence and wiring that enters the Run command.
• Set up a relay to make sure that the Run command stays enabled during a loss of power.
For applications that use 3-wire sequence, the momentary power loss continued Examine the wiring and circuitry for the relay that keeps the Run command enabled during the
for a long time, and the relay that keeps the Run command has been switched momentary power loss ride-thru time.
off.
Hex. Hexadecimal numbers that represent MEMOBUS addresses to change parameters over network communication.
*1 Set A1-01 = 3 [Access Level Selection = Expert Level] to show and set Expert Mode parameters on the keypad.
Note:
Gray icons identify parameters that are not available in the specified control method.
Parameter List
Parameter List
A1-00 Language Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0100) Sets the language for the LCD keypad. (0 - 12)
RUN Note:
When you use A1-03 [Initialize Parameters] to initialize the drive, the drive will not reset this
parameter.
0 : English
1 : Japanese
2 : German
3 : French
4 : Italian
5 : Spanish
6 : Portuguese
7 : Chinese
8 : Czech
9 : Russian
10 : Turkish
11 : Polish
12 : Greek
A1-01 Access Level Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(0101) Sets user access to parameters. The access level controls which parameters the keypad will display, (0 - 3)
RUN and which parameters the user can set.
0 : Operation Only
1 : User Parameters
2 : Advanced Level
3 : Expert Level
A1-02 Control Method Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(0102) Sets the control method for the drive application and the motor. (0 - 8)
0 : V/f Control
1 : V/f Control with Encoder
2 : Open Loop Vector
3 : Closed Loop Vector
4 : Advanced Open Loop Vector
5 : PM Open Loop Vector
6 : PM Advanced Open Loop Vector
7 : PM Closed Loop Vector
8 : EZ Vector Control
A1-03 Initialize Parameters V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0103) Sets parameters to default values. (0 - 3330)
0 : No Initialization
1110 : User Initialization
2220 : 2-Wire Initialization
3330 : 3-Wire Initialization
A1-04 Password V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000
(0104) Entry point for the password set in A1-05 [Password Setting]. The user can view the settings of (0000 - 9999)
parameters that are locked without entering the password. Enter the correct password in this
parameter to change parameter settings.
A1-05 Password Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000
(0105) Set the password to lock parameters and prevent changes to parameter settings. Enter the correct (0000 - 9999)
password in A1-04 [Password] to unlock parameters and accept changes.
A1-06 Application Preset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0127) Sets the drive to operate in selected application conditions. (0 - 5)
0 : General-purpose
1 : Water Supply Pump 2
2 : Conveyor
3 : Exhaust Fan
4 : HVAC Fan
5 : Air Compressor
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
A1-07 DriveWorksEZ Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0128) Selection Sets the drive to operate with DriveWorksEZ. (0 - 2)
0 : DWEZ Disabled
1 : DWEZ Enabled
2 : Enabled/Disabled wDigital Input
A1-11 Firmware Update Lock V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(111D) Protects the drive firmware. When you enable the protection, you cannot update the drive firmware. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
A1-12 Bluetooth ID V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(1564) Sets the password necessary to use Bluetooth to control the drive with a smartphone or tablet. (0000 - 9999)
A2-01 User Parameter 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV A1-02
(0106) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 1 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-02 User Parameter 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV b1-01
(0107) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 2 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-03 User Parameter 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV b1-02
(0108) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 3 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-04 User Parameter 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV b1-03
(0109) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 4 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-05 User Parameter 5 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV C1-01
(010A) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 5 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-06 User Parameter 6 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV C1-02
(010B) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 6 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-07 User Parameter 7 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV C6-01
(010C) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 7 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-08 User Parameter 8 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV C6-02
(010D) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 8 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
Parameter List
A2-09 User Parameter 9 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV d1-01
(010E) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 9 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-10 User Parameter 10 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV d1-02
(010F) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 10 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
(Determined by A1-06) 3
01 to A2-32.
A2-11 User Parameter 11 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV d1-03
(0110) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 11 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-12 User Parameter 12 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV d1-04
(0111) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 12 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
A2-13 User Parameter 13 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV d1-17
(0112) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 13 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-14 User Parameter 14 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E1-01
(0113) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 14 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-15 User Parameter 15 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E1-03
(0114) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 15 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-16 User Parameter 16 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E1-04
(0115) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 16 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32.
A2-17 User Parameter 17 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E1-05
(0116) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 17 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-18 User Parameter 18 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E1-06
(0117) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 18 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-19 User Parameter 19 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E1-09
(0118) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 19 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-20 User Parameter 20 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E1-13
(0119) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 20 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-21 User Parameter 21 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E2-01
(011A) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 21 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-22 User Parameter 22 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E2-04
(011B) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 22 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-23 User Parameter 23 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV E2-11
(011C) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 23 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-24 User Parameter 24 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV H4-02
(011D) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 24 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-25 User Parameter 25 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV L1-01
(011E) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 25 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-26 User Parameter 26 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV L3-04
(011F) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 26 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-27 User Parameter 27 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(0120) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 27 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
A2-28 User Parameter 28 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(0121) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 28 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-29 User Parameter 29 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(0122) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 29 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-30 User Parameter 30 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(0123) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 30 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-31 User Parameter 31 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(0124) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 31 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-32 User Parameter 32 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(0125) Sets the parameter number to be shown for number 32 of the [User Custom Parameters] under the (Determined by A1-06)
main menu. You can select a maximum of 32 parameters for the drive and set them to parameters A2-
01 to A2-32. You can set A2-17 to A2-32 when A2-33 = 0 [User Parameter Auto Selection =
Disabled: Manual Entry Required].
A2-33 User Parameter Auto V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-06
(0126) Selection Sets the automatic save feature for changes to parameters A2-17 to A2-32 [User Parameters 17 to (0, 1)
32].
0 : Disabled: Manual Entry Required
1 : Enabled: Auto Save Recent Parms
Parameter List
3.5 b: Application
◆ b1: Operation Mode Selection
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Setting Range)
b1-01 Frequency Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0180) Selection 1 Sets the input method for the frequency reference. (0 - 4)
0 : Keypad
1 : Analog Input
2 : Memobus/Modbus Communications
3 : Option PCB
4 : Pulse Train Input
b1-02 Run Command Selection 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0181) Sets the input method for the Run command. (0 - 3)
0 : Keypad
1 : Digital Input
2 : Memobus/Modbus Communications
3 : Option PCB
b1-03 Stopping Method Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0182) Sets the method to stop the motor after removing a Run command or entering a Stop command. (0 - 3)
Note:
When A1-02 = 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8 [Control Method Selection = CLV, AOLV, OLV/PM, AOLV/PM,
CLV/PM, EZOLV], the setting range is 0, 1, 3.
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : DC Injection Braking to Stop
3 : Coast to Stop with Timer
b1-04 Reverse Operation Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0183) Sets the reverse operation function. Disable reverse operation in fan or pump applications where (0, 1)
reverse rotation is dangerous.
0 : Reverse Enabled
1 : Reverse Disabled
b1-05 Operation Below Minimum V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0184) Freq Sets the drive operation when the frequency reference decreases to less than the value set in E1-09 (0 - 3)
[Minimum Output Frequency].
0 : Operate at Frequency Reference
1 : Baseblock (Motor Coasts)
2 : Operate at Minimum Frequency
3 : Operate at Zero Speed
b1-06 Digital Input Reading V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0185) Sets the number of times that the drive reads the sequence input command to prevent malfunction (0, 1)
because of electrical interference.
0 : Single Scan
1 : Double Scan
b1-07 LOCAL/REMOTE Run V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0186) Selection Sets drive response to an existing Run command when the drive receives a second Run command (0, 1)
from a different location.
0 : Disregard Existing RUN Command
1 : Accept Existing RUN Command
b1-08 Run Command Select in V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0187) PRG Mode Sets the conditions for the drive to accept a Run command entered from an external source when (0 - 2)
using the keypad to set parameters.
0 : Disregard RUN while Programming
1 : Accept RUN while Programming
2 : Allow Programming Only at Stop
b1-09 LOCAL/REMOTE Select V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0188) during RUN (0, 1)
Sets the function that lets you use the during operation to switch between LOCAL and
Expert REMOTE Modes.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Setting Range)
b1-14 Phase Order Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01C3) Sets the phase order for output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3. This parameter can align the (0, 1)
Forward Run command from the drive and the forward direction of the motor without changing
wiring.
0 : Standard
1 : Switch Phase Order
b1-15 Frequency Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01C4) Selection 2 Sets the input method for frequency reference 2. (0 - 4)
0 : Keypad
1 : Analog Input
2 : Memobus/Modbus Communications
3 : Option PCB
4 : Pulse Train Input
b1-16 Run Command Selection 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01C5) Sets the input method for Run Command 2 when the user switches the control circuit terminals ON/ (0 - 3)
OFF to change the Run command source.
0 : Keypad
1 : Digital Input
2 : Memobus/Modbus Communications
3 : Option PCB
b1-17 Run Command at Power Up V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01C6) Sets drive response when the CPU changes from de-energized to energized and there is an active Run (0, 1)
command. Set this parameter in applications where energizing or de-energizing the drive enables the
Run command. When the CPU stays energized during loss of power, L2-01 [Power Loss Ride
Through Select] sets operation.
0 : Disregard Existing RUN Command
1 : Accept Existing RUN Command
b1-21 CLV Start Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0748) Sets the conditions for the drive to accept a Run command when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method (0, 1)
Expert Selection = CLV, CLV/PM]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
0 : Reject RUN if b2-01<U1-05<E1-09
1 : Accept RUN Command at Any Speed
b1-35 Digital Input Deadband V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 ms
(1117) Time Sets the deadband time for MFDIs. (0.0 to 100.0 ms)
Expert
b2-01 DC Injection/Zero V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0189) SpeedThreshold Sets the frequency to start DC Injection Braking, Short Circuit Braking, or Zero Servo near the end (0.0 - 10.0 Hz)
of a stop ramp.
Note:
This parameter is available when b1-03 = 0 [Stopping Method Selection = Ramp to Stop].
b2-02 DC Injection Braking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50%
(018A) Current Sets the DC Injection Braking current as a percentage of the drive rated current. (0 - 100%)
Parameter List
b2-03 DC Inject Braking Time at V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV A1-02 = 4: 0.30 s
(018B) Start Sets the DC Injection Braking Time at stop. Sets the time of Zero Speed Control at start when A1-02 Other than A1-02 = 4: 0.00 s
= 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM]. (0.00 - 10.00 s)
b2-04 DC Inject Braking Time at V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(018C) Stop Sets the DC Injection Braking Time at stop. Sets the time of Zero Speed Control at stop when A1-02 (0.00 - 10.00 s)
= 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM]. 3
b2-08 Magnetic Flux V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(0190) Compensation Value Sets how much current the drive injects when DC Injection Braking at Start starts (Initial Excitation) (0 - 1000%)
as a percentage of E2-03 [Motor No-Load Current].
b2-12 Short Circuit Brake Time @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 s
(01BA) Start Sets the Short Circuit Braking time at start. (0.00 - 25.50 s)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
b2-13 Short Circuit Brake Time @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV A1-02 = 8: 0.00 s
(01BB) Stop Sets the Short Circuit Braking time at stop. Other than A1-02 = 8: 0.50 s
(0.00 - 25.50 s)
b2-18 Short Circuit Braking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0177) Current Sets the Short Circuit Braking Current as a percentage of the motor rated current. (0.0 - 200.0%)
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the motor rated current.
• A1-02 = 5, 6 [OLV/PM, AOLV/PM]: E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
• A1-02 = 8 [EZOLV]: E9-06 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
b3-01 Speed Search at Start V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0191) Selection Sets the Speed Search at Start function so the drive will do Speed Search with each Run command. (0, 1)
0 : Disable
1 : Enabled
b3-02 SpeedSearch Deactivation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0192) Current Sets the current level that stops Speed Search as a percentage of the drive rated output current. (0 - 200%)
Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
b3-03 Speed Search Deceleration V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2.0 s
(0193) Time Sets the deceleration time during Speed Search operation. Set the length of time to decelerate from (0.1 - 10.0 s)
the maximum output frequency to the minimum output frequency.
Note:
When A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZOLV], this parameter takes effect only in
Expert Mode.
b3-04 V/f Gain during Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(0194) Search Sets the ratio used to reduce the V/f during searches to reduce the output current during speed (10 - 100)
searches.
b3-05 Speed Search Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.2 s
(0195) Sets the Speed Search delay time to activate a magnetic contactor installed between the drive and (0.0 - 100.0 s)
motor.
b3-06 Speed Estimation Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(0196) Level 1 Sets the level of current that flows to the motor during Speed Estimation Speed Search as a (0.0 - 2.0)
Expert coefficient of the motor rated current. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
b3-07 Speed Estimation Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(0197) Level 2 Sets the level of current that flows to the motor during Speed Estimation Speed Search as a (0.0 - 3.0)
Expert coefficient of E2-03 [Motor No-Load Current] or E4-03 [Motor 2 Rated No-Load Current]. Usually
it is not necessary to change this setting.
b3-08 Speed Estimation ACR P V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02 and
(0198) Gain Sets the proportional gain for the automatic current regulator during Speed Estimation Speed Search. o2-04
Also adjusts speed search responsiveness. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.00 - 6.00)
b3-09 Speed Estimation ACR I V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02 when
(0199) Time Sets the integral time for the automatic current regulator during Speed Estimation Speed Search. Also A1-02 ≠ 5
adjusts speed search responsiveness. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. 20.0 when A1-02 = 5
(0.0 - 1000.0 ms)
b3-10 Speed Estimation Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.05
(019A) Gain Sets the gain to correct estimated frequencies from Speed Estimation Speed Search. (1.00 - 1.20)
Expert
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
b3-14 Bi-directional Speed Search V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02, b3-
(019E) Sets the direction of Speed Search to the direction of the frequency reference or in the motor rotation 24, and E9-01
direction as detected by the drive. (0, 1)
0 : Disable
1 : Enabled
Note:
• The initial value of b3-14 is different for different A1-02 [Control Method Selection] settings
when you set these parameters:
–A1-02 = 0, 2, 8 [V/f, OLV, EZOLV]
–E9-01 = 0 [Motor Type Selection = Induction (IM)]
–b3-24 = 1 [Speed Search Method Selection = Speed Estimation].
• The initial value of b3-14 is different for different A1-02 [Control Method Selection] settings
when you set these parameters:
–A1-02 = 1, 4, 8 [CL-V/f, AOLV, EZOLV]
–E9-01 = 1, 2 [Permanent Magnet (PM), Synchronous Reluctance (SynRM)]
• The initial value of b3-14 is 0 when you set these parameters:
–A1-02 = 0, 2, 8
–E9-01 = 0
–b3-24 = 2 [Current Detection 2]
• When you set A1-02, b3-24, and E9-01, set b3-14.
b3-17 Speed Est Retry Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 150%
(01F0) Level Sets the current level for the search retry function in Speed Estimation Speed Search as a percentage (0 - 200%)
Expert where drive rated current is a setting value of 100%.
b3-18 Speed Est Retry Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.10 s
(01F1) Time Sets the length of time that the drive will wait to retry Speed Estimation Speed Search when too (0.00 - 1.00 s)
Expert much current flow stopped the Speed Search.
b3-19 Speed Search Restart V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3 times
(01F2) Attempts Sets the number of times to restart Speed Search if Speed Search does not complete. (0 - 10 times)
b3-24 Speed Search Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(01C0) Selection Sets the Speed Search method when you start the motor or when you restore power after a (1, 2)
momentary power loss.
Note:
• When A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZOLV], the default setting changes when the
setting for E9-01 [Motor Type Selection] and the drive model change.
–E9-01 = 0 [Induction (IM)]
–2004 to 2313, 4002 to 4302, T103 to T302: 1
–2360, 2415, 4371 to 4720, T371 to T720: 2
–E9-01 = 1, 2 [Permanent Magnet (PM), Synchronous Reluctance (SynRM)]: 1
• When you set A1-02 = 8 and E9-01 = 1 or 2, also set b3-24 = 1. If b3-24 = 2, the drive will
detect oPE08 [Parameter Selection Error].
• When you set b3-24, it will trigger the drive to initialize b3-14 [Bi-directional Speed Search].
After you set b3-24, set b3-14.
1 : Speed Estimation
2 : Current Detection 2
b3-25 Speed Search Wait Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.5 s
(01C8) Sets the length of time the drive will wait to start the Speed Search Retry function. (0.0 - 30.0 s)
Expert
b3-26 Direction Determination V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1000
(01C7) Level Sets the level to find the motor rotation direction. Increase the value if the drive cannot find the (40 to 60000)
Expert direction.
Parameter List
b3-27 Speed Search RUN/BB V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01C9) Priority Sets the conditions necessary to start Speed Search. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : SS Only if RUN Applied Before BB
1 : SS Regardless of RUN/BB Sequence
b3-29 Speed Search Back-EMF V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10%
Threshold
(077C) Sets the induced voltage for motors that use Speed Search. The drive will start Speed Search when
the motor induced voltage level is the same as the setting value. Usually it is not necessary to change
(0 - 10%) 3
Expert
this setting.
b3-31 Spd Search Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.50
(0BC0) Reference Lvl Sets the current level that decreases the output current during Current Detection Speed Search. (1.50 - 3.50)
Expert
b3-32 Spd Search Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.20
(0BC1) Complete Lvl Sets the current level that completes Speed Search. (0.00 - 1.49)
Expert
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
b3-33 Speed Search during Uv V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0B3F) Selection Sets the function that starts Speed Search at start-up if the drive detects a Uv [Undervoltage] when it (0, 1)
Expert receives a Run command.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
b3-35 Low Back EMF Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10%
(0BC3) Level Sets the Low Back EMF Detection Level. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (5 - 50%)
Expert
b3-36 High Back EMF Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.970
(0BC4) Level Sets the voltage level for Speed Search restart. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.500 - 1.000)
Expert
b3-39 Regen Judgment Lv of Spd V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 15%
(1B8F) Search Sets the level to determine the regenerative state during speed search. Usually it is not necessary to (0 - 50%)
Expert change this setting.
b3-54 Search Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 400 ms
(3123) Sets the length of time that the drive will run Speed Search. (10 - 2000 ms)
b3-55 Current Increment Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 ms
(3124) Sets the length of time that the drive will increase the current from zero current to the setting value of (10 - 2000 ms)
Expert b3-06 [Speed Estimation Current Level 1].
b3-56 InverseRotationSearch V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(3126) WaitTime Sets the wait time until the drive starts inverse rotation search after it completes forward search when (0.1 - 5.0 s)
you do inverse rotation search during Current Detection Speed Search.
b3-61 Init Magnet Pole Estimation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5.0
(1B96) Gain Sets the responsiveness for initial motor magnetic pole calculation when A1-02 = 6 [Control Method (-20.0 - +20.0)
Expert Selection = AOLV/PM]. Set b3-61 > 0.0 for an ordinary IPM motor.
When you use High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning, the drive will automatically set this value.
Note:
• Set n8-35 = 1 [Initial Pole Calculation Method = High Frequency Injection] to enable this
parameter.
• When A1-02= 6 [AOLV/PM] and you do High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning, the drive
automatically sets this parameter .
• Set n8-41 [HFI P Gain] to adjust the responsiveness for initial motor magnetic pole calculation
when A1-02 = 5, 7 [OLV/PM, CLV/PM].
b4-01 Timer Function ON-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(01A3) Time Sets the ON-delay time for the timer input. (0.0 - 3000.0 s)
b4-02 Timer Function OFF-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(01A4) Time Sets the OFF-delay time for the timer input. (0.0 - 3000.0 s)
b4-03 Terminal M1-M2 ON-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(0B30) Time Sets the delay time to activate the contact after the function set in H2-01 activates. (0 - 65000 ms)
Expert
b4-04 Terminal M1-M2 OFF-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(0B31) Time Sets the delay time to deactivate the contact after the function set in H2-01 deactivates. (0 - 65000 ms)
Expert
b4-05 Terminal M3-M4 ON-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(0B32) Time Sets the delay time to activate the contact after the function set in H2-02 activates. (0 - 65000 ms)
Expert
b4-06 Terminal M3-M4 OFF-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(0B33) Time Sets the delay time to deactivate the contact after the function set in H2-02 deactivates. (0 - 65000 ms)
Expert
b4-07 Terminal M5-M6 ON-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(0B34) Time Sets the delay time to activate the contact after the function set in H2-03 activates. (0 - 65000 ms)
Expert
b4-08 Terminal M5-M6 OFF-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(0B35) Time Sets the delay time to deactivate the contact after the function set in H2-03 deactivates. (0 - 65000 ms)
Expert
b5-01 PID Mode Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01A5) Sets the type of PID control. (0 - 8)
0 : Disabled
1 : Standard
2 : Standard (D on feedback)
3 : Fref + PID Trim
4 : Fref + PID Trim (D on feedback)
5 : Same as 7series & prior, b5-01=1
6 : Same as 7series & prior, b5-01=2
7 : Same as 7series & prior, b5-01=3
8 : Same as 7series & prior, b5-01=4
Note:
Use settings 5 to 8 when the drive is a replacement for a previous generation drive.
b5-02 Proportional Gain (P) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(01A6) Sets the proportional gain (P) that is applied to PID input. (0.00 - 25.00)
RUN
b5-03 Integral Time (I) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 s
(01A7) Sets the integral time (I) that is applied to PID input. (0.0 - 360.0 s)
RUN
b5-04 Integral Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(01A8) Sets the upper limit for integral control (I) as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-05 Derivative Time (D) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 s
(01A9) Sets the derivative time (D) for PID control. This parameter adjusts system responsiveness. (0.00 - 10.00 s)
RUN
b5-06 PID Output Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(01AA) Sets the maximum possible output from the PID controller as a percentage of the Maximum Output (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN Frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-07 PID Offset Adjustment V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(01AB) Sets the offset for the PID control output as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. (-100.0 - +100.0%)
RUN Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-08 PID Primary Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 s
Parameter List
(01AC) Constant Sets the primary delay time constant for the PID control output. Usually it is not necessary to change (0.00 - 10.00 s)
RUN this setting.
Expert
b5-09 PID Output Level Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01AD) Sets the polarity of the PID output. (0, 1)
0 : Normal Output (Direct Acting) 3
1 : Reverse Output (Reverse Acting)
b5-10 PID Output Gain Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(01AE) Sets the amount of gain to apply to the PID output. (0.00 - 25.00)
RUN
b5-11 PID Output Reverse V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01AF) Selection Sets the function that enables and disables reverse motor rotation for negative PID control output. (0, 1)
0 : Lower Limit is Zero
1 : Negative Output Accepted
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
b5-12 Feedback Loss Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01B0) Select Sets the drive response to PID Feedback Low/High. Sets drive operation after the drive detects PID (0 - 5)
feedback Low/High.
0 : Digital Out Only, Always Detect
1 : Alarm + Digital Out, Always Det
2 : Fault + Digital Out, Always Det
3 : Digital Out Only, @ PID Enable
4 : Alarm + Digital Out, @PID Enable
5 : Fault + Digital Out, @PID Enable
b5-13 PID Feedback Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(01B1) Detection Lvl Sets the level that triggers PID Feedback Loss [FbL] detection as a percentage of the Maximum (0 - 100%)
Output Frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-14 PID Feedback Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 s
(01B2) Detection Time Sets the length of time that PID Feedback must be less than b5-13 [PID Feedback Loss Detection (0.0 - 25.5 s)
Lvl] to detect PID Feedback Loss [FbL].
b5-15 PID Sleep Function Start V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(01B3) Level Sets the output level that triggers the PID Sleep function. (0.0 - 590.0)
b5-16 PID Sleep Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(01B4) Sets a delay time to start or stop the PID Sleep function. (0.0 - 25.5 s)
b5-17 PID Accel/Decel Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(01B5) Raises or lowers the PID setpoint using the acceleration and deceleration times set to the drive. This (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN is a soft-starter for the PID setpoint.
b5-18 b5-19 PID Setpoint Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01DC) Sets the function that enables and disables b5-19 [PID Setpoint Value]. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
b5-19 PID Setpoint Value V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00%
(01DD) Sets the PID setpoint when b5-18 = 1 [b5-19 PID Setpoint Selection = Enabled]. (0.00 - 100.00%)
RUN
b5-20 PID Unit Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(01E2) Sets the number of digits to set and show the PID setpoint. (0 - 3)
0 : 0.01Hz units
1 : 0.01% units
2 : rev/min
3 : User Units
b5-34 PID Output Lower Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(019F) Level Sets the output lower limit for the PID control as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. (-100.0 - +100.0%)
RUN Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-35 PID Input Limit Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1000.0%
(01A0) Sets the output upper limit for the PID control as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. (0.0 - 1000.0%)
RUN Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-36 PID High Feedback V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100%
(01A1) Detection Lvl Sets the level that triggers Excessive PID Feedback [FbH] as a percentage of the Maximum Output (0 - 100%)
Frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
b5-37 PID High Feedback V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 s
(01A2) Detection Time Sets the length of time that the PID feedback signal must be more than the level set in b5-36 [PID (0.0 - 25.5 s)
Feedback High Detection Lvl] to cause Excessive PID Feedback [FbH].
b5-38 PID User Unit Display V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by b5-20
(01FE) Scaling Sets the value that the drive sets or shows as the PID setpoint when at the maximum output (1 - 60000)
frequency.
b5-39 PID User Unit Display V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by b5-20
(01FF) Digits Sets the number of digits to set and show the PID setpoint. (0 - 3)
0 : No Decimal Places (XXXXX)
1 : One Decimal Places (XXXX.X)
2 : Two Decimal Places (XXX.XX)
3 : Three Decimal Places (XX.XXX)
b5-40 Frequency Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(017F) Monitor @PID Sets the contents for monitor U1-01 [Frequency Reference] in PID control. (0, 1)
0 : U1-01 Includes PID Output
1 : U1-01 Excludes PID Output
b5-47 PID Trim Mode Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(017D) Reverse Sel Sets reverse motor rotation when the PID control output is negative. (0, 1)
0 : Lower Limit is Zero
1 : Negative Output Accepted
b5-53 PID Integrator Ramp Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(0B8F) Sets the responsiveness of PID control when the PID feedback changes quickly. (0.0 - 10.0 Hz)
RUN
b5-55 PID Feedback Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 000
(0BE1) Selection Sets the monitor (Ux-xx) used as the PID Feedback. Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. (000 - 999)
b5-56 PID Feedback Monitor Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(0BE2) Sets the gain for the monitor set in b5-55 [PID Feedback Monitor Selection]. (0.00 - 10.00)
b5-57 PID Feedback Monitor Bias V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00
(11DD) Sets the bias for the monitor specified in b5-55 [PID Feedback Monitor Selection]. (-10.00 - +10.00)
b5-58 PID Setpoints 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00%
(1182) Sets the PID setpoint when H1-xx = 3E or 3F [MFDI Function Select = PID Setpoint Selection 1/2]. (0.00 - 100.00%)
RUN This value is a percentage of the maximum output frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-59 PID Setpoints 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00%
(1183) Sets the PID setpoint when H1-xx = 3E or 3F [MFDI Function Select = PID Setpoint Selection 1/2]. (0.00 - 100.00%)
RUN This value is a percentage of the maximum output frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
b5-60 PID Setpoints 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00%
Parameter List
(1184) Sets the PID setpoint when H1-xx = 3E or 3F [MFDI Function Select = PID Setpoint Selection 1/2]. (0.00 - 100.00%)
RUN This value is a percentage of the maximum output frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
3
b5-61 PID Trim Mode Lower Limit 0
(119A) Sel Sets the function that adjusts the PID output in relation to the frequency reference. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
b5-62 PID Trim Mode Lower Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00%
(119B) Value Sets the PID Trim Mode Lower Limit Value as a percentage of the maximum output frequency. (0.00 - 100.00%)
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
b5-63 PID Differential FB Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 000
(119C) Sel Selects the monitor (Ux-xx) used as the PID Differential Feedback. Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx (000 - 999)
[Monitor].
b5-64 PID Differential FB Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(119D) Gain Sets the gain for the monitor specified in b5-63 [PID Differential FB Monitor Sel]. (0.00 - 10.00)
b5-65 PID Differential FB Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00
(119F) Bias Sets the bias for the monitor specified in b5-63 [PID Differential FB Monitor Sel]. (-10.00 - +10.00)
b5-66 PID Feedback Monitor Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11DE) Sets the signal level for the monitor specified in b5-55 [PID Feedback Monitor Selection]. (0, 1)
0 : Absolute
1 : Bi-directional (+/-)
b5-67 PID Differential FB Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11DF) Lvl Sets the signal level for the monitor specified in b5-63 [PID Differential FB Monitor Sel]. (0, 1)
0 : Absolute
1 : Bi-directional (+/-)
b5-89 Sleep Method Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B89) Sets sleep and wake up operation when using PID. (0, 1)
RUN 0 : Standard
1 : EZ Sleep/Wake-up
b5-90 EZ Sleep Unit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B90) Sets the measurement units for b5-91 [EZ Sleep Minimum Speed] and b5-92 [EZ Sleep Level]. (0, 1)
0 : 0.1Hz units
1 : rev/min
b5-91 EZ Sleep Minimum Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz or 0 min-1 (r/min)
(0B91) Sets the minimum speed for the EZ Sleep/Wakeup function. This parameter uses the largest value (0.0 to 590.0 Hz or 0 to
RUN from b5-91, b5-34 [PID Output Lower Limit Level], and d2-02 [Frequency Reference Lower Limit]. 35400 min-1 (r/min))
b5-92 EZ Sleep Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz or 0 min-1 (r/min)
(0B92) Sets the value that the output frequency or motor speed must be less than for longer than b5-93 [EZ (0.0 to 590.0 Hz or 0 to
RUN Sleep Time] to enter Sleep Mode. 35400 min-1 (r/min))
b5-93 EZ Sleep Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5.0 s
(0B93) Sets the length of time that the output frequency or motor speed must be less than b5-92 [EZ Sleep (0.0 - 1000.0 s)
RUN Level] to enter Sleep Mode.
b5-94 EZ Sleep Wake-up Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00%
(0B94) Sets the level at which the drive resumes operation when exiting Sleep Mode. (0.00 - 600.00%)
RUN
b5-95 EZ Sleep Wake-up Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B95) Sets the wake-up mode to use when exiting Sleep Mode. (0, 1)
0 : Absolute
1 : Setpoint Delta
b5-96 EZ Sleep Wake-up Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 s
(0B96) Sets the EZ Wake-up time. (0.0 - 1000.0 s)
RUN
b6-01 Dwell Reference at Start V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0
(01B6) Sets the output frequency that the drive will hold momentarily when the motor starts. (Determined by A1-02)
b6-02 Dwell Time at Start V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(01B7) Sets the length of time that the drive will hold the output frequency when the motor starts. (0.0 - 10.0 s)
b6-03 Dwell Reference at Stop V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0
(01B8) Sets the output frequency that the drive will hold momentarily when ramping to stop the motor. (Determined by A1-02)
b6-04 Dwell Time at Stop V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(01B9) Sets the length of time for the drive to hold the output frequency when ramping to stop the motor. (0.0 - 10.0 s)
b7-01 Droop Control Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(01CA) Sets the amount of deceleration when the torque reference is at 100% as a percentage of E1-04 (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN [Maximum Output Frequency].
b7-02 Droop Control Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.05 s
(01CB) Sets the responsiveness of Droop control. Decrease this setting when drive response is slow. Increase (0.03 - 2.00 s)
RUN this setting when hunting or oscillation occur.
b7-03 Droop Control Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(017E) Selection Sets the Droop control limit function. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
b8-01 Energy Saving Control V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(01CC) Selection Sets the Energy-saving control function. (0 - 2)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
2 : Automatic Optimization
Note:
Setting 2 is available only when A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM]
and in Expert Mode.
b8-02 Energy Saving Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(01CD) Sets the gain for Energy-saving control. (0.0 - 10.0)
RUN
Expert
b8-03 Energy Saving Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02,C6-
(01CE) Sets the responsiveness for Energy-saving control. 01 and o2-04
RUN (0.00 - 10.00 s)
Expert
b8-04 Energy Saving Coefficient V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-01, E2-
(01CF) Value Sets the Energy-saving control coefficient to maintain maximum motor efficiency. The default setting 11, and o2-04
Expert is for Yaskawa motors. (0.00 - 655.00)
b8-05 Power Detection Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 20 ms
(01D0) Sets the time constant to measure output power. (0 - 2000 ms)
Expert
b8-06 Search Operation Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(01D1) Limit Sets the voltage limit for Search Operation as a percentage of the motor rated voltage. (0 - 100%)
Expert
b8-16 PM E-Save Coefficient Ki V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
Parameter List
(01F8) Sets torque linearity. This parameter uses the Ki value from the motor nameplate. Usually it is not (0.00 - 3.00)
Expert necessary to change this setting.
b8-17 PM E-Save Coefficient Kt V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(01F9) Sets torque linearity. This parameter uses the Kt value from the motor nameplate. Usually it is not (0.00 - 3.00)
Expert necessary to change this setting.
b8-19 E-Save Search Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0B40) Sets the frequency of Energy-saving control search operations. Usually it is not necessary to change (10 - 300 Hz)
Expert this setting.
b8-20 E-Save Search Width V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 degrees
(0B41) Sets the amplitude of Energy-saving control search operations. (0.1 - 5.0 degrees)
Expert
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
b8-21 PM E-Save Search Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.3Hz
(0B42) Sets the gain of Energy-saving control search operations. (0.1 - 20.0 Hz)
Expert
b8-22 PM E-Save Search LPF V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 Hz
(0B43) Cutoff Freq Sets the frequency of the filter used to extract the high-efficiency phase from search operations. (1.0 - 30.0 Hz)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
b8-23 PM E-Save Search Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 15.0 degrees
(0B44) Sets the search operations output limit. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.0 - 30.0 degrees)
Expert
b8-24 PM E-Save High Freq ACR V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200.0 Hz
(0B45) Gain Sets the gain for high-frequency current control. (100.0 - 1000.0 Hz)
Expert
b8-25 PM E-Save Search Start V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0%
(0B46) Level Sets the start level for search operations. (0.0 - 100.0%)
Expert
b8-26 PM E-Save Power Setpoint V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0B47) Sets a value to increase torque accuracy. (-10.0 - +10.0%)
Expert
b8-28 Over Excitation Action V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B8B) Selection Sets the function for excitation operation. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
b8-29 Energy Saving Priority V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B8C) Selection Sets the priority of drive response between changes to the load or Energy-saving control. Enable this (0, 1)
to prioritize energy-saving control. Disable this to prioritize tracking related to fast load changes, and
prevent motor stall.
0 : Priority: Drive Response
1 : Priority: Energy Savings
b8-50 Standby Mode Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B0D) Sets the Standby Mode function. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
b8-51 Standby Mode Wait Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 600 s
(0B01) Sets the delay time before turning off the electromagnetic contactor after the drive stops. (0 - 6000 s)
b9-01 Zero Servo Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5
(01DA) Sets the responsiveness for the Zero Servo function. (0 - 100)
b9-02 Zero Servo Completion V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10
(01DB) Window Sets the range to trigger an output terminal set for “Zero Servo Complete” during Zero Servo (0 - 16383)
operation. Be sure to set the deviation from the Zero Servo start position.
3.6 C: Tuning
◆ C1: Accel & Decel Time
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
C1-01 Acceleration Time 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0200) Sets the length of time to accelerate from zero to maximum output frequency. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-02 Deceleration Time 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0201) Sets the length of time to decelerate from maximum output frequency to zero. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-03 Acceleration Time 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0202) Sets the length of time to accelerate from zero to maximum output frequency. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-04 Deceleration Time 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0203) Sets the length of time to decelerate from maximum output frequency to zero. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-05 Acceleration Time 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0204) Sets the length of time to accelerate from zero to maximum output frequency. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-06 Deceleration Time 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0205) Sets the length of time to decelerate from maximum output frequency to zero. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-07 Acceleration Time 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0206) Sets the length of time to accelerate from zero to maximum output frequency. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-08 Deceleration Time 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0207) Sets the length of time to decelerate from maximum output frequency to zero. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN
C1-09 Fast Stop Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(0208) Sets the length of time that the drive will decelerate to zero for a Fast Stop. (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
RUN Note:
• Decelerating too quickly can cause an ov [Overvoltage] fault that shuts off the drive while the
motor to coasts to a stop. Set a Fast Stop time in C1-09 that prevents motor coasting and makes
sure that the motor stops quickly and safely.
• When L2-29 = 0 [Kinetic Energy Backup Method = Single Drive KEB Ride-Thru 1] and you do
KEB Auto-Tuning, the drive will automatically set C1-09. If you must not change the Fast Stop
time, do not do KEB Tuning.
C1-10 Accel/Decel Time Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0209) Units Sets the setting units for C1-01 to C1-08 [Accel/Decel Times 1 to 4], C1-09 [Fast Stop Time], L2-06 (0, 1)
[Kinetic Energy Backup Decel Time], and L2-07 [Kinetic Energy Backup Accel Time].
0 : 0.01 s (0.00 to 600.00 s)
1 : 0.1 s (0.0 to 6000.0 s)
C1-11 Accel/Decel Time Switching V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(020A) Frequency Sets the frequency at which the drive will automatically change acceleration and deceleration times. (0.0 - 590.0 Hz)
Parameter List
C1-14 Accel/Decel Rate Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(0264) Sets the base frequency used to calculate acceleration and deceleration rates. (0.0 - 590.0 Hz)
RUN
C2-01 S-Curve Time @ Start of V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(020B) Accel Sets the S-curve acceleration time at start. (0.00 - 10.00 s)
C2-02 S-Curve Time @ End of V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.20 s
(020C) Accel Sets the S-curve acceleration time at completion. (0.00 - 10.00 s)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
C2-03 S-Curve Time @ Start of V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.20 s
(020D) Decel Sets the S-curve deceleration time at start. (0.00 - 10.00 s)
C2-04 S-Curve Time @ End of V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 s
(020E) Decel Sets the S-curve deceleration time at completion. (0.00 - 10.00 s)
C3-01 Slip Compensation Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(020F) Sets the gain for the slip compensation function. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.0 - 2.5)
RUN Note:
• When A1-02 = 4 [AOLV], you cannot change the setting while the drive is running.
• Correctly set these parameters before you change the slip compensation gain:
–E2-01 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
–E2-02 [Motor Rated Slip]
–E2-03 [Motor No-Load Current]
C3-02 Slip Compensation Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0210) Time Sets the slip compensation delay time when speed is unstable or when the slip compensation (0 - 10000 ms)
RUN response is too slow. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
C3-03 Slip Compensation Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200%
(0211) Sets the upper limit for the slip compensation function as a percentage of the motor rated slip. (0 - 250%)
C3-04 Slip Compensation at Regen V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0212) Sets the slip compensation function during regenerative operation. (0 - 2)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled Above 6Hz
2 : Enabled Above C3-15
C3-05 Output Voltage Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0213) Selection Sets the automatic reduction of motor magnetic flux when the output voltage is saturated. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
C3-16 Vout Modulation Limit Start V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 90.0%
(0261) Lvl Sets the modulation factor that starts the output voltage limit operation when C3-05 = 1 [Output (70.0 - 90.0%)
Expert Voltage Limit Selection = Enabled].
C3-17 Vout Modulation Limit Max V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0262) Level Sets the modulation factor used with C3-18 [Output Voltage Limit Level] for the output voltage limit (85.0 - 100.0%)
Expert operation when C3-05 = 1 [Output Voltage Limit Selection = Enabled].
C3-18 Output Voltage Limit Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 90.0%
(0263) Sets the maximum drop width of the voltage reference when C3-05 = 1 [Output Voltage Limit (50.0 - 100.0%)
Expert Selection = Enabled].
C3-21 Motor 2 Slip Compensation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(033E) Gain Sets the gain for the motor 2 slip compensation function. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0.0 - 2.5)
RUN setting.
Note:
Correctly set these parameters before changing the slip compensation gain:
• E4-01 [Motor 2 Rated Current]
• E4-02 [Motor 2 Rated Slip]
• E4-03 [Motor 2 Rated No-Load Current]
C3-22 Motor 2 Slip Comp Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(0241) Time Sets the slip compensation delay time for motor 2 when speed is unstable or when the slip (0 - 10000 ms)
RUN compensation response is too slow. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
C3-23 Motor 2 Slip Compensation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200%
(0242) Limit Sets the upper limit for the slip compensation function as a percentage of the motor 2 rated slip. (0 - 250%)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
C3-24 Motor 2 Slip Comp during V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0243) Regen Sets the slip compensation during regenerative operation function for motor 2. (0 - 2)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled Above 6Hz
2 : Enabled Above C3-15
C3-28 Adaptive Slip Control Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B5B) Sets the slip compensation function mode. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Normal
1 : Advanced
C4-01 Torque Compensation Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0215) Sets the gain for the torque compensation function. Use this parameter value for motor 1 when (0.00 - 2.50)
RUN operating multiple motors.
Note:
If A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZOLV], you cannot change the setting while the
drive is running.
C4-02 Torque Compensation Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0216) Time Sets the torque compensation delay time. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0 - 60000 ms)
RUN Note:
• When A1-02 = 5 [Control Method Selection = OLV/PM], you cannot change the setting while
the drive is running.
• When A1-02 = 8 [EZOLV], you cannot change the setting while the drive is running.
C4-03 Torque Compensation @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0217) FWD Start Set the amount of torque reference for forward start as a percentage of the motor rated torque. (0.0 - 200.0%)
C4-04 Torque Compensation @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0218) REV Start Sets the amount of torque reference for reverse start as a percentage of the motor rated torque. (-200.0 - 0.0%)
C4-05 Torque Compensation Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 ms
(0219) Sets the starting torque constant to use with C4-03 and C4-04 [Torque Compensation @ FWD/REV (0 - 200 ms)
Start].
C4-06 Motor 2 Torque Comp Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 150 ms
(021A) Time Sets the value if ov [Overvoltage] occurs with sudden changes in the load, at the end of acceleration, (0 - 10000 ms)
or at the start of deceleration.
C4-07 Motor 2 Torque V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(0341) Compensation Gain Sets the gain for motor 2 torque compensation function when using the Motor Switch function. (0.00 - 2.50)
RUN
C4-19 Torque Ripple Suppress Min V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 Hz
(0B8D) Freq If there is slow oscillation at low speeds, adjust this setting. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0.0 - 10.0 Hz)
Expert setting.
Increase this parameter in 1.0 Hz increments when current ripples and torque ripples occur during
low-speed operation. Set this parameter to 0.0 to disable the function if increasing the value does not
fix the problem.
Note:
Parameter List
Set C4-20 [Voltage Compensation Adjust 1] ≠ 0 to enable this parameter.
C4-20 Voltage Compensation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 120 Hz
(0BCB) Adjust 1 Sets voltage precision compensation. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0 - 200 Hz)
Expert
C4-21 Voltage Compensation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5
(0BCC) Adjust 2 Sets voltage precision compensation. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0 - 10) 3
Expert
C4-23 Current Control Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(1583) Sets the Current control gain. Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter. (0.50 - 2.50)
Expert
C5-01 ASR Proportional Gain 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(021B) Sets the gain to adjust ASR response. (0.00 - 300.00)
RUN Note:
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
C5-02 ASR Integral Time 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(021C) Sets the ASR integral time. (0.000 - 60.000 s)
RUN Note:
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
C5-03 ASR Proportional Gain 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(021D) Sets the gain to adjust ASR response. (0.00 - 300.00)
RUN Note:
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
C5-04 ASR Integral Time 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(021E) Sets the ASR integral time. (0.000 - 60.000 s)
RUN Note:
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
C5-05 ASR Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5.0%
(021F) Set the ASR output limit as a percentage of E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]. (0.0 - 20.0%)
C5-06 ASR Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0220) Sets the filter time constant of the torque reference output from the speed loop. Usually it is not (0.000 - 0.500 s)
necessary to change this setting.
C5-07 ASR Gain Switchover V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0221) Frequency Sets the frequency where the drive will switch between these parameters: (Determined by A1-02)
C5-01 and C5-03 [ASR Proportional Gain 1/2]
C5-02 and C5-04 [ASR Integral Time 1/2]
C5-08 ASR Integral Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 400%
(0222) Set the upper limit of the ASR integral amount as a percentage of the rated load. (0 - 400%)
C5-12 Integral Operation @ Accel/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0386) Decel Sets ASR integral operation during acceleration and deceleration. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
Note:
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
C5-17 Motor Inertia V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-
(0276) Sets the motor inertia. 01, and E5-01
Expert Note: (0.0001 - 600.00 kgm2)
The display units for the default setting and setting range are different for different models:
• 0.0001 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.0001 kgm2 to 6.0000 kgm2): 2004 to 2021, 4002 to 4012
• 0.001 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.001 kgm2 to 60.000 kgm2): 2030 to 2211, 4018 to 4103,
T103
• 0.01 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.01 kgm2 to 600.00 kgm2): 2257 to 2415, 4140 to 4720, T140
to T720
C5-18 Load Inertia Ratio V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(0277) Sets the load inertia ratio for the motor inertia. (0.0 - 6000.0)
Expert
C5-21 Motor 2 ASR Proportional V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(0356) Gain 1 Sets the gain to adjust ASR response for motor 2. (0.00 - 300.00)
RUN
C5-22 Motor 2 ASR Integral Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(0357) 1 Sets the ASR integral time for motor 2. (0.000 - 60.000 s)
RUN
C5-23 Motor 2 ASR Proportional V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(0358) Gain 2 Sets the gain to adjust ASR response for motor 2. (0.00 - 300.00)
RUN
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
C5-24 Motor 2 ASR Integral Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(0359) 2 Sets the ASR integral time for motor 2. (0.000 - 60.000 s)
RUN
C5-25 Motor 2 ASR Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5.0%
(035A) Set the motor 2 ASR output limit as a percentage of E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]. (0.0 - 20.0%)
C5-26 Motor 2 ASR Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(035B) Sets the motor 2 filter time constant of the torque reference output from the speed loop. Usually it is (0.000 - 0.500 s)
not necessary to change this setting.
C5-27 Motor 2 ASR Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0
(035C) Switchover Freq Sets the frequency where the drive will switch between these parameters: (0.0 - 400.0)
C5-21 and C5-23 [Motor 2 ASR Proportional Gain 1/2]
C5-22 and C5-24 [Motor 2 ASR Integral Time 1/2]
C5-28 Motor 2 ASR Integral Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 400%
(035D) Set the upper limit of the motor 2 ASR integral amount as a percentage of the rated load. (0 - 400%)
C5-29 Speed Control Response V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B18) Sets the level of speed control responsiveness. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Standard
1 : High Performance 1
C5-32 Motor 2 Integral Oper at V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0361) Acc/Dec Sets ASR integral operation during acceleration and deceleration for motor 2. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
C5-37 Motor 2 Inertia V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0278) Sets the motor inertia for motor 2. (0.0001 - 600.00 kgm2)
Expert Note:
The display units for the default setting and setting range are different for different models:
• 0.0001 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.0001 kgm2 to 6.0000 kgm2): 2004 to 2021, 4002 to 4012
• 0.001 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.001 kgm2 to 60.000 kgm2): 2030 to 2211, 4018 to 4103,
T103
• 0.01 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.01 kgm2 to 600.00 kgm2): 2257 to 2415, 4140 to 4720, T140
to T720
C5-38 Motor 2 Load Inertia Ratio V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(0279) Sets the load inertia ratio for the motor 2 inertia. (0.0 - 6000.0)
Expert
C5-39 ASR Primary Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.000 s
(030D) Const 2 Sets the filter time constant used when the torque reference is output from ASR. Usually it is not (0.000 - 0.500 s)
necessary to change this parameter.
C5-50 Notch Filter Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 Hz
(0B14) Sets the machine resonance frequency. (0, or 2 to 100 Hz)
Expert Note:
Set C5-50 = 0 [0 Hz] to disable the notch filter.
C5-51 Notch Filter Bandwidth V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(0B15) Sets the notch width of the notch filter. (0.5 - 5.0)
Expert Note:
Set C5-50 = 0 [Notch Filter Frequency = 0 Hz] to disable the notch filter.
Parameter List
C6-01 Normal / Heavy Duty V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0223) Selection Sets the drive duty rating. (0, 1)
0 : Heavy Duty Rating
1 : Normal Duty Rating
C6-02 Carrier Frequency Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02, C6-
(0224) Sets the carrier frequency for the transistors in the drive. 01, and o2-04
1 : 2.0 kHz (Determined by A1-02)
2 : 5.0 kHz (4.0 kHz for AOLV/PM)
3 : 8.0 kHz (6.0 kHz for AOLV/PM)
4 : 10.0 kHz (8.0 kHz for AOLV/PM)
5 : 12.5 kHz (10.0 kHz for AOLV/PM)
6 : 15.0 kHz (12.0 kHz for AOLV/PM)
7 : Swing PWM4 (Audible Sound 1)
8 : Swing PWM4 (Audible Sound 2)
9 : Swing PWM4 (Audible Sound 3)
A : Swing PWM4 (Audible Sound 4)
F : User Defined (C6-03 to C6-05)
Note:
The carrier frequency for Swing PWM 1 to 4 is equivalent to 2.0 kHz.
C6-03 Carrier Frequency Upper V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-02
(0225) Limit Sets the upper limit of the carrier frequency. Set C6-02 = F [Carrier Frequency Selection = User (1.0 - 15.0 kHz)
Defined (C6-03 to C6-05)] to set this parameter.
C6-04 Carrier Frequency Lower V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-02
(0226) Limit Sets the lower limit of the carrier frequency. Set C6-02 = F [Carrier Frequency Selection = User (1.0 - 15.0 kHz)
Defined (C6-03 to C6-05)] to set this parameter.
C6-05 Carrier Freq Proportional V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-02
(0227) Gain Sets the proportional gain for the carrier frequency. Set C6-02 = F [Carrier Frequency Selection = (0 - 99)
User Defined (C6-03 to C6-05)] to set this parameter.
C6-09 Carrier Freq at Rotational V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(022B) Tune Sets the Auto-Tuning carrier frequency. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0, 1)
0 : 5kHz
1 : use C6-03
d1-01 Reference 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0280) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-02 Reference 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0281) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-03 Reference 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0282) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-04 Reference 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0283) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-05 Reference 5 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0284) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-06 Reference 6 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0285) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-07 Reference 7 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0286) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-08 Reference 8 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0287) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-09 Reference 9 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
Parameter List
(0288) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-10 Reference 10 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(028B) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note: 3
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-11 Reference 11 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(028C) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
d1-12 Reference 12 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(028D) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-13 Reference 13 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(028E) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-14 Reference 14 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(028F) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-15 Reference 15 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0290) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-16 Reference 16 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0291) Sets the frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive changes o1-03
= 1 [0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d1-17 Jog Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 6.00 Hz
(0292) Sets the Jog frequency reference in the units from o1-03 [Frequency Display Unit Selection]. Set H1- (0.00 - 590.00 Hz)
RUN xx = 6 [MFDI Function Select = Jog Reference Selection] to use the Jog frequency reference.
Note:
When A1-02 = 6, 7 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM, CLV/PM], the drive sets o1-03 = 1
[0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
d2-01 Frequency Reference Upper V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0289) Limit Sets maximum limit for all frequency references. The maximum output frequency is 100%. (0.0 - 110.0%)
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Motor Max Revolutions]
d2-02 Frequency Reference Lower V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(028A) Limit Sets minimum limit for all frequency references. The maximum output frequency is 100%. (0.0 - 110.0%)
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Motor Max Revolutions]
d2-03 Analog Frequency Ref V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0293) Lower Limit Sets the lower limit for the master frequency reference (the first frequency of the multi-step speed (0.0 - 110.0%)
reference) as a percentage. The maximum output frequency is 100%.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
d3-01 Jump Frequency 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(0294) Sets the median value of the frequency band that the drive will avoid. (Determined by A1-02)
d3-02 Jump Frequency 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(0295) Sets the median value of the frequency band that the drive will avoid. (Determined by A1-02)
d3-03 Jump Frequency 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(0296) Sets the median value of the frequency band that the drive will avoid. (Determined by A1-02)
d3-04 Jump Frequency Width V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 Hz
(0297) Sets the width of the frequency band that the drive will avoid. (Determined by A1-02)
d4-01 Freq Reference Hold V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0298) Selection Sets the function that saves the frequency reference or the frequency bias (Up/Down 2) after a Stop (0, 1)
command or when de-energizing the drive.
Set H1-xx [MFDI Function Selection] to one of these values to enable this parameter:
• A [Accel/Decel Ramp Hold]
• 10/11 [Up/Down Command]
• 75/76 [Up/Down 2 Command]
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
d4-03 Up/Down 2 Bias Step V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(02AA) Frequency Sets the bias that the Up/Down 2 function adds to or subtracts from the frequency reference. (0.00 - 99.99 Hz)
RUN
d4-04 Up/Down 2 Ramp Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02AB) Sets the acceleration and deceleration times for the Up/Down 2 function to apply the bias to the (0, 1)
RUN frequency reference.
0 : Use Selected Accel/Decel Time
1 : Use Accel/Decel Time 4
d4-05 Up/Down 2 Bias Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02AC) Selection Sets the function that saves the bias value to the drive when you open or close the two Up/Down 2 (0, 1)
RUN Commands [H1-xx = 75, 76]. Set d4-03 [Up/Down 2 Bias Step Frequency] = 0.00 before you set this
parameter.
0 : Hold when Neither Up/Down Closed
1 : Reset when Neither / Both Closed
d4-06 Frequency Ref Bias (Up/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(02AD) Down 2) Saves the bias value from the Up/Down 2 Command where the Maximum Output Frequency is (-99.9 - +100.0%)
100%.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
Parameter List
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
d4-07 Analog Freq Ref Fluctuate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0%
(02AE) Limit If the frequency reference changes for more than the level set to this parameter, then the bias value (0.1 - 100.0%)
RUN will be held. The value is set as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency] 3
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
d4-08 Up/Down 2 Bias Upper V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(02AF) Limit Sets the upper limit of the Up/Down 2 bias as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
d4-09 Up/Down 2 Bias Lower V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(02B0) Limit Sets the lower limit of the Up/Down 2 bias as a percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency. (-99.9 - 0.0%)
RUN Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
d4-10 Up/Down Freq Lower Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02B6) Select Sets the lower frequency limit for the Up/Down function. (0, 1)
0 : Greater of d2-02 or Analog
1 : d2-02
d5-01 Torque Control Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(029A) Sets the drive for torque control or speed control. (0, 1)
0 : Speed Control
1 : Torque Control
d5-02 Torque Reference Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(029B) Time Sets the primary delay time constant for the torque reference filter. (0 - 1000 ms)
d5-03 Speed Limit Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(029C) Sets the torque control speed limit method. (1, 2)
1 : Active Frequency Reference
2 : d5-04 Setting
d5-04 Speed Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(029D) Sets the speed limit during Torque Control as a percentage of E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]. (-120 - +120%)
Set d5-03 = 2 [Speed Limit Selection = d5-04 Setting] before you set this parameter.
d5-05 Speed Limit Bias V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10%
(029E) Sets the speed limit bias value as a percentage of E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]. (0 - 120%)
d5-06 Speed/Torque Changeover V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(029F) Time Sets the delay time to switch between Speed Control and Torque Control. Set H1-xx = 71 [MFDI (0 - 1000 ms)
Function Selection = Torque Control] before you set this parameter.
d5-08 Uni-directional Speed Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(02B5) Bias Sets the direction of the speed limit reference to which Speed Limit Bias [d5-05] applies. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
d6-01 Field Weakening Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 80%
(02A0) Sets the drive output voltage as a percentage of E1-05 [Maximum Output Voltage] when H1-xx = 63 (0 - 100%)
[Field Weakening] is activated.
d6-02 Field Weakening Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(02A1) Limit Sets the minimum output frequency to start field weakening. (0.0 - 590.0 Hz)
d6-03 Field Forcing Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02A2) Sets the field forcing function. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
d6-06 Field Forcing Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 400%
(02A5) Sets the limit value for field forcing to increase the motor excitation current reference as a percentage (100 - 400%)
of E2-03 [Motor No-Load Current]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
d7-01 Offset Frequency 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(02B2) Uses H1-xx = 44 [MFDI Function Select = Add Offset Frequency 1 (d7-01)] as a percentage of the (-100.0 - +100.0%)
RUN Maximum Output Frequency to add or subtract the set frequency to/from the frequency reference.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
d7-02 Offset Frequency 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(02B3) Uses H1-xx = 45 [MFDI Function Select = Add Offset Frequency 2 (d7-02)] as a percentage of the (-100.0 - +100.0%)
RUN Maximum Output Frequency to add or subtract the set frequency to/from the frequency reference.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
d7-03 Offset Frequency 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(02B4) Uses H1-xx = 46 [MFDI Function Select = Add Offset Frequency 3 (d7-03)] as a percentage of the (-100.0 - +100.0%)
RUN Maximum Output Frequency to add or subtract the set frequency to/from the frequency reference.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
Parameter List
E1-01 Input AC Supply Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 240 V,
(0300) Sets the drive input voltage. 400 V Class: 480 V
NOTICE: Set parameter E1-01 to align with the drive input voltage (not (200 V Class: 155 to 255 V,
400 V Class: 310 to 510 V)
motor voltage). If this parameter is incorrect, the protective functions of
the drive will not operate correctly and it can cause damage to the drive.
E1-03 V/f Pattern Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0302) Sets the V/f pattern for the drive and motor. You can use one of the preset patterns or you can make a (Determined by A1-02)
custom pattern.
0 : Const Trq, 50Hz base, 50Hz max
1 : Const Trq, 60Hz base, 60Hz max
2 : Const Trq, 50Hz base, 60Hz max
3 : Const Trq, 60Hz base, 72Hz max
4 : VT, 50Hz, 65% Vmid reduction
5 : VT, 50Hz, 50% Vmid reduction
6 : VT, 60 Hz, 65% Vmid reduction
7 : VT, 60Hz, 50% Vmid reduction
8 : High Trq, 50Hz, 25% Vmin boost
9 : High Trq, 50Hz, 65% Vmin boost
A : High Trq, 60Hz, 25% Vmin boost
B : High Trq, 60Hz, 65% Vmin boost
C : High Freq, 60Hz base, 90Hz max
D : High Freq, 60Hz base, 120Hz max
E : High Freq, 60Hz base, 180Hz max
F : Custom
Note:
• When A1-02 = 2 [Control Method Selection = OLV], settings 0 to E are not available.
• Set the correct V/f pattern for the application and operation area. An incorrect V/f pattern can
decrease motor torque and increase current from overexcitation.
E1-04 Maximum Output Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02 and
(0303) Sets the maximum output frequency for the V/f pattern. E5-01
(Determined by A1-02 and
E5-01)
E1-05 Maximum Output Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 230.0 V, 400 V:
(0304) Sets the maximum output voltage for the V/f pattern. 460.0 V
(200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
E1-06 Base Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02 and
(0305) Sets the base frequency for the V/f pattern. E5-01
(0.0 - E1-04)
E1-07 Mid Point A Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0306) Sets a middle output frequency for the V/f pattern. (0.0 - E1-04)
E1-08 Mid Point A Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02,C6-
(0307) Sets a middle output voltage for the V/f pattern. 01 and o2-04
(200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
E1-09 Minimum Output Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02 and
(0308) Sets the minimum output frequency for the V/f pattern. E5-01
(Determined by A1-02, E1-
04, and E5-01)
E1-10 Minimum Output Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0309) Sets the minimum output voltage for the V/f pattern. (200 V Class: 0.0 to 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 to 510.0 V)
E1-11 Mid Point B Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(030A) Sets a middle output frequency for the V/f pattern. (0.0 - E1-04)
Expert
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
E1-12 Mid Point B Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 V
(030B) Sets a middle point voltage for the V/f pattern. (200 V Class: 0.0 to 255.0 V,
Expert 400 V Class: 0.0 to 510.0 V)
E1-13 Base Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 V
(030C) Sets the base voltage for the V/f pattern. (200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0
Expert V,400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0
V)
E2-01 Motor Rated Current (FLA) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(030E) Sets the motor rated current in amps. (10% to 200% of the drive
rated current)
E2-02 Motor Rated Slip V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(030F) Sets motor rated slip. (0.000 - 20.000 Hz)
E2-03 Motor No-Load Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0310) Sets the no-load current for the motor in amps when operating at the rated frequency and the no-load (0 to E2-01)
voltage.
E2-04 Motor Pole Count V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(0311) Sets the number of motor poles. (2 - 120)
Note:
• When A1-02 = 0, 1, 3 [Control Method Selection = V/f, CL-V/f, CLV], the maximum value is
120.
• When A1-02 = 2, 4 [OLV, AOLV], the maximum value is 48.
E2-05 Motor Line-to-Line V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0312) Resistance Sets the line-to-line resistance for the motor stator windings. (0.000 - 65.000 Ω)
E2-06 Motor Leakage Inductance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0313) Sets the voltage drop from motor leakage inductance when the motor is operating at the rated (0.0 - 60.0%)
frequency and rated current. This value is a percentage of Motor Rated Voltage.
E2-07 Motor Saturation Coefficient V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.50
(0314) 1 Sets the motor iron-core saturation coefficient at 50% of the magnetic flux. (0.00 - 0.50)
E2-08 Motor Saturation Coefficient V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.75
(0315) 2 Sets the motor iron-core saturation coefficient at 75% of the magnetic flux. (E2-07 - 0.75)
E2-09 Motor Mechanical Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0316) Sets the mechanical loss of the motor. It is set as a percentage of E2-11 [Motor Rated Power]. (0.0 - 10.0%)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
E2-10 Motor Iron Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0317) Sets the motor iron loss. (0 - 65535 W)
E2-11 Motor Rated Power V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0318) Sets the motor rated output in the units from o1-58 [Motor Power Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 650.00)
E3-01 Motor 2 Control Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
Selection
(0319) Sets the control method for motor 2.
Note:
(0 - 3)
3
When you change this setting, the drive will set all parameters that are dependent on this
parameter to their default settings.
0 : V/f Control
1 : V/f Control with Encoder
2 : Open Loop Vector
3 : Closed Loop Vector
E3-04 Motor 2 Maximum Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(031A) Frequency Set the maximum output frequency for the motor 2 V/f pattern. (40.0 - 590.0 Hz)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
E3-05 Motor 2 Maximum Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(031B) Voltage Sets the maximum output voltage for the motor 2 V/f pattern. (200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
E3-06 Motor 2 Base Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(031C) Sets the base frequency for the motor 2 V/f pattern. (0.0 - E3-04)
E3-07 Motor 2 Mid Point A V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(031D) Frequency Sets a middle output frequency for the motor 2 V/f pattern. (0.0 - E3-04)
E3-08 Motor 2 Mid Point A Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(031E) Sets a middle output voltage for the motor 2 V/f pattern. (200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
E3-09 Motor 2 Minimum Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(031F) Frequency Sets the minimum output frequency for the motor 2 V/f pattern. (0.0 - E3-04)
E3-10 Motor 2 Minimum Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E3-01
(0320) Voltage Sets the minimum output voltage for the motor 2 V/f pattern. (200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
E3-11 Motor 2 Mid Point B V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 Hz
(0345) Frequency Sets a middle output frequency for the motor 2 V/f pattern. Set this parameter to adjust the V/f (0.0 - E3-04)
Expert pattern for the constant output range. Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter.
E3-12 Motor 2 Mid Point B Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 V
(0346) Sets a middle output voltage for the motor 2 V/f pattern. Set this parameter to adjust the V/f pattern (200 V Class: 0.0 to 255.0 V,
Expert for the constant output range. Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter. 400 V Class: 0.0 to 510.0 V)
E3-13 Motor 2 Base Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 V
(0347) Sets the base voltage for the motor 2 V/f pattern. Set this parameter to adjust the V/f pattern for the (200 V Class: 0.0 to 255.0 V,
Expert constant output range. Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter. 400 V Class: 0.0 to 510.0 V)
E4-01 Motor 2 Rated Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0321) Sets the motor rated current for motor 2 in amps. (10% to 200% of the drive
rated current)
E4-02 Motor 2 Rated Slip V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0322) Sets the motor rated slip for motor 2. (0.000 - 20.000 Hz)
E4-03 Motor 2 Rated No-Load V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0323) Current Sets the no-load current for motor 2 in amps when operating at the rated frequency and the no-load (Less than 0 - E4-01)
voltage.
E4-04 Motor 2 Motor Poles V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(0324) Sets the number of poles for motor 2. (2 - 120)
E4-05 Motor 2 Line-to-Line V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0325) Resistance Sets the line-to-line resistance for the motor 2 stator windings. (0.000 - 65.000 Ω)
E4-06 Motor 2 Leakage Inductance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0326) Sets the voltage drop from motor 2 leakage inductance as a percentage of Motor Rated Voltage when (0.0 - 60.0%)
motor 2 operates at the rated frequency and rated current.
E4-07 Motor 2 Saturation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.50
(0343) Coefficient 1 Sets the motor 2 iron-core saturation coefficient at 50% of the magnetic flux. (0.00 - 0.50)
E4-08 Motor 2 Saturation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.75
(0344) Coefficient 2 Sets the motor 2 iron-core saturation coefficient at 75% of the magnetic flux. (E4-07 - 0.75)
E4-09 Motor 2 Mechanical Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(033F) Sets the mechanical loss of motor 2. It is set as a percentage of E4-11 [Motor 2 Rated Power]. (0.0 - 10.0%)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
E4-10 Motor 2 Iron Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0340) Sets the motor iron loss for motor 2. (0 - 65535 W)
E4-11 Motor 2 Rated Power V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0327) Sets the motor rated power in the units from o1-58 [Motor Power Unit Selection]. (0.00 - 650.00 HP)
E5-01 PM Motor Code Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV FFFF
(0329) Sets the motor code for Yaskawa PM motors. The drive uses the motor code to automatically set (0000 - FFFF)
some parameters to their correct settings.
E5-02 PM Motor Rated Power V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(032A) Sets the PM motor rated output in the units set in o1-58 [Motor Power Unit Selection]. (0.10 - 650.00 HP)
E5-03 Motor Rated Current (FLA) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E5-01
(032B) Sets the PM motor rated current (FLA). (10% to 200% of the drive
rated current)
E5-04 PM Motor Pole Count V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(032C) Sets the number of PM motor poles. (2 - 120)
Note:
• When A1-02 = 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV/PM], the maximum value is 120.
• When A1-02 = 5, 6 or 8 [OLV/PM, AOLV/PM or EZOLV], the maximum value is 48.
E5-05 PM Motor Resistance (ohms/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.100 Ω
(032D) phase) Sets the resistance per phase of a PM motor. Set 50% of the line-to-line resistance. (0.000 - 65.000 Ω)
E5-06 PM d-axis Inductance (mH/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00 mH
(032E) phase) Sets the PM motor d-axis inductance. (0.00 - 300.00 mH)
E5-07 PM q-axis Inductance (mH/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00 mH
(032F) phase) Sets the PM motor q-axis inductance. (0.00 - 600.00 mH)
E5-09 PM Back-EMF Vpeak (mV/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 mV/(rad/sec)
(0331) (rad/s)) Sets the peak value of PM motor induced voltage. (0.0 - 2000.0 mV/(rad/s))
E5-11 Encoder Z-Pulse Offset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 degrees
(0333) Sets the encoder Z-pulse offset. (-180.0 - +180.0 degrees)
E5-24 PM Back-EMF L-L Vrms V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class:
(0353) (mV/rpm) Sets the RMS value for PM motor line voltage. 100.0 mV/min-1
400 V Class:
200.0 mV/min-1
(0.0 - 6500.0 mV/min-1)
E5-25 Polarity Estimation Timeout V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(035E) Sets the function that switches polarity for initial polarity estimation. Usually it is not necessary to (0, 1)
Expert change this setting.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
E9-01 Motor Type Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11E4) Sets the type of motor. (0 - 2)
0 : Induction (IM)
Parameter List
1 : Permanent Magnet (PM)
2 : Synchronous Reluctance (SynRM)
E9-02 Maximum Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-01
(11E5) Sets the maximum speed of the motor. (40.0 - 120.0 Hz)
E9-03 Rated Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-01
(11E6) Sets the rated rotation speed of the motor. (100 - 7200 min-1) 3
E9-04 Base Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-01
(11E7) Sets the rated frequency of the motor. (40.0 - 120.0 Hz)
E9-05 Base Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 230.0 V,
(11E8) Sets the rated voltage of the motor. 400 V Class: 460.0 V
(200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
E9-06 Motor Rated Current (FLA) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-01 and
(11E9) Sets the motor rated current in amps. o2-04
(10% to 200% of the drive
rated current)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
E9-07 Motor Rated Power V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-02 and
(11EA) Sets the motor rated output in the units from o1-58 [Motor Power Unit Selection]. o2-04
(0.00 - 650.00 kW)
E9-08 Motor Pole Count V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(11EB) Sets the number of motor poles. (2 to 120)
E9-09 Motor Rated Slip V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.000 Hz
(11EC) Sets the motor rated slip. (0.000 - 20.000 Hz)
E9-10 Motor Line-to-Line V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(11ED) Resistance Sets the line-to-line resistance for the motor stator windings. (0.000 - 65.000 Ω)
3.9 F: Options
◆ F1: Encoder Option Setup
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F1-01 Encoder 1 Pulse Count V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1024 ppr
(0380) (PPR) Sets the number of output pulses for each motor revolution. (1 - 60000 ppr)
F1-02 Encoder Signal Loss Detect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0381) Sel Sets the method to stop the motor or let the motor continue operating when the drive detects PGo (0 - 4)
[Encoder (PG) Feedback Loss].
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
4 : No Alarm Display
F1-03 Overspeed Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0382) Selection Sets the method to stop the motor or let the motor continue operating when the drive detects oS (0 - 3)
[Overspeed].
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
F1-04 Speed Deviation Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(0383) Select Sets the method to stop the motor or let the motor continue operating when the drive detects dEv (0 - 3)
[Speed Deviation].
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
F1-05 Encoder 1 Rotation Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0384) Sets the output sequence for the A and B pulses from the encoder, assuming that the motor is (0, 1)
operating in the forward direction.
0 : Pulse A leads in FWD Direction
1 : Pulse B leads in FWD Direction
F1-06 Encoder 1 Pulse Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 001
(0385) Scaling Sets the ratio between the pulse input and the pulse output of the encoder as a 3-digit number. The (001 - 032, 102 - 132 (1 - 1/
first digit is the numerator and the second and third digits set the denominator. 32))
The dividing ratio = (1 + x)/yz when the setting value is a 3-digit value (xyz).
F1-08 Overspeed Detection Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 115%
(0387) Sets the detection level of oS [Overspeed] as a percentage when the maximum output frequency is (0 - 120%)
100%.
Note:
• Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
–A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
–A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
• If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
Parameter List
F1-09 Overspeed Detection Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0388) Time Sets the length of time that the speed feedback must be more than the F1-08 level to cause oS (0.0 - 2.0 s)
[Overspeed].
Note:
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
F1-10 Speed Deviation Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10%
3
(0389) Level Sets the detection level of dEv [Speed Deviation] as a percentage when the maximum output (0 - 50%)
frequency is 100%.
Note:
• Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
–A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
–A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
• If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F1-11 Speed Deviation Detect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.5 s
(038A) DelayTime Sets the length of time that the difference between the frequency reference and speed feedback must (0.0 - 10.0 s)
be more than the level in F1-10 to cause dEv [Speed Deviation].
Note:
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
F1-12 Encoder 1 Gear Teeth 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(038B) Sets the number of gear teeth on the motor side. This parameter and F1-13 [Encoder 1 Gear Teeth 2] (0 - 1000)
set the gear ratio between the motor and encoder.
F1-13 Encoder 2 Gear Teeth 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(038C) Sets the number of gear teeth on the load side. This parameter and F1-12 [Encoder 1 Gear Teeth 1] (0 - 1000)
set the gear ratio between the motor and encoder.
F1-14 Encoder Open-Circuit Detect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2.0 s
(038D) Time Sets the length of time that the drive must not receive a pulse signal to cause PGo [Encoder (PG) (0.0 - 10.0 s)
Feedback Loss].
Note:
Motor speed and load conditions can cause ov [Overvoltage] and oC [Overcurrent] faults.
If A1-02 = 0 [Control Method Selection = V/f], you must set H6-01 = 3 [Terminal RP Pulse
Train Function = Speed Feedback (V/F Control)] to enable this parameter.
F1-17 Deviation 2 Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10
(03AC) Selection Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. Sets the number of motor rotations that the drive (0 - 100)
will detect more than one Z pulse per rotation to detect dv2.
F1-18 Deviation 3 Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10
(03AD) Selection Sets the number of rotations necessary to detect conditions that invert the torque reference and rate of (0 - 10)
acceleration and cause dv3 [Inversion Detection].
F1-19 Deviation 4 Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 128
(03AE) Selection Sets the number of pulses necessary to cause dv4 [Inversion Prevention Detection]. (0 - 5000)
F1-20 Encoder 1 PCB Disconnect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03B4) Detect Sets the function that enables and disables detection of a disconnected encoder connection cable to (0, 1)
cause PGoH [Encoder (PG) Hardware Fault].
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
F1-21 Encoder 1 Signal Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03BC) Sets the number of channels for the signal to the encoder option card. (0, 1)
0 : A Pulse Detection
1 : AB Pulse Detection
F1-30 Motor 2 Encoder PCB Port V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03AA) Select Sets the drive port to install the motor 2 encoder option card. (0, 1)
0 : CN5-C
1 : CN5-B
F1-31 Encoder 2 Pulse Count V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1024 ppr
(03B0) (PPR) Sets the number of output pulses for each motor revolution for motor 2. (1 - 60000 ppr)
F1-32 Encoder 2 Rotation Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03B1) Sets the output sequence for the A and B pulses from the encoder for motor 2. This parameter (0, 1)
assumes that the motor is operating in the forward direction.
0 : Pulse A leads in FWD Direction
1 : Pulse B leads in FWD Direction
F1-33 Encoder 2 Gear Teeth 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03B2) Sets the number of gear teeth on the motor side for motor 2. This parameter and F1-34 [Encoder 2 (0 - 1000)
Gear Teeth 2] set the gear ratio between the motor and encoder.
F1-34 Encoder 2 Gear Teeth 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03B3) Sets the number of gear teeth on the load side for motor 2. This parameter and F1-33 [Encoder 2 (0 - 1000)
Gear Teeth 1] set the gear ratio between the motor and encoder.
F1-35 Encoder 2 Pulse Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 001
(03BE) Scaling Sets the ratio between the pulse input and the pulse output of the encoder as a 3-digit number for (001 - 032, 102 - 132 (1 - 1/
motor 2. The first digit is the numerator and the second and third digits set the denominator. 32))
The dividing ratio = (1 + x)/yz when the setting value is a 3-digit value (xyz).
F1-36 Encoder 2 PCB Disconnect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03B5) Detect Sets the function that enables and disables detection of a disconnected encoder connection cable to (0, 1)
cause PGoH [Encoder (PG) Hardware Fault] for motor 2.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F1-37 Encoder 2 Signal Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03BD) Sets the number of channels for the signal to the encoder option card for motor 2. (0, 1)
0 : A Pulse Detection
1 : AB Pulse Detection
F1-46 dv2 Detection Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B98) Selection Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. Sets the detection method for dv2 [Z Pulse Noise (0, 1)
Fault Detection].
0 : ElectricalAngle Detection Method
1 : MechanicalAngle Detection Method
F1-47 Deviation 2 Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 15°
(1B99) Selection Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. Sets the sensitivity of detection for dv2 [Z Pulse (0 - 180°)
Noise Fault Detection]. Increase the value to decrease the sensitivity.
F1-50 PG-F3 Option Encoder Type V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03D2) Sets the type of encoder connected to the PG-F3 option. (0 - 2)
0 : EnDat Sin/Cos
1 : EnDat Serial Only
2 : HIPERFACE
F1-51 PG-F3 PGoH Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 80%
(03D3) Level The drive will detect PGoH [Encoder (PG) Hardware Fault] if the value of this parameter is smaller (1 - 100%)
than the value of .
Note:
This function is enabled when F1-20 = 1 [Encoder 1 PCB Disconnect Detect = Enabled].
F1-52 Serial Encoder Comm Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03D4) Sets the communication speed between the PG-F3 option and the serial encoder. (0 - 2)
0 : 1M/9600bps
1 : 500k/19200bps
2 : 1M/38400bps
F2-01 Analog Input Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(038F) Selection Sets the input method for the analog reference used with AI-A3. (0, 1)
0 : 3 Independent Channels
1 : 3 Channels Added Together
F2-02 Analog Input Option Card V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0368) Gain Sets the analog reference gain as a percentage when the maximum output frequency is 100%. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN Note:
• Set F2-01 = 1 [Analog Input Function Selection = 3 Channels Added Together] to enable this
function.
• Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
–A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
–A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Parameter List
F2-03 Analog Input Option Card 0.0%
(0369) Bias Sets the analog reference bias as a percentage when the maximum output frequency is 100%. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN Note:
• Set F2-01 = 1 [Analog Input Function Selection = 3 Channels Added Together] to enable this
function.
• Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
–A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
–A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
3
F3-01 Digital Input Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 8
(0390) Selection Sets the data format of digital input signals. This parameter is enabled when o1-03 = 0 or 1 (0 - 8)
[Frequency Display Unit Selection = 0.01 Hz or 0.01% (100% = E1-04)].
Note:
When o1-03 = 2 or 3 [Revolutions Per Minute (RPM) or User Units (o1-10 & o1-11)], the input
signal will be BCD. The o1-03 value sets the setting units.
0 : BCD, 1% units
1 : BCD, 0.1% units
2 : BCD, 0.01% units
3 : BCD, 1 Hz units
4 : BCD, 0.1 Hz units
5 : BCD, 0.01 Hz units
6 : BCD (5-digit), 0.02 Hz
7 : Binary input
8 : Multi-Function Digital Input
F3-03 Digital Input Data Length V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(03B9) Select Sets the number of bits to set the frequency reference with DI-A3. (0 - 2)
0 : 8-bit
1 : 12-bit
2 : 16-bit
F3-10 Terminal D0 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BE3) Selection Sets the function for terminal D0 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-11 Terminal D1 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BE4) Selection Sets the function for terminal D1 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-12 Terminal D2 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BE5) Selection Sets the function for terminal D2 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-13 Terminal D3 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BE6) Selection Sets the function for terminal D3 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-14 Terminal D4 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BE7) Selection Sets the function for terminal D4 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-15 Terminal D5 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BE8) Selection Sets the function for terminal D5 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-16 Terminal D6 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BE9) Selection Sets the function for terminal D6 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-17 Terminal D7 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BEA) Selection Sets the function for terminal D7 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-18 Terminal D8 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BEB) Selection Sets the function for terminal D8 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-19 Terminal D9 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BEC) Selection Sets the function for terminal D9 of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-20 Terminal DA Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BED) Selection Sets the function for terminal DA of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-21 Terminal DB Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BEE) Selection Sets the function for terminal DB of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F3-22 Terminal DC Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BEF) Selection Sets the function for terminal DC of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-23 Terminal DD Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BF0) Selection Sets the function for terminal DD of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-24 Terminal DE Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BF1) Selection Sets the function for terminal DE of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F3-25 Terminal DF Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0BF2) Selection Sets the function for terminal DF of the DI-A3 option when F3-01 = 8 [Digital Input Function (1 - 19F)
Expert Selection = Multi-Function Digital Input].
F4-01 Terminal V1 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 102
(0391) Selection Sets the monitor signal output from terminal V1. (000 - 999)
Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. For example, set F4-01 = 102 to monitor U1-02 [Output
Frequency].
F4-02 Terminal V1 Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0392) Sets the gain of the monitor signal that is sent from terminal V1. Sets the analog signal output level (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN from the terminal V1 at 10 V or 20 mA as 100% when an output for monitoring items is 100%.
F4-03 Terminal V2 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 103
(0393) Selection Sets the monitor signal output from terminal V2. (000 - 999)
Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. For example, set F4-03 = 103 to monitor U1-03 [Output
Current].
F4-04 Terminal V2 Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50.0%
(0394) Sets the gain of the monitor signal that is sent from terminal V2. Sets the analog signal output level (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN from terminal V2 at 10 V or 20 mA as 100% when an output for monitoring items is 100%.
F4-05 Terminal V1 Bias V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0395) Sets the bias of the monitor signal that is sent from terminal V1. When an output for monitoring (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN items is 0%, this parameter sets the analog signal output level from the V1 terminal as a percentage
of 10 V or 20 mA.
F4-06 Terminal V2 Bias V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0396) Sets the bias of the monitor signal that is sent from terminal V2. Set the level of the analog signal (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN sent from the V2 terminal at 10 V or 20 mA as 100% when an output for monitoring items is 0%.
F4-07 Terminal V1 Signal Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0397) Sets the output signal level for terminal V1. (0, 1)
0 : 0 to 10 V
1 : -10 to 10 V
F4-08 Terminal V2 Signal Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0398) Sets the output signal level for terminal V2. (0, 1)
Parameter List
0 : 0 to 10 V
1 : -10 to 10 V
F5-01 Terminal P1-PC Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0399) Select Sets the function of terminal P1-PC on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
F5-02 Terminal P2-PC Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(039A) Select Sets the function of terminal P2-PC on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F5-03 Terminal P3-PC Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(039B) Select Sets the function of terminal P3-PC on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
F5-04 Terminal P4-PC Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(039C) Select Sets the function of terminal P4-PC on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
F5-05 Terminal P5-PC Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 6
(039D) Select Sets the function of terminal P5-PC on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
F5-06 Terminal P6-PC Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 37
(039E) Select Sets the function of terminal P6-PC on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
F5-07 Terminal M1-M2 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(039F) Select Sets the function of terminal M3-M2 on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
F5-08 Terminal M3-M4 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(03A0) Select Sets the function of terminal M3-M4 on the DO-A3 option. Set F5-09 = 2 [DO-A3 Output Mode (0 - 1A7)
Selection = Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)] to enable this function.
F5-09 DO-A3 Output Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03A1) Selection Sets the output mode of signals from the DO-A3 option. (0 - 2)
0 : Predefined Individual Outputs
1 : Binary Output
2 : Programmable (F5-01 to F5-08)
F6-01 Communication Error V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03A2) Selection Sets the method to stop the motor or let the motor continue operating when the drive detects bUS (0 - 5)
[Option Communication Error].
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
4 : Alarm (Run at d1-04)
5 : Alarm - Ramp Stop
F6-02 Comm External Fault (EF0) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03A3) Detect Sets the conditions at which EF0 [Option Card External Fault] is detected. (0, 1)
0 : Always Detected
1 : Detected during RUN Only
F6-03 Comm External Fault (EF0) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03A4) Select Sets the method to stop the motor or let the motor continue operating when the drive detects an EF0 (0 - 3)
[Option Card External Fault].
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
F6-04 bUS Error Detection Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2.0 s
(03A5) Sets the delay time for the drive to detect bUS [Option Communication Error]. (0.0 - 5.0 s)
Note:
When you install an option card in the drive, the parameter value changes to 0.0 s.
F6-06 Torque Reference/Limit by V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03A7) Comm Sets the function that enables and disables the torque reference and torque limit received from the (0, 1)
communication option.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F6-07 Multi-Step Ref @ NetRef/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03A8) ComRef Sets the function that enables and disables the multi-step speed reference when the frequency (0, 1)
reference source is NetRef or ComRef (communication option card or MEMOBUS/Modbus
communications).
0 : Disable Multi-Step References
1 : Enable Multi-Step References
F6-08 Comm Parameter Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(036A) @Initialize Sets the function to initialize F6-xx and F7-xx parameters when the drive is initialized with A1-03 (0, 1)
[Initialize Parameters].
0 : No Reset - Parameters Retained
1 : Reset Back to Factory Default
F6-10 CC-Link Node Address V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03B6) Sets the node address for CC-Link communication. Restart the drive after you change the parameter (0 - 64)
setting.
Note:
Be sure to set a node address that is different than all other node addresses. Do not set this
parameter to 0. Incorrect parameter settings will cause AEr [Station Address Setting Error] errors
and the L.ERR LED on the option will come on.
F6-11 CC-Link Communication V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03B7) Speed Sets the communication speed for CC-Link communication. Restart the drive after you change the (0 - 4)
parameter setting.
0 : 156 kbps
1 : 625 kbps
2 : 2.5 Mbps
3 : 5 Mbps
4 : 10 Mbps
F6-14 BUS Error Auto Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03BB) Sets the automatic reset function for bUS [Option Communication Errors]. (0, 1)
0 : Disable
1 : Enabled
F6-15 Comm. Option Parameters V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B5B) Reload Sets the update method when you change F6-xx, F7-xx [Communication Options]. (0 - 2)
0 : Reload at Next Power Cycle
1 : Reload Now
2 : Cancel Reload Request
F6-16 Gateway Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B8A) Sets the gateway mode operation and the number of connected slave drives. (0 to 4)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled: 1 Slave Drives
2 : Enabled: 2 Slave Drives
3 : Enabled: 3 Slave Drives
4 : Enabled: 4 Slave Drives
F6-20 MECHATROLINK Station V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0021h
(036B) Address Sets the station address for MECHATROLINK communication. Restart the drive after you change (MECHATROLINK-II:
the parameter setting. 0020h - 003Fh,
Note: MECHATROLINK-III:
• The setting range changes if using MECHATROLINK-II or MECHATROLINK-III: 0003h - 00EFh)
–MECHATROLINK-II (SI-T3) range: 20 - 3F
Parameter List
–MECHATROLINK-III (SI-ET3) range: 03 - EF
• Be sure to set a node address that is different than all other node addresses. Incorrect parameter
settings will cause AEr [Station Address Setting Error] errors and the L.ERR LED on the
option will come on.
• When the station addressis 20 or 3F, the drive detects AEr errors.
F6-21 MECHATROLINK Frame V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
Size
(036C) Sets the frame size for MECHATROLINK communication. Restart the drive after you change the
parameter setting.
(0, 1)
3
0 : 32byte (M-2) / 64byte (M-3)
1 : 17byte (M-2) / 32byte (M-3)
F6-22 MECHATROLINK Link V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(036D) Speed Sets the communications speed for MECHATROLINK-II. Restart the drive after you change the (0, 1)
parameter setting.
Note:
This parameter is only available with the MECHATROLINK-II option.
0 : 10 Mbps
1 : 4 Mbps
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F6-23 MECHATROLINK Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(036E) Select (E) Sets the MEMOBUS register used for the monitor functions of INV_CTL (drive operation control (0000h - FFFFh)
command) and INV_I/O (drive I/O control command). Restart the drive after you change the
parameter setting.
F6-24 MECHATROLINK Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(036F) Select (F) Sets the MEMOBUS register used for the monitor functions of INV_CTL (drive operation control (0000h - FFFFh)
command) and INV_I/O (drive I/O control command). Restart the drive after you change the
parameter setting.
F6-25 MECHATROLINK V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03C9) Watchdog Error Sel Sets the method to stop the motor or let the motor continue operating when the drive detects an E5 (0 - 3)
[MECHATROLINK Watchdog Timer Err].
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
F6-26 MECHATROLINK V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(03CA) Allowable No of Err Sets the number of times that the option must detect a bUS alarm to cause a bUS [Option (2 - 10 times)
Communication Error].
F6-30 PROFIBUS-DP Node V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03CB) Address Sets the node address for PROFIBUS-DP communication. Restart the drive after you change the (0 - 125)
parameter setting.
Note:
Be sure to set an address that is different than all other node addresses. Do not set this parameter
to 0.
F6-31 PROFIBUS-DP Clear Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03CC) Selection Sets what the drive will do after it receives the Clear Mode command. (0, 1)
0 : Reset
1 : Hold Previous State
F6-32 PROFIBUS-DP Data Format V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03CD) Select Sets the data format of PROFIBUS-DP communication. Restart the drive after you change the (0 - 5)
parameter setting.
0 : PPO Type
1 : Conventional
2 : PPO (bit0)
3 : PPO (Enter)
4 : Conventional (Enter)
5 : PPO (bit0, Enter)
F6-35 CANopen Node ID Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03D0) Sets the node address for CANopen communication. Restart the drive after you change the parameter (0 - 126)
setting.
Note:
Be sure to set an address that is different than all other node addresses. Do not set this parameter
to 0. Incorrect parameter settings will cause AEr [Station Address Setting Error] errors and the L.
ERR LED on the option will come on.
F6-36 CANopen Communication V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 6
(03D1) Speed Sets the CANopen communications speed. Restart the drive after you change the parameter setting. (0 - 8)
0 : Auto-detection
1 : 10 kbps
2 : 20 kbps
3 : 50 kbps
4 : 125 kbps
5 : 250 kbps
6 : 500 kbps
7 : 800 kbps
8 : 1 Mbps
F6-45 BACnet Node Address V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(02FB) Sets the node address for BACnet communication. (0 - 127)
Note:
Be sure to set an address that is different than all other node addresses. Do not set this parameter
to 0.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F6-46 BACnet Baud Rate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(02FC) Sets the BACnet communications speed. (0 - 8)
0 : 1200 bps
1 : 2400 bps
2 : 4800 bps
3 : 9600 bps
4 : 19.2 kbps
5 : 38.4 kbps
6 : 57.6 kbps
7 : 76.8 kbps
8 : 115.2 kbps
F6-47 Rx to Tx Wait Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5 ms
(02FD) Sets the wait time for the drive to receive and send BACnet communication. (5 - 65 ms)
F6-48 BACnet Device Object V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02FE) Identifier0 Sets the last word of BACnet communication addresses. (0 - FFFF)
F6-49 BACnet Device Object V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02FF) Identifier1 Sets the last word of BACnet communication addresses. (0 - 3F)
F6-50 DeviceNet MAC Address V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 64
(03C1) Sets the MAC address for DeviceNet communication. Restart the drive after you change the (0 - 64)
parameter setting.
Note:
Be sure to set a MAC address that is different than all other node addresses. Do not set this
parameter to 0. Incorrect parameter settings will cause AEr [Station Address Setting Error] errors
and the MS LED on the option will flash.
F6-51 DeviceNet Baud Rate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(03C2) Sets the DeviceNet communications speed. Restart the drive after you change the parameter setting. (0 - 4)
0 : 125 kbps
1 : 250 kbps
2 : 500 kbps
3 : Adjustable from Network
4 : Detect Automatically
F6-52 DeviceNet PCA Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 21
(03C3) Sets the format of data that the DeviceNet communication master sends to the drive. (0 - 255)
F6-53 DeviceNet PPA Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 71
(03C4) Sets the format of data that the drive sends to the DeviceNet communication master. (0 - 255)
F6-54 DeviceNet Idle Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03C5) Detection Sets the function to detect EF0 [Option Card External Fault] when the drive does not receive data (0 - 4)
from the DeviceNet master.
0 : Enabled
1 : Disabled, No Fault Detection
2 : Vendor Specific
3 : RUN Forward
4 : Reverse run
F6-55 DeviceNet Baud Rate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03C6) Monitor Sets the function to see the actual DeviceNet communications speed using the keypad. This (0 - 2)
parameter functions as a monitor only.
Parameter List
0 : 125 kbps
1 : 250 kbps
2 : 500 kbps
F6-56 DeviceNet Speed Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03D7) Sets the speed scale for DeviceNet communication. (-15 - +15)
F6-57 DeviceNet Current Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 3
(03D8) Sets the current scale of the DeviceNet communication master. (-15 - +15)
F6-58 DeviceNet Torque Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03D9) Sets the torque scale of the DeviceNet communication master. (-15 - +15)
F6-59 DeviceNet Power Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03DA) Sets the power scale of the DeviceNet communication master. (-15 - +15)
F6-60 DeviceNet Voltage Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03DB) Sets the voltage scale of the DeviceNet communication master. (-15 - +15)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F6-61 DeviceNet Time Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03DC) Sets the time scale of the DeviceNet communication master. (-15 - +15)
F6-62 DeviceNet Heartbeat V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03DD) Interval Sets the heartbeat for DeviceNet communication. Set this parameter to 0 to disable the heartbeat (0 - 10)
function.
F6-63 DeviceNet Network MAC V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 63
(03DE) ID Sets the function to see the actual DeviceNet MAC address using the keypad. This parameter (0 - 63)
functions as a monitor only.
F6-64 Dynamic Out Assembly 109 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03DF) Param1 Sets Configurable Output 1 written to the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-65 Dynamic Out Assembly 109 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03E0) Param2 Sets Configurable Output 2 written to the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-66 Dynamic Out Assembly 109 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03E1) Param3 Sets Configurable Output 3 written to the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-67 Dynamic Out Assembly 109 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03E2) Param4 Sets Configurable Output 4 written to the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-68 Dynamic In Assembly 159 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03E3) Param 1 Sets Configurable Input 1 read from the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-69 Dynamic In Assembly 159 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03E4) Param 2 Sets Configurable Input 2 read from the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-70 Dynamic In Assembly 159 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03C7) Param 3 Sets Configurable Input 3 read from the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-71 Dynamic In Assembly 159 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000h
(03C8) Param 4 Sets Configurable Input 4 read from the MEMOBUS register. (0000h - FFFFh)
F6-72 PowerLink Node Address V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(081B) Sets the node ID for PowerLink communication. (0 - 255)
Note:
Be sure to set an address that is different than all other node addresses. Do not set this parameter
to 0.
F7-01 IP Address 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 192
(03E5) Sets the first octet of the IP Address for the device that is connecting to the network. Restart the drive (0 - 255)
after you change this parameter.
Note:
When F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static]:
• Use parameters F7-01 to F7-04 [IP Address 1 to 4] to set the IP Address. Be sure to set a
different IP address for each drive on the network.
• Also set parameters F7-05 to F7-12 [Subnet Mask 1 to 4, Gateway Address 1 to 4].
F7-02 IP Address 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 168
(03E6) Sets the second octet of the IP Address for the device that is connecting to the network. Restart the (0 - 255)
drive after you change this parameter.
Note:
When F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static]:
• Use parameters F7-01 to F7-04 [IP Address 1 to 4] to set the IP Address. Be sure to set a
different IP address for each drive on the network.
• Also set parameters F7-05 to F7-12 [Subnet Mask 1 to 4, Gateway Address 1 to 4].
F7-03 IP Address 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03E7) Sets the third octet of the IP Address for the device that is connecting to the network. Restart the (0 - 255)
drive after you change this parameter.
Note:
When F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static]:
• Use parameters F7-01 to F7-04 [IP Address 1 to 4] to set the IP Address. Be sure to set a
different IP address for each drive on the network.
• Also set parameters F7-05 to F7-12 [Subnet Mask 1 to 4, Gateway Address 1 to 4].
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F7-04 IP Address 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 20
(03E8) Sets the fourth octet of the IP Address for the device that is connecting to the network. Restart the (0 - 255)
drive after you change this parameter.
Note:
When F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static]:
• Use parameters F7-01 to F7-04 [IP Address 1 to 4] to set the IP Address. Be sure to set a
different IP address for each drive on the network.
• Also set parameters F7-05 to F7-12 [Subnet Mask 1 to 4, Gateway Address 1 to 4].
F7-05 Subnet Mask 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 255
(03E9) Sets the first octet of the subnet mask of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-06 Subnet Mask 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 255
(03EA) Sets the second octet of the subnet mask of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-07 Subnet Mask 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 255
(03EB) Sets the third octet of the subnet mask of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-08 Subnet Mask 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03EC) Sets the fourth octet of the subnet mask of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-09 Gateway Address 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 192
(03ED) Sets the first octet of the gateway address of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-10 Gateway Address 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 168
(03EE) Sets the second octet of the gateway address of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-11 Gateway Address 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03EF) Sets the third octet of the gateway address of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-12 Gateway Address 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(03F0) Sets the fourth octet of the gateway address of the connected network. (0 - 255)
Note:
Set this parameter when F7-13 = 0 [Address Mode at Startup = Static].
F7-13 Address Mode at Startup V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(03F1) Sets the method to set option card IP addresses. (0 - 2)
0 : Static
1 : BOOTP
2 : DHCP
Parameter List
Note:
• The following setting values are available when using the PROFINET communication option
card (SI-EP3).
–0: Static
–2: DHCP
• When F7-13 = 0, set parameters F7-01 to F7-12 [IP Address 1 to Gateway Address 4] to set the
IP Address. Be sure to set a different IP address for each drive on the network.
F7-14 Duplex Mode Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1 3
(03F2) Sets the duplex mode setting method. (0 - 8)
0 : Half/Half
1 : Auto/Auto
2 : Full/Full
3 : Half/Auto
4 : Half/Full
5 : Auto/Half
6 : Auto/Full
7 : Full/Half
8 : Full/Auto
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F7-15 Communication Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10
(03F3) Selection Sets the communications speed. (10, 100 - 102)
10 : 10/10 Mbps
100 : 100/100 Mbps
101 : 10/100 Mbps
102 : 100/10 Mbps
F7-16 Timeout Value V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(03F4) Sets the detection time for a communications timeout. (0.0 - 30.0 s)
Note:
Set this parameter to 0.0 to disable the connection timeout function.
F7-17 EtherNet/IP Speed Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03F5) Factor Sets the scaling factor for the speed monitor in the EtherNet/IP Class ID 2AH Object. (-15 - +15)
F7-18 EtherNet/IP Current Scale V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03F6) Factor Sets the scaling factor for the output current monitor in the EtherNet/IP Class ID 2AH Object. (-15 - +15)
F7-19 EtherNet/IP Torque Scale V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03F7) Factor Sets the scaling factor for the torque monitor in the EtherNet/IP Class ID 2AH Object. (-15 - +15)
F7-20 EtherNet/IP Power Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03F8) Factor Sets the scaling factor for the power monitor in the EtherNet/IP Class ID 2AH Object. (-15 - +15)
F7-21 EtherNet/IP Voltage Scale V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03F9) Factor Sets the scaling factor for the voltage monitor in the EtherNet/IP Class ID 2AH Object. (-15 - +15)
F7-22 EtherNet/IP Time Scaling V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03FA) Sets the scaling factor for the time monitor in the EtherNet/IP Class ID 2AH Object. (-15 - +15)
F7-23 Dynamic Out Param 1 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03FB) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0. When you use a PROFINET option, set this parameter to set to configurable
output 1.
F7-24 Dynamic Out Param 2 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03FC) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0. When you use a PROFINET option, set this parameter to set to configurable
output 2.
F7-25 Dynamic Out Param 3 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03FD) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0. When you use a PROFINET option, set this parameter to set to configurable
output 3.
F7-26 Dynamic Out Param 4 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03FE) CommCard Sets Output Assembly 116 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0. When you use a ProfiNet option, set this parameter to set to configurable output
4.
F7-27 Dynamic Out Param 5 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(03FF) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0. When you use a PROFINET option, set this parameter to set to configurable
output 5.
F7-28 Dynamic Out Param 6 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0370) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0.
F7-29 Dynamic Out Param 7 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0371) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0.
F7-30 Dynamic Out Param 8 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0372) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F7-31 Dynamic Out Param 9 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0373) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0.
F7-32 Dynamic Out Param 10 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0374) CommCard When you use an Ethernet/IP option, sets Output Assembly 116. The drive writes the values from
Output Assembly 116 to the MEMOBUS/Modbus address register that is stored for each parameter.
The drive will not write the values from Output Assembly 116 to the registers when the MEMOBUS/
Modbus address is 0.
F7-33 Dynamic In Param 1 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0375) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined. When you use a ProfiNet option, set this
parameter to set to configurable input 1.
F7-34 Dynamic In Param 2 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0376) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined. When you use a ProfiNet option, set this
parameter to set to configurable input 2.
F7-35 Dynamic In Param 3 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0377) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined. When you use a ProfiNet option, set this
parameter to set to configurable input 3.
F7-36 Dynamic In Param 4 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0378) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined. When you use a ProfiNet option, set this
parameter to set to configurable input 4.
F7-37 Dynamic In Param 5 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0379) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined. When you use a ProfiNet option, set this
parameter to set to configurable input 5.
F7-38 Dynamic In Param 6 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(037A) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined.
F7-39 Dynamic In Param 7 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(037B) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined.
F7-40 Dynamic In Param 8 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(037C) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined.
Parameter List
F7-41 Dynamic In Param 9 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(037D) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined.
F7-42 Dynamic In Param 10 for V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(037E) CommCard Sets Input Assembly 166 when you use an Ethernet/IP option. The drive sends the values from the 3
MEMOBUS/Modbus address registers stored for each parameter to Input Assembly 166. The drive
returns the default register value for the option card when the MEMOBUS/Modbus address is 0 and
the value sent to Input Assembly 166 is not defined.
F7-60 PZD1 Write (Control Word) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0780) When you use a Profibus option, set the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD1 (PPO output). PZD1
(PPO output) functions as the STW when F7-60 = 0 to 2.
F7-61 PZD2 Write (Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0781) Reference) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD2 (PPO output).
PZD2 (PPO output) functions as the HSW when F7-61 = 0 to 2.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
F7-62 PZD3 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0782) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD3 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD3 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-63 PZD4 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0783) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD4 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD4 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-64 PZD5 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0784) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD5 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD5 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-65 PZD6 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0785) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD6 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD6 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-66 PZD7 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0786) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD7 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD7 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-67 PZD8 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0787) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD8 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD8 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-68 PZD9 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0788) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD9 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD9 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-69 PZD10 Write V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0789) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD10 (PPO output). A
value of 0, 1, or 2 will disable the PZD10 (PPO output) write operation to the MEMOBUS/Modbus
register.
F7-70 PZD1 Read (Status Word) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(078A) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD1 (PPO input). PZD1
(PPO input) functions as the ZSW when F7-70 = 0.
F7-71 PZD2 Read (Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(078B) Frequency) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD2 (PPO input). PZD2
(PPO input) functions as the HIW when F7-71 = 0.
F7-72 PZD3 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(078C) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD3 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD3 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
F7-73 PZD4 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(078D) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD4 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD4 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
F7-74 PZD5 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(078E) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD5 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD5 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
F7-75 PZD6 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(078F) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD6 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD6 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
F7-76 PZD7 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0790) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD7 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD7 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
F7-77 PZD8 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0791) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD8 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD8 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
F7-78 PZD9 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0792) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD9 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD9 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
F7-79 PZD10 Read V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0793) When you use a Profibus option, sets the MEMOBUS/Modbus address for PZD10 (PPO input). A
value of 0 will disable the PZD10 (PPO input) load operation from the MEMOBUS/Modbus register.
H1-01 Terminal S1 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 40
(0438) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S1. (1 - 1FF)
Note:
The default setting is F when you initialize the drive for 3-Wire Initialization [A1-03 = 3330].
H1-02 Terminal S2 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 41
(0439) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S2. (1 - 1FF)
Note:
The default setting is F when you initialize the drive for 3-Wire Initialization [A1-03 = 3330].
H1-03 Terminal S3 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 24
(0400) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S3. (0 - 1FF)
H1-04 Terminal S4 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 14
(0401) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S4. (0 - 1FF)
H1-05 Terminal S5 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(0402) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S5. (0 - 1FF)
Note:
The default setting is 0 when the drive is initialized for 3-Wire Initialization [A1-03 = 3330].
H1-06 Terminal S6 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(0403) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S6. (0 - 1FF)
Note:
The default setting is 3 when the drive is initialized for 3-Wire Initialization [A1-03 = 3330].
H1-07 Terminal S7 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 6
(0404) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S7. (0 - 1FF)
Note:
The default setting is 4 when the drive is initialized for 3-Wire Initialization [A1-03 = 3330].
H1-08 Terminal S8 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 8
(0405) Selection Sets the function for MFDI terminal S8. (0 - 1FF)
H1-21 Terminal S1 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B70) Selection 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S1. (1 - 19F)
H1-22 Terminal S2 Function Select V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B71) 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S2. (1 - 19F)
H1-23 Terminal S3 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B72) Selection 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S3. (1 - 19F)
H1-24 Terminal S4 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B73) Selection 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S4. (1 - 19F)
H1-25 Terminal S5 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B74) Selection 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S5. (1 - 19F)
H1-26 Terminal S6 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
Parameter List
(0B75) Selection 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S6. (1 - 19F)
H1-27 Terminal S7 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B76) Selection 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S7. (1 - 19F)
H1-28 Terminal S8 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B77) Selection 2 Sets the second function for MFDI terminal S8. (1 - 19F)
H1-40 Mbus Reg 15C0h bit0 Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
3
(0B54) Func Sets MFDI function to set to bit 0 of the MEMOBUS register 15C0 (Hex.). (1 - 19F)
H1-41 Mbus Reg 15C0h bit1 Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B55) Func Sets MFDI function to set to bit 1 of the MEMOBUS register 15C0 (Hex.). (1 - 19F)
H1-42 Mbus Reg 15C0h bit2 Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B56) Func Sets MFDI function to set to bit 2 of the MEMOBUS register 15C0 (Hex.). (1 - 19F)
0 3-Wire Sequence V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1 LOCAL/REMOTE Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets drive control for the keypad (LOCAL) or an external source (REMOTE).
ON : LOCAL
OFF : REMOTE
2 External Reference 1/2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Selection Sets the drive to use Run command source 1/2 or Reference command source 1/2 when in REMOTE Mode.
ON : b1-15 [Frequency Reference Selection 2], b1-16 [Run Command Selection 2]
OFF : b1-01 [Frequency Reference Selection 1], b1-02 [Run Command Selection 1]
3 Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1 Uses speed references d1-01 to d1-16 to set a multi-step speed reference.
4 Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
2 Uses speed references d1-01 to d1-16 to set a multi-step speed reference.
5 Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
3 Uses speed references d1-01 to d1-16 to set a multi-step speed reference.
6 Jog Reference Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the drive to use the JOG Frequency Reference (JOG command) set in d1-17. The JOG Frequency Reference (JOG command)
overrides Frequency References 1 to 16 (d1-01 to d1-16).
7 Accel/Decel Time Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1 Sets the drive to use Acceleration/Deceleration Time 1 [C1-01, C1-02] or Acceleration/Deceleration Time 2 [C1-03, C1-04].
8 Baseblock Command (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command that stops drive output and coasts the motor to stop when the input is ON.
ON : Baseblock (drive output stop)
OFF : Normal operation
9 Baseblock Command (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command that stops drive output and coasts the motor to stop when the input terminal is OFF.
ON : Normal operation
OFF : Baseblock (drive output stop)
A Accel/Decel Ramp Hold V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Momentarily pauses motor acceleration and deceleration when the terminal is turned ON, retains the output frequency that was
stored in the drive at the time of the pause, and restarts motor operation.
B Overheat Alarm (oH2) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the drive to show an oH2 [External Overheat (H1-XX=B)] alarm when the input terminal is ON. The alarm does not have an
effect on drive operation.
C Analog Terminal Enable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Selection Sets the command that enables or disables the terminals selected in H3-14 [Analog Input Terminal Enable Sel].
ON : Terminal selected with H3-14 is enabled
OFF : Terminal selected with H3-14 is disabled
D Ignore Speed Fdbk (V/f w/o V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enc) Sets the command to disable speed feedback control and run the drive in V/f control or use speed feedback from the encoder.
ON : Speed feedback control disable (V/f Control)
OFF : Speed feedback control enable (Closed Loop V/f Control)
E ASR Integral Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to reset the integral value and use PI control or P control for the speed control loop.
ON : P control
OFF : PI control
F Not Used V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Use this setting for unused terminals or to use terminals in through mode.
10 Up Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to use a push button switch to increase the drive frequency reference. You must also set Setting 11 [Down
Command].
ON : Increases the frequency reference.
OFF : Holds the current frequency reference.
11 Down Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to use a push button switch to decrease the drive frequency reference. You must also set Setting 10 [Up
Command].
ON : Decreases the frequency reference.
OFF : Holds the current frequency reference.
12 Forward Jog V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to operate the motor in the forward direction at the Jog Frequency set in d1-17 [Jog Reference].
13 Reverse Jog V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to operate the motor in the reverse direction at the Jog Frequency set in d1-17 [Jog Reference].
14 Fault Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to reset the current fault when the Run command is inactive.
Note:
The drive ignores the fault reset command when the Run command is active. Remove the Run command before trying to reset a
fault.
15 Fast Stop (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to ramp to stop in the deceleration time set in C1-09 [Fast Stop Time] when the input terminal is ON while the
drive is operating.
16 Motor 2 Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command for the drive to operate motor 1 or motor 2. Stop the motors before switching.
ON : Selects motor 2
OFF : Selects motor 1
17 Fast Stop (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to ramp to stop in the deceleration time set in C1-09 [Fast Stop Time] when the input terminal is ON while the
drive is operating.
18 Timer Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to start the timer function. Use this setting with Timer Output [H2-xx = 12].
19 PID Disable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to disable PID control when b5-01 = 1 to 8 [PID Mode Setting = Enabled].
ON : PID control disabled
OFF : PID control enabled
1A Accel/Decel Time Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
2 Set this function and H1-xx = 7 [Accel/Decel Time Selection 1] together. Sets the drive to use Acceleration/Deceleration Time 3
[C1-05, C1-06] or Acceleration/Deceleration Time 4 [C1-07, C1-08].
1B Programming Lockout V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to prevent parameter changes when the terminal is OFF.
ON : Programming Lockout
OFF : Parameter Write Prohibit
1E Reference Sample Hold V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to sample the frequency reference at terminals A1, A2, or A3 and hold the frequency reference at that frequency.
20 External Fault (NO-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Ramp) When the terminal activates, the drive ramps to stop in the selected deceleration time. Fault relay output terminal MA-MC will turn
ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive always detects external faults whether the drive is stopped or running.
21 External Fault (NC-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Ramp) When the terminal deactivates, the drive ramps to stop in the selected deceleration time. Fault relay output terminal MA-MC will
turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive always detects external faults whether the drive is stopped or running.
Parameter List
22 External Fault (NO-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Ramp) When the terminal activates during run, the drive ramps to stop in the selected deceleration time. Fault relay output terminal MA-
MC will turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive does not detect external faults while the drive is stopped.
23 External Fault (NC-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Ramp) When the terminal deactivates during run, the drive ramps to stop in the selected deceleration time. Fault relay output terminal MA-
MC will turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive does not detect external faults while the drive is stopped.
24 External Fault (NO-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
Coast) When the terminal activates, the drive shuts off the output and the motor coasts to stop. Fault relay output terminal MA-MC will
turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive always detects external faults whether the drive is stopped or running.
25 External Fault (NC-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Coast) When the terminal deactivates, the drive shuts off the output and the motor coasts to stop. Fault relay output terminal MA-MC will
turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive always detects external faults whether the drive is stopped or running.
26 External Fault (NO-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Coast) When the terminal activates during run, the drive shuts off the output and the motor coasts to stop. Fault relay output terminal MA-
MC will turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive does not detect external faults while the drive is stopped.
27 External Fault (NC-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Coast) When the terminal deactivates during run, the drive shuts off the output and the motor coasts to stop. Fault relay output terminal
MA-MC will turn ON, and MB-MC will turn OFF. The drive does not detect external faults while the drive is stopped.
28 External Fault (NO-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
FStop) When the terminal activates, the drive stops the motor in the deceleration time set to C1-09 [Fast Stop Time]. Fault relay output
terminal MA-MC turns ON, and MB-MC turns OFF. Stopped drives and running drives will detect external faults.
29 External Fault (NC-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
FStop) When the terminal deactivates, the drive stops the motor in the deceleration time set to C1-09 [Fast Stop Time]. Fault relay output
terminal MA-MC turns ON, and MB-MC turns OFF. Stopped drives and running drives will detect external faults.
2A External Fault (NO-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
FStop) When the terminal activates during run, the drive stops the motor in the deceleration time set to C1-09 [Fast Stop Time]. Fault relay
output terminal MA-MC turns ON, and MB-MC turns OFF. Stopped drives will not detect external faults.
2B External Fault (NC-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
FStop) When the terminal deactivates during run, the drive stops the motor in the deceleration time set to C1-09 [Fast Stop Time]. Fault
relay output terminal MA-MC turns ON, and MB-MC turns OFF. Stopped drives will not detect external faults.
2C External Fault (NO-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Alarm) When the terminal activates, the keypad shows EFx [External Fault (Input Terminal Sx)] and the output terminal set for Alarm [H2-
01 to H2-03 = 10] activates. The drive continues operation. Stopped drives and running drives will detect external faults.
2D External Fault (NC-Always- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Alarm) When the terminal deactivates, the keypad shows EFx [External Fault (Input Terminal Sx)] and the output terminal set for Alarm
[H2-01 to H2-03 = 10] activates. The drive continues operation. Stopped drives and running drives will detect external faults.
2E External Fault (NO-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Alarm) When the terminal activates during run, the keypad shows EFx [External Fault (Input Terminal Sx)] and the output terminal set for
Alarm [H2-01 to H2-03 = 10] activates. The drive continues operation. Stopped drives will not detect external faults.
2F External Fault (NC-@Run- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Alarm) When the terminal deactivates during run, the keypad shows EFx [External Fault (Input Terminal Sx)] and the output terminal set
for Alarm [H2-01 to H2-03 = 10] activates. The drive continues operation. Stopped drives will not detect external faults.
30 PID Integrator Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to reset and hold the PID control integral to 0 when the terminal is ON.
31 PID Integrator Hold V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to hold the integral value of the PID control while the terminal is activated.
32 Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
4 Uses speed references d1-01 to d1-16 to set a multi-step speed reference.
34 PID Soft Starter Disable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
35 PID Input (Error) Invert V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to turn the terminal ON and OFF to switch the PID input level (polarity).
3E PID Setpoint Selection 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set this function and H1-xx = 3F [PID Setpoint Selection 2] together. Sets the function to switch the PID setpoint to b5-58 to b5-60
[PID Setpoint 2 to 4].
3F PID Setpoint Selection 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set this function and H1-xx = 3E [PID Setpoint Selection 1] at the same time. Sets the function to switch the PID setpoint to b5-58
to b5-60 [PID Setpoint 2 to 4].
40 Forward RUN (2-Wire) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the Forward Run command for 2-wire sequence 1. Set this function and H1-xx = 41 [Reverse RUN (2-Wire)] together.
ON : Forward Run
OFF : Stop
Note:
• If you turn ON the Forward Run command terminal and the Reverse Run command terminal, it will cause an EF [FWD/REV
Run Command Input Error] alarm and the motor will ramp to stop.
• Initialize the drive with a 2-wire sequence to set the Forward Run command to terminal S1.
• This function will not operate at the same time as H1-xx = 42, 43 [Run Command (2-Wire Sequence 2), FWD/REV (2-Wire
Sequence 2)].
41 Reverse RUN (2-Wire) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the Forward Run command for 2-wire sequence 1. Set this function and H1-xx = 40 [Forward RUN (2-Wire)] together.
ON : Reverse Run
OFF : Stop
Note:
• If you turn ON the Forward Run command terminal and the Reverse Run command terminal, it will cause an EF [FWD/REV
Run Command Input Error] alarm and the motor will ramp to stop.
• Initialize the drive with a 2-wire sequence to set the Reverse Run command to terminal S2.
• This function will not operate at the same time as H1-xx = 42, 43 [Run Command (2-Wire Sequence 2), FWD/REV (2-Wire
Sequence 2)].
42 Run Command (2-Wire V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sequence 2) Sets the Run command for 2-wire sequence 2. Set this function and H1-xx = 43 [FWD/REV (2-Wire Sequence 2)] together.
ON : Run
OFF : Stop
Note:
This function will not operate at the same time as H1-xx = 40, 41 [Forward RUN (2-Wire), Reverse RUN (2-Wire)].
43 FWD/REV (2-Wire V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sequence 2) Sets the direction of motor rotation for 2-wire sequence 2. Set this function and H1-xx = 42 [Run Command (2-Wire Sequence 2)]
together.
ON : Reverse Run
OFF : Forward Run
Note:
• You must input the Run command to rotate the motor.
• This function will not operate at the same time as H1-xx = 40, 41 [Forward RUN (2-Wire), Reverse RUN (2-Wire)].
44 Add Offset Frequency 1 (d7- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
01) Sets the function to add the offset frequency set in d7-01 [Offset Frequency 1] to the frequency reference when the terminal
activates.
45 Add Offset Frequency 2 (d7- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
02) Sets the function to add the offset frequency set in d7-02 [Offset Frequency 2] to the frequency reference when the terminal
activates.
46 Add Offset Frequency 3 (d7- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
03) Sets the function to add the offset frequency set in d7-03 [Offset Frequency 3] to the frequency reference when the terminal
activates.
47 Node Setup (CANopen) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function in CANopen communications to start the Node Setup function to set the drive node address from the host
controller.
60 DC Injection Braking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Command Sets the command to use DC Injection Braking to stop the motor.
Note:
When A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZOLV], this function is available with a PM motor.
61 Speed Search from Fmax V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to use an external reference to start speed search although b3-01 = 0 [Speed Search Selection at Start = Disabled]
to not allow speed search at start.
Note:
The drive will detect oPE03 [Multi-Function Input Setting Err] when H1-xx = 61 [Speed Search from Fmax] and H1-xx = 62
[Speed Search from Fref] are set at the same time.
62 Speed Search from Fref V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to use an external reference to start speed search although b3-01 = 0 [Speed Search Selection at Start = Disabled]
to not allow speed search at start.
Parameter List
Note:
The drive will detect oPE03 [Multi-Function Input Setting Err] when H1-xx = 61 [Speed Search from Fmax] and H1-xx = 62
[Speed Search from Fref] are set at the same time.
63 Field Weakening V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to send the Field Weakening Level and Field Weakening Frequency Limit commands set in d6-01 [Field
Weakening Level] and d6-02 [Field Weakening Frequency Limit] when the input terminal is activated.
65 KEB Ride-Thru 1 Activate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(N.C.) Sets operation of the KEB1 function through the KEB Ride-Thru 1 (N.C.).
ON : Normal operation
OFF : Deceleration during momentary power loss
66 KEB Ride-Thru 1 Activate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(N.O.) Sets operation of the KEB1 function through the KEB Ride-Thru 1 (N.O.).
ON : Deceleration during momentary power loss
OFF : Normal operation
67 Communications Test Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set the function for the drive to self-test RS-485 serial communications operation.
68 High Slip Braking (HSB) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Activate Sets the command to use high-slip braking to stop the motor.
6A Drive Enable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to show dnE [Drive Disabled] on the keypad and ignore Run commands when the terminal is OFF.
71 Torque Control V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to switch between torque control and speed control.
ON : Torque control
OFF : Speed control
72 Zero Servo V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
75 Up 2 Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to increase the frequency reference bias value to accelerate the motor when the terminal is activated. Set this
function and H1-xx = 76 [Down 2 Command] together.
Note:
When you use this function, set the optimal bias limit values with d4-08 and d4-09 [Up/Down 2 Bias Upper Limit/Lower Limit].
76 Down 2 Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to decrease the frequency reference bias value to decelerate the motor when the terminal is activated. Set this
function and H1-xx = 75 [Up 2 Command] together.
Note:
When you use this function, set the optimal bias limit values with d4-08 and d4-09 [Up/Down 2 Bias Upper Limit/Lower Limit].
77 ASR Gain (C5-03) Select V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to switch the ASR proportional gain to C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1] or C5-03 [ASR Proportional Gain 2].
ON : C5-03
OFF : C5-01
78 Analog TorqueRef Polarity V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Invert Sets the rotation direction of the external torque reference.
ON : External torque reference reverse direction
OFF : External torque reference forward direction
7A KEB Ride-Thru 2 Activate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(N.C.) Sets operation of the KEB2 function through the KEB Ride-Thru 2 (N.C.).
ON : Normal operation
OFF : Deceleration during momentary power loss
7B KEB Ride-Thru 2 Activate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(N.O.) Sets operation of the KEB2 function through the KEB Ride-Thru 2 (N.O.).
ON : Deceleration during momentary power loss
OFF : Normal operation
7C Short Circuit Braking (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the rotation direction of the motor when in Simple Closed Loop V/f Control method and F1-21, F1-37 = 0 [Encoder Option
Function Selection = A pulse detection], or when in Closed Loop V/f Control method.
ON : Reverse run
OFF : Forward run
90 DWEZ Digital Input 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 1. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
91 DWEZ Digital Input 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 2. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
92 DWEZ Digital Input 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 3. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
93 DWEZ Digital Input 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 4. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
94 DWEZ Digital Input 5 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 5. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
95 DWEZ Digital Input 6 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 6. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
96 DWEZ Digital Input 7 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 7. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
97 DWEZ Digital Input 8 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital input 8. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
9F DWEZ Disable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
102 !External Reference 1/2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Selection Sets the drive to use Run command source 1/2 or Reference command source 1/2 when in REMOTE Mode.
ON : b1-01 = [Frequency Reference Selection 1], b1-02 [Run Command Selection 1]
OFF : b1-15 = [Frequency Reference Selection 2], b1-16 [Run Command Selection 2]
103 !Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1 Uses a combination of multi-step speed references 1, 2 and 3 (N.C.) to set d1-01 to d1-08 [Multi-Step Speed Reference].
104 !Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
2 Uses a combination of multi-step speed references 1, 2 and 3 (N.C.) to set d1-01 to d1-08 [Multi-Step Speed Reference].
105 !Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
3 Uses a combination of multi-step speed references 1, 2 and 3 (N.C.) to set d1-01 to d1-08 [Multi-Step Speed Reference].
106 !Jog Reference Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the drive to use the JOG Frequency Reference (JOG command) set in d1-17 [Jog Reference]. The JOG Frequency Reference
(JOG command) overrides the d1-01 to d1-16 [References 1 to 16].
107 !Accel/Decel Time Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1 Sets the drive to use C1-01, C1-02 [Acceleration/Deceleration Time 1] or C1-03, C1-04 [Acceleration/Deceleration Time 2].
10A !Accel/Decel Ramp Hold V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Momentarily pauses motor acceleration and deceleration when the terminal deactivates, retains the output frequency that was stored
in the drive at the time of the pause, and restarts motor operation.
10B !Overheat Alarm (oH2) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the drive to display an oH2 [Drive Overheat Warning] alarm when the input terminal deactivates. The alarm does not have an
effect on drive operation.
10C !Analog Terminal Enable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Selection Enables and disables the terminal selected with the H3-14 [Analog Input Term Enable Select] function.
Parameter List
ON : Input to the terminal selected with H3-14 is disabled
OFF : Input to the terminal selected with H3-14 is enabled
10D !Ignore Speed Fdbk (V/f w/o V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enc) When the terminal deactivates, the drive ignores the feedback control from the encoder and operates in V/f control. When the
terminal activates, the drive uses the feedback from the encoder to control the motor speed again.
ON : Speed feedback control enable (Closed Loop V/f Control)
OFF : Speed feedback control disable (V/f Control) 3
10E !ASR Integral Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to reset the integral value and use PI control or P control for the speed control loop.
ON : PI control
OFF : P control
110 !Up Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set this function and 111 [! Down Command] together. Sets the Up command and Down command to use the two push button
switches to increase and decrease the drive frequency reference.
ON : Holds the current frequency reference.
OFF : Increases the frequency reference.
111 !Down Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set this function and 110 [!Up Command] together. Sets the Up command and Down command to use the two push button switches
to increase and decrease the drive frequency reference.
ON : Holds the current frequency reference.
OFF : Decreases the frequency reference.
114 !Fault Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to reset the current fault when the Run command is not active.
Note:
The drive ignores the fault reset command when the Run command is active. Remove the Run command before you try to reset
a fault.
116 !Motor 2 Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Switches between motor 1 or motor 2. Switch the motor while the motor is stopped.
ON : Selects motor 1
OFF : Selects motor 2
118 !Timer Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to start the timer function. Use this setting with H2-xx = 112 [!Timer Output].
119 !PID Disable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to disable PID control with an external input when b5-01 = 1 to 8 [PID Function Setting = Enabled].
ON : PID control enabled
OFF : PID control disabled
11A !Accel/Decel Time Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
2 Set this function and H1-xx = 107 [!Accel/Decel Time Selection 1] together. Sets the drive to use C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/
Deceleration Times 1 to 4].
11B !Programming Lockout V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to prevent parameter changes when the terminal is OFF. You can continue to view parameter setting values when
the terminal is ON [Parameter Write Prohibit].
ON : Parameter Write Prohibit
OFF : Programming Lockout
11E !Reference Sample Hold V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Samples the analog frequency reference input to the terminals A1, A2, or A3, and continues operation at the sampled frequency.
130 !PID Integrator Reset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to reset and hold the PID control integral to 0 when the terminal deactivates.
131 !PID Integrator Hold V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to hold the integral value of the PID control while the terminal deactivates.
132 !Multi-Step Speed Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
4 Uses a combination of multi-step speed references 1, 2 and 3 (N.C.) to switch d1-09 to d1-16 [Reference 9 to 16].
134 !PID Soft Starter Disable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
135 !PID Input (Error) Invert V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the command to turn the terminal ON and OFF to switch the PID input level (polarity).
13E !PID Setpoint Selection 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set this function and H1-xx = 13F [!PID Setpoint Selection 2] together. Sets the function to use the PID setpoint set in b5-58 to b5-
60 [PID setpoint2 to 4].
13F !PID Setpoint Selection 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set this function and H1-xx = 13E [!PID Setpoint Selection 1] together. Sets the function to use the PID setpoint set in b5-58 to b5-
60 [PID setpoint2 to 4].
144 !Add Offset Frequency 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(d7-01) Sets the function to add the offset frequency set in d7-01 to the frequency reference when the terminal deactivates.
145 !Add Offset Frequency 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(d7-02) Sets the function to add the offset frequency set in d7-02 to the frequency reference when the terminal deactivates.
146 !Add Offset Frequency 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(d7-03) Sets the function to add the offset frequency set in d7-03 to the frequency reference when the terminal deactivates.
147 !Node Setup (CANopen) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function in CANopen communications to start the Node Setup function to set the drive node address from the host
controller.
160 !DC Injection Braking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Command Sets the command to use DC Injection Braking to stop the motor.
Note:
When A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZ Vector Control], this function is available if you use a PM motor.
161 !Speed Search from Fmax V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to use an external reference to start speed search although b3-01 = 0 [Speed Search Selection at Start = Disabled]
to not allow speed search at start.
Note:
The drive will detect oPE03 [Multi-Function Input Setting Err] when H1-xx = 161 [!Speed Search from Fmax] and H1-xx =
162 [!Speed Search from Fref] are set at the same time.
162 !Speed Search from Fref V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to use an external reference to start speed search although b3-01 = 0 [Speed Search Selection at Start = Disabled]
to not allow speed search at start.
Note:
The drive will detect oPE03 [Multi-Function Input Setting Err] when H1-xx = 161 [!Speed Search from Fmax] and H1-xx =
162 [!Speed Search from Fref] are set at the same time.
163 !Field Weakening V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to send the Field Weakening Level and Field Weakening Frequency Limit commands set in d6-01 and d6-02 when
the input terminal deactivates.
167 !Communications Test Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set the function for the drive to self-test RS-485 serial communications operation.
168 !High Slip Braking (HSB) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Activate Sets the command to use high-slip braking to stop the motor.
16A !Drive Enable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to show dnE [Drive Enabled] on the keypad and ignore Run commands when the terminal activates.
171 !Torque Control V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
172 !Zero Servo V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
175 !Up 2 Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
When the terminal deactivates, the motor accelerates by increasing the frequency reference bias value. Set !Up 2 Command and !
Down 2 Command together.
Note:
When you use the functions, set the optimal bias limit values with d4-08 and d4-09 [Up/Down 2 Bias Upper Limit/Lower Limit
(Up/Down 2)].
176 !Down 2 Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
When the terminal deactivates, the motor decelerates by decreasing the frequency reference bias value. Set !Up 2 Command and !
Down 2 Command together.
Note:
When you use the functions, set the optimal bias limit values with d4-08 and d4-09 [Up/Down 2 Bias Upper Limit/Lower Limit
(Up/Down 2)].
177 !ASR Gain (C5-03) Select V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the function to switch the ASR proportional gain to C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1] or C5-03 [ASR Proportional Gain 2].
ON : C5-01
OFF : C5-03
Parameter List
178 !Analog TorqueRef Polarity V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Invert Switches the rotation direction of the external torque reference.
ON : External torque reference forward direction
OFF : External torque reference reverse direction
17E !Reverse Rotation Identifier V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Lets you set the rotation direction of the motor when F1-21, F1-37 = 0 [Encoder Option Function Selection = A pulse detection] for
Simple Closed Loop V/f Control method and Closed Loop V/f Control method.
3
ON : Forward run
OFF : Reverse run
17F !PID Bi-Directional Enable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
19F !DWEZ Disable V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
◆ H2: MFDO
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H2-01 Term M1-M2 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(040B) Selection Sets the function for MFDO terminal M1-M2. (0 - 1FF)
Note:
When you do not use the terminal or when you use the terminal in through mode, set this
parameter to F.
H2-02 Term M3-M4 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(040C) Selection Sets the function for MFDO terminal M3-M4. (0 - 1FF)
Note:
When you do not use the terminal or when you use the terminal in through mode, set this
parameter to F.
H2-03 Term M5-M6 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(040D) Selection Sets the function for MFDO terminal M5-M6. (0 - 1FF)
Note:
When you do not use the terminal or when you use the terminal in through mode, set this
parameter to F.
H2-06 Watt Hour Output Unit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0437) Selection Sets the unit for the output signal when H2-01 to H2-03 = 39 [MFDO Function Selection = Watt (0 - 4)
Hour Pulse Output].
0 : 0.1 kWh units
1 : 1 kWh units
2 : 10 kWh units
3 : 100 kWh units
4 : 1000 kWh units
H2-07 Modbus Register 1 Address V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0001
(0B3A) Select Sets the address of the MEMOBUS/Modbus register output to the MFDO terminal. (0001 - 1FFF)
H2-08 Modbus Register 1 Bit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000
(0B3B) Select Sets the bit of the MEMOBUS/Modbus register output to the MFDO terminal. (0000 - FFFF)
H2-09 Modbus Register 2 Address V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0001
(0B3C) Select Sets the address of the MEMOBUS/Modbus register output to the MFDO terminal. (0001 - 1FFF)
H2-10 Modbus Register 2 Bit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0000
(0B3D) Select Sets the bit of the MEMOBUS/Modbus register output to the MFDO terminal. (0000 - FFFF)
H2-20 Comparator 1 Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 102
(1540) Selection Sets the monitor number for comparator 1. Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. For example, set (000 - 999)
H2-20 = 102 to monitor U1-02 [Output Frequency].
H2-21 Comparator 1 Lower Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(1541) Sets the lower limit detection level for comparator 1 when the full scale analog output for the monitor (0.0 - 300.0%)
selected in H2-20 [Comparator 1 Monitor Selection] is the 100% value.
H2-22 Comparator 1 Upper Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(1542) Sets the upper limit detection level for comparator 1 when the full scale analog output for the monitor (0.0 - 300.0%)
selected in H2-20 [Comparator 1 Monitor Selection] is the 100% value.
H2-23 Comparator 1 Hysteresis V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(1543) Sets the hysteresis level for comparator 1 as a percentage of the full scale analog output for the (0.0 - 10.0%)
monitor selected in H2-20 [Comparator 1 Monitor Selection].
H2-24 Comparator 1 On-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(1544) Time Sets the on-delay time for comparator 1. (0.0 - 600.0 s)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H2-25 Comparator 1 Off-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(1545) Time Sets the off-delay time for comparator 1. (0.0 - 600.0 s)
H2-26 Comparator 2 Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 103
(1546) Selection Sets the monitor number for comparator 2. Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. For example, set (000 - 999)
H2-26 = 103 to monitor U1-03 [Output Current].
H2-27 Comparator 2 Lower Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(1547) Sets the lower limit detection level for comparator 2 as a percentage of the full scale analog output (0.0 - 300.0%)
for the monitor selected in H2-26 [Comparator 2 Monitor Selection].
H2-28 Comparator 2 Upper Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(1548) Sets the upper limit detection level for comparator 2 as a percentage of the full scale analog output (0.0 - 300.0%)
for the monitor selected in H2-26 [Comparator 2 Monitor Selection].
H2-29 Comparator 2 Hysteresis V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(1549) Sets the hysteresis level for comparator 2 as a percentage of the full scale analog output for the (0.0 - 10.0%)
monitor selected in H2-26 [Comparator 2 Monitor Selection].
H2-30 Comparator 2 On-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(154A) Time Sets the on-delay time for comparator 2. (0.0 - 600.0 s)
H2-31 Comparator 2 Off-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(154B) Time Sets the off-delay time for comparator 2. (0.0 - 600.0 s)
H2-32 Comparator 1 Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0s
(159A) Sets the time constant that is applied to the primary delay filter used for the analog output of the (0.0 - 10.0 s)
monitor selected with H2-20 [Comparator 1 Monitor Selection].
H2-33 Comparator1 Protection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(159B) Selection Sets drive operation when it detects CP1 [Comparator1 Limit Fault]. (0 - 4)
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
4 : Digital Output Only
H2-34 Comparator 2 Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0s
(159C) Sets the time constant that is applied to the primary delay filter used for the analog output of the (0.0 - 10.0 s)
monitor selected with H2-26 [Comparator 2 Monitor Selection].
H2-35 Comparator2 Protection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(159D) Selection Sets drive operation when it detects CP2 [Comparator2 Limit Fault]. (0 - 4)
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
4 : Digital Output Only
H2-36 Comparator 1 Ineffective V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(159E) Time Sets the length of time that CP1 [Comparator1 Limit Fault] is disabled. (0.0 - 1000.0 s)
H2-37 Comparator 2 Ineffective V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(159F) Time Sets the length of time that CP2 [Comparator2 Limit Fault] is disabled. (0.0 - 1000.0 s)
H2-40 Mbus Reg 15E0h bit0 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B58) Output Func Sets the MFDO for bit 0 of MEMOBUS register 15E0 (Hex.). (0 - 1FF)
Parameter List
H2-41 Mbus Reg 15E0h bit1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B59) Output Func Sets the MFDO for bit 1 of MEMOBUS register 15E0 (Hex.). (0 - 1FF)
H2-42 Mbus Reg 15E0h bit2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B5A) Output Func Sets the MFDO for bit 2 of MEMOBUS register 15E0 (Hex.). (0 - 1FF)
H2-60 Term M1-M2 Secondary V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1B46) Function Sets the second function for terminal M1-M2. Outputs the logical calculation results of the terminals (0 - FF) 3
Expert assigned to functions by H2-01 [Term M1-M2 Function Selection].
H2-61 Terminal M1-M2 Logical V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B47) Operation Sets the logical operation for the functions set in H2-01 [Term M1-M2 Function Selection] and H2- (0 - 8)
Expert 60 [Term M1-M2 Secondary Function].
H2-62 Terminal M1-M2 Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(1B48) Time Sets the minimum on time used to output the logical calculation results from terminal M1-M2. (0.0 - 25.0 s)
Expert
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H2-63 Term M3-M4 Secondary V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1B49) Function Sets the second function for terminal M3-M4. Outputs the logical calculation results of the terminals (0 - FF)
Expert assigned to functions by H2-02 [Term M3-M4 Function Selection].
H2-64 Terminal M3-M4 Logical V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B4A) Operation Sets the logical operation for the functions set in H2-02 [Term M3-M4 Function Selection] and H2- (0 - 8)
Expert 63 [Term M3-M4 Secondary Function].
H2-65 Terminal M3-M4 Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(1B4B) Time Sets the minimum on time used to output the logical calculation results from terminal M3-M4. (0.0 - 25.0 s)
Expert
H2-66 Term M5-M6 Secondary V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1B4C) Function Sets the second function for terminal M5-M6. Outputs the logical calculation results of the terminals (0 - FF)
Expert assigned to functions by H2-03 [Terminal M5-M6 Function Select].
H2-67 Terminal M5-M6 Logical V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B4D) Operation Sets the logical operation for the functions set in H2-03 [Term M5-M6 Function Selection] and H2- (0 - 8)
Expert 66 [Term M5-M6 Secondary Function].
H2-68 Terminal M5-M6 Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(1B4E) Time Sets the minimum on time used to output the logical calculation results from terminal M5-M6. (0.0 - 25.0 s)
Expert
0 During Run V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when you input a Run command and when the drive is outputting voltage.
ON : Drive is running
OFF : Drive is stopping
1 Zero Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the output frequency < E1-09 [Minimum Output Frequency] or b2-01 [DC Injection/Zero
SpeedThreshold].
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the reference.
0 V/f E1-09
1 CL-V/f E1-09
2 OLV b2-01
3 CLV E1-09
4 AOLV E1-09
5 OLV/PM E1-09
6 AOLV/PM E1-09
7 CLV/PM b2-01
8 EZOLV E1-09
2 Speed Agree 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal turns on when the output frequency is in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-02 [Speed Agree Detection Width].
Note:
• The detection function operates in the two motor rotation directions.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [CLV, CLV/PM]. It also outputs the motor speed status when A1-
02 = 4 and n4-72 = 1.
ON : The output frequency is in the range of “frequency reference ± L4-02”.
OFF : The output frequency does not align with the frequency reference although the drive is running.
3 User-Set Speed Agree 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the output frequency is in the range of L4-01 [Speed Agree Detection Level] ± L4-02 [Speed Agree
Detection Width] and in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-02.
Note:
• The detection function operates in the two motor rotation directions. The drive uses the L4-01 value as the forward/reverse
detection level.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [CLV, CLV/PM]. It also outputs the motor speed status when A1-
02 = 4 and n4-72 = 1.
ON : The output frequency is in the range of “L4-01 ± L4-02” and the range of frequency reference ± L4-02.
OFF : The output frequency is not in the range of “L4-01 ± L4-02” or the range of frequency reference ± L4-02.
4 Frequency Detection 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency > “L4-01 [Speed Agree Detection Level] + L4-02 [Speed Agree Detection
Width]”. After the terminal deactivates, the terminal stays deactivated until the output frequency is at the value of L4-01.
Note:
• The detection function operates in the two motor rotation directions. The drive uses the L4-01 value as the forward/reverse
detection level.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM]. It also outputs the
motor speed status when A1-02 = 4 [AOLV] and n4-72 = 1 [Speed Feedback Mode = With Encoder].
ON : The output frequency < L4-01, or the output frequency ≤ “L4-01 + L4-02”
OFF : The output frequency > “L4-01 + L4-02”
5 Frequency Detection 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the output frequency > L4-01 [Speed Agree Detection Level]. After the terminal activates, the terminal
stays activated until the output frequency is at the value of “L4-01 - L4-02”.
Note:
• The detection function operates in the two motor rotation directions. The drive uses the L4-01 value as the forward/reverse
detection level.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM]. It also outputs the
motor speed status when A1-02 = 4 [AOLV] and n4-72 = 1 [Speed Feedback Mode = With Encoder].
ON : The output frequency > L4-01
OFF : The output frequency < “L4-01 - L4-02”, or the output frequency ≤ L4-01
6 Drive Ready V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
7 DC Bus Undervoltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the DC bus voltage or control circuit power supply is at the voltage set in L2-05 [Undervoltage
Detection Lvl (Uv1)] or less. The terminal also activates when there is a fault with the DC bus voltage.
ON : The DC bus voltage ≤ L2-05
OFF : The DC bus voltage > L2-05
8 During Baseblock (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates during baseblock. When the drive is in baseblock, the drive output transistor stops switching and does not
make DC bus voltage.
ON : During baseblock
OFF : The drive is not in baseblock.
9 Frequency Reference from V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Keypad Shows the selected frequency reference source.
ON : The keypad is the frequency reference source.
OFF : Parameter b1-01 or b1-15 [Frequency Reference Selection 1 or 2] is the frequency reference source.
A Run Command Source V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
B Torque Detection 1 (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Parameter List
The terminal activates when the drive detects overtorque or undertorque.
ON : The output current/torque > L6-02 [Torque Detection Level 1], or the output current/torque < L6-02 for longer than the time set
in L6-03 [Torque Detection Time 1].
C Frequency Reference Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the drive detects a loss of frequency reference.
D Braking Resistor Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
3
The terminal activates when the mounting-type braking resistor is overheating or when there is a braking transistor fault.
E Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Use this setting for unused terminals or to use terminals in through mode. Also use this setting as the PLC contact output via
MEMOBUS/Modbus or the communication option. This signal does not function if you do not configure signals from the PLC.
10 Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
11 Fault Reset Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Active The terminal activates when the drive receives the Reset command from the control circuit terminal, serial communications, or the
communication option.
12 Timer Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the terminal as the timer output. Use this setting with the timer input set in H1-xx = 18 [MFDI Function Selection = Timer
Function].
13 Speed Agree 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the output frequency is in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-04 [Speed Agree Detection Width
(+/-)].
Note:
• The detection function operates in the two motor rotation directions.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM].
ON : The output frequency is in the range of “frequency reference ± L4-04”.
OFF : The output frequency is not in the range of “frequency reference ± L4-04”.
14 User-Set Speed Agree 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the output frequency is in the range of L4-03 [Speed Agree Detection Level (+/-)] ± L4-04 [Speed
Agree Detection Width (+/-)] and in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-04.
Note:
• The detection level set in L4-03 is a signed value. The drive will only detect in one direction.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM].
ON : The output frequency is in the range of “L4-03 ± L4-04” and the range of frequency reference ± L4-04.
OFF : The output frequency is not in the range of “L4-03 ± L4-04” or the range of frequency reference ± L4-04.
15 Frequency Detection 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency > “L4-03 [Speed Agree Detection Level(+/-)] + L4-04 [Speed Agree Detection
Width(+/-)]”. After the terminal deactivates, the terminal stays deactivated until the output frequency is at the value of L4-03.
Note:
• The detection level set in L4-03 is a signed value. The drive will only detect in one direction.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM].
ON : The output frequency < L4-03, or the output frequency ≤ “L4-03 + L4-04”
OFF : The output frequency > “L4-03 + L4-04”
16 Frequency Detection 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the output frequency > L4-03 [Speed Agree Detection Level(+/-)]. After the terminal activates, the
terminal stays activated until the output frequency is at the value of “L4-03 - L4-04”.
Note:
• The detection level set in L4-03 is a signed value. The drive will only detect in one direction.
• The drive outputs the motor speed status when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/PM].
ON : The output frequency > L4-03
OFF : The output frequency < “L4-03 - L4-04”, or the output frequency ≤ L4-03
17 Torque Detection 1 (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
18 Torque Detection 2 (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
19 Torque Detection 2 (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1A During Reverse V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the motor operates in the reverse direction.
ON : The motor is operating in the reverse direction.
OFF : The motor is operating in the forward direction or the motor stopped.
1B During Baseblock (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates during baseblock. When the drive is in baseblock, the drive output transistor stops switching and does not
make DC bus voltage.
ON : The drive is not in baseblock.
OFF : During baseblock
1C Motor 2 Selected V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1D During Regeneration V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
1E Executing Auto-Restart V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the Auto Restart function is trying to restart after a fault.
1F Motor Overload Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(oL1) The terminal activates when the electronic thermal protection value of the motor overload protective function is a minimum of 90%
of the detection level.
20 Drive Overheat Pre-Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(oH) The terminal activates when the drive heatsink temperature is at the level set with L8-02 [Overheat Alarm Level].
21 Safe Torque OFF V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates (safety stop state) when the safety circuit and safety diagnosis circuit are operating correctly and when
terminals H1-HC and H2-HC are OFF (Open).
ON : Safety stop state
OFF : Safety circuit fault or RUN/READY
22 Mechanical Weakening V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Detection The terminal activates when the drive detects mechanical weakening.
2F Maintenance Notification V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when drive components are at their estimated maintenance period.
Tells you about the maintenance period for these items:
• IGBT
• Cooling Fan
• Capacitor
• Soft charge bypass relay
30 During Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the torque reference is the torque limit set with L7 parameters, H3-02, H3-06, or H3-10 [MFAI
Function Selection].
31 During Speed Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
32 In Speed Limit During Trq V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Ctrl The motor accelerates in the forward direction or the reverse direction after enabling torque control and the externally input torque
reference is disproportionate to the load. The output terminal activates when this speed is not higher than a constant speed and the
motor speed is at the speed limit. This does not include operation when the drive is stopped.
33 Zero Servo Complete V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when positioning in the range set with b9-02 [Zero Servo Completion Window] completes after sending the
Zero-Servo command.
37 During Frequency Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
38 Drive Enabled V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
This terminal activates when the H1-xx = 6A [Drive Enable] terminal activates.
39 Watt Hour Pulse Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Parameter List
3C LOCAL Control Selected V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the Run command source or frequency reference source is LOCAL.
ON : LOCAL
OFF : REMOTE
3D During Speed Search V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the drive detects FbL [PID Feedback Loss].
3F PID Feedback High V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the drive detects FbH [Excessive PID Feedback].
4A During KEB Ride-Thru V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
4B During Short Circuit Braking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
4D oH Pre-Alarm Time Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when L8-03 = 4 [Overheat Pre-Alarm Selection = Operate at Reduced Speed (L8-19)] and oH [Heatsink
Overheat] does not clear after the drive decreases the frequency for 10 cycles.
4E Braking Transistor Fault (rr) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the internal braking transistor overheats and the drive detects an rr [Dynamic Braking Transistor Fault]
fault.
4F Braking Resistor Overheat V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(rH) The terminal activates when the braking resistor overheats and the drive detects an rH [Braking Resistor Overheat] fault.
60 Internal Cooling Fan Failure V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the drive detects a cooling fan failure in the drive.
61 Pole Position Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Complete The terminal activates when drive receives a Run command and the drive detects the motor magnetic pole position of the PM motor.
62 Modbus Reg 1 Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Satisfied The terminal activates when the bit specified by H2-08 [Modbus Register 1 Bit Select] for the MEMOBUS register address set with
H2-07 [Modbus Register 1 Address Select] activates.
63 Modbus Reg 2 Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Satisfied The terminal activates when the bit specified by H2-10 [Modbus Register 2 Bit Select] for the MEMOBUS register address set with
H2-09 [Modbus Register 2 Address Select] activates.
65 Standby Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates after the drive stops operating and after the time set with b8-51 [Standby Mode Wait Time].
ON : The Run command turns on and the magnetic contactor on the input side turns on.
OFF : The Run command turns off and the drive stops operating. Then, the magnetic contactor on the input side turns off after the
time set in b8-51 [Standby Mode Wait Time] elapses.
66 Comparator1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates if the monitor value set with H2-20 [Comparator 1 Monitor Selection] is in range of the values of H2-21
[Comparator 1 Lower Limit] and H2-22 [Comparator 1 Upper Limit] for the time set in H2-24 [Comparator 1 On-Delay Time].
67 Comparator2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates if the monitor value set with H2-26 [Comparator 2 Monitor Selection] is not in the range of the values of H2-
27 [Comparator 2 Lower Limit] and H2-28 [Comparator 2 Upper Limit] for the time set in H2-30 [Comparator 2 On-Delay Time].
69 External Power 24V Supply V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when there is an external 24V power supply between terminals PS-AC.
ON : The external 24V power supply is supplying power.
OFF : The external 24V power supply is not supplying power.
6A Data Logger Error V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the drive detects a LoG [Com Error / Abnormal SD card].
90 DWEZ Digital Output 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 1. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
91 DWEZ Digital Output 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 2. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
92 DWEZ Digital Output 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 3. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
93 DWEZ Digital Output 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 4. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A0 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 1 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 1. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A1 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 2 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 2. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A2 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 3 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 3. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A3 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 4 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 4. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A4 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 5 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 5. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A5 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 6 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 6. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A6 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 7 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 7. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
A7 DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 8 Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 8. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
100 !During Run V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when you input a Run command and when the drive is outputting voltage.
ON : Drive is stopping
OFF : Drive is running
101 !Zero Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is less than E1-09 [Minimum Output Frequency] or b2-01 [DC Injection/Zero
SpeedThreshold].
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the reference.
102 !Speed Agree 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-02 [Speed Agree Detection
Width].
Note:
In CLV, the motor speed is the reference.
ON : The output frequency does not align with the frequency reference although the drive is running.
OFF : The output frequency is in the range of “frequency reference ± L4-02”.
103 !User-Set Speed Agree 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is in the range of L4-01 [Speed Agree Detection Level] ± L4-02 [Speed Agree
Detection Width] and in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-02.
Note:
• The detection function operates in the two motor rotation directions. The drive uses the L4-01 value as the forward/reverse
detection level.
• When using Closed Loop Vector Control, this is the value of “Motor Speed ± L4-02.”
ON : The output frequency is not in the range of “L4-01 ± L4-02” nor the range of frequency reference ± L4-02.
Parameter List
OFF : The output frequency is in the range of “L4-01 ± L4-02” and the range of frequency reference ± L4-02.
104 !Frequency Detection 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is higher than the value of L4-01 [Speed Agree Detection Level] + L4-02
[Speed Agree Detection Width]. When the terminal activates, it stays activated until the output frequency = L4-01.
Note:
• The detection function operates in the two motor rotation directions. The drive uses the L4-01 value as the forward/reverse
detection level.
• In CLV, the motor speed is the reference. 3
ON : The output frequency is higher than L4-01 + L4-02.
OFF : The output frequency is less than L4-01 or is not more than L4-01 + L4-02.
105 !Frequency Detection 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is higher than the value of L4-01 [Speed Agree Detection Level]. When the
terminal deactivates, it stays deactivated until the output frequency = L4-01 - L4-02.
ON : The output frequency is less than “L4-01 - L4-02,” or it is not more than L4-01.
OFF : The output frequency is more than L4-01.
106 !Drive Ready V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
107 !DC Bus Undervoltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the DC bus voltage or control circuit power supply is at or below the voltage set in L2-05
[Undervoltage Detection Lvl (Uv1)]. The terminal also deactivates when there is a fault with the DC bus voltage.
ON : The DC bus voltage is more than the setting value of L2-05.
OFF : The DC bus voltage is less than the setting value of L2-05.
108 During Baseblock (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates during baseblock. When the drive is in baseblock, the drive output transistor stops switching and does not
make DC bus voltage.
ON : The drive is not in baseblock.
OFF : During baseblock
109 !Frequency Reference from V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Keypad Shows the selected frequency reference source.
ON : b1-01 [Frequency Reference Selection 1] or b1-15 [Frequency Reference Selection 2] is the frequency reference source.
OFF : The keypad is the frequency reference source.
10A !Run Command from V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Keypad Shows the selected Run command source.
ON : b1-02 [Run Command Selection 1] or b1-16 [Run Command Selection 2] is the Run command source.
OFF : The keypad is the Run command source.
10B Torque Detection 1 (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
10C !Frequency Reference Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the drive detects a loss of frequency reference.
10D !Braking Resistor Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the mounting-type braking resistor is overheating or when there is a braking transistor fault.
10E !Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
111 !Fault Reset Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Active The terminal deactivates when the drive receives the Reset command from the control circuit terminal, serial communications, or
the communication option.
112 !Timer Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the terminal as the timer output. Use this setting with the timer input set in H1-xx = 118 [MFDI Function Selection = !Timer
Function].
113 !Speed Agree 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-04 [Speed Agree Detection
Width(+/-)].
Note:
The drive uses the motor speed as the reference in CLV and CLV/PM.
ON : The output frequency is not in the range of “frequency reference ± L4-04”.
OFF : The output frequency is in the range of “frequency reference ± L4-04”.
114 !User-Set Speed Agree 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is in the range of L4-03 [Speed Agree Detection Level(+/-)] ± L4-04 [Speed
Agree Detection Width(+/-)] and in the range of the frequency reference ± L4-04.
ON : The output frequency is not in the range of “L4-03 ± L4-04” nor the range of frequency reference ± L4-04.
OFF : The output frequency is in the range of “L4-03 ± L4-04” and the range of frequency reference ± L4-04.
115 !Frequency Detection 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates when the output frequency is higher than “L4-03 [Speed Agree Detection Level(+/-)] + L4-04 [Speed Agree
Detection Width(+/-)]”. When the terminal activates, it stays activated until the output frequency = L4-03.
Note:
• The detection level set in L4-03 is a signed value. Detections only occur one specific orientation.
• The drive uses the motor speed as the reference in CLV and CLV/PM.
ON : The output frequency is higher than L4-03 + L4-04.
OFF : The output frequency is less than L4-03 or is not more than L4-03 + L4-04.
116 !Frequency Detection 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the output frequency is higher than the value of L4-03 [Speed Agree Detection Level(+/-)]. After the
terminal deactivates, the terminal stays deactivated until the output frequency = L4-03 - L4-04.
ON : The output frequency is less than “L4-03 - L4-04,” or it is not more than L4-03.
OFF : The output frequency is more than L4-03.
117 Torque Detection 1 (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
118 Torque Detection 2 (N.C.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
119 Torque Detection 2 (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
11A !During Reverse V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the motor operates in the reverse direction.
ON : The motor is operating in the forward direction or the motor stopped.
OFF : The motor is operating in the reverse direction.
11B During Baseblock (N.O.) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activates during baseblock. When the drive is in baseblock, the drive output transistor stops switching and does not
make DC bus voltage.
ON : During baseblock
OFF : The drive is not in baseblock.
11C !Motor 2 Selected V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
11D !During Regeneration V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
11E !Executing Auto-Restart V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the Auto Restart function is trying to restart after a fault.
11F !Motor Overload Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(oL1) The terminal deactivates when the electronic thermal protection value of the motor overload protective function is a minimum of
90% of the detection level.
120 !Drive Overheat Pre-Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(oH) The terminal deactivates when the drive heatsink temperature is at the level set with L8-02 [Overheat Alarm Level].
121 !Safe Torque OFF V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates (safety stop state) when the safety circuit and safety diagnosis circuit are operating correctly and when
terminals H1-HC and H2-HC are OFF (Open).
ON : Safety circuit fault or RUN/READY
OFF : Safety stop state
122 !Mechanical Weakening V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Detection The terminal deactivates when the drive detects mechanical weakening.
12F !Maintenance Notification V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when drive components are at their estimated maintenance period.
Tells you about the maintenance period for these items:
Parameter List
• IGBT
• Cooling Fan
• Capacitor
• Soft charge bypass relay
130 !During Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the torque reference is the torque limit set with L7 parameters, H3-02, H3-06, or H3-10 [MFAI
Function Selection].
3
131 !During Speed Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
132 !In Speed Limit During Trq V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Ctrl The motor accelerates in the forward direction or the reverse direction after enabling torque control and the externally-input torque
reference is disproportionate to the load. The output terminal deactivates when this speed is not higher than a constant speed and the
motor speed is at the speed limit. This does not include operation when the drive is stopped.
133 !Zero Servo Complete V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when positioning in the range set with b9-02 [Zero Servo Completion Window] completes after sending the
Zero-Servo command.
137 !During Frequency Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
138 !Drive Enabled V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
This terminal deactivates when the H1-xx = 16A [Drive Enable] terminal deactivates.
139 !Watt Hour Pulse Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
13C !LOCAL Control Selected V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the Run command source or frequency reference source is LOCAL.
ON : REMOTE
OFF : LOCAL
13D !During Speed Search V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
13E !PID Feedback Low V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the drive detects FbL [PID Feedback Loss].
13F !PID Feedback High V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the drive detects FbH [Excessive PID Feedback].
14A !During KEB Ride-Thru V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the drive executes the KEB Ride-Thru function.
14B !During Short Circuit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Braking The terminal deactivates during Short Circuit Braking.
Note:
When A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZ Vector Control], this function is available when you use a PM motor.
14C !During Fast Stop V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
14D !oH Pre-Alarm Reduction V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Limit The terminal deactivates when L8-03 = 4 [Overheat Pre-Alarm Selection = Operate at Reduced Speed (L8-19)] and oH [Heatsink
Overheat] does not clear after the drive decreases the frequency for 10 cycles.
14E !Braking Transistor Fault (rr) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the internal braking transistor overheats and the drive detects an rr [Dynamic Braking Transistor
Fault] fault.
14F !Braking Resistor Overheat V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
(rH) The terminal deactivates when the braking resistor overheats and the drive detects an rH [Braking Resistor Overheat] fault.
160 !Internal Cooling Fan Failure V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the drive detects a cooling fan failure in the drive.
161 !RotorPositionDetection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Complete The terminal deactivates when drive receives a Run command and the drive detects the motor magnetic pole position of the PM
motor.
162 !Modbus Reg 1 Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Satisfied The terminal deactivates when the bit specified by H2-07 turns on regarding the MEMOBUS register address configured with H2-
08.
163 !Modbus Reg 2 Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Satisfied The terminal deactivates when the bit specified by H2-10 turns on regarding the MEMOBUS register address configured with H2-
09.
165 !Standby Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal activated after the drive stops operating and after the time set with b8-51 [Standby Mode Wait Time].
ON : The Run command turns off and the drive stops operating. When time set in b8-51 [Standby Mode Wait Time] is expired, the
magnetic contactor on the input side turns off.
OFF : The Run command turns on and the magnetic contactor on the input side turns on.
166 !Comparator 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the monitor value set with H2-20 is within range of H2-21 and H2-22 for the time set in H2-24.
167 !Comparator 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the when the monitor value set with H2-26 is outside the range of H2-27 and H2-28 for the time set
in H2-30.
169 !External Power 24V Supply V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when there is an external 24V power supply between terminals PS-AC.
ON : The external 24V power supply is not supplying power.
OFF : The external 24V power supply is supplying power.
16A !Data Logger Error V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The terminal deactivates when the drive detects a LoG [Com Error / Abnormal SD card].
190 !DWEZ Digital Output 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 1. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
191 !DWEZ Digital Output 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 2. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
192 !DWEZ Digital Output 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 3. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
193 !DWEZ Digital Output 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Sets the DriveWorksEZ digital output 4. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A0 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 1 Sets the digital output 1 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A1 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 2 Sets the digital output 2 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A2 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 3 Sets the digital output 3 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A3 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 4 Sets the digital output 4 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A4 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 5 Sets the digital output 5 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A5 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 6 Sets the digital output 6 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A6 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 7 Sets the digital output 7 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
1A7 !DWEZ Extended Digital V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Output 8 Sets the digital output 8 for the DriveWorksEZ DO-A3 option. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
H3-01 Terminal A1 Signal Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0410) Select Sets the input signal level for MFAI terminal A1. (0 - 3)
0 : 0-10V (Lower Limit at 0)
1 : -10 to +10V (Bipolar Reference)
2 : 4 to 20 mA
3 : 0 to 20 mA
H3-02 Terminal A1 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0434) Selection Sets the function for MFAI terminal A1. (0 - 32)
H3-03 Terminal A1 Gain Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0411) Sets the gain of the analog signal input to MFAI terminal A1. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
Parameter List
RUN
H3-04 Terminal A1 Bias Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0412) Sets the bias of the analog signal input to MFAI terminal A1. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN
H3-05 Terminal A3 Signal Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0413) Select Sets the input signal level for MFAI terminal A3. (0 - 3)
0 : 0-10V (Lower Limit at 0)
3
1 : -10 to +10V (Bipolar Reference)
2 : 4 to 20 mA
3 : 0 to 20 mA
H3-06 Terminal A3 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(0414) Selection Sets the function for MFAI terminal A3. (0 - 32)
H3-07 Terminal A3 Gain Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0415) Sets the gain of the analog signal input to MFAI terminal A3. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H3-08 Terminal A3 Bias Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0416) Sets the bias of the analog signal input to MFAI terminal A3. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN
H3-09 Terminal A2 Signal Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(0417) Select Sets the input signal level for MFAI terminal A2. (0 - 3)
0 : 0-10V (Lower Limit at 0)
1 : -10 to +10V (Bipolar Reference)
2 : 4 to 20 mA
3 : 0 to 20 mA
H3-10 Terminal A2 Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0418) Selection Sets the function for MFAI terminal A2. (0 - 32)
H3-11 Terminal A2 Gain Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(0419) Sets the gain of the analog signal input to MFAI terminal A2. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN
H3-12 Terminal A2 Bias Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(041A) Sets the bias of the analog signal input to MFAI terminal A2. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN
H3-13 Analog Input FilterTime V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.03 s
(041B) Constant Sets the time constant for primary delay filters on MFAI terminals. (0.00 - 2.00 s)
H3-14 Analog Input Terminal V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 7
(041C) Enable Sel Sets the enabled terminal or terminals when H1-xx = C [MFDI Function Select = Analog Terminal (1 - 7)
Enable Selection] is ON.
1 : Terminal A1 only
2 : Terminal A2 only
3 : Terminals A1 and A2
4 : Terminal A3 only
5 : Terminals A1 and A3
6 : Terminals A2 and A3
7 : Terminals A1, A2, and A3
H3-16 Terminal A1 Offset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02F0) Sets the offset level for analog signals input to terminal A1. Usually it is not necessary to change this (-500 - +500)
setting.
H3-17 Terminal A2 Offset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02F1) Sets the offset level for analog signals input to terminal A2. Usually it is not necessary to change this (-500 - +500)
setting.
H3-18 Terminal A3 Offset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(02F2) Sets the offset level for analog signals input to terminal A3. Usually it is not necessary to change this (-500 - +500)
setting.
H3-40 Mbus Reg 15C1h Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B5C) Function Sets the MEMOBUS AI1 function. (4 - 2F)
H3-41 Mbus Reg 15C2h Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B5F) Function Sets the MEMOBUS AI2 function. (4 - 2F)
H3-42 Mbus Reg 15C3h Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(0B62) Function Sets the MEMOBUS AI3 function. (4 - 2F)
H3-43 Mbus Reg Inputs FilterTime V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 s
(117F) Const Sets the time constant to apply a primary delay filter to the MEMOBUS analog input register values. (0.00 - 2.00 s)
0 Frequency Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The input value from the MFAI terminal set with this function becomes the master frequency reference.
1 Frequency Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
The drive multiplies the analog frequency reference with the input value from the MFAI set with this function.
2 Auxiliary Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Reference 1 Sets Reference 2 through multi-step speed reference to enable the command reference (Auxiliary Frequency Reference 1) from the
analog input terminal set here. This value is a percentage where the Maximum Output Frequency setting is a setting value of 100%.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
3 Auxiliary Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Reference 2 Sets Reference 3 through multi-step speed reference to enable the command reference (Auxiliary Frequency Reference 2) from the
analog input terminal set here. This value is a percentage where the Maximum Output Frequency setting is a setting value of 100%.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
4 Output Voltage Bias V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Set this parameter to input a bias signal and amplify the output voltage.
5 Accel/Decel Time Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters a signal to adjust the gain used for C1-01 to C1-08 [Acceleration/Deceleration Times 1 to 4] and C1-09 [Fast Stop Time]
when the full scale analog signal (10 V or 20 mA) is 100%.
6 DC Injection Braking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Current Enters a signal to adjust the current level used for DC Injection Braking when the drive rated output current is 100%.
7 Torque Detection Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
9 Output Frequency Lower V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Limit Enters a signal to adjust the output frequency lower limit level as a percentage of the maximum output frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
B PID Feedback V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enter the PID feedback value as a percentage of the maximum output frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
C PID Setpoint V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters the bias value added to the frequency reference as a percentage of the maximum output frequency.
Parameter List
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
E Motor Temperature (PTC V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Input) Uses the motor Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) thermistor to prevent heat damage to the motor as a percentage of the
current value when the 10 V analog signal is input.
3
F Not Used V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Use this setting for unused terminals or to use terminals in through mode.
10 Forward Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters the forward torque limit if the motor rated torque is 100%.
11 Reverse Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters the load torque limit if the motor rated torque is 100%.
12 Regenerative Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters the regenerative torque limit if the motor rated torque is 100%.
13 Torque Reference / Torque V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Limit Enters the torque reference if the motor rated torque is 100%. This setting is the torque limit for speed control.
14 Torque Compensation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters the torque compensation value if the motor rated torque is 100%.
15 General Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters the torque limit that is the same for all quadrants for forward, reverse, and regenerative operation if the motor rated torque is
100%.
16 Differential PID Feedback V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Enters the PID differential feedback value if the full scale analog signal (10 V or 20 mA) is 100%.
1F Not Used V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Use this setting for unused terminals or to use terminals in through mode.
30 DWEZ Analog Input 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Use with DriveWorksEZ. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
31 DWEZ Analog Input 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Use with DriveWorksEZ. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
32 DWEZ Analog Input 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Use with DriveWorksEZ. Refer to the DriveWorksEZ online manual for more information.
H4-01 Terminal FM Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 102
(041D) Select Sets the monitor number to send from MFAO terminal FM. (000 - 999)
Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. For example, set H4-01 = 102 to monitor U1-02 [Output
Frequency].
H4-02 Terminal FM Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(041E) Gain Sets the gain of the monitor signal that is sent from MFAO terminal FM. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN Sets the analog signal output level from the terminal FM at 10 V or 20 mA as 100% when an output
for monitoring items is 100%.
H4-03 Terminal FM Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(041F) Bias Sets the bias of the monitor signal that is sent from MFAO terminal FM. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN Set the level of the analog signal sent from terminal FM at 10 V or 20 mA as 100% when an output
for monitoring items is 0%.
H4-04 Terminal AM Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 103
(0420) Select Sets the monitoring number to be output from the MFAO terminal AM. (000 - 999)
Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. For example, set H4-04 = 103 to monitor U1-03 [Output
Current].
H4-05 Terminal AM Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50.0%
(0421) Gain Sets the gain of the monitor signal that is sent from MFAO terminal AM. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN When an output for monitoring items is 0%, this parameter sets the analog signal output level from
the AM terminal at 10 V or 20 mA as 100%.
H4-06 Terminal AM Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0422) Bias Sets the bias of the monitor signal that is sent from MFAO terminal AM. (-999.9 - +999.9%)
RUN When an output for monitoring items is 0%, this parameter sets the analog signal output level from
the AM terminal at 10 V or 20 mA as 0%.
H4-07 Terminal FM Signal Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0423) Select Sets the MFAO terminal FM output signal level. (0 - 2)
Note:
Set jumper S5 on the control circuit terminal block accordingly when changing these parameters.
0 : 0-10V (Lower Limit at 0)
1 : -10 to +10V (Bipolar Reference)
2 : 4 to 20 mA
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H4-08 Terminal AM Signal Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0424) Select Sets the MFAO terminal AM output signal level. (0 - 2)
Note:
Set jumper S5 on the control circuit terminal block accordingly when changing these parameters.
0 : 0 to 10 Vdc
1 : -10 to +10 Vdc
2 : 4 to 20 mA
H4-20 Analog Power Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 kW
(0B53) 100% Level Sets the level at 10 V when U1-08 [Output Power] is set for analog output. (0.00 - 650.00 kW)
H5-01 Drive Node Address V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1FH
(0425) Sets the communication slave address for drives. (0 - FFH)
Note:
• Re-energize the drive or set H5-10 = 1 [Modbus Register 0025H Unit Sel= 1 V units] after you
change the parameter setting.
• Setting 0 will not let the drive respond to MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
H5-02 Communication Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(0426) Selection Sets the communications speed for MEMOBUS/Modbus communications. (0 - 8)
Note:
Re-energize the drive or set H5-20 = 1 [Communication Parameters Reload = Reload Now] after
you change the parameter setting.
0 : 1200 bps
1 : 2400 bps
2 : 4800 bps
3 : 9600 bps
4 : 19.2 kbps
5 : 38.4 kbps
6 : 57.6 kbps
7 : 76.8 kbps
8 : 115.2 kbps
H5-03 Communication Parity V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0427) Selection Sets the communications parity used for MEMOBUS/Modbus communications. (0 - 2)
Note:
Re-energize the drive or set H5-20 = 1 [Communication Parameters Reload = Reload Now] after
you change the parameter setting.
0 : No parity
1 : Even parity
2 : Odd parity
H5-04 Communication Error Stop V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(0428) Method Sets the motor Stopping Method when the drive detects CE [Modbus Communication Error] issues. (0 - 3)
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
Parameter List
3 : Alarm Only
H5-05 Comm Fault Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0429) Selection Sets the function that detects CE [Modbus Communication Error] issues during MEMOBUS/ (0, 1)
Modbus communications.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
H5-06 Drive Transmit Wait Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5 ms
3
(042A) Sets the time to wait to send a response message after the drive receives a command message from (0 - 65 ms)
the master.
Note:
Restart the drive after changing the parameter setting.
H5-09 CE Detection Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2.0 s
(0435) Sets the detection time for CE [Modbus Communication Error] issues when communication stops. (0.0 - 10.0 s)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H5-10 Modbus Register 0025H V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0436) Unit Sel Sets the unit of measure used for the MEMOBUS/Modbus communications monitor register 0025H (0, 1)
(output voltage reference monitor).
0 : 0.1 V units
1 : 1 V units
H5-11 Comm ENTER Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(043C) Mode Sets the function to make the Enter command necessary to change parameters through MEMOBUS/ (0, 1)
Modbus communications.
0 : ENTER Command Required
1 : ENTER Command Not Required
H5-12 Run Command Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(043D) Selection Sets the input method for the Run command when b1-02 = 2 [Run Command Selection 1 = (0, 1)
Memobus/Modbus Communications] or b1-16 = 2 [Run Command Selection 2 = Memobus/Modbus
Communications].
0 : FWD/Stop, REV/Stop
1 : Run/Stop, FWD/REV
H5-17 ENTER command response V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11A1) @CPU BUSY Sets operation when the EEPROM write command is sent without EEPROM write available. Usually (0, 1)
Expert it is not necessary to change this setting.
0 : Ignore Command(No ROM/RAM Write)
1 : Write to RAM Only
H5-18 Motor Speed Filter over V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(11A2) Comms Sets the filter time constant used when monitoring motor speed during MEMOBUS/Modbus (0 - 100 ms)
communications or with a communication option.
H5-20 Communication Parameters V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B57) Reload Sets the function to immediately enable updated MEMOBUS/Modbus communications parameters. (0, 1)
0 : Reload at Next Power Cycle
1 : Reload Now
H5-22 Speed Search from V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11CF) MODBUS Enables the MEMOBUS/Modbus communication register Speed Search function (bit0 of 15DFH). (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
H5-25 Function 5A Register 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0044H (U1-05)
(1589) Selection Returns the contents of the specified MEMOBUS/Modbus communications register when responding (0000H - FFFFH)
RUN to the master device.
H5-26 Function 5A Register 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0045H (U1-06)
(158A) Selection Returns the contents of the specified MEMOBUS/Modbus communications register when responding (0000H - FFFFH)
RUN to the master device.
H5-27 Function 5A Register 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0042H (U1-03)
(158B) Selection Returns the contents of the specified MEMOBUS/Modbus communications register when responding (0000H - FFFFH)
RUN to the master device.
H5-28 Function 5A Register 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0049H (U1-10)
(158C) Selection Returns the contents of the specified MEMOBUS/Modbus communications register when responding (0000H - FFFFH)
RUN to the master device.
H6-01 Terminal RP Pulse Train V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(042C) Function Sets the function for pulse train input terminal RP. (0 - 3)
0 : Frequency Reference
1 : PID Feedback Value
2 : PID Setpoint Value
3 : Speed Feedback (V/F Control)
H6-02 Terminal RP Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1440 Hz
(042D) Scaling Sets the frequency of the pulse train input signal used when the item selected with H6-01 [Terminal (100 - 32000 Hz)
RUN RP Pulse Train Function] is input at 100%.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H6-03 Terminal RP Function Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(042E) Sets the gain used when the function in H6-01 [Terminal RP Pulse Train Function] is input to (0.0 - 1000.0%)
RUN terminal RP.
H6-04 Terminal RP Function Bias V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(042F) Sets the bias used when the function in H6-01 [Terminal RP Pulse Train Function] is input to (-100.0 - 100.0%)
RUN terminal RP. Sets a value at the time when the pulse train is 0 Hz.
H6-05 Terminal RP Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.10 s
(0430) Sets the time constant for the pulse train input primary delay filters. (0.00 - 2.00 s)
RUN
H6-06 Terminal MP Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 102
(0431) Selection Sets a function for pulse train monitor output terminal MP. Sets the “x-xx” part of the Ux-xx monitor. (000, 031, 101, 102, 105,
RUN 116, 501, 502, 801 - 809,
821 - 825, 831 - 839, 851 -
855)
H6-07 Terminal MP Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1440 Hz
(0432) Scaling Sets the frequency of the pulse train output signal used when the monitor set with H6-06 [Terminal (0 - 32000 Hz)
RUN MP Monitor Selection] is 100%.
H6-08 Terminal RP Minimum V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.5 Hz
(043F) Frequency Sets the minimum frequency of the pulse train signal that terminal RP can detect. (0.1 - 1000.0 Hz)
H6-09 Voltage Phase Sync MP V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(156E) Selection Set whether to output the pulse synchronized with drive output voltage phase from the pulse train (0, 1)
monitor output terminal MP. This parameter is only enabled when H6-06 = 102 [Terminal MP
Monitor Selection = Output Frequency] and H6-07 = 0 [Terminal MP Frequency Scaling = 0 Hz].
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
H7-00 Virtual MFIO selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(116F) Sets the function to enable and disable the virtual I/O function. Set this parameter to 1 to operate the (0, 1)
Expert virtual I/O function.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
H7-01 Virtual Multi-Function Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1185) 1 Sets the function that enters the virtual input set in H7-10 [Virtual Multi-Function Output 1]. (1 - 19F)
Expert Note:
1B [Programming Lockout] and 11B [Inverse Input of 1B] are not available.
H7-02 Virtual Multi-Function Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1186) 2 Sets the function that enters the virtual input set in H7-12 [Virtual Multi-Function Output 2]. (1 - 19F)
Expert Note:
1B [Programming Lockout] and 11B [Inverse Input of 1B] are not available.
H7-03 Virtual Multi-Function Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1187) 3 Sets the function that enters the virtual input set in H7-14 [Virtual Multi-Function Output 3]. (1 - 19F)
Parameter List
Expert Note:
1B [Programming Lockout] and 11B [Inverse Input of 1B] are not available.
H7-04 Virtual Multi-Function Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1188) 4 Sets the function that enters the virtual input set in H7-16 [Virtual Multi-Function Output 4]. (1 - 19F)
Expert Note:
1B [Programming Lockout] and 11B [Inverse Input of 1B] are not available. 3
H7-10 Virtual Multi-Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(11A4) Output 1 Sets the function for virtual digital output 1. (0 - 1A7)
Expert
H7-11 Virtual Output 1 Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(11A5) Sets the minimum ON time for virtual digital output 1. (0.0 - 25.0 s)
Expert
H7-12 Virtual Multi-Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(11A6) Output 2 Sets the function for virtual digital output 2. (0 - 1A7)
Expert
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
H7-13 Virtual Output 2 Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(11A7) Sets the minimum ON time for virtual digital output 2. (0.0 - 25.0 s)
Expert
H7-14 Virtual Multi-Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(11A8) Output 3 Sets the function for virtual digital output 3. (0 - 1A7)
Expert
H7-15 Virtual Output 3 Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(11A9) Sets the minimum ON time for virtual digital output 3. (0.0 - 25.0 s)
Expert
H7-16 Virtual Multi-Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(11AA) Output 4 Sets the function for virtual digital output 4. (0 - 1A7)
Expert
H7-17 Virtual Output 4 Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(11AB) Sets the minimum ON time for virtual digital output 4. (0.0 - 25.0 s)
Expert
H7-30 Virtual Analog Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV F
(1177) Selection Sets the virtual analog input function. (0 - 32)
Expert
H7-31 Virtual Analog Input Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(1178) Sets the virtual analog input gain. (-999.9 - 999.9%)
RUN
Expert
H7-32 Virtual Analog Input Bias V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(1179) Sets the virtual analog input bias. (-999.9 - 999.9%)
RUN
Expert
H7-40 Virtual Analog Out Signal V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1163) Select Sets the signal level of the virtual analog output. (0 - 2)
0 : 0 to 100% (Absolute Value)
1 : -100 to 100%
2 : 0 to 100% (Lower Limit at 0)
H7-41 Virtual Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 102
(1164) Function Sets the monitor to be output from the virtual analog output. (0 - 999)
Set the x-xx part of the Ux-xx [Monitor]. For example, set H7-41 = 102 to monitor U1-02 [Output
Frequency].
H7-42 Virtual Analog Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 s
(1165) FilterTime Sets the time constant for a primary filter of the virtual analog output. (0.00 - 2.00 s)
L1-01 Motor Overload (oL1) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0480) Protection Sets the motor overload protection with electronic thermal protectors. (0 - 6)
0 : Disable
1 : Variable Torque
2 : Constant Torque 10:1 Speed Range
3 : Constant Torque 100:1 SpeedRange
4 : PM Variable Torque
5 : PM Constant Torque
6 : Variable Torque (50Hz)
Note:
When only one motor is connected to a drive, set L1-01 = 1 to 6 [Enabled]. External thermal
relays are not necessary in these conditions.
L1-02 Motor Overload Protection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 min
(0481) Time Sets the operation time for the electronic thermal protector of the drive to prevent damage to the (0.1 - 5.0 min)
motor. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
L1-03 Motor Thermistor oH Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(0482) Select Sets drive operation when the PTC input signal entered into the drive is at the oH3 [Motor Overheat (0 - 3)
Alarm] detection level.
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
L1-04 Motor Thermistor oH Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0483) Select Sets the drive operation when the PTC input signal to the drive is at the oH4 [Motor Overheat Fault (0 - 2)
(PTC Input)] detection level.
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
L1-05 Motor Thermistor Filter V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.20 s
(0484) Time Sets the primary delay time constant for the PTC input signal entered to the drive. This parameter (0.00 - 10.00 s)
prevents accidental motor overheat faults.
L1-08 oL1 Current Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 A
(1103) Sets the reference current for the motor 1 thermal overload detection. When the current level > 0.0 A, (0.0 A or 10% to 150% of
you cannot set this value < 10% of drive rated current. the drive rated current)
L1-09 oL1 Current Level for Motor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 A
(1104) 2 Sets the reference current for the motor 2 thermal overload detection. When the current level > 0.0 A, (0.0 A or 10 to150% of the
you cannot set this value < 10% of drive rated current. drive rated current)
L1-13 Motor Overload Memory V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(046D) Selection Sets the function that keeps the current electronic thermal protector value when the drive stops (0, 1)
receiving power.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
Parameter List
L2-01 Power Loss Ride Through V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0485) Select Sets the drive operation after a momentary power loss. (0 - 5)
0 : Disable
1 : Enabled
2 : Enabled while CPU Power Active
3 : Kinetic Energy Backup: L2-02
4 : Kinetic Energy Backup: CPU Power
5 : Kinetic Energy Backup: DecelStop
Note:
When the CPU is inactive, b1-17 [Run Command at Power Up] sets operation at power up.
L2-02 Power Loss Ride Through V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0486) Time Sets the maximum time that the drive will wait until trying to restart after power loss. (0.0 - 25.5 s)
L2-03 Minimum Baseblock Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0487) Sets the minimum time to continue the drive output block (baseblock) after a baseblock. (0.1 - 5.0 s)
L2-04 Powerloss V/f Recovery V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0488) Ramp Time Sets the time for the drive output voltage to go back to correct voltage after completing speed (0.0 - 5.0 s)
searches.
L2-05 Undervoltage Detection Lvl V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04 and
(0489) (Uv1) Sets the voltage at which a Uv1 [DC Bus Undervoltage] fault is triggered or at which the KEB E1-01
function is activated. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (200 V Class: 150 - 210 V,
400 V Class: 300 - 420 V)
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. When you set this parameter to a
value lower than the default, you must install an AC reactor on the input
side of the power supply. If you do not install an AC reactor, it will cause
damage to the drive circuitry.
L2-06 Kinetic Energy Backup V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(048A) Decel Time Sets the deceleration time during KEB operation used to decrease the maximum output frequency to (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
Expert 0.
Note:
When L2-29 = 1, 2, or 3 [Kinetic Energy Backup Method = Single Drive KEB Ride-Thru 2,
System KEB Ride-Thru 1, or System KEB Ride-Thru 2] and you do KEB Auto-Tuning, the drive
will automatically set this value.
L2-07 Kinetic Energy Backup V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(048B) Accel Time Sets the acceleration time to return the frequency to the frequency reference before a power loss after (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
Expert canceling KEB operation.
L2-08 Frequency Gain at KEB V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100%
(048C) Start Sets the quantity of output frequency reduction used when KEB operation starts as a percentage of (0 - 300%)
Expert the motor rated slip before starting KEB operation.
L2-09 KEB Minimum Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 20%
(048D) Level Sets the quantity of output frequency reduction used as a percentage of E2-02 [Motor Rated Slip] (0 - 100%)
Expert when KEB operation starts.
L2-10 Minimum KEB Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50 ms
(048E) Sets the minimum length of time to operate the KEB after the drive detects a momentary power loss. (0 - 25500 ms)
Expert
L2-11 KEB DC Bus Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E1-01
(0461) Setpoint Sets the target value that controls the DC bus voltage to a constant level in Single Drive KEB Ride- (Determined by E1-01)
Expert Thru 2. Sets the DC bus voltage level that completes the KEB operation for all other KEB methods.
L2-29 Kinetic Energy Backup V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0475) Method Sets the KEB function operation mode. (0 - 3)
Expert 0 : Single Drive KEB Ride-Thru 1
1 : Single Drive KEB Ride-Thru 2
2 : System KEB Ride-Thru 1
3 : System KEB Ride-Thru 2
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L2-30 KEB Zero Speed Operation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(045E) Sets the operation when the output frequency decreases below the zero level (DC braking injection (0, 1)
Expert starting frequency) during KEB deceleration when L2-01 = 3 to 5 [Power Loss Ride Through Select
= Kinetic Energy Backup: L2-02, Kinetic Energy Backup: CPU Power, or Kinetic Energy Backup:
DecelStop].
0 : Baseblock
1 : DC/SC Braking
L2-31 KEB Start Voltage Offset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(045D) Level Sets the KEB start voltage offset. (200 V Class: 0 - 100 V,400
Expert V Class: 0 - 200 V)
L3-01 Stall Prevention during V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(048F) Accel Sets the method of the Stall Prevention During Acceleration. (0 - 3)
0 : Disable
1 : Enabled
2 : Intelligent (Ignore Accel Ramp)
3 : Current Limit Acceleration
L3-02 Stall Prevent Level during V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-01 and
(0490) Accel Sets the output current level to activate the Stall Prevention function during acceleration as a L8-38
percentage of the drive rated output current. (0 - 150%)
Note:
The upper limit of the setting range changes when C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection]
changes.
• 150% when C6-01 = 0 [Heavy Duty Rating].
• 110% when C6-01 = 1 [Normal Duty Rating].
L3-03 Stall Prevent Limit during V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50%
(0491) Accel Sets the lower limit for the stall prevention level used in the constant output range as a percentage of (0 - 100%)
the drive rated output current.
L3-04 Stall Prevention during V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0492) Decel Sets the method that the drive will use to prevent overvoltage faults when decelerating. (Determined by A1-02)
Note:
1. To connect a dynamic braking option (braking resistor or braking resistor unit) to the drive,
set this parameter to 0 or 3. Parameter values 1, 2, 4, and 5 will enable Stall Prevention
function during deceleration, and the dynamic braking option will not function.
2. The setting range changes when the A1-02 [Control Method Selection] value changes:
• When A1-02 = 5 [OLV/PM], the setting range is 0 to 2.
• When A1-02 = 6, 7, 8 [AOLV/PM, CLV/PM, EZOLV], the setting range is 0, 1.
0 : Disable
1 : General Purpose
2 : Intelligent (Ignore Accel Ramp)
3 : General Purpose w/ DB resistor
4 : Overexcitation/High Flux 1
5 : Overexcitation/High Flux 2
L3-05 Stall Prevention during RUN V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
Parameter List
(0493) Sets the function to enable and disable Stall Prevention During Run. (0 - Determined by A1-02)
Note:
1. An output frequency lower than 6 Hz will disable Stall Prevention during Run. The L3-05
and L3-06 [Stall Prevent Level during Run] settings do not have an effect.
2. The setting range changes when the A1-02 [Control Method] value changes:
• A1-02 = 0, 1, 5 [V/f, CL-V/f, OLV/PM]: 0 to 2
• A1-02 =8[EZOLV]: 0, 3
0 : Disabled 3
1 : Deceleration Time 1 (C1-02)
2 : Deceleration Time 2 (C1-04)
3 : Intelligent (Ignore Decel Ramp)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L3-06 Stall Prevent Level during V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-01 and
(0494) Run Sets the output current level to enable the Stall Prevention function during operation as a percentage L8-38
of the drive rated output current. (5 - 150%)
Note:
• This parameter is applicable when L3-05 = 1, 2 [Stall Prevention during RUN = Deceleration
Time 1 (C1-02), Deceleration Time 2 (C1-04)].
• The upper limit of the setting range changes when C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection]
changes.
–150% when C6-01 = 0 [Heavy Duty Rating 1 (HD1) for Constant Torque Applications].
–110% when C6-01 = 1 [Normal Duty Rating 1 (ND1) for Variable Torque Applications].
L3-11 Overvoltage Suppression V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04C7) Select Sets the overvoltage suppression function. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L3-17 DC Bus Regulation Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 375 V,
(0462) Sets the target value for the DC bus voltage when the overvoltage suppression function and the Decel 400 V Class: 750 V
Stall Prevention function (Intelligent Stall Prevention) are active. (200 V Class: 150 to 400 V,
400 V Class: 300 to 800 V)
L3-20 DC Bus Voltage Adjustment V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0465) Gain Sets the proportional gain used to control the DC bus voltage. (0.00 - 5.00)
Expert
L3-21 OVSuppression Accel/Decel V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0466) P Gain Sets the proportional gain to calculate acceleration and deceleration rates. (0.10 - 10.00)
Expert
L3-22 PM Stall Prevention Decel V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(04F9) Time Sets the momentary deceleration time that the drive will use when it tries to accelerate a PM motor (0.0 - 6000.0 s)
and detected motor stalls. This function is applicable when L3-01 = 1 [Stall Prevention during Accel
= Enabled].
L3-23 Stall P Reduction at V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04FD) Constant HP Sets the function to automatically decrease the Stall Prevention Level during Run for Constant Horse (0, 1)
Power (CHP) part of the speed range.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L3-24 Motor Accel Time @ Rated V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-
(046E) Torque Sets the motor acceleration time to reach the maximum frequency at the motor rated torque for 01, E2-11, and E5-01
Expert stopped single-drive motors. (0.001 - 10.000 s)
L3-25 Load Inertia Ratio V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(046F) Sets the ratio between motor inertia and machine inertia. (0.1 - 1000.0)
Expert
L3-26 Additional DC Bus V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 μF
(0455) Capacitors Sets the capacity for external main circuit capacitors. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0 to 65000 μF)
Expert setting. Sets this parameter when you use the KEB Ride-Thru function.
L3-27 Stall Prevention Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50 ms
(0456) Time Sets a delay time between reaching the Stall Prevention level and starting the Stall Prevention (0 - 5000 ms)
function.
L3-34 Torque Limit Delay Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(016F) Sets the filter time constant that returns the torque limit to its initial value when KEB operation (0.000 - 1.000 s)
Expert operates in Single Drive KEB Ride-Thru mode.
L3-35 Speed Agree Width for Auto V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00 Hz
(0747) Decel Sets the width for speed agreement when L3-04 = 2 [Stall Prevention during Decel = Intelligent (0.00 - 1.00 Hz)
Expert (Ignore Decel Ramp)]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
L3-36 Current Suppression V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(11D0) Gain@Accel Sets the gain to suppress current and motor speed hunting during operation when L3-01 = 3 [Stall (0.0 - 100.0)
Prevention during Accel = Current Limit Method]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
L3-37 Current Limit P Gain @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5 ms
(11D1) Accel Suppresses current hunting during acceleration. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0 - 100 ms)
Expert
L3-38 Current Limit I Time @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0
(11D2) Accel Suppresses current hunting and overshooting that occurs when the drive stalls during acceleration. (0.0 - 100.0)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L3-39 Current Limit Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0 ms
(11D3) @Accel Sets the time constant to adjust the acceleration rate when L3-01 = 3 [Stall Prevention during Accel (1.0 - 1000.0 ms)
= Current Limit Method]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
L3-40 Current Limit S-Curve @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11D4) Acc/Dec Sets the function to enable and disable the best S-curve characteristic used for current-limited (0, 1)
acceleration.
0 : Disable
1 : Enabled
L4-01 Speed Agree Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0499) Level Sets the level to detect speed agree or motor speed. (Determined by A1-02)
Sets the level to detect speed agree or motor speed when H2-01 to H2-03 = 2, 3, 4, 5 [MFDO
Function Selection = Speed Agree 1, User-set Speed Agree 1, Frequency Detection 1, Frequency
Detection 2].
L4-02 Speed Agree Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(049A) Width Sets the width to detect speed agree or motor speed. (Determined by A1-02)
Sets the width to detect speed agree or motor speed when H2-01 to H2-03 = 2, 3, 4, 5 [MFDO
Function Selection = Speed Agree 1, User-set Speed Agree 1, Frequency Detection 1, Frequency
Detection 2].
L4-03 Speed Agree Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(049B) Level (+/-) Sets the level to detect speed agree or motor speed. (Determined by A1-02)
Sets the speed agree detection level or motor speed detection level when H2-01 to H2-03 = 13, 14,
15, 16 [MFDO Function Selection = Speed Agree 2, User-set Speed Agree 2, Frequency Detection 3,
Frequency Detection 4].
L4-04 Speed Agree Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(049C) Width (+/-) Sets the width to detect speed agree or motor speed. (Determined by A1-02)
Sets the width to detect speed agree or motor speed when H2-01 to H2-03 = 13, 14, 15, 16 [MFDO
Function Selection = Speed Agree 2, User-set Speed Agree 2, Frequency Detection 3, Frequency
Detection 4].
L4-05 Fref Loss Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(049D) Selection Sets the operation when the drive detects a loss of frequency reference. (0, 1)
0 : Stop
1 : Run at (L4-06 x Last Reference)
L4-06 Frequency Reference @Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 80.0%
(04C2) of Ref Sets the frequency reference as a percentage to continue drive operation after it detects a frequency (0.0 - 100.0%)
reference loss. The value is a percentage of the frequency reference before the drive detected the loss.
L4-07 Speed Agree Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0470) Selection Sets the condition that activates speed detection. (0, 1)
0 : No Detection during Baseblock
1 : Detection Always Enabled
Parameter List
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L5-01 Number of Auto-Restart V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(049E) Attempts Sets the number of times that the drive will try to restart. (0 - 10 times)
L5-03 Continuous Method Max V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(04A0) Restart T Sets the time for which the drive will try to restart. If the drive cannot restart inthe time set in L5-03, (0.5 - 180.0 s)
the drive detects a fault. This is available when L5-05 = 0 [Auto-Restart Method = Continuous/
Immediate Attempts].
L5-04 Interval Method Restart V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 s
(046C) Time Sets the time interval between each Auto Restart attempt. This function is enabled when L5-05 = 1 (0.5 - 600.0 s)
[Auto Restart Operation Selection = Use L5-04 Time].
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L5-05 Auto-Restart Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0467) Sets the count method for the Auto Restart operation. (0, 1)
0 : Continuous/Immediate Attempts
1 : Interval/Attempt after L5-04 sec
L5-07 Fault Reset Enable Select V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1111
(0B2A) Grp1 Use these 4 digits to set the Auto Restart function for oL1 to oL4. From left to right, the digits set (0000 - 1111)
oL1, oL2, oL3, and oL4, in order.
0000 : Disabled
0001 : Enabled (—/—/—/oL4)
0010 : Enabled (—/—/oL3/—)
0011 : Enabled (—/—/oL3/oL4)
0100 : Enabled (—/oL2/—/—)
0101 : Enabled (—/oL2/—/oL4)
0110 : Enabled (—/oL2/oL3/—)
0111 : Enabled (—/oL2/oL3/oL4)
1000 : Enabled (oL1/—/—/—)
1001 : Enabled (oL1/—/—/oL4)
1010 : Enabled (oL1/—/oL3/—)
1011 : Enabled (oL1/—/oL3/oL4)
1100 : Enabled (oL1/oL2/—/—)
1101 : Enabled (oL1/oL2/—/oL4)
1110 : Enabled (oL1/oL2/oL3/—)
1111 : Enabled (oL1/oL2/oL3/oL4)
L5-08 Fault Reset Enable Select V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1111
(0B2B) Grp2 Use these 4 digits to set the Auto Restart function for Uv1, ov, oH1, and GF. From left to right, the (0000 - 1111)
digits set Uv1, ov, oH1, and GF, in order.
0000 : Disabled
0001 : Enabled (—/–/—/GF)
0010 : Enabled (—/–/oH1/–)
0011 : Enabled (—/–/oH1/GF)
0100 : Enabled (—/ov/—/–)
0101 : Enabled (—/ov/—/GF)
0110 : Enabled (—/ov/oH1/–)
0111 : Enabled (—/ov/oH1/GF)
1000 : Enabled (Uv1/–/—/–)
1001 : Enabled (Uv1/–/—/GF)
1010 : Enabled (Uv1/–/oH1/–)
1011 : Enabled (Uv1/–/oH1/GF)
1100 : Enabled (Uv1/ov/—/–)
1101 : Enabled (Uv1/ov/—/GF)
1110 : Enabled (Uv1/ov/oH1/–)
1111 : Enabled (Uv1/ov/oH1/GF)
L6-01 Torque Detection Selection 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04A1) Sets torque detection conditions that will trigger an overtorque or undertorque response from the (0 - 8)
drive.
0 : Disabled
1 : oL @ Speed Agree - Alarm only
2 : oL @ RUN - Alarm only
3 : oL @ Speed Agree - Fault
4 : oL @ RUN - Fault
5 : UL @ Speed Agree - Alarm only
6 : UL @ RUN - Alarm only
7 : UL @ Speed Agree - Fault
8 : UL @ RUN - Fault
L6-02 Torque Detection Level 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 150%
(04A2) Sets the detection level for Overtorque/Undertorque Detection 1. In V/f control, drive rated output (0 - 300%)
current = 100% value. In vector control, motor rated torque = 100% value.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L6-03 Torque Detection Time 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(04A3) Sets the detection time for Overtorque/Undertorque Detection 1. (0.0 - 10.0 s)
L6-04 Torque Detection Selection 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04A4) Sets the speed range that detects overtorque and undertorque and the operation of drives (operation (0 - 8)
status) after detection.
0 : Disabled
1 : oL @ Speed Agree - Alarm only
2 : oL @ RUN - Alarm only
3 : oL @ Speed Agree - Fault
4 : oL @ RUN - Fault
5 : UL @ Speed Agree - Alarm only
6 : UL @ RUN - Alarm only
7 : UL @ Speed Agree - Fault
8 : UL @ RUN - Fault
L6-05 Torque Detection Level 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 150%
(04A5) Sets the detection level for Overtorque/Undertorque Detection 2. In V/f control, drive rated output (0 - 300%)
current = 100% value. In vector control, motor rated torque = 100% value.
L6-06 Torque Detection Time 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(04A6) Sets the detection time for Overtorque/Undertorque Detection 2. (0.0 - 10.0 s)
L6-07 Torque Detection Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 ms
(04E5) Sets the time constant for a primary filter to the torque reference or to the output current used to (0 - 1000 ms)
detect overtorque/undertorque.
L6-08 Mechanical Fatigue Detect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0468) Select Sets the speed where the drive detects mechanical deterioration and how the drive operates (operation (0 - 8)
status) after detection.
0 : Disabled
1 : oL5 @ Speed > L6-09 - Alarm
2 : oL5 @ |Speed| > L6-09 - Alarm
3 : oL5 @ Speed > L6-09 - Fault
4 : oL5 @ |Speed| > L6-09 - Fault
5 : UL5 @ Speed < L6-09 - Alarm
6 : UL5 @ |Speed| < L6-09 - Alarm
7 : UL5 @ Speed < L6-09 - Fault
8 : UL5 @ |Speed| < L6-09 - Fault
L6-09 Mech Fatigue Detect Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 110.0%
(0469) Level Sets the speed level where the drive will operate the mechanical deterioration detection function, as a (-110.0 - 110.0%)
percentage of the Maximum Output Frequency.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the maximum output
frequency.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-02 [Maximum Speed]
L6-10 Mech Fatigue Detect Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.1 s
(046A) Time Sets the time for mechanical deterioration detection. (0.0 - 10.0 s)
L6-11 Mech Fatigue Hold Off Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0h
(046B) Sets the time that the drive will start mechanical deterioration detection triggered by the cumulative (0 - 65535 h)
operation time of the drive.
Parameter List
◆ L7: Torque Limit
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L7-01 Forward Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200%
3
(04A7) Sets the torque limit value for forward motoring as a percentage, where motor rated torque is the (0 - 300%)
RUN 100% value.
L7-02 Reverse Torque Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200%
(04A8) Sets the torque limit value for reversed motoring as a percentage, where motor rated torque is the (0 - 300%)
RUN 100% value.
L7-03 Forward Regenerative Trq V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200%
(04A9) Limit Sets the torque limit value for forward regenerative conditions as a percentage of the motor rated (0 - 300%)
RUN torque.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L7-04 Reverse Regenerative Trq V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200%
(04AA) Limit Sets the torque limit value for reversed regenerative conditions as a percentage of the motor rated (0 - 300%)
RUN torque.
L7-06 Torque Limit Integral Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 ms
(04AC) Sets the integral time constant for the torque limit function. (5 - 10000 ms)
L7-07 Torque Limit during Accel/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04C9) Decel Sets the torque limit function during acceleration and deceleration. (0, 1)
0 : Proportional only
1 : Proportional & Integral control
L7-16 Torque Limit Process at Start V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(044D) Assigns a time filter to allow the torque limit to build at start. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L7-35 Low Freq Regen Torque V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50.0%
(1B57) Limit Lvl Sets the torque limit used during low-speed regeneration. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0.0 - 200.0%)
Expert setting.
L7-36 Regen Torque Limit Derate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 6.0 Hz
(1B58) Freq Sets the frequency width at which L7-35 [Low Freq Regen Torque Limit Lvl] operates. (0.0 - 30.0 Hz)
Expert
L8-01 3% ERF DB Resistor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04AD) Protection Sets the function to enable braking resistor protection with a Yaskawa ERF series braking resistor (0, 1)
(3% ED) installed on the heatsink.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L8-02 Overheat Alarm Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(04AE) Sets the oH detection level in temperature. (50 - 150 °C)
L8-03 Overheat Pre-Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(04AF) Selection Sets the operation of drives when an oH alarm is detected. (0 - 4)
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
4 : Operate at Reduced Speed (L8-19)
L8-05 Input Phase Loss Protection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(04B1) Sel Sets the function to enable and disable input phase loss detection. (0 - 4)
Note:
The default setting and setting range is different for different models.
• 200 V Class and 400 V Class
Default: 1
Setting range: 0, 1
• 6-Phase/12-Pulse 400 V Class
Default: 4
Setting range: 0 - 4
The software version for 6-Phase/12-Pulse drive is PRG: 09015 and later. The “PRG” column
on the nameplate on the right side of the drive identifies the software version. You can also use
U1-25 [SoftwareNumber Flashr] to identify the software version.
0 : Disable
1 : Enabled
4 : Enabled, with Hardware Detection
L8-07 Output Phase Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(04B3) Protection Sel Sets the function to enable and disable output phase loss detection. The drive starts output phase loss (0 - 2)
detection when the output current decreases to less than 5% of the drive rated current.
Note:
The drive can incorrectly start output phase loss detection in these conditions:
• The motor rated current is very small compared to the drive rating.
• The drive is operating a PM motor with a small load.
0 : Disabled
1 : Fault when one phase is lost
2 : Fault when two phases are lost
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L8-09 Output Ground Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(04B5) Detection Sets the function to enable and disable ground fault protection. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L8-10 Heatsink Fan Operation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04B6) Selection Sets operation of the heatsink cooling fan. (0 - 2)
0 : During Run, w/ L8-11 Off-Delay
1 : Always On
2 : Temperature-Dependent Fan Ctrl.
L8-11 Heatsink Fan Off-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 60 s
(04B7) Time Sets the length of time that the drive will wait before it stops the cooling fan after it cancels the Run (0 - 300 s)
command when L8-10 = 0 [Heatsink Fan Operation Selection = During Run, w/ L8-11 Off-Delay].
L8-12 Ambient Temperature V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 40 °C
(04B8) Setting Sets the ambient temperature of the drive installation area. (-10 °C - +50 °C)
L8-15 Drive oL2 @ Low Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(04BB) Protection Sets the function to decrease the drive overload level at which the drive will trigger oL2 [Drive (0, 1)
Overload] during low speed operation (6 Hz or slower) to prevent damage to the main circuit
transistors.
Note:
Contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative before disabling this function at low
speeds. If you frequently operate drives with high output current in low speed ranges, it can cause
heat stress and decrease the life span of drive IGBTs.
0 : Disabled (No Additional Derate)
1 : Enabled (Reduced oL2 Level)
L8-18 Software Current Limit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04BE) Selection Set the software current limit selection function to prevent damage to the main circuit transistor (0, 1)
caused by too much current.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L8-19 Freq Reduction @ oH Pre- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.8
(04BF) Alarm Sets the ratio at which the drive derates the frequency reference during an oH alarm. (0.1 - 0.9)
L8-20 Control Fault & Step Out V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(04C0) Detect Sets operation after the drive detects a CF fault when A1-02 = 4 [Control Method Selection = (0 - 2)
Expert Advanced Open Loop Vector].
0 : Disabled
1 : CF/STPo Detection Enabled
2 : CF ALM/Stop
L8-27 Overcurrent Detection Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 300.0%
(04DD) Sets the PM motor overcurrent detection level as a percentage of the motor rated current value. (0.0 - 1000.0%)
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the motor rated current.
• A1-02 ≠ 8 [EZOLV]: E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
• A1-02 = 8: E9-06 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
L8-29 Output Unbalance Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(04DF) Sel Sets the function to detect LF2 [Output Current Imbalance]. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
Parameter List
L8-31 LF2 Detection Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(04E1) Sets the LF2 [Output Current Imbalance] detection time. (1 – 100)
L8-35 Installation Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by the drive
(04EC) Selection Sets the type of drive installation. (0 - 3)
0 : IP20/UL Open Type/Ex Heatsink
1 : Side-by-Side Mounting 3
2 : IP20/UL Type 1
3 : Finless
L8-38 Carrier Frequency Reduction V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02, C6-
(04EF) Sets the carrier frequency reduction function. The drive reduces the carrier frequency when the 01 and o2-04
output current is more than a specified level. (0 - 2)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled below 6 Hz
2 : Enabled for All Speeds
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
L8-40 Carrier Freq Reduction Off- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(04F1) Delay Sets the length of time until the automatically reduced carrier frequency returns to the condition (0.00 - 2.00 s)
before the reduction.
L8-41 High Current Alarm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(04F2) Selection Sets the function to cause an HCA [Current Alarm] when the output current is more than 150% of the (0, 1)
drive rated current.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L8-51 STPo I Detection Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0%
(0471) Sets the STPo [Motor Step-Out Detected] detection level as a percentage of the motor rated current. (0.0 - 300.0%)
Expert Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the motor rated current.
• A1-02 = 5 [OLV/PM]: E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
• A1-02 = 8 [EZOLV]: E9-06 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
L8-52 STPo Integration Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(0472) Sets the detection level for STPo [Motor Step-Out Detected] related to the ACR integral value. (0.1 - 2.0)
Expert
L8-53 STPo Integration Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 s
(0473) Sets the length of time until the drive detects STPo after it is more than the value of L8-51 [STPo I (1.0 - 10.0 s)
Expert Detection Level].
L8-54 STPo Id Diff Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0474) Sets the Id deviation detection function for STPo [Motor Step-Out Detected]. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
L8-55 Internal DB V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(045F) TransistorProtection Sets the protection function for the internal braking transistor. (0, 1)
0 : Disable
1 : Protection Enabled
L8-56 Stall P @ Accel Activation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5000 ms
(047D) Time Sets the length time that the acceleration stall prevention function can continue to operate before the (100 - 5000 ms)
Expert drive detects an STPo [Motor Step-Out Detected].
L8-57 Stall Prevention Retry V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10
(047E) Counts Sets the number of times the acceleration stall prevention function can operate until speeds agree (1 - 10 times)
Expert before the drive detects an STPo [Motor Step-Out Detected].
L8-90 STPo Detection Level (Low V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0175) Speed) Sets the detection level that the control fault must be equal to or more than to cause an STPo [Motor (0 - 5000 times)
Expert Step-Out Detected].
L8-93 Low Speed Pull-out V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 s
(073C) DetectionTime Sets the length of time the drive will wait to start baseblock after detecting LSo [Low Speed Motor (0.0 - 10.0 s)
Expert Step-Out].
L8-94 Low Speed Pull-out Detect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3%
(073D) Level Sets the detection level for LSo [Low Speed Motor Step-Out] as a percentage of E1-04 [Maximum (0 - 10%)
Expert Output Frequency].
L8-95 Low Speed Pull-out Amount V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10
(077F) Sets the average count of LSo [Low Speed Motor Step-Out] detections. (1 - 50 times)
Expert
L9-16 FAn1 Detect Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4.0 s
(11DC) Sets the detection time for FAn1 [Drive Cooling Fan Fault]. Yaskawa recommends that you do not (0.0 - 30.0 s)
Expert change this parameter value.
n1-01 Hunting Prevention V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(0580) Selection Sets the function to prevent hunting. (0 to 2)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled (Normal)
2 : Enabled (High Carrier Frequency)
n1-02 Hunting Prevention Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(0581) Setting Sets the performance of the hunting prevention function. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0.00 - 2.50)
Expert parameter.
n1-03 Hunting Prevention Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(0582) Constant Sets the primary delay time constant of the hunting prevention function. Usually it is not necessary to (0 - 500 ms)
Expert change this parameter.
n1-05 Hunting Prevent Gain in V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.00
(0530) Reverse Sets the performance of the hunting prevention function. This parameter adjusts Reverse run. Usually (0.00 - 2.50)
Expert it is not necessary to change this parameter.
n1-08 Current Detection Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1105) Sets how the drive decreases the motor vibration that is caused by leakage current. Usually it is not (0, 1)
Expert necessary to change this parameter.
0 : 2-Phases
1 : 3-Phases
n1-13 DC Bus Stabilization V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B59) Control Sets the oscillation suppression function for the DC bus voltage. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
n1-14 DC Bus Stabilization Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0 ms
(1B5A) Adjusts the responsiveness of the oscillation suppression function for the DC bus voltage. Set n1-13 (50.0 - 500.0 ms)
Expert = 1 [DC Bus Stabilization Control = Enabled] to enable this parameter.
n1-15 PWM Voltage Offset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0BF8) Calibration Sets the calibration method that the drive uses to decrease torque/current ripple. (0 - 2)
Expert 0 : No Calibration
1 : One Time Calibrate at Next Start
2 : Calibrate Every Time at Start
n1-16 Hunting Prevention High Fc V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(0BFB) Gain Sets the gain for the hunting prevention function. This parameter functions best with a high carrier (0.00 - 2.50)
Expert frequency. Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter.
n1-17 Hunting Prevent High Fc V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 500 ms
(0BFC) Filter Sets the responsiveness of the hunting prevention function. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0 - 1000 ms)
Expert parameter.
n1-20 Voltage Calibration Duration V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50 ms
Parameter List
(1588) Sets the calibration time at start. Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter. (10 - 500 ms)
Expert
n2-02 Automatic Freq Regulator V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50 ms
(0585) Time 1 Sets the time constant that sets the rate of change for the AFR function. Usually it is not necessary to (0 - 2000 ms)
change this setting.
n2-03 Automatic Freq Regulator V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 750 ms
(0586) Time 2 Sets the time constant that sets the speed difference of the AFR function. Use this parameter for (0 - 2000 ms)
speed searches or regeneration. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n3-01 HSB Deceleration V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5%
(0588) Frequency Width Sets the amount by which the output frequency is to be lowered during high-slip braking, as a (1 - 20%)
Expert percentage of E1-04 [Maximum Output Frequency], which represents the 100% value.
n3-02 HSB Current Limit Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-01 and
(0589) Sets the maximum current output during high-slip braking as a percentage, where E2-01 [Motor L8-38
Expert Rated Current (FLA)] is 100%. Also set the current suppression to prevent exceeding drive overload (0 - 150%)
tolerance.
Note:
The upper limit to the setting range changes when the setting for C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty
Selection] changes.
• 150% when C6-01 = 0 [Heavy Duty Rating]
• 110% when C6-01 = 1 [Normal Duty Rating]
n3-03 HSB Dwell Time at Stop V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0 s
(058A) Sets the dwell time, a length of time when high-slip braking is ending and during which the motor (0.0 - 10.0 s)
Expert speed decreases and runs at a stable speed. For a set length of time, the drive will hold the actual
output frequency at the minimum output frequency set in E1-09.
n3-04 HSB Overload Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 40 s
(058B) Sets the time used to detect oL7 [High Slip Braking Overload], which occurs when the output (30 - 1200 s)
Expert frequency does not change during high-slip braking. Usually it is not necessary to change this
parameter.
n3-13 OverexcitationBraking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.10
(0531) (OEB) Gain Sets the gain value that the drive multiplies by the V/f pattern output value during overexcitation (1.00 - 1.40)
deceleration to calculate the overexcitation level.
n3-14 OEB High Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0532) Injection Sets the function that injects harmonic signals during overexcitation deceleration. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
n3-21 HSB Current Suppression V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100%
(0579) Level Sets the upper limit of the current that is suppressed at the time of overexcitation deceleration as a (0 - 150%)
percentage of the drive rated current.
n3-23 Overexcitation Braking V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(057B) Operation Sets the direction of motor rotation where the drive will enable overexcitation. (0 - 2)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled Only when Rotating FWD
2 : Enabled Only when Rotating REV
n4-60 Motoring Low Speed Comp V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(1B80) Gain Sets a compensation gain to improve the control qualities for motoring loads in the low speed range. (50.0 - 200.0%)
n4-61 Low Speed Comp Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 6.00 Hz
(1B81) Level Sets a frequency at which the settings n4-60 [Motoring Low Speed Comp Gain] and n4-62 [Regen (0.50 - 12.00 Hz)
Low Speed Comp Gain] are enabled. When the output frequency < n4-61, the drive adjusts the torque
to agree with the settings for n4-60 and n4-62. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n4-62 Regen Low Speed Comp V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0 %
(1B82) Gain Sets a compensation gain to improve the control qualities for regenerative loads in the low speed (50.0 - 500.0%)
range.
n4-63 Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 60.0
(1B83) EstimateResponse@High Sets the responsiveness of the speed estimation in high speed ranges, where the output frequency is ≥ (0.1 - 300.0)
Freq n4-67 [Estimate Gain Switchover Freq].
n4-64 Speed Estimate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 60.0
(1B84) Response@Low Freq Sets the responsiveness of the speed estimation in low speed ranges, where 0 ≤ the output frequency, (0.1 - 300.0)
which is < n4-67 [Estimate Gain Switchover Freq].
n4-65 Flux Estimate V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(1B85) Response@High Freq Sets the responsiveness of the magnetic flux estimation in high speed ranges, where the output (0.50 - 3.00)
frequency is ≥ n4-67 [Estimate Gain Switchover Freq]. Usually it is not necessary to change this
setting.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
n4-66 Flux Estimate Response V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.50
(1B86) @Low Freq Sets the responsiveness of the magnetic flux estimation in low speed ranges, where 0 ≤ the output (0.50 - 3.00)
frequency, which is < n4-67 [Estimate Gain Switchover Freq]. Usually it is not necessary to change
this setting.
n4-67 Estimate Gain Switchover V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 6.00 Hz
(1B87) Freq Sets the switching frequency for estimation gain for these parameters: (0.00 - E1-04 setting)
n4-63 [Speed EstimateResponse@High Freq]
n4-64 [Speed Estimate Response@Low Freq]
n4-65 [Flux Estimate Response@High Freq]
n4-66 [Flux Estimate Response @Low Freq]
Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n4-68 Speed Estimation Filter V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.001 s
(1B88) Time Sets the primary delay time constant for the speed estimation value. Usually it is not necessary to (0.001 - 0.010 s)
change this setting.
n4-69 Flux Control Response V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(1B89) Unifies control of magnetic flux to make motor vibrations more stable. (0.00 - 60.00)
n4-70 Speed Command Comp @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00 Hz
(1B8A) Low Freq Sets the function to make the drive more stable when operating at low speeds. Usually it is not (0.00 - 6.00 Hz)
necessary to change this setting.
n4-71 Flux Estimation Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B8B) Sets the flux estimation method. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Method 1
1 : Method 2
n4-72 Speed Feedback Mode V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B8C) Sets the requirement for an encoder option when A1-02 = 4 [Control Method Selection = Advanced (0, 1)
Open Loop Vector].
0 : Without Encoder
1 : With Encoder
n4-73 PGo Recovery Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1B8D) Sets the restart mode to Without Encoder Mode or the With Encoder Mode when an encoder is (0, 1)
disconnected.
0 : Without Encoder
1 : With Encoder
n4-74 Limit of Flux Loop V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 250%
(1B8E) Sets the control level for flux loop control output. (100 - 500%)
n5-01 Feed Forward Control V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(05B0) Selection Sets the feed forward function. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
n5-02 Motor Inertia Acceleration V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by C6-01, E5-
(05B1) Time Sets the length of time for the motor to accelerate from the stopped to the maximum frequency with a 01, and o2-04
Parameter List
single motor at the rated torque. Inertia Tuning automatically sets the motor acceleration time. (0.001 - 10.000 s)
n5-03 Feed Forward Control Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(05B2) Sets the ratio between load inertia and motor inertia. Inertia Tuning automatically sets the (0.00 - 100.00)
Feedforward Control Gain value.
n5-04 Speed Response Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(05B3) Sets the response frequency for the speed reference. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0.00 - 500.00 Hz)
RUN parameter. 3
Expert
n6-01 Online Tuning Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0570) Sets the type of motor data that Online Tuning uses for OLV control. (0 - 2)
0 : Disabled
1 : Line-to-Line Resistance Tuning
2 : Voltage Correction Tuning
n6-05 Online Tuning Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(05C7) Sets the compensation gain when n6-01 = 2 [Online Tuning Selection = Voltage Correction Tuning]. (0.1 - 50.0)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter.
n6-11 Online Resistance Tuning V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.000
(1B56) Sets the responsiveness for online resistor tuning. Set this parameter to approximately 1.000 to enable (0.000 - 1.000)
Expert the function. The function is disabled when the value is 0.000.
◆ n7: EZ Drive
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
n7-01 Damping Gain for Low V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.0
(3111) Frequency Sets the oscillation suppression gain for the low speed range. (0.1 - 10.0)
Expert
n7-05 Response Gain for Load V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100
(3115) Changes Sets the response gain related to changes in the load. (10 - 1000)
Expert
n7-07 Speed Calculation Gain1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 15.0
(3117) Sets the speed calculation gain during usual operation. Usually it is not necessary to change this (1.0 - 50.0)
Expert setting.
n7-08 Speed Calculation Gain2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 25.0
(3118) Sets the speed calculation gain during a speed search. (1.0 - 50.0)
Expert
n7-10 Pull-in Current Switching V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0%
(311A) Speed Sets the speed range to operate with the pull-in current command. Drive rated frequency = 100% (0.0 - 100.0%)
Expert value. If there is a large quantity of oscillation when you operate in the low speed range, increase the
setting value.
n7-11 Drv Mode Switch Hysteresis V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5.0%
(311B) Band Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. Sets the hysteresis level for Switching Speed set in (1.0 - 20.0%)
Expert n7-10 [Pull-in Current Switching Speed].
When the speed is lower than n7-10 + n7-11 during acceleration, the drive enables pull-in current.
Note:
• When the drive accelerates, it enables these settings:
–Motor speed ≤ n7-10 + n7-11: n8-51 [Pull-in Current @ Acceleration]
–Motor speed > n7-10 + n7-11: b8-01 [Energy Saving Control Selection]
• If there is a large quantity of oscillation when you operate in the low speed range, increase the
setting value.
• When it is most important to save energy in the low speed range, decrease the setting value.
n7-13 Driving Method Switching V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100 ms
(311D) Time Sets a time to enable the pull-in current commands. (0 - 1000 ms)
Expert If there is a large quantity of oscillation at speeds around n7-10 [Pull-in Current Switching Speed],
decrease the setting in 20 ms decrements.
n7-17 Resistance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(3122) TemperatureCorrection Sets the function to adjust for changes in the motor resistance value caused by changes in the (0 to 2)
temperature.
0 : Invalid
1 : Valid (Only 1 time)
2 : Valid (Every time)
n8-01 Pole Position Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50%
(0540) Current Sets the Initial Rotor Position Estimated Current as a percentage where E5-03 [PM Motor Rated (0 - 100%)
Current (FLA)] = 100%. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-02 Pole Alignment Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 80%
(0541) Level Sets the current at the time of polar attraction as a percentage where E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (0 - 150%)
Expert (FLA)] = 100%. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-03 Pole Position Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.5 s
(0542) Time Sets the length of the Current Starting Time, which is used for Z Pulse Offset Tuning. Usually it is (1.5 - 5.0 s)
not necessary to change this setting.
n8-04 Pole Alignment Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.5 s
(0543) Sets the length of the Polar Attraction Time, which is used for Z Pulse Offset Tuning. Usually it is (1.5 - 5.0 s)
Expert not necessary to change this setting.
n8-11 Observer Calculation Gain 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by n8-72
(054A) Sets the gain for speed estimation. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.0 - 1000.0)
n8-14 Polarity Compensation Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.000
(054D) 3 Sets the gain for speed estimation. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.000 - 10.000)
Expert
n8-15 Polarity Compensation Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.500
(054E) 4 Sets the gain for speed estimation. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.000 - 10.000)
Expert
n8-21 Motor Back-EMF (Ke) Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.90
(0554) Sets the gain for speed estimation. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.80 - 1.00)
Expert
n8-23 ACR q Gain @PoleEst V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0556) Sets the proportional gain for current regulator q-axis control when the drive estimates the initial (0 - 2000)
Expert pole. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-24 ACR q Integral Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 ms
(0557) @PoleEst Sets the integral time for current regulator q-axis control when the drive estimates the initial pole. (0.0 - 100.0 ms)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-25 ACR q Limit @PoleEst V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(0558) Sets the q-axis limit of the current regulator when the drive estimates the initial pole. Usually it is not (0 - 150%)
Expert necessary to change this setting.
n8-26 ACR d Gain @PoleEst V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 500
(0559) Sets the proportional gain for current regulator d-axis control when the drive estimates the initial (0 - 2000)
Expert pole. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-27 ACR d Integral Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 ms
(055A) @PoleEst Sets the integral time for current regulator d-axis control when the drive estimates the initial pole. (0.0 - 100.0 ms)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-28 ACR d Lim @PoleEst V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100%
(055B) Sets the d-axis limit of the current regulator when the drive estimates the initial pole. Usually it is not (0 - 150%)
Expert necessary to change this setting.
Parameter List
n8-35 Initial Pole Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0562) Method Sets how the drive detects the position of the rotor at start. (0 - 2)
Note:
• When you operate an SPM motor, set n8-35 = 0. When you operate an IPM motor, you can set
n8-35 = 0 to 2.
• When you set n8-35 = 1, doHigh Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning.
0 : Pull-in 3
1 : High Frequency Injection
2 : Pulse Injection
n8-36 HFI Frequency Level for L V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 500 Hz
(0563) Tuning Sets the injection frequency for high frequency injection. (200 - 1000 Hz)
Note:
• Set n8-35 = 1 [Initial Pole Detection Method = High Frequency Injection] or n8-57 = 1 [HFI
Overlap Selection = Enabled] to enable this parameter.
• The drive automatically calculates this value when High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning
completes successfully.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
n8-37 HFI Voltage Amplitude V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 20.0%
(0564) Level Sets the high frequency injection amplitude as a percentage where 200 V = 100% for 200 V class (0.0 - 50.0%)
Expert drives and 400 V = 100% for a 400 V class drives. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
Note:
• Set n8-35 = 1 [Initial Pole Detection Method = High Frequency Injection] or n8-57 = 1 [HFI
Overlap Selection = Enabled] to enable this parameter.
• The drive automatically calculates this value when High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning
completes successfully.
n8-39 HFI LPF Cutoff Freq V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 250 Hz
(0566) Sets the low-pass filter shut-off frequency for high frequency injection. (0 - 1000 Hz)
Note:
• Set n8-35 = 1 [Initial Pole Detection Method = High Frequency Injection] or n8-57 = 1 [HFI
Overlap Selection = Enabled] to enable this parameter.
• The drive automatically calculates this value when High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning
completes successfully.
n8-41 HFI P Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2.5
(0568) Sets the response gain for the high frequency injection speed estimation. (-10.0 - +10.0)
Expert Note:
• Set n8-35 = 1 [Initial Pole Detection Method = High Frequency Injection] or n8-57 = 1 [HFI
Overlap Selection = Enabled] to enable this parameter.
• When A1-02= 6 [Control Method Selection = AOLV/PM] and you do High Frequency Injection
Auto-Tuning, the drive automatically sets this parameter .
n8-42 HFI I Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.10 s
(0569) Sets the integral time constant for the high frequency injection speed estimation. Usually it is not (0.00 - 9.99 s)
Expert necessary to change this setting.
n8-45 Speed Feedback Detection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.80
(0538) Gain Sets the internal speed feedback detection reduction unit gain as a magnification value. Usually it is (0.00 - 10.00)
not necessary to change this setting.
n8-46 PM Phase Compensation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.3
(0539) Gain Sets the gain to compensate for phase differences. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.0 - 10.0)
Expert
n8-47 Pull-in Current Comp Filter V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5.0 s
(053A) Time Sets the time constant the drive uses to align the pull-in current reference value with the actual (0.0 - 100.0 s)
current value. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-48 Pull-in/Light Load Id V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 30%
(053B) Current Sets the d-axis current that flows to the motor during run at constant speed as a percentage where E5- (0 - 200%)
03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)] = 100%.
n8-49 Heavy Load Id Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E5-01
(053C) Sets the d-axis current to that the drive will supply to the motor to run it at a constant speed with a (-200.0 - +200.0%)
heavy load. Considers E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)] to be 100%. Usually it is not
necessary to change this setting.
n8-50 Medium Load Iq Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 80%
(053D) (High) Sets the load current level to start high efficiency control as a percentage of E5-03 [PM Motor Rated (50 - 255%)
Current (FLA)]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-51 Pull-in Current @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(053E) Acceleration Sets the pull-in current allowed to flow during acceleration/deceleration as a percentage of the motor (0 - 200%)
rated current.
Note:
Parameter A1-02 [Control Method Selection] selects which parameter is the motor rated current.
• A1-02 = 5 [OLV/PM]: E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
• A1-02 = 8 [EZOLV]: E9-06 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)]
n8-52 ACR P Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0
(053F) Sets the proportional gain of the current regulator. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (-100.0 - 100.0)
Expert
n8-54 Voltage Error Compensation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00 s
(056D) Time Sets the time constant that the drive uses when adjusting for voltage errors. (0.00 - 10.00 s)
Expert
n8-55 Motor to Load Inertia Ratio V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(056E) Sets the ratio between motor inertia and machine inertia. (0 - 3)
0 : Below 1:10
1 : Between 1:10 and 1:30
2 : Between 1:30 and 1:50
3 : Beyond 1:50
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
n8-56 PM High Performance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(056F) Selection Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. Sets the high efficiency control method for IPM (0 - 2)
Expert motor.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled (Vd)
2 : Enabled (Vd & Vq)
n8-57 HFI Overlap Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0574) Sets the function that detects motor speed with high frequency injection. (0, 1)
Note:
When you set n8-57 = 1, do High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
n8-62 Output Voltage Limit Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 200.0 V,
(057D) Sets the output voltage limit to prevent saturation of the output voltage. Usually it is not necessary to 400 V Class: 400.0 V
Expert change this parameter. (200 V Class: 0.0 to 240.0 V,
Note: 400 V Class: 0.0 to 480.0 V)
• When A1-02 = 7, 8 [Control Method Selection = CLV/PM EZOLV], this parameter is available
in Expert mode.
• When A1-02 = 8 [Control Method Selection = EZOLV], the default settings are:
• 200 V Class: 230.0 V
• 400 V Class: 460.0 V
n8-63 Output Voltage Limit P Gain V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(057E) Sets the proportional gain for output voltage control. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0.00 - 100.00)
Expert setting.
n8-64 Output Voltage Limit I Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.040 s
(057F) Sets the integral time for output voltage control. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0.000 - 5.000)
Expert
n8-65 Speed Fdbk Gain @ oV V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.50
(065C) Suppression Sets the gain of internal speed feedback detection suppression while the overvoltage suppression (0.00 - 10.00)
Expert function is operating as a magnification value. Usually it is not necessary to change this parameter.
n8-66 Output Voltage Limit Filter V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.020 s
(0235) Time Sets the filter time constant for output voltage control. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0.000 - 5.000)
Expert setting.
n8-69 Speed Observer Control P V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1.00
(065D) Gain Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. Sets the Proportional gain that the drive uses for (0.00 - 20.00)
Expert speed estimation.
n8-70 Speed Observer Control I V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 s
(065E) Time Sets the speed estimator integral time constant. It is available when n8-72 = 1 [Speed Estimation (0.0 - 100.0 s)
Expert Method Select = Method 2]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-71 Speed Observer Control D V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5.00
(065F) Gain Set the speed estimator differential gain. It is available when n8-72 = 1 [Speed Estimation Method (0.00 - 50.00)
Expert Select = Method 2]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-72 Speed Estimation Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0655) Select Selects the speed estimation method. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting. (0, 1)
Expert 0 : Method 1
Parameter List
1 : Method 2
n8-73 Observer Mode Switch-Over V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10%
(0656) Speed Sets the speed level for pull-in current control at motor start as a percentage of E1-06 [Base (0 - 100%)
Expert Frequency]. Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
n8-74 Light Load Iq Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 30%
(05C3) Set n8-48 [Pull-in/Light Load Id Current] to the percentage of load current (q-axis current) that you
will apply, where E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)] = a setting value of 100%.
(0 - 255%)
3
n8-75 Medium Load Iq Level (low) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50%
(05C4) Set n8-78 [Medium Load Id Current] to the percentage of load current (q-axis current) that you will (0 - 255%)
apply, where E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)] = a setting value of 100%.
n8-76 Id Switching Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 ms
(05CD) Sets the filter time constant for d-axis current reference. Usually it is not necessary to change this (0 - 5000 ms)
Expert setting.
n8-77 Heavy Load Iq Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 90%
(05CE) Set n8-49 [Heavy Load Id Current] to the percentage of load current (q-axis current) that you will (0 - 255%)
apply, where E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)] = a setting value of 100%.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
n8-78 Medium Load Id Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(05F4) Sets the level of the pull-in current for mid-range loads. (-200 - +200%)
n8-79 Pull-in Current @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 50%
(05FE) Deceleration Sets the pull-in current that can flow during deceleration as a percentage of the E5-03 [PM Motor (0 - 200%)
Rated Current (FLA)].
Note:
When n8-79 = 0, the drive will use the value set in n8-51 [Pull-in Current @ Acceleration].
n8-84 Polarity Detection Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100%
(02D3) Sets the current that the drive uses to estimate the initial motor magnetic pole as a percentage where (0 - 150%)
Expert E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)] = 100%.
Note:
The drive automatically calculates this value when High Frequency Injection Auto-Tuning
completes successfully.
n8-94 Flux Position Estimation V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by d5-01
(012D) Method Sets the criteria that the drive uses to find changes in speed or load. Usually it is not necessary to (0, 1)
Expert change this setting.
0 : Softstarter
1 : Speed Feedback
n8-95 Flux Position Est Filter Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 30 ms
(012E) Sets the time constant of the filter used for the recognition criteria value for speed and load changes. (0 - 100 ms)
Expert Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
o1-01 User Monitor Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 106
(0500) Sets the U monitor for the Drive Mode. This parameter is only available with an LED keypad. (104 - 855)
RUN
o1-02 Monitor Selection at Power- V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0501) up Sets the monitor item that the keypad screen shows after you energize the drive. Refer to “U: (1 - 5)
RUN Monitors” for information about the monitor items that the keypad screen can show. This parameter is
only available with an LED keypad.
1 : Frequency Reference (U1-01)
2 : Direction
3 : Output Frequency (U1-02)
4 : Output Current (U1-03)
5 : User Monitor (o1-01)
o1-03 Frequency Display Unit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0502) Selection Sets the display units for the frequency reference and output frequency. (0 - 3)
0 : 0.01 Hz
1 : 0.01% (100% = E1-04)
2 : min-1 (r/min) units
3 : User Units (o1-10 & o1-11)
o1-04 V/f Pattern Display Unit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0503) Sets the setting unit for parameters that set the V/f pattern frequency. (0, 1)
0 : Hz
1 : min-1 (r/min) units
o1-05 LCD Contrast Adjustment V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5
(0504) Sets the contrast of the LCD display on the keypad. (0 - 10)
RUN
o1-10 User Units Maximum Value V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o1-03
(0520) Sets the value that the drive shows as the maximum output frequency. (1 - 60000)
o1-11 User Units Decimal Position V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o1-03
(0521) Sets the number of decimal places for frequency reference and monitor values. (0 - 3)
0 : No Decimal Places (XXXXX)
1 : One Decimal Places (XXXX.X)
2 : Two Decimal Places (XXX.XX)
3 : Three Decimal Places (XX.XXX)
o1-24 Custom Monitor 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 101
(11AD) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the first line. The registered monitor is also used
for different monitor displays of bar graph, analog meter, and waveform.
o1-25 Custom Monitor 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 102
(11AE) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the second line. The registered monitor is also
used for different monitor displays of bar graph and waveform.
Parameter List
o1-26 Custom Monitor 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 103
(11AF) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the third line. The registered monitor is also used
for the monitor display of the bar graph.
o1-27 Custom Monitor 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B0)
RUN
You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1-
35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the fourth line.
(0, 101 - 999)
3
o1-28 Custom Monitor 5 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B1) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the fifth line.
o1-29 Custom Monitor 6 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B2) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the sixth line.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
o1-30 Custom Monitor 7 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B3) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the seventh line.
o1-31 Custom Monitor 8 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B4) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the eighth line.
o1-32 Custom Monitor 9 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B5) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the ninth line.
o1-33 Custom Monitor 10 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B6) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the 10th line.
o1-34 Custom Monitor 11 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B7) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the 11th line.
o1-35 Custom Monitor 12 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11B8) You can select a maximum of 12 monitors as user monitors and set them to parameters o1-24 to o1- (0, 101 - 999)
RUN 35. This parameter sets the user monitor to show on the 12th line.
o1-36 LCD Backlight Brightness V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5
(11B9) Sets the intensity of the LCD keypad backlight. (1 - 5)
RUN
o1-37 LCD Backlight ON/OFF V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(11BA) Selection Sets the automatic shut off function for the LCD backlight. (0, 1)
RUN 0 : OFF
1 : ON
o1-38 LCD Backlight Off-Delay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 60 s
(11BB) Sets the time until the LCD backlight automatically turns off. (10 - 300 s)
RUN
o1-39 Show Initial Setup Screen V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(11BC) Sets the function to show the LCD keypad initial setup screen each time you energize the drive. This (0, 1)
RUN parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
0 : No
1 : Yes
o1-40 Home Screen Display V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11BD) Selection Sets the monitor display mode for the Home screen. This parameter is only available with an LCD (0 - 3)
RUN keypad.
0 : Custom Monitor
1 : Bar Graph
2 : Analog Gauge
3 : Trend Plot
o1-41 1st Monitor Area Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11C1) Sets the horizontal axis value used to display the monitor set in o1-24 [Custom Monitor 1] as a bar (0 - 1)
RUN graph. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
0 : +/- Area ( - o1-42 ~ o1-42 )
1 : + Area ( 0 ~ o1-42 )
o1-42 1st Monitor Area Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(11C2) Sets the horizontal axis value used to display the monitor set in o1-24 [Custom Monitor 1] as a bar (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN graph. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-43 2nd Monitor Area Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11C3) Selects the horizontal range used to display the monitor set in o1-25 [Custom Monitor 2] as a bar (0 - 1)
RUN graph. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
0 : +/- Area ( - o1-44 ~ o1-44 )
1 : + Area ( 0 ~ o1-44 )
o1-44 2nd Monitor Area Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(11C4) Sets the horizontal axis value used to display the monitor set in o1-25 [Custom Monitor 2] as a bar (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN graph. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
o1-45 3rd Monitor Area Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11C5) Sets the horizontal axis value used to display the monitor set in o1-26 [Custom Monitor 3] as a bar (0 - 1)
RUN graph. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
0 : +/- Area ( - o1-46 ~ o1-46 )
1 : + Area ( 0 ~ o1-46 )
o1-46 3rd Monitor Area Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(11C6) Sets the horizontal axis value used to display the monitor set in o1-26 [Custom Monitor 3] as a bar (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN graph. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-47 Trend Plot 1 Scale Minimum V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -100.0%
(11C7) Value Sets the horizontal axis minimum value used to display the monitor set in o1-24 [Custom Monitor 1] (-300.0 - +300.0%)
RUN as a trend plot. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-48 Trend Plot 1 Scale V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(11C8) Maximum Value Sets the maximum value for the vertical axis used to display the monitor that was set in o1-24 (-300.0 - +300.0%)
RUN [Custom Monitor 1] as a trend plot. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-49 Trend Plot 2 Scale Minimum V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -100.0%
(11C9) Value Sets the horizontal axis minimum value used to display the monitor set in o1-25 [Custom Monitor 2] (-300.0 - +300.0%)
RUN as a trend plot. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-50 Trend Plot 2 Scale V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(11CA) Maximum Value Sets the maximum value for the vertical axis used to display the monitor that was set in o1-25 (-300.0 - +300.0%)
RUN [Custom Monitor 2] as a trend plot. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-51 Trend Plot Time Scale V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 300 s
(11CB) Setting Sets the time scale (horizontal axis) to display the trend plot. When you change this setting, the drive (1 - 3600 s)
RUN automatically adjusts the data sampling time. This parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-55 Analog Gauge Area V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(11EE) Selection Sets the range used to display the monitor set in o1-24 [Custom Monitor 1] as an analog gauge. This ( 0, 1 )
RUN parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
0 : +/- Area ( - o1-56 ~ o1-56 )
1 : + Area ( 0 ~ o1-56 )
o1-56 Analog Gauge Area Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100.0%
(11EF) Sets the value used to display the monitor set in o1-24 [Custom Monitor 1] as an analog meter. This (0.0 - 100.0%)
RUN parameter is only available with an LCD keypad.
o1-58 Motor Power Unit Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(3125) Sets the setting unit for parameters that set the motor rated power. (0, 1)
0 : kW
1 : HP
o2-01 LO/RE Key Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0505) Selection (0, 1)
Sets the function that lets you use to switch between LOCAL and REMOTE Modes.
0 : Disabled
Parameter List
1 : Enabled
o2-02 STOP Key Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0506) Selection (0, 1)
Sets the function to use on the keypad to stop the drive when the Run command source for
the drive is REMOTE (external) and not assigned to the keypad.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled 3
o2-03 User Parameter Default V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0507) Value Sets the function to keep the settings of changed parameters as user parameter defaults to use during (0 - 2)
initialization.
0 : No change
1 : Set defaults
2 : Clear all
o2-04 Drive Model (KVA) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by the drive
(0508) Selection Sets the Drive Model code. Set this parameter after replacing the control board. (-)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
o2-05 Home Mode Freq Ref Entry V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0509) Mode (0, 1)
Sets the function that makes it necessary to push to use the keypad to change the frequency
reference value while in Drive Mode.
0 : ENTER Key Required
1 : Immediate / MOP-style
o2-06 Keypad Disconnect V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(050A) Detection Sets the function that stops the drive if you disconnect the keypad connection cable from the drive or (0, 1)
if you damage the cable while the keypad is the Run command source.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
o2-07 Keypad RUN Direction @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0527) Power-up Sets the direction of motor rotation when the drive is energized and the keypad is the Run command (0, 1)
source.
0 : Forward
1 : Reverse
o2-09 Reserved - -
(050D)
o2-23 External 24V Powerloss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(11F8) Detection Sets the function to give a warning if the backup external 24 V power supply turns off when the main (0, 1)
RUN circuit power supply is in operation.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
o2-24 LED Light Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(11FE) Selection Sets the function to show the LED status rings and keypad LED lamps. (0 - 2)
Note:
When you initialize the drive with parameter A1-03 [Initialize Parameters], the drive will not
reset this parameter.
0 : Enable Status Ring & Keypad LED
1 : LED Status Ring Disable
2 : Keypad LED Light Disable
o2-26 Alarm Display at Ext. 24V V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(1563) Power When you connect a backup external 24 V power supply, this parameter sets the function to trigger (0, 1)
an alarm when the main circuit power supply voltage decreases.
Note:
The drive will not run when it is operating from one 24-V external power supply.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
o2-27 bCE Detection Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3
(1565) Sets drive operation if the Bluetooth device is disconnected when you operate the drive in Bluetooth (0 - 4)
Mode.
0 : Ramp to Stop
1 : Coast to Stop
2 : Fast Stop (Use C1-09)
3 : Alarm Only
4 : No Alarm Display
o3-01 Copy Keypad Function V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0515) Selection Sets the function that saves and copies drive parameters to a different drive with the keypad. (0 - 4)
0 : Copy Select
1 : Backup (drive → keypad)
2 : Restore (keypad → drive)
3 : Verify (check for mismatch)
4 : Erase (backup data of keypad)
o3-02 Copy Allowed Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0516) Sets the copy function when o3-01 = 1 [Copy Keypad Function Selection = Backup (drive → (0, 1)
keypad)].
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
o3-04 Select Backup/Restore V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0B3E) Location Sets the storage location for drive parameters when you back up and restore parameters. This (0 - 3)
parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad.
0 : Memory Location 1
1 : Memory Location 2
2 : Memory Location 3
3 : Memory Location 4
o3-05 Select Items to Backup/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0BDA) Restore Sets which parameters are backed up, restored, and referenced. This parameter is only available when (0, 1)
using an LCD keypad.
0 : Standard Parameters
1 : Standard + DWEZ Parameters
o3-06 Auto Parameter Backup V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0BDE) Selection Sets the function that automatically backs up parameters. This parameter is only available when (0, 1)
using an LCD keypad.
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
o3-07 Auto Parameter Backup V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0BDF) Interval Sets the interval at which the automatic parameter backup function saves parameters from the drive (0 - 3)
to the keypad.
Note:
This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad.
0 : Every 10 minutes
1 : Every 30 minutes
2 : Every 60 minutes
3 : Every 12 hours
o4-01 Elapsed Operating Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0h
(050B) Setting Sets the initial value of the cumulative drive operation time in 10-hour units. (0 - 9999 h)
o4-02 Elapsed Operating Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(050C) Selection Sets the condition that counts the cumulative operation time. (0, 1)
0 : U4-01 Shows Total Power-up Time
1 : U4-01 Shows Total RUN Time
o4-03 Fan Operation Time Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0h
(050E) Sets the value from which to start the cumulative drive cooling fan operation time in 10-hour units. (0 - 9999 h)
o4-05 Capacitor Maintenance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(051D) Setting Sets the U4-05 [CapacitorMaintenance] monitor value. (0 - 150%)
o4-07 Softcharge Relay V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(0523) Maintenance Set Sets the U4-06 [PreChargeRelayMainte] monitor value. (0 - 150%)
o4-09 IGBT Maintenance Setting V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0%
(0525) Sets the U4-07 [IGBT Maintenance] monitor value. (0 - 150%)
Parameter List
o4-11 Fault Trace/History Init (U2/ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0510) U3) Resets the records of Monitors U2-xx [Fault Trace] and U3-xx [Fault History]. (0, 1)
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
o4-12 kWh Monitor Initialization V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0512) Resets the monitor values for U4-10 [kWh, Lower 4 Digits] and U4-11 [kWh, Upper 5 Digits]. (0, 1) 3
0 : No Reset
1 : Reset
o4-13 RUN Command Counter @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0528) Initialize Resets the monitor values for U4-02 [Num of Run Commands], U4-24 [Number of Runs (Low)], and (0, 1)
U4-25 [Number of Runs (High)].
0 : No Reset
1 : Reset
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
o4-22 Time Format V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(154F) Sets the time display format. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (0 - 2)
RUN 0 : 24 Hour Clock
1 : 12 Hour Clock
2 : 12 Hour JP Clock
o4-23 Date Format V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 2
(1550) Sets the date display format. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (0 - 2)
RUN 0 : YYYY/MM/DD
1 : DD/MM/YYYY
2 : MM/DD/YYYY
o4-24 bAT Detection Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(310F) Sets operation when the drive detects bAT [Keypad Battery Low Voltage] and TiM [Keypad Time Not (0 - 2)
RUN Set].
0 : Disable
1 : Enable (Alarm Detected)
2 : Enable (Fault Detected)
o5-01 Log Start/Stop Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1551) Sets the data log function. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (0 - 1)
RUN 0 : OFF
1 : ON
o5-02 Log Sampling Interval V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 100 ms
(1552) Sets the data log sampling cycle. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (100 - 60000 ms)
RUN
o5-03 Log Monitor Data 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 101
(1553) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
o5-04 Log Monitor Data 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 102
(1554) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
o5-05 Log Monitor Data 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 103
(1555) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
o5-06 Log Monitor Data 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 107
(1556) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
o5-07 Log Monitor Data 5 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 108
(1557) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
o5-08 Log Monitor Data 6 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 105
(1558) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN Note:
When A1-02 = 0 or 5 [Control Method Selection = V/f, OLV/PM], the default setting is 0.
o5-09 Log Monitor Data 7 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 110
(1559) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
o5-10 Log Monitor Data 8 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 112
(155A) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
o5-11 Log Monitor Data 9 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 000
(155B) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
o5-12 Log Monitor Data 10 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 000
(155C) Sets the data log monitor. This parameter is only available when using an LCD keypad. (000, 101 - 999)
RUN
Parameter List
q1-01 to qx-xx Reserved for DriveWorksEZ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Refer to “DriveWorksEZ
(1600 - xxxx) These parameters are reserved for use with DriveWorksEZ. Operation Manual”.
r1-01 to r1-40: DriveWorksEZ Connection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1840 - 1867) Parameters 1 to 20 (Upper / DriveWorksEZ Connection Parameters 1 to 20 (Upper / Lower) (0 - FFFFH)
Lower)
Parameter List
T0-00 Tuning Mode Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1197) Sets the type of Auto-Tuning. (0, 1)
0 : Motor Parameter Tuning
1 : Control Tuning
T1-00 Motor 1/Motor 2 Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0700) Sets which motor to tune when motor 1/2 switching is enabled. (1, 2)
You can only use the keypad to set this parameter. You cannot use external input terminals to set it.
Note:
This parameter is enabled when H1-xx = 16 [Motor 2 Selection] is set. When H1-xx ≠ 16 the
keypad will not show this parameter.
1 : Motor 1 (sets E1-xx, E2-xx)
2 : Motor 2 (sets E3-xx, E4-xx)
T1-01 Auto-Tuning Mode Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by A1-02
(0701) Sets the type of Auto-Tuning. (Determined by A1-02)
0 : Rotational Auto-Tuning
1 : Stationary Auto-Tuning 1
2 : Stationary Line-Line Resistance
T1-02 Motor Rated Power V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0702) Uses the units set in o1-58 [Motor Power Unit Selection] to set the motor rated output power. (0.00 - 650.00 HP)
T1-03 Motor Rated Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0703) Sets the rated voltage (V) of the motor. Enter the base speed voltage for constant output motors. (200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.5 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 511.0 V)
T1-04 Motor Rated Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(0704) Sets the rated current (A) of the motor. (10% to 200% of the drive
rated current)
T1-05 Motor Base Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 60.0 Hz
(0705) Sets the base frequency (Hz) of the motor. (0.0 - 590.0 Hz)
T1-06 Number of Motor Poles V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(0706) Sets the number of motor poles. (2 to 120)
T1-07 Motor Base Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1750 min-1 (r/min)
(0707) Sets the motor base speed for Auto-Tuning (min-1 (r/min)). (0 - 35400 min-1 (r/min))
T1-08 Encoder Pulse Count (PPR) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1024 ppr
(0708) Sets the number of PG (pulse generator, encoder) pulses. (0 - 60,000 ppr)
T1-09 Motor No-Load Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(0709) Sets the no-load current of the motor. (0 A - T1-04; max. of
2999.9)
T1-10 Motor Rated Slip Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(070A) Sets motor rated slip. (0.000 - 20.000 Hz)
T1-11 Motor Iron Loss V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E2-11 or E4-
(070B) Sets the iron loss for calculating the energy-saving coefficient. 11
(0 - 65535 W)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
T1-12 Test Mode Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0BDB) Sets the function to enable Test Mode after Stationary Auto-Tuning. When you can operate the motor (0, 1)
with a light load attached after Stationary Auto-Tuning is complete, enable this parameter.
Note:
You must first set T1-10 = 0 [Motor Rated Slip Frequency = 0 Hz] to enable this parameter.
0 : No
1 : Yes
T1-13 No-Load Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV T1-03 × 0.85
(0BDC) Sets the no-load voltage of the motor. When the no-load voltage at rated speed is available, for (200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
example on the motor test report, set the voltage in this parameter. If the no-load voltage is not 400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
available, do not change this parameter.
Note:
• To get the same qualities as a Yaskawa 1000-series drive or previous series drive, set this
parameter = T1-03 [Motor Rated Voltage].
• The default setting is different for different models.
–2004 to 2006, 4002 to 4004: T1-03 × 0.85
–2010 to 2415, 4005 to 4250, T103 to T250: T1-03 × 0.90
–4296 to 4720, T296 to T720: T1-03 × 0.95
T2-01 PM Auto-Tuning Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0750) Sets the type of Auto-Tuning for PM motors. (Determined by A1-02)
0 : Manual Entry w/ Motor Data Sheet
1 : Stationary (Ld, Lq, R)
2 : Stationary (R Only)
3 : Z-Pulse Offset (Pole Position)
4 : Rotational (Ld, Lq, R, back-EMF)
5 : High Frequency Injection
T2-02 PM Motor Code Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV FFFF
(0751) Enter the PM motor code as specified by the rotation speed and motor output. (0000 - FFFF)
T2-03 PM Motor Type V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1
(0752) Sets the type of PM motor the drive will operate. (0, 1)
0 : IPM motor
1 : SPM motor
T2-04 PM Motor Rated Power V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(0730) Uses the units set in o1-58 [Motor Power Unit Selection] to set the PM motor rated output power. (0.00 - 650.00 HP)
T2-05 PM Motor Rated Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 230.0 V,
(0732) Sets the rated voltage (V) of the motor. 400 V Class: 460.0 V
(200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
T2-06 PM Motor Rated Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04
(0733) Sets the rated current (A) of the motor. (10% to 200% of the drive
rated current)
V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV
Parameter List
T2-07 PM Motor Base Frequency 60.0 Hz
(0753) Sets the base frequency (Hz) of the motor. (0.0 - 590.0 Hz)
T2-08 Number of PM Motor Poles V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 4
(0734) Sets the number of motor poles. (2 - 48)
T2-09 PM Motor Base Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1750 min-1 (r/min)
(0731) Sets the motor base speed (min-1 (r/min)). (0 - 34500 min-1 (r/min))
3
T2-10 PM Motor Stator Resistance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by T2-02
(0754) Sets the stator resistance for each motor phase. (0.000 - 65.000 Ω)
Note:
This parameter does not set line-to-line resistance.
T2-11 PM Motor d-Axis V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by T2-02
(0735) Inductance Sets the d-axis inductance of the motor on a per phase basis. (0.00 - 600.00 mH)
T2-12 PM Motor q-Axis V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by T2-02
(0736) Inductance Sets the q-Axis inductance of the motor on a per phase basis. (0.00 - 600.00 mH)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
T2-13 Back-EMF Units Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(0755) Sets the units that the drive uses to set the induced voltage constant. (0, 1)
0 : mV/(rev/min)
1 : mV/(rad/sec)
T2-14 Back-EMF Voltage Constant V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by T2-13
(0737) (Ke) Sets the motor induced voltage constant (Ke). (0.0 - 2000.0)
T2-15 Pull-In Current Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 30%
(0756) Sets the level of the pull-in current as a percentage of E5-03 [PM Motor Rated Current (FLA)]. (0 - 120%)
Usually it is not necessary to change this setting.
T2-16 Encoder Pulse Count (PPR) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 1024 ppr
(0738) Sets the number of PG (pulse generator, encoder) pulses. (1 - 15000 ppr)
T2-17 Encoder Z-Pulse Offset V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.0 °
(0757) Sets the encoder Z-pulse offset (Δθ) (pulse generator, encoder) that is listed on the motor nameplate. (-180.0 - +180.0°)
T3-00 Control Loop Tuning V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(1198) Selection Sets the type of Control Auto-Tuning. (0 - 3)
0 : Inertia Tuning
1 : ASR (Speed Regulator)
2 : Deceleration Rate Tuning
3 : KEB Tuning
Note:
Settings 0 and 1 are available only when A1-02 = 3, 7 [Control Method Selection = CLV, CLV/
PM].
T3-01 Test Signal Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 3.0 Hz
(0760) Sets the frequency of the test signal applied to the motor during Inertia Tuning. Usually it is not (0.1 - 20.0 Hz)
necessary to change this setting.
T3-02 Test Signal Amplitude V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0.5 rad
(0761) Sets the amplitude of the test signal applied to the motor during Inertia Tuning. Usually it is not (0.1 - 10.0 rad)
necessary to change this setting.
T3-03 Motor Inertia V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-
(0762) Sets the inertia of the motor. This value uses the test signal response to calculate the load inertia. 01, and E5-01
Note: (0.0001 - 600.00 kgm2)
The display units for the default setting and setting range are different for different models:
• 0.0001 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.0001 kgm2 to 6.0000 kgm2): 2004 to 2021, 4002 to 4012
• 0.001 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.001 kgm2 to 60.000 kgm2): 2030 to 2211, 4018 to 4103,
T103
• 0.01 kgm2 units (setting range: 0.01 kgm2 to 600.00 kgm2): 2257 to 2415, 4140 to 4720, T140
to T720
T3-04 System Response Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10.0 Hz
(0763) This parameter uses the load inertia value from the Inertia Tuning process to automatically calculate (0.1 - 50.0 Hz)
and set C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1].
◆ T4: EZ Tuning
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
T4-01 EZ Tuning Mode Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(3130) Sets the type of Auto-Tuning for EZOLV control. (0, 1)
0 : Motor Parameter Setting
1 : Line-to-Line Resistance
T4-02 Motor Type Selection V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0
(3131) Sets the type of motor. (0, 1, 2)
0 : Induction (IM)
1 : Permanent Magnet (PM)
2 : Synchronous Reluctance (SynRM)
No. Default
Name Description
(Hex.) (Range)
T4-04 Motor Rated Revolutions V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV -
(3133) Sets rated rotation speed (min-1) of the motor. ((40 Hz to 120 Hz) × 60 × 2/
E9-08)
T4-05 Motor Rated Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-01 and
(3134) Sets the rated frequency (Hz) of the motor. o2-04
(40.0 - 120.0 Hz)
T4-06 Motor Rated Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 230.0 V,
(3135) Sets the rated voltage (V) of the motor. 400 V Class: 460.0 V
(200 V Class: 0.0 - 255.0 V,
400 V Class: 0.0 - 510.0 V)
T4-07 Motor Rated Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by o2-04, C6-01
(3136) Sets the rated current (A) of the motor. (10% to 200% of the drive
rated current)
T4-08 Motor Rated Capacity V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-10
(3137) Sets the motor rated power in the units set in o1-58 [Motor Power Unit Selection]. (0.10 - 650.00 HP)
T4-09 Number of Poles V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by E9-01
(3138) Sets the number of motor poles. (2 - 48)
Parameter List
3.17 U: Monitors
◆ U1: Operation Status Monitors
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U1-01 Frequency Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Maximum frequency
(0040) Shows the frequency reference value. Parameter o1-03 [Keypad Display Unit Selection] sets the (0 V to +10 V)
display units.
Unit: 0.01 Hz
U1-02 Output frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Maximum frequency
(0041) Shows the output frequency. Parameter o1-03 [Keypad Display Unit Selection] sets the display units. (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01 Hz
U1-03 Output current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Drive rated current
(0042) Shows the output current.
The keypad shows the value of U1-03 in amperes (A). When you use MEMOBUS/Modbus
communications to show the monitor, the current is “8192 = drive rated current (A)”. Use the
formula: “Numerals being displayed / 8192 × drive rated current (A)” to use the MEMOBUS/Modbus
communication current value shown in the monitor.
Unit: When the drive model changes, the display units for this parameter also change.
• 0.01 A: 2004 - 2042, 4002 - 4023
• 0.1 A: 2056 - 2415, 4031 - 4720, T103 - T720
U1-04 Control Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0043) Shows the drive control method.
0 : V/f Control
1 : V/f Control with Encoder
2 : Open Loop Vector
3 : Closed Loop Vector
4 : Advanced Open Loop Vector
5 : PM Open Loop Vector
6 : PM Advanced Open Loop Vector
7 : PM Closed Loop Vector
8 : EZ Vector Control
U1-05 Motor Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Maximum frequency
(0044) Shows the detected motor speed. Parameter o1-03 [Keypad Display Unit Selection] sets the display (0 V to +10 V)
units.
Unit: 0.01 Hz
U1-06 Output Voltage Ref V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 10 V = 200
(0045) Shows the output voltage reference. Vrms
Unit: 0.1 V 400 V Class: 10 V = 400
Vrms
U1-07 DC Bus Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 10 V = 400 V
(0046) Shows the DC bus voltage. 400 V Class: 10 V = 800 V
Unit: 1 V
U1-08 Output Power V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Drive capacity (motor
(0047) Shows the internally-calculated output power. rated power) kW
When you change A1-02 [Control Method Selection], it will also change the signal level of the (-10 V to +10 V)
analog output.
• A1-02 = 0, 1: Drive capacity (kW)
• A1-02 = 2, 3, 4: PM Motor Rated Power [E2-11] (kW)
• A1-02 = 5, 6, 7: PM Motor Rated Power [E5-02] (kW)
• A1-02 = 8: Motor Rated Power [E9-07] (kW)
Unit: The display units are different for different models:
• 0.01 kW: 2004 - 2042, 4002 - 4023
• 0.1 kW: 2056 - 2415, 4031 - 4720, T103 - T720
U1-09 Torque Reference V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Motor rated torque (0
(0048) Shows the internal torque reference value. V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.1%
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U1-10 Input Terminal Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0049) Shows the status of the MFDI terminal where 1 = ON, 0 = OFF.
For example, U1-10 shows “00000011” when terminals S1 and S2 are ON.
bit0 : Terminal S1 (MFDI 1)
bit1 : Terminal S2 (MFDI 2)
bit2 : Terminal S3 (MFDI 3)
bit3 : Terminal S4 (MFDI 4)
bit4 : Terminal S5 (MFDI 5)
bit5 : Terminal S6 (MFDI 6)
bit6 : Terminal S7 (MFDI 7)
bit7 : Terminal S8 (MFDI 8)
U1-11 Output Terminal Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(004A) Shows the status of the MFDO terminal where 1 = ON and 0 = OFF.
For example, U1-11 shows “00000011” when terminals M1 and M3 are ON.
Note:
When H2-xx = 100 to 1A7 [Inverse Output of Function], U1-11 does not show the status in
inverse.
bit0 : Terminal M1-M2
bit1 : Terminal M3-M4
bit2 : Terminal M5-M6
bit3 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit4 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit5 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit6 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit7 : Fault relay MA/MB-MC
U1-12 Drive Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(004B) Shows drive status where 1 = ON and 0 = OFF.
For example, U1-12 shows “00000101” during run with the Reverse Run command.
bit0 : During Run
bit1 : During zero-speed
bit2 : During reverse
bit3 : During fault reset signal input
bit4 : During speed agreement
bit5 : Drive ready
bit6 : During minor fault detection
bit7 : During fault detection
U1-13 Terminal A1 Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100% (0 V to +10 V)
(004E) Shows the signal level of terminal A1.
Unit: 0.1%
U1-14 Terminal A2 Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100% (0 V to +10 V)
(004F) Shows the signal level of terminal A2.
Unit: 0.1%
U1-15 Terminal A3 Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 0 V = 100% (-10 V to +10
(0050) Shows the signal level of terminal A3. V)
Unit: 0.1%
U1-16 SFS Output Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Maximum frequency
(0 V to +10 V)
Parameter List
(0053) Shows the output frequency after soft start. Shows the frequency with acceleration and deceleration
times and S-curves. Parameter o1-03 [Keypad Display Unit Selection] sets the display units.
Unit: 0.01 Hz
U1-17 DI-A3 Input Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0058) Shows the reference value input from DI-A3 option.
Shows the input signal for DI-A3 in hexadecimal as set in F3-01 [Digital Input Function Selection].
3FFFF: Set (1 bit) + Sign (1 bit) + 16 bit 3
U1-18 oPE Fault Parameter V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0061) Shows the parameter number that caused the oPE02 [Parameter Range Setting Error] or oPE08
[Parameter Selection Error].
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U1-19 MEMOBUS/Modbus Error V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0066) Code Shows the contents of the MEMOBUS/Modbus communication error where 1 = “error” and 0 = “no
error”.
For example, U1-19 shows “00000001” when there is a CRC error.
bit0 : CRC Error
bit1 : Data Length Error
bit2 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit3 : Parity Error
bit4 : Overrun Error
bit5 : Framing Error
bit6 : Timed Out
bit7 : Not used (normal value of 0).
U1-21 AI-A3 Term V1 Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100% (-10 V to +10
(0077) Shows the analog reference of terminal V1 on analog input option card AI-A3. V)
Unit: 0.1%
U1-22 AI-A3 Term V2 Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100% (-10 V to +10
(072A) Shows the analog reference of terminal V2 on analog input option card AI-A3. V)
Unit: 0.1%
U1-23 AI-A3 Term V3 Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100% (-10 V to +10
(072B) Shows the analog reference of terminal V3 on analog input option card AI-A3. V)
Unit: 0.1%
U1-24 Input Pulse Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by H6-02
(007D) Shows the frequency to pulse train input terminal RP.
Unit: 1 Hz
U1-25 SoftwareNumber Flash V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(004D) Shows the FLASH ID.
U1-26 SoftwareNumber ROM V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(005B) Shows the ROM ID.
U1-50 Virtual Analog Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by H7-40
(1199) Shows the virtual analog input value.
Expert
U1-91 Output Voltage V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 10 V = 200
(154E) Shows the drive internal output voltage reference. Vrms
Expert Unit: 0.1 V 400 V Class: 10 V = 400
Vrms
U2-01 Current Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0080) Shows the fault that the drive has when viewing the monitor.
U2-02 Previous Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0081) Shows the fault that occurred most recently.
U2-03 Freq Reference@Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0082) Shows the frequency reference at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-01 [Frequency Reference] to monitor the frequency reference value.
Unit: 0.01 Hz
U2-04 Output Freq @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0083) Shows the output frequency at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-02 [Output Frequency] to monitor the actual output frequency.
Unit: 0.01 Hz
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U2-05 Output Current@Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0084) Shows the output current at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-03 [Output Current] to monitor the output current. The keypad shows the value of U1-03 in
amperes (A).
When you use MEMOBUS/Modbus communications to show the monitor, the current is “8192 =
drive rated current (A)”. Use the formula: “Numerals being displayed / 8192 × drive rated current
(A)” to use the MEMOBUS/Modbus communication current value shown in the monitor.
Unit: When the drive model changes, the display units for this parameter also change.
• 0.01 A: 2004 - 2042, 4002 - 4023
• 0.1 A: 2056 - 2415, 4031 - 4720, T103 - T720
U2-06 Motor Speed @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0085) Shows the motor speed at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-05 [Motor Speed] to monitor the motor speed.
Unit: 0.01 Hz
U2-07 Output Voltage@Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0086) Shows the output voltage reference at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-06 [Output Voltage Ref] to monitor the output voltage reference.
Unit: 0.1 V
U2-08 DC Bus Voltage@Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0087) Shows the DC bus voltage at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-07 [DC Bus Voltage] to monitor the DC bus voltage.
Unit: 1 V
U2-09 Output Power @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0088) Shows the output power at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-08 [Output Power] to monitor the output power.
Unit: 0.1 kW
U2-10 Torque Ref @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0089) Shows the torque reference at the fault that occurred most recently as a percentage of the motor rated
torque.
Use U1-09 [Torque Reference] to monitor the torque reference.
Unit: 0.1%
U2-11 Input Terminal Status @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(008A) Fault Shows the status of the MFDI terminals at the most recent fault where 1 = (ON) and 0 = (OFF).
For example, U2-11 shows “00000011” when terminals S1 and S2 are ON.
Use U1-10 [Input Terminal Status] to monitor the MFDI terminal status.
bit0 : Terminal S1
bit1 : Terminal S2
bit2 : Terminal S3
bit3 : Terminal S4
bit4 : Terminal S5
bit5 : Terminal S6
bit6 : Terminal S7
bit7 : Terminal S8
U2-12 Output Terminal Status @ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(008B) Fault Shows the status of the MFDO terminals at the most recent fault where 1 = (ON) and 0 = (OFF).
For example, U2-12 shows “00000011” when terminals M1 and M3 are ON.
Parameter List
Use U1-11 [Output Terminal Status] to monitor the MFDO terminal status.
bit0 : Terminal M1-M2
bit1 : Terminal M3-M4
bit2 : Terminal M5-M6
bit3 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit4 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit5 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit6 : Not used (normal value of 0).
3
bit7 : Fault relay MA/MB-MC
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U2-13 Operation Status @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(008C) Shows the status of the MFDO terminals at the most recent fault where 1 = (ON) and 0 = (OFF).
For example, U2-13 shows “00000001” during run.
Use U1-12 [Drive Status] to monitor the MFDO terminal status.
bit0 : During Run
bit1 : During zero-speed
bit2 : During reverse
bit3 : During fault reset signal input
bit4 : During speed agreement
bit5 : Drive ready
bit6 : During minor fault detection
bit7 : During fault detection
U2-14 Elapsed Time @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(008D) Shows the cumulative operation time of the drive at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U4-01 [Cumulative Ope Time] to monitor the cumulative operation time.
Unit: 1 h
U2-15 SFS Output @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07E0) Shows the output frequency after soft start at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U1-16 [SFS Output Frequency] to monitor the output frequency after soft start.
Unit: 0.01 Hz
U2-16 q-Axis Current@Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07E1) Shows the q-Axis current of the motor at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U6-01 [Iq Secondary Current] to monitor the q-Axis current of the motor.
Unit: 0.1 %
U2-17 d-Axis Current@Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07E2) Shows the d-Axis current of the motor at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U6-02 [Id ExcitationCurrent] to monitor the d-Axis current of the motor.
Unit: 0.1 %
U2-19 ControlDeviation@Flt V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07E4) Shows the amount of control axis deviation (Δθ) at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U6-10 [ContAxisDeviation Δθ] to monitor the actual amount of control axis deviation (Δθ).
Unit: 0.1 °
U2-20 Heatsink Temp @Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(008E) Shows the heatsink temperature at the fault that occurred most recently.
Use U4-08 [Heatsink Temperature] to monitor the temperature of the heatsink.
Unit: 1 °C
U2-21 STPo Detect @ Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(1166) Monitors conditions to detect STPo [Motor Step-Out Detected] faults. The bit for each condition is
Expert shown as ON or OFF.
bit0 : Excessive current
bit1 : Induced voltage deviation
bit2 : d-axis current deviation
bit3 : Motor lock at startup
bit4 : Acceleration stall continue
bit5 : Acceleration stall repeat
bit6 : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit7 : Not used (normal value of 0).
U3-01 1st MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0090) Shows the fault history of the most recent fault.
Note:
The drive saves this fault history to two types of registers at the same time for the MEMOBUS/
Modbus communications.
U3-02 2nd MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0091) Shows the fault history of the second most recent fault.
Note:
The drive saves this fault history to two types of registers at the same time for the MEMOBUS/
Modbus communications.
U3-03 3rd MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0092) Shows the fault history of the third most recent fault.
Note:
The drive saves this fault history to two types of registers at the same time for the MEMOBUS/
Modbus communications.
U3-04 4th MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0093) Shows the fault history of the fourth most recent fault.
Note:
The drive saves this fault history to two types of registers at the same time for the MEMOBUS/
Modbus communications.
U3-05 5th MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0804) Shows the fault history of the fifth most recent fault.
U3-06 6th MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0805) Shows the fault history of the sixth most recent fault.
U3-07 7th MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0806) Shows the fault history of the seventh most recent fault.
U3-08 8th MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0807) Shows the fault history of the eighth most recent fault.
U3-09 9th MostRecent Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0808) Shows the fault history of the ninth most recent fault.
U3-10 10th MostRecentFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0809) Shows the fault history of the tenth most recent fault.
U3-11 ElapsedTime@1stFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0094) Shows the cumulative operation time when the most recent fault occurred.
Note:
The drive saves this cumulative operation time to two types of registers at the same time for the
MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
Unit: 1 h
U3-12 ElapsedTime@2ndFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0095) Shows the cumulative operation time when the second most recent fault occurred.
Note:
The drive saves this cumulative operation time to two types of registers at the same time for the
MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
Parameter List
Unit: 1 h
U3-13 ElapsedTime@3rdFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0096) Shows the cumulative operation time when the third most recent fault occurred.
Note:
The drive saves this cumulative operation time to two types of registers at the same time for the
MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
Unit: 1 h
3
U3-14 ElapsedTime@4thFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0097) Shows the cumulative operation time when the fourth most recent fault occurred.
Note:
The drive saves this cumulative operation time to two types of registers at the same time for the
MEMOBUS/Modbus communications.
Unit: 1 h
U3-15 ElapsedTime@5thFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(080E) Shows the cumulative operation time when the fifth most recent fault occurred.
Unit: 1 h
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U3-16 ElapsedTime@6thFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(080F) Shows the cumulative operation time when the sixth most recent fault occurred.
Unit: 1 h
U3-17 ElapsedTime@7thFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0810) Shows the cumulative operation time when the seventh most recent fault occurred.
Unit: 1 h
U3-18 ElapsedTime@8thFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0811) Shows the cumulative operation time when the eighth most recent fault occurred.
Unit: 1 h
U3-19 ElapsedTime@9thFault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0812) Shows the cumulative operation time when the ninth most recent fault occurred.
Unit: 1 h
U3-20 ElapsedTime@10 Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0813) Shows the cumulative operation time when the tenth most recent fault occurred.
Unit: 1 h
U4-01 Cumulative Ope Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 99999 h
(004C) Shows the cumulative operation time of the drive.
Use parameter o4-01 [Elapsed Operating Time Setting] to reset this monitor. Use parameter o4-02
[Elapsed Operating Time Selection] to select the cumulative operation times from:
• The time from when the drive is energized until it is de-energized.
• The time at which the Run command is turned ON.
The maximum value that the monitor will show is 99999. After this value is more than 99999, the
drive automatically resets it and starts to count from 0 again.
Unit: 1 h
Note:
The MEMOBUS/Modbus communication data is shown in 10 h units. Use register 0099H for
data in 1 h units.
U4-02 Num of Run Commands V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 65535 times
(0075) Shows how many times that the drive has received a Run command.
Use parameter o4-13 [RUN Command Counter @ Initialize] to reset this monitor. The maximum
value that the monitor will show is 65535. After this value is more than 65535, the drive
automatically resets it and starts to count from 0 again.
Unit: 1
U4-03 Cooling Fan Ope Time V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 99999 h
(0067) Shows the cumulative operation time of the cooling fans.
Use parameter o4-03 [Fan Operation Time Setting] to reset this monitor. The maximum value that
the monitor will show is 99999. After this value is more than 99999, the drive automatically resets it
and starts to count from 0 again.
Unit: 1 h
Note:
The MEMOBUS/Modbus communication data is shown in 10 h units. Use register 009BH for
data in 1 h units.
U4-04 Cool Fan Maintenance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 100%
(007E) Shows the cumulative operation time of the cooling fans as a percentage of the replacement life of
the cooling fans.
Use parameter o4-03 [Fan Operation Time Setting] to reset this monitor.
Unit: 1%
Note:
Replace the cooling fans when this monitor is 90%.
U4-05 CapacitorMaintenance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 100%
(007C) Shows the operation time of the electrolytic capacitors for the main circuit and control circuit as a
percentage of the replacement life of the electrolytic capacitors.
Use parameter o4-05 [Capacitor Maintenance Setting] to reset this monitor.
Unit: 1%
Note:
Replace the electrolytic capacitor when this monitor is 90%.
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U4-06 PreChargeRelayMainte V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 100%
(07D6) Shows the operation time of the soft charge bypass relay as a percentage of the replacement life of
the soft charge bypass relay.
Use parameter o4-07 [Softcharge Relay Maintenance Set] to reset this monitor.
Unit: 1%
Note:
Replace the drive when this monitor is 90%.
U4-07 IGBT Maintenance V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 100%
(07D7) Shows the operation time of the IGBTs as a percentage of the replacement life of the IGBTs.
Set parameter o4-09 [IGBT Maintenance Setting] to reset this monitor.
Unit: 1%
Note:
Replace the drive when this monitor is 90%.
U4-08 Heatsink Temperature V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 100 °C
(0068) Shows the heatsink temperature of the drive.
Unit: 1 °C
U4-09 LED Check V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(005E) Turns on the LED Status Ring and all of the keypad LEDs to make sure that the LEDs operate
correctly.
Note:
A damaged LED Status Ring board will prevent an accurate estimate of the internal status of the
drive. Do not use only the LED Status Ring to estimate the status of the drive and motors.
1. Set o2-24 = 0 [LED Light Function Selection = Enable Status Ring & Keypad LED].
U4-10 kWh, Lower 4 Digits V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(005C) Shows the lower 4 digits of the watt hour value for the drive.
Unit: 1 kWh
Note:
The watt hour is displayed in 9 digits. Monitor U4-11 [kWh, Upper 5 Digits] shows the upper 5
digits and U4-10 shows the lower 4 digits.
Example for 12345678.9 kWh:
U4-10: 678.9 kWh
U4-11: 12345 MWh
U4-11 kWh, Upper 5 Digits V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(005D) Shows the upper 5 digits of the watt hour value for the drive.
Unit: 1 MWh
Note:
Monitor U4-11 shows the upper 5 digits and U4-10 [kWh, Lower 4 Digits] shows the lower 4
digits.
Example for 12345678.9 kWh:
U4-10: 678.9 kWh
U4-11: 12345 MWh
U4-13 Peak Hold Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07CF) Shows the hold value of the peak value (rms) for the drive output current.
Parameter List
Use U4-14 [PeakHold Output Freq] to show the drive output frequency at the time that the drive
holds the output current.
The drive will hold the peak hold current at the next start up and restart of the power supply. The
drive keeps the value that was under hold during baseblock (during stop).
The keypad shows the value of U4-13 in amperes (A). When you use MEMOBUS/Modbus
communications to show the monitor, the current is “8192 = drive rated current (A)”. Use the
formula: “Numerals being displayed / 8192 × drive rated current (A)” to use the MEMOBUS/Modbus
communication current value shown in the monitor. 3
Unit: When the drive model changes, the display units for this parameter also change.
• 0.01 A: 2004 - 2042, 4002 - 4023
• 0.1 A: 2056 - 2415, 4031 - 4720, T103 - T720
U4-14 PeakHold Output Freq V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07D0) Shows the output frequency at which the peak value (rms) of the drive output current is held.
The peak hold current can be monitored by U4-13 [Peak Hold Current].
The peak hold output frequency will be cleared at the next startup and restart of the power supply.
The drive keeps the value that was under hold during baseblock (during stop).
Unit: 0.01 Hz
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U4-16 Motor oL1 Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 100%
(07D8) Shows the integrated value of oL1 [Motor Overload] as a percentage of oL1 detection level.
Unit: 0.1%
U4-18 Reference Source V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07DA) Shows the selected frequency reference source.
The keypad shows the frequency reference source as “XY-nn” as specified by these rules:
X: External Reference 1/2 Selection [H1-xx = 2] selection status
• 1: b1-01 [Frequency Reference Selection 1]
• 2: b1-15 [Frequency Reference Selection 2]
Y-nn: Frequency reference source
• 0-01: Keypad (d1-01 [Reference 1])
• 1-00: Analog input (unassigned)
• 1-01: MFAI terminal A1
• 1-02: MFAI terminal A2
• 1-03: MFAI terminal A3
• 2-02 to 2-17: Multi-step speed reference (d1-02 to d1-17 [Reference 2 to 16, Jog Reference])
• 3-01: MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
• 4-01: Communication option card
• 5-01: Pulse train input
• 7-01: DriveWorksEZ
• 9-01: Up/Down command
U4-19 Modbus FreqRef (dec) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(07DB) Shows the frequency reference sent to the drive from the MEMOBUS/Modbus communications as a (0 V to +10 V)
decimal.
Unit: 0.01%
U4-20 Option Freq Ref(dec) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(07DC) Shows the frequency reference sent to the drive from the communication option as a decimal. (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01 %
U4-21 Run Command Source V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output The keypad
(07DD) Shows the selected Run command source. shows the Run command
source as "XY-nn" as
The keypad shows the Run command source as “XY-nn” as specified by these rules: specified by these rules:
X: External Reference 1/2 Selection [H1-xx = 2] selection status available
• 1: b1-02 [Run Command Selection 1]
• 2: b1-16 [Run Command Selection 2]
Y: Run command source
• 0: Keypad
• 1: Control circuit terminal
• 3: MEMOBUS/Modbus communications
• 4: Communication option card
• 7: DriveWorksEZ
nn: Run command limit status data
• 00: No limit status.
• 01: The Run command was left ON when the drive stopped in the Programming Mode.
• 02: The Run command was left ON when switching from LOCAL Mode to REMOTE Mode.
• 03: The Run command is in standby after the drive was energized until the soft charge bypass
contactor turns ON.
Note:
The drive will detect Uv1 [DC Bus Undervoltage] or Uv [Undervoltage] if the soft charge
bypass contactor does not turn ON after 10 s.
• 04: Restart after run stop is prohibited.
• 05: Fast stop has been executed using the MFDI terminal. Or, the motor has ramped to stop by
pressing the STOP key on the keypad.
• 06: b1-17 = 0 [Run Command at Power Up = Disregard Existing RUN Command] is set.
• 07: During baseblock while coast to stop with timer.
• 08: Frequency reference is below E1-09 [Minimum Output Frequency] during baseblock.
• 09: Waiting for the Enter command from PLC.
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U4-22 Modbus CmdData (hex) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07DE) Shows the operation signal (register 0001H) sent to the drive from MEMOBUS/Modbus
communications as a 4-digit hexadecimal number (zero suppress). The keypad shows the operation
signal as specified by these rules:
bit 0 : Forward run/Stop
bit 1 : Reverse run/Stop
bit 2 : External fault
bit 3 : Fault Reset
bit 4 : Multi-function input 1
bit 5 : Multi-function input 2
bit 6 : Multi-function input 3
bit 7 : Multi-function input 4
bit 8 : Multi-function input 5
bit 9 : Multi-function input 6
bit A : Multi-function input 7
bit B : Multi-function input 8
bit C : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit D : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit E : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit F : Not used (normal value of 0).
U4-23 Option CmdData (hex) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07DF) Shows the operation signal (register 0001H) sent to the drive from MEMOBUS/Modbus
communications as a 4-digit hexadecimal number. The keypad shows the operation signal as
specified by these rules:
bit 0 : Forward run/Stop
bit 1 : Reverse run/Stop
bit 2 : External fault
bit 3 : Fault Reset
bit 4 : Multi-function input 1
bit 5 : Multi-function input 2
bit 6 : Multi-function input 3
bit 7 : Multi-function input 4
bit 8 : Multi-function input 5
bit 9 : Multi-function input 6
bit A : Multi-function input 7
bit B : Multi-function input 8
bit C : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit D : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit E : Not used (normal value of 0).
bit F : Not used (normal value of 0).
U4-24 Number of Runs (Low) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07E6) Shows the lower 4 digits of the drive run count.
Note:
The drive run count is an 8-digit number. Monitor U4-25 [Number of Runs(High)] shows the
upper 4 digits and U4-24 shows the lower 4 digits.
U4-25 Number of Runs(High) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07E7) Shows the upper 4 digits of the drive run count.
Note:
The drive run count is an 8-digit number. Monitor U4-25 shows the upper 4 digits and U4-24
Parameter List
[Number of Runs (Low)] shows the lower 4 digits.
U4-52 Torque Ref from Comm V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 100% (0 V to +10 V)
(1592) Shows the torque reference that the drive received from a serial communication option card or from
MEMOBUS/Modbus communications as a decimal number.
Unit: 0.1%
U5-01 PID Feedback V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(0057) Shows the PID control feedback value. Parameter b5-20 [PID Unit Selection] sets the display units. (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01%
U5-02 PID Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(0063) Shows the change between the PID setpoint and PID feedback (the quantity of PID input) as a (0 V to +10 V)
percentage of the maximum output frequency.
Unit: 0.01%
U5-03 PID Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(0064) Shows the PID control output as a percentage of the maximum output frequency. (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01%
U5-04 PID Setpoint V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(0065) Shows the PID setpoint. Parameter b5-20 [PID Unit Selection] sets the display units. (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01%
U5-05 PID DifferentialFdbk V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Maximum frequency
(07D2) Shows the PID differential feedback value as a percentage of the maximum output frequency. (-10 V to +10 V)
This monitor is available after you set H3-02, H3-10, or H3-06 = 16 [MFAI Function Selection =
Differential PID Feedback].
Unit: 0.01%
U5-06 PID Fdbk-Diff PID Fdbk V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Maximum frequency
(07D3) Shows the difference from calculating U5-05 - U5-01 [PID DifferentialFdbk] - [PID Feedback]. (-10 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01%
Note:
U5-01 [PID Feedback] = U5-06 when H3-02, H3-10, or H3-06 ≠ 16 [MFAI Function Selection ≠
Differential PID Feedback].
U5-21 Energy Save Coeff Ki V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0872) Shows the energy-saving coefficient Ki value for PM.
Expert Unit: 0.01
U5-22 Energy Save Coeff Kt V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0873) Shows the energy-saving coefficient Kt value for PM.
Expert Unit: 0.01
U5-99 PID Setpoint Command V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(1599) Shows the PID setpoint command. Parameter b5-20 [PID Unit Selection] sets the display units. (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01%
U6-01 Iq Secondary Current V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Motor secondary rated
(0051) Shows the value calculated for the motor secondary current (q-Axis) as a percentage of the motor current (0 V to +10 V)
rated secondary current.
Unit: 0.1%
U6-02 Id ExcitationCurrent V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Motor secondary rated
(0052) Shows the value calculated for the motor excitation current (d-Axis) as a percentage of the motor current (0 V to +10 V)
rated secondary current.
Unit: 0.1%
U6-03 ASR Input V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum frequency
(0054) Shows the ASR input value as a percentage of the maximum frequency. (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01%
U6-04 ASR Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Motor secondary rated
(0055) Shows the ASR output value as a percentage of the motor rated secondary current. current (0 V to +10 V)
Unit: 0.01%
U6-05 OutputVoltageRef: Vq V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 10 V = 200
(0059) Shows the drive internal voltage reference for motor secondary current control (q-Axis). Vrms
Unit: 0.1 V 400 V Class: 10 V = 400
Vrms
(0 V to +10 V)
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U6-06 OutputVoltageRef: Vd V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 10 V = 200
(005A) Shows the drive internal voltage reference for motor excitation current control (d-Axis). Vrms
Unit: 0.1 V 400 V Class: 10 V = 400
Vrms
(0 V to +10 V)
U6-07 q-Axis ACR Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 10 V = 200
(005F) Shows the output value for current control related to motor secondary current (q axis). Vrms
Expert Unit: 0.1 % 400 V Class: 10 V = 400
Vrms
(0 V to +10 V)
U6-08 d-Axis ACR Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 200 V Class: 10 V = 200
(0060) Shows the output value for current control related to motor excitation current (d axis). Vrms
Expert Unit: 0.1 % 400 V Class: 10 V = 400
Vrms
(0 V to +10 V)
U6-09 AdvPhase Compen Δθcmp V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5 V: 180 ° (-10 V to +10 V)
(07C0) Displays the data on forward phase compensation for the calculation results of the amount of control
Expert axis deviation.
Unit: 1 °
U6-10 ContAxisDeviation Δθ V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 5 V: 180 ° (-10 V to +10 V)
(07C1) Shows the deviation between the γδ-Axis that the drive uses for motor control and the dq-Axis.
Expert Unit: 0.1 °
U6-13 MagPolePosition(Enc) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 180° (-10 V to +10 V)
(07CA) Shows the value of the flux position detection.
Expert Unit: 0.1 °
U6-14 MagPolePosition(Obs) V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 180 ° (-10 V to +10 V)
(07CB) Shows the value of the flux position estimation.
Expert Unit: 0.1 °
U6-17 Energy Save Coeff V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07D1) Shows the total time of direction of motor rotation detections for Speed Estimation Speed Searches.
Expert This value adjusts b3-26 [Direction Determination Level].
Note:
Upper limit is +32767 and lower limit is -32767.
U6-18 Enc 1 Pulse Counter V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 65536
(07CD) Shows the number of pulses for speed detection (PG1).
Unit: 1 pulse
U6-19 Enc 2 Pulse Counter V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: 65536
(07E5) Shows the number of pulses for speed detection (PG2).
Unit: 1 pulse
U6-20 UP/DOWN 2 Bias Value V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum Frequency
(07D4) Shows the bias value used to adjust the frequency reference.
Unit: 0.1%
U6-21 Offset Frequency V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V: Maximum Frequency
(07D5) Shows the total value of d7-01 to d7-03 [Offset Frequency 1 to 3] selected with Add Offset
Frequency 1 to 3 [H1-xx = 44 to 46].
Unit: 0.1%
Parameter List
U6-22 ZeroServo Pulse Move V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Number of pulses per
(0062) Shows the distance that the rotor moved from its last position when Zero Servo is available. The revolution (-10 V to +10 V)
value shown in this monitor = 4 X [No. of PG pulses].
Unit: 1 pulse
U6-25 ASR Output Level V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Motor secondary
rated current (-10 V to +10
(006B)
Expert
Shows the primary delay filter input value of the ASR (speed control loop).
Unit: 0.01%
V) 3
U6-26 Feed Fwd Cont Output V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Motor secondary
(006C) Shows the Feed Forward control output. rated current (-10 V to +10
V)
Expert Unit: 0.01%
U6-27 FeedFwd Estimate Spd V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = Maximum frequency
(006D) Shows the feed forward estimated speed. (-10 V to +10 V)
Expert Unit: 0.01%
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U6-31 TorqueDetect Monitor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V:100%
(007B) Monitors the torque reference or the output current after applying the filter set to L6-07 [Torque
Detection Filter Time].
Unit: 0.1%
U6-36 Comm Errors-Host V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0720) Shows the number of inter-CPU communication errors. When you de-energize the drive, this value
Expert resets to 0.
U6-37 Comm Errors-Sensor V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(0721) Shows the number of inter-CPU communication errors. When you de-energize the drive, this value
Expert resets to 0.
U6-48 ASIC Comm Errors V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(072E) Shows the number of inter-ASIC communication errors detected by the ASIC. When you de-energize
Expert the drive, this value resets to 0.
U6-57 PolePolarityDeterVal V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07C4) Shows the change from the integrated current when the drive finds the polarity.
Unit: 1
Note:
If the change from the integrated current is less than 819, increase n8-84 [Polarity Detection
Current]. U6-57 = 8192 is equivalent to the motor rated current.
U6-80 Option IP Address 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B0) Shows the currently available local IP Address (1st octet).
U6-81 Option IP Address 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B1) Shows the currently available local IP Address (2nd octet).
U6-82 Option IP Address 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B2) Shows the currently available local IP Address (3rd octet).
U6-83 Option IP Address 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B3) Shows the currently available local IP Address (4th octet).
U6-84 Online Subnet 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B4) Shows the currently available subnet mask (1st octet).
U6-85 Online Subnet 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B5) Shows the currently available subnet mask (2nd octet).
U6-86 Online Subnet 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B6) Shows the currently available subnet mask (3rd octet).
U6-87 Online Subnet 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B7) Shows the currently available subnet mask (4th octet).
U6-88 Online Gateway 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B8) Shows the currently available Gateway address (1st octet).
U6-89 Online Gateway 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07B9) Shows the currently available Gateway address (2nd octet).
U6-90 Online Gateway 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07F0) Shows the currently available Gateway address (3rd octet).
U6-91 Online Gateway 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07F1) Shows the currently available Gateway address (4th octet).
U6-92 Online Speed V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07F2) Shows the currently available communications speed.
10: 10 Mbps
100: 100 Mbps
U6-93 Online Duplex V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07F3) Shows the currently available Duplex setting.
U6-98 First Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07F8) Shows the contents of the most recent communication options fault (DeviceNet, Modbus TCP/IP,
EtherNet/IP).
U6-99 Current Fault V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(07F9) Shows the contents of current fault from communication options (DeviceNet, Modbus TCP/IP,
EtherNet/IP).
U8-01 DWEZ Monitor 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1950) Shows DWEZ Monitor 1. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-02 DWEZ Monitor 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1951) Shows DWEZ Monitor 2. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-03 DWEZ Monitor 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1952) Shows DWEZ Monitor 3. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-04 DWEZ Monitor 4 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1953) Shows DWEZ Monitor 4. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-05 DWEZ Monitor 5 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1954) Shows DWEZ Monitor 5. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-06 DWEZ Monitor 6 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1955) Shows DWEZ Monitor 6. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-07 DWEZ Monitor 7 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1956) Shows DWEZ Monitor 7. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-08 DWEZ Monitor 8 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1957) Shows DWEZ Monitor 8. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-09 DWEZ Monitor 9 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1958) Shows DWEZ Monitor 9. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-10 DWEZ Monitor 10 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(1959) Shows DWEZ Monitor 10.
U8-11 DWEZ Version 1 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(195A) Shows the Upper three digits of the user ID. When you click the setting button on the title bar of the
PC tool to open the setting screen, you can confirm the user ID with the primary user ID display.
U8-12 DWEZ Version 2 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(195B) Shows the lower five digits of the user ID. When you click the setting button on the title bar of the
PC tool to open the setting screen, you can confirm the user ID with the primary user ID display.
U8-13 DWEZ Version 3 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(195C) Shows the software ID.
U8-18 DWEZ Platform Ver V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(1961) Shows the DriveWorksEZ platform version.
U8-21 DWEZ Monitor 21 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
Parameter List
(1964) Shows DWEZ Monitor 21. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-22 DWEZ Monitor 22 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1965) Shows DWEZ Monitor 22.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-21.
U8-23 DWEZ Monitor 23 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100% 3
(1966) Shows DWEZ Monitor 23.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-22.
U8-24 DWEZ Monitor 24 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1967) Shows DWEZ Monitor 24.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-23.
U8-25 DWEZ Monitor 25 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1968) Shows DWEZ Monitor 25.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-24.
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U8-31 DWEZ Monitor 31 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(196E) Shows DWEZ Monitor 31. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-32 DWEZ Monitor 32 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(196F) Shows DWEZ Monitor 32. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-33 DWEZ Monitor 33 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1970) Shows DWEZ Monitor 33. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-34 DWEZ Monitor 34 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1971) Shows DWEZ Monitor 34. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-35 DWEZ Monitor 35 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1972) Shows DWEZ Monitor 35. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-36 DWEZ Monitor 36 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1973) Shows DWEZ Monitor 36. (Display range: 0.00% to 999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-37 DWEZ Monitor 37 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1974) Shows DWEZ Monitor 37. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-38 DWEZ Monitor 38 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1975) Shows DWEZ Monitor 38. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-39 DWEZ Monitor 39 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1976) Shows DWEZ Monitor 39. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-40 DWEZ Monitor 40 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(1977) Shows DWEZ Monitor 40.
U8-51 DWEZ Monitor 51 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1982) Shows DWEZ Monitor 51. (Display range: -999.9% to +999.99%)
Unit: 0.01%
U8-52 DWEZ Monitor 52 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1983) Shows DWEZ Monitor 52.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-41.
U8-53 DWEZ Monitor 53 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1984) Shows DWEZ Monitor 53.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-42.
U8-54 DWEZ Monitor 54 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1985) Shows DWEZ Monitor 54.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-43.
U8-55 DWEZ Monitor 55 V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 10 V = 100%
(1986) Shows DWEZ Monitor 55.
Unit: The number of decimal points shown is set with Q2-44.
U8-60 RemoteIO Status V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(198B) Shows the operation status of Remote IO as 1 (ON) and 0 (OFF). If the DriveWorksEZ MEMOBUS
master active signal is ON, for example, the monitor shows U8-60 = 00000001.
bit 0 : Bit 0: DriveWorksEZ MEMOBUS Master Active
bit 1 : Not used (normal value of 0)
bit 2 : Not used (normal value of 0)
bit 3 : Not used (normal value of 0)
bit 4 : Not used (normal value of 0)
bit 5 : Not used (normal value of 0)
bit 6 : Not used (normal value of 0)
bit 7 : Not used (normal value of 0)
No.
Name Description MFAO Signal Level
(Hex.)
U8-61 RemoteDI Monitor 0-7bit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(198C) Shows the operation status of Remote DI1 to DI8 as 1 (ON) and 0 (OFF). If Remote DI1 and DI2 are
ON, for example, the monitor shows U8-61 = 00000011.
bit 0 : Remote DI1
bit 1 : Remote DI2
bit 2 : Remote DI3
bit 3 : Remote DI4
bit 4 : Remote DI5
bit 5 : Remote DI6
bit 6 : Remote DI7
bit 7 : Remote DI8
U8-62 RemoteDI Monitor 8-Fbit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(198D) Shows the operation status of Remote DI9 to DI16 as 1 (ON) and 0 (OFF). If Remote DI9 and DI10
are ON, for example, the monitor shows U8-62 = 00000011.
bit 0 : Remote DI9
bit 1 : Remote DI10
bit 2 : Remote DI11
bit 3 : Remote DI12
bit 4 : Remote DI13
bit 5 : Remote DI14
bit 6 : Remote DI15
bit 7 : Remote DI16
U8-63 RemoteDO Monitor 0-7bit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(198E) Shows the operation status of Remote DO1 to DO8 as 1 (ON) and 0 (OFF). If Remote DO1 and DO2
are ON, for example, the monitor shows U8-63 = 00000011.
bit 0 : Remote DO1
bit 1 : Remote DO2
bit 2 : Remote DO3
bit 3 : Remote DO4
bit 4 : Remote DO5
bit 5 : Remote DO6
bit 6 : Remote DO7
bit 7 : Remote DO8
U8-64 RemoteDO Monitor 8-Fbit V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV No signal output available
(198F) Shows the operation status of Remote DO9 to DO16 as 1 (ON) and 0 (OFF). If Remote DO9 and
DO10 are ON, for example, the monitor shows U8-64 = 00000011.
bit 0 : Remote DO9
bit 1 : Remote DO10
bit 2 : Remote DO11
bit 3 : Remote DO12
bit 4 : Remote DO13
bit 5 : Remote DO14
bit 6 : Remote DO15
bit 7 : Remote DO16
Parameter List
b2-01 DC Injection/Zero 0.0 - 10.0 0.1 Hz 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
SpeedThreshold
DC Inject Braking
b2-04 Time at Stop 0.00 - 10.00 0.01 s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
Speed Search at
b3-01 Start Selection 0-1 1 0 1 0 - 0
SpeedSearch
b3-02 Deactivation 0 - 200 1% 120 - 100 - -
Current
Speed Estimation
b3-08 ACR P Gain 0.00 - 6.00 0.01 0.50 *1 0.50 *1 0.50 *1 0.50 *1 0.50 *1
Speed Estimation
b3-09 0.0 - 1000.0 0.1 ms 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0 2.0
ACR I Time
Bi-directional
b3-14 0-1 1 0 0 0 - 1
Speed Search
PID Sleep
b5-15 Function Start 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
Level
Dwell Reference
b6-01 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
at Start
b6-03 Dwell Reference 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
at Stop
Energy Saving
b8-02 Gain 0.0 - 10.0 0.1 - - 0.7 1.0 1.0
Energy Saving
b8-03 Filter Time 0.00 - 10.00 0.01 s - - 0.50 *2 0.01 *2 0.01 *2
E-Save Search
b8-19 10 - 300 1 Hz - - - - -
Injection Freq
Accel/Decel Time
C1-11 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
Switchover Freq
C2-01 S-Curve Time @ 0.00 - 10.00 0.01 s 0.20 0.20 0.20 0.20 0.20
Start of Accel
Slip
C3-01 Compensation 0.0 - 2.5 0.1 0.0 - 1.0 1.0 0.0
Gain
Slip
C3-02 Compensation 0 - 10000 1 ms 2000 - 200 - -
Delay Time
Torque
C4-01 Compensation 0.00 - 2.50 0.01 1.00 1.00 1.00 - -
Gain
Torque
C4-02 Compensation 0 - 60000 1 ms 200 200 20 - -
Delay Time
ASR Integral
C5-02 Time 1 0.000 - 60.000 0.001 s - 0.200 - 0.500 0.500
ASR Proportional
C5-03 0.00 - 300.00 0.01 - 0.02 - 20.00 20.00
Gain 2
ASR Integral
C5-04 0.000 - 60.000 0.001 s - 0.050 - 0.500 0.500
Time 2
ASR Gain
C5-07 Switchover 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz - - - 0.0 0.0
Frequency
Carrier Frequency
C6-02 1-F 1 1 *3 1 *3 1 *3 1 1
Selection
d3-01 Jump Frequency 1 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
d3-02 Jump Frequency 2 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
d3-03 Jump Frequency 3 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
d3-04 Jump Frequency 0.0 - 20.0 0.1 Hz 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0
Width
Torque Reference
d5-02 Delay Time 0 - 1000 1 ms - - - 0 0
Maximum Output
E1-04 40.0 - 590.0 *3 *4 0.1 Hz 60.0 *5 60.0 *5 60.0 60.0 60.0
Frequency
Maximum Output
E1-05 0.0 - 255.0 *6 0.1 V 200.0 *5 200.0 *5 200.0 200.0 200.0
Voltage
E1-06 Base Frequency 0.0 - 590.0 *4 0.1 Hz 60.0 *5 60.0 *5 60.0 60.0 60.0
Mid Point A
E1-07 0.0 - 590.0 *7 0.1 Hz 3.0 *5 3.0 *5 3.0 - 0.0
Frequency
Mid Point A
E1-08 0.0 - 255.0 *6 0.1 V 15.0 *5 15.0 *5 11.0 - 0.0
Voltage
E1-09 Minimum Output 0.0 - 590.0 *4 0.1 Hz 1.5 *5 1.5 *5 0.5 0.0 0.0
Frequency
E1-10 Minimum Output 0.0 - 255.0 *6 0.1 V 9.0 *5 9.0 *5 2.0 - 0.0
Voltage
Mid Point B
E1-11 Frequency 0.0 - 400.0 0.1 Hz 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
Mid Point A
E1-12 0.0 - 255.0 *6 0.1 V 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
Voltage
E1-13 Base Voltage 0.0 - 255.0 *6 0.1 V 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
Encoder 1 Pulse
F1-01 Count (PPR) 0 - 60000 1 ppr - 600 - 600 600
Encoder 1
F1-05 Rotation 0-1 1 - 0 - 0 0
Selection
Overspeed
F1-09 Detection Delay 0.0 - 2.0 0.1 s - 1.0 - 0.0 0.1
Time
Motor Overload
L1-01 0-6 1 2 2 2 2 2
(oL1) Protection
KEB Start
Parameter List
L2-31 Voltage Offset 0 - 100 *6 1V 0 0 0 0 0
Level
Stall Prevention
L3-05 0-3 1 2 2 - - -
during RUN
L3-20 DC Bus Voltage 0.00 - 5.00 0.01 1.00 1.00 0.30 0.30 0.30
Adjustment Gain
OVSuppression 3
L3-21 Accel/Decel P 0.10 - 10.00 0.01 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00
Gain
Current
L3-36 Suppression 0.0 - 100.0 0.1 10.0 10.0 20.0 - -
Gain@Accel
Speed Agree
L4-01 0.0 - 590.0 *4 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz
Detection Level
Speed Agree
L4-02 0.0 - 20.0 0.1 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz
Detection Width
Speed Agree
-590.0 - +590.0 *4
L4-03 Detection Level *8 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz 0.0 Hz
(+/-)
Speed Agree
L4-04 Detection Width 0.0 - 20.0 0.1 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz 2.0 Hz
(+/-)
Carrier Freq
L8-40 Reduction Off- 0.00 - 2.00 0.01 s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 -
Delay
STPo Detection
L8-90 Level (Low 0 - 5000 1 - - - - -
Speed)
PWM Voltage
n1-15 0-2 1 1 1 1 1 2
Offset Calibration
Speed Response
n5-04 0.00 - 500.00 0.01 Hz - - - 50.00 50.00
Frequency
Pull-in Current @
n8-51 Acceleration 0 - 200 1% - - - - -
Frequency
o1-03 Display Unit 0-3 1 0 0 0 0 0
Selection
V/f Pattern
o1-04 Display Unit 0-1 1 - - - 0 0
*1 The default setting changes when the setting for o2-04 [Drive Model Selection] changes.
*2 Models 2211 to 2415, 4103 to 4720, and T103 to T720 use these default settings when C6-01 = 1 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection =
Normal Duty Rating]. Models 2257 to 2415, 4140 to 4720, and T103 to T720 use these default settings when C6-01 = 0 [Heavy Duty
Rating].
• A1-02 = 2 [Open Loop Vector]: 2.00
• A1-02 = 3, 4 [Closed Loop Vector, Advanced Open Loop Vector]: 0.05
*3 The default setting changes when C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection] changes.
*4 The maximum value changes when A1-02 changes:
• When A1-02 = 0, 2 [V/f Control, Open Loop Vector], the maximum value is 590.0 Hz.
• When A1-02 = 1, 3 [V/f Control with Encoder, Closed Loop Vector], the maximum value is 400.0 Hz.
• When A1-02 = 4 [Advanced Open Loop Vector], the maximum value is 120.0 Hz.
*5 The default setting changes when the drive model and E1-03 [V/f Pattern Selection] change.
*6 This is the value for 200 V class drives. Double the value for 400 V class drives.
*7 The maximum value changes when A1-02 changes:
• When A1-02 = 0, 2 [V/f Control, Open Loop Vector], the maximum value is 590.0 Hz.
• When A1-02 = 1 [V/f Control with Encoder], the maximum value is 400.0 Hz.
• When A1-02 = 4 [Advanced Open Loop Vector], the maximum value is 120.0 Hz.
*8 The minimum value changes when A1-02 changes:
• When A1-02 = 0, 2 [V/f Control, Open Loop Vector], the minimum value is -590.0 Hz.
• When A1-02 = 1, 3 [V/f Control with Encoder, Closed Loop Vector], the minimum value is -400.0 Hz.
• When A1-02 = 4 [Advanced Open Loop Vector], the minimum value is -120.0 Hz.
DC Injection/Zero
b2-01 SpeedThreshold 0.0 - 10.0 0.1 0.5 Hz 1.0% 0.5% 0.5 Hz
SpeedSearch
b3-02 0 - 200 1% - - - -
Deactivation Current
b3-08 Speed Estimation ACR 0.00 - 6.00 0.01 0.30 0.30 - 0.60 *1
P Gain
Bi-directional Speed
b3-14 0-1 1 - - - 0
Search
b6-01 Dwell Reference at 0.0 - 400.0 *3 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0% 0.0% 0.0 Hz
Start
b6-03 Dwell Reference at Stop 0.0 - 400.0 *3 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0% 0.0% 0.0 Hz
Accel/Decel Time
C1-11 0.0 - 400.0 *3 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0% 0.0% 0.0 Hz
Switchover Freq
Slip Compensation
C3-02 Delay Time 0 - 10000 1 ms - - - 200
Torque Compensation
C4-01 0.00 - 2.50 0.01 0.00 - - 0.00
Gain
Torque Compensation
C4-02 0 - 60000 1 ms 100 - - 200
Delay Time
C5-01 ASR Proportional Gain 0.00 - 300.00 0.01 - 10.00 20.00 10.00
1
C5-02 ASR Integral Time 1 0.000 - 60.000 0.001 s - 0.500 0.500 0.500
C5-04 ASR Integral Time 2 0.000 - 60.000 0.001 s - 0.500 0.500 0.500
C5-06 ASR Delay Time 0.000 - 0.500 0.001 s - 0.016 0.004 0.004
Parameter List
Selection
d3-01 Jump Frequency 1 0.0 - 400.0 *3 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0% 0.0% 0.0 Hz
d3-02 Jump Frequency 2 0.0 - 400.0 *3 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0% 0.0% 0.0 Hz
d3-03 Jump Frequency 3 0.0 - 400.0 *3 0.1 0.0 Hz 0.0% 0.0% 0.0 Hz
d3-04 Jump Frequency Width 0.0 - 20.0 *4 0.1 1.0 Hz 1.0% 1.0% 1.0 Hz 3
Torque Reference Delay
d5-02 0 - 1000 1 ms - 0 0 -
Time
E1-04 Maximum Output 40.0 - 590.0 *5 *6 0.1 Hz Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 -
Frequency
Maximum Output
E1-05 Voltage 0.0 - 255.0 *7 0.1 V Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 -
E1-06 Base Frequency 0.0 - 590.0 *6 0.1 Hz Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 -
E1-09 Minimum Output 0.0 - 590.0 *6 0.1 Hz Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 Determined by E5-01 -
Frequency
Minimum Output
E1-10 Voltage 0.0 - 255.0 *7 0.1 V - - - -
Encoder 1 Rotation
F1-05 0-1 1 - - 1 -
Selection
L3-20 DC Bus Voltage 0.00 - 5.00 0.01 0.65 0.65 0.65 0.65
Adjustment Gain
OVSuppression Accel/
L3-21 Decel P Gain 0.10 - 10.00 0.01 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00
Current Suppression
L3-36 0.0 - 100.0 0.1 - - - -
Gain@Accel
L4-02 Speed Agree Detection 0.0 - 20.0 *4 0.1 2.0 Hz 4.0% 4.0% 2.0 Hz
Width
Carrier Frequency
L8-38 0-2 1 0 - 0 0
Reduction
Speed Response
n5-04 0.00 - 500.00 0.01 Hz - 20.00 50.00 -
Frequency
Parameter List
Motor 2 ASR
C5-21 Proportional Gain 1 (P) 0.00 - 300.00 0.01 - 0.20 - 20.00
Motor 2 ASR
C5-23 0.00 - 300.00 0.01 - 0.02 - 20.00
Proportional Gain 2 (P)
Motor 2 Maximum
E3-04 40.0 - 590.0 0.1 Hz 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0
Output Frequency
E3-06 Motor 2 Base Frequency 0.0 - 590.0 0.1 Hz 60.0 60.0 60.0 60.0
E3-09 Motor 2 Minimum Output 0.0 - 590.0 0.1 Hz 1.5 1.5 0.5 0.0
Frequency
0.0 - 255.0
E3-13 Motor 2 Base Voltage 0.1 V 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
*1
*1 This is the value for 200 V class drives. Double the value for 400 V class drives.
Unit - Hz V Hz Hz V Hz V
*1 This is the value for 200 V class drives. Double the value for 400 V class drives.
*2 These values are the default settings for E1-04 to E1-10 and E3-04 to E3-10 [V/f Pattern for Motor 2]. These settings are the same as
those for the V/f pattern when E1-03 = 1 [Const Trq, 60Hz base, 60Hz max].
*3 The default setting varies depending on the setting of E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection].
Parameter List
Table 3.2 Parameters Changed by E1-03: 2030 to 2211 (HD), 2021 to 2169 (ND), 4018 to 4103 (HD), 4012 to 4089 (ND), and
T103 (HD)
No. E1-03 E1-04 E1-05 *1 E1-06 E1-07 E1-08 *1 E1-09 E1-10 *1
Unit - Hz V Hz Hz V Hz V
*1 This is the value for 200 V class drives. Double the value for 400 V class drives.
*2 These values are the default settings for E1-04 to E1-10 and E3-04 to E3-10 [V/f Pattern for Motor 2]. These settings are the same as
those for the V/f pattern when E1-03 = 1 [Const Trq, 60Hz base, 60Hz max].
*3 The default setting varies depending on the setting of E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection].
Table 3.3 Parameters Changed by E1-03: 2257 to 2415 (HD), 2211 to 2415 (ND), 4140 to 4720 (HD), 4103 to 4720 (ND), and
T140 to T720 (HD), T103 to T720 (ND)
No. E1-03 E1-04 E1-05 *1 E1-06 E1-07 E1-08 *1 E1-09 E1-10 *1
Unit - Hz V Hz Hz V Hz V
*1 This is the value for 200 V class drives. Double the value for 400 V class drives.
*2 These values are the default settings for E1-04 to E1-10 and E3-04 to E3-10 [V/f Pattern for Motor 2]. These settings are the same as
those for the V/f pattern when E1-03 = 1 [Const Trq, 60Hz base, 60Hz max].
*3 The default setting varies depending on the setting of E5-01 [PM Motor Code Selection].
Parameter List
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0062 0063 0064 0065
Selection
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
Search
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 Current Level - 1 1 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 Filter Time s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 288.2 223.7 223.7 196.6 196.6 169.4 169.4 156.8
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.0015 0.0028 0.0028 0.0068 0.0068 0.0068 0.0068 0.0088
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 18.2 13.8 13.8 18.5 18.5 18.5 18.5 18.4
(E4-06) Inductance
E5-01 PM Motor - 1202 1202 1203 1203 FFFF FFFF 1205 1205
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.2 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 0.2 0.3 0.3 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.4 0.5
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0062 0063 0064 0065
Selection
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 190 190 190 190 190 190 190 190
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.178 0.142 0.142 0.142 0.142 0.166 0.166 0.145
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 115 115 115 115 115 115 115 115
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.178 0.142 0.142 0.142 0.142 0.166 0.166 0.145
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0066 0067 0068 006A
Selection
Parameter List
E2-11 Motor Rated
Power kW 2.2 3.0 3.0 3.7 3.7 5.5 5.5 7.5
(E4-11)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
Search
Speed
b3-06 Estimation
Current Level
- 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 3
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 Filter Time s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0066 0067 0068 006A
Selection
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 156.8 136.4 136.4 122.9 122.9 94.75 94.75 72.69
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.0088 0.0158 0.0158 0.0158 0.0158 0.0255 0.026 0.037
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 18.4 19 19 19.6 19.6 18.2 18.2 15.5
(E4-06) Inductance
E5-01 PM Motor - 1206 1206 FFFF FFFF 1208 1208 120A 120A
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 0.5 0.5 1 1 1 1 1 1
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.6 0.6 0.7 0.7 0.8
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 190 190 190 190 190 190 190 190
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.145 0.145 0.145 0.154 0.154 0.168 0.168 0.175
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 124 124 110 110 110 110 110 110
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Time Constant
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0066 0067 0068 006A
Selection
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.145 0.145 0.145 0.154 0.154 0.168 0.168 0.175
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 006B 006D 006E 006F
Selection
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
Search
Speed
b3-06 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
Current Level
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
b8-03 Energy Saving s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
Filter Time
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 72.69 70.44 70.44 63.13 63.13 57.87 57.87 51.79
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.037 0.053 0.053 0.076 0.076 0.138 0.138 0.165
(C5-37)
Parameter List
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 15.5 19.5 19.5 17.2 17.2 15.7 20.1 19.5
(E4-06) Inductance
E2-10 Motor Iron W 262 245 245 272 272 505 505 538
(E4-10) Loss
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 006B 006D 006E 006F
Selection
PM Motor
E5-01 - 120B 120B 120D 120D 120E 120E 120F 120F
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 0.8 0.9 0.9 1 1 1 1 1
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 190 190 190 190 190 190 190 190
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.175 0.265 0.265 0.244 0.244 0.317 0.317 0.355
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 Alarm Level °C 110 110 115 115 120 120 133 130
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.175 0.265 0.265 0.244 0.244 0.317 0.317 0.355
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0070 0072 0073 0074
Selection
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 80 80 80 80 80 80 80
Search
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
Current Level
1
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0070 0072 0073 0074
Selection
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 2.00
Filter Time
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 51.79 46.27 46.27 38.16 38.16 35.78 35.78 31.35
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.165 0.220 0.220 0.273 0.273 0.333 0.333 0.490
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-01 Motor Rated A 77.2 105 105 131 131 160 160 190
(E4-01) Current (FLA)
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 19.5 20.8 20.8 18.8 18.8 20.2 20.2 20.5
(E4-06) Inductance
E2-10 Motor Iron W 538 699 699 823 823 852 852 960
(E4-10) Loss
PM Motor
E5-01 - 1210 1210 1212 1212 1213 1213 1214 1214
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 1 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.2 1.2 1.3
Time
Parameter List
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 1 1 1
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 190 190 190 190 190 190 190 190
(Uv1)
L3-24
Motor Accel
Time @ Rated s 0.355 0.323 0.323 0.32 0.32 0.387 0.387 0.317
3
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 Alarm Level °C 105 105 115 115 105 105 105 105
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0070 0072 0073 0074
Selection
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.355 0.323 0.323 0.32 0.32 0.387 0.387 0.317
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0075 0076 0077 0078
Selection
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 80 80 80 80 80 80 80 80
Search
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 Current Level - 0.5 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 s 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00
Filter Time
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 31.35 23.1 23.1 20.65 20.65 18.12 18.12 18.12
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.49 0.90 0.90 1.10 1.10 1.90 1.90 1.90
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0075 0076 0077 0078
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 20.5 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
(E4-06) Inductance
E5-01 PM Motor - 1215 1215 1216 1216 FFFF FFFF FFFF FFFF
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.7 1.7 1.7
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 190 190 190 190 190 190 190 190
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.317 0.533 0.533 0.592 0.592 0.646 0.646 0.646
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 105 105 105 105 105 105 105 105
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 100 100 100 100
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00
Parameter List
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.317 0.533 0.533 0.592 0.592 0.646 0.646 0.646
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0092 0093 0094 0095
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 0.75 1 1 2 2 3 3 4
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (0.4) (0.75) (1.1) (1.5) (1.5) (2.2) (2.2) (3.0)
02)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
Search
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 Current Level - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 Filter Time s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 576.4 447.4 447.4 338.8 338.8 313.6 313.6 265.7
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.0015 0.0028 0.0028 0.0068 0.0068 0.0088 0.0088 0.0158
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 18.2 14.3 14.3 18.3 18.3 18.7 18.7 19
(E4-06) Inductance
E5-01 PM Motor - 1232 1232 1233 1233 1235 1235 1236 1236
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 0.1 0.1 0.2 0.2 0.3 0.3 0.5 0.5
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 0.2 0.3 0.3 0.4 0.4 0.5 0.5 0.5
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0092 0093 0094 0095
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 0.75 1 1 2 2 3 3 4
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (0.4) (0.75) (1.1) (1.5) (1.5) (2.2) (2.2) (3.0)
02)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.178 0.142 0.142 0.166 0.166 0.145 0.145 0.145
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 100 100 105 105 112 112 100 100
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.178 0.142 0.142 0.166 0.166 0.145 0.145 0.145
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0096 0097 0099 009A
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 4 5 5 7.5 7.5 10 10 15
(E4-11, E5- Power
02) (kW) (3.0) (4.0) (4.0) (5.5) (5.5) (7.5) (7.5) (11)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
Search
Parameter List
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
Current Level
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain 3
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
Filter Time
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 265.7 245.8 245.8 189.5 189.5 145.38 145.38 140.88
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.0158 0.0158 0.0158 0.0255 0.026 0.037 0.037 0.053
(C5-37)
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 0096 0097 0099 009A
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 4 5 5 7.5 7.5 10 10 15
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (3.0) (4.0) (4.0) (5.5) (5.5) (7.5) (7.5) (11)
02)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 19 19.3 19.3 18.2 18.2 15.5 15.5 19.6
(E4-06) Inductance
E2-10 Motor Iron W 105 130 130 193 193 263 263 385
(E4-10) Loss
PM Motor
E5-01 - FFFF FFFF 1238 1238 123A 123A 123B 123B
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.8 0.8 1 1
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 0.5 0.6 0.6 0.7 0.7 0.8 0.8 0.9
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3 0.3
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.145 0.154 0.154 0.168 0.168 0.175 0.175 0.265
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 Alarm Level °C 100 100 100 100 105 105 105 105
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.145 0.154 0.154 0.168 0.168 0.175 0.175 0.265
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 009C 009D 009E 009F
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 15 20 20 25 25 30 30 40
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (11) (15) (15) (18.5) (18.5) (22) (22) (30)
02)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
Search
Speed
b3-06 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
Current Level
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 Filter Time s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 140.88 126.26 126.26 115.74 115.74 103.58 103.58 92.54
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.053 0.076 0.076 0.138 0.138 0.165 0.165 0.220
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 19.6 17.2 17.2 20.1 20.1 23.5 23.5 20.7
(E4-06) Inductance
PM Motor
Parameter List
E5-01 - 123D 123D 123E 123E 123F 123F 1240 1240
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 0.9 1 1 1 1 1 1 1.1
Time 3
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.3 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.265 0.244 0.244 0.317 0.317 0.355 0.355 0.323
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 115 115 120 120 120 120 130 137
Alarm Level
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 009C 009D 009E 009F
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 15 20 20 25 25 30 30 40
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (11) (15) (15) (18.5) (18.5) (22) (22) (30)
02)
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 10 10
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.265 0.244 0.244 0.317 0.317 0.355 0.355 0.323
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 00A1 00A2 00A3 00A4
Selection
E2-11 HP 40 50 50 60 60 75 75 100
Motor Rated
(E4-11, E5- Power
02) (kW) (30) (37) (37) (45) (45) (55) (55) (75)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 100 100 100 100 80 80 60
Search
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.7
Current Level
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.8
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 s 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 2.00 2.00 2.00
Filter Time
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 92.54 76.32 76.32 71.56 71.56 67.2 67.2 46.2
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.220 0.273 0.273 0.333 0.333 0.490 0.49 0.90
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 00A1 00A2 00A3 00A4
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 40 50 50 60 60 75 75 100
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (30) (37) (37) (45) (45) (55) (55) (75)
02)
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 20.7 18.8 18.8 19.9 19.9 20 20 20
(E4-06) Inductance
E2-10 Motor Iron W 750 925 925 1125 1125 1260 1260 1600
(E4-10) Loss
PM Motor
E5-01 - 1242 1242 1243 1243 1244 1244 1245 1245
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.2 1.2 1.2 1.2 1.3
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 0.6 1 1 1
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.323 0.32 0.32 0.387 0.387 0.317 0.317 0.533
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 120 120 115 115 126 120 120 120
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Parameter List
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 10 10 10 10 30 30
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain 3
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.323 0.32 0.32 0.387 0.387 0.317 0.317 0.533
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 00A5 00A6 00A7 00A8
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 100 125 125 150 150 200 200 250
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (75) (90) (90) (110) (110) (150) (150) (185)
02)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
Search
Speed
b3-06 Estimation - 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7
Current Level
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 Filter Time s 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 46.2 38.91 38.91 36.23 36.23 32.79 32.79 30.13
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.90 1.10 1.10 1.90 1.90 2.10 2.10 3.30
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
(E4-06) Inductance
E5-01 PM Motor - 1246 1246 1247 1247 1248 1248 1249 1249
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.7 1.7 1.7 1.7 1.8
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.533 0.592 0.592 0.646 0.646 0.673 0.673 0.777
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 110 110 105 105 120 120 120 120
Alarm Level
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 00A5 00A6 00A7 00A8
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 100 125 125 150 150 200 200 250
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (75) (90) (90) (110) (110) (150) (150) (185)
02)
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.533 0.592 0.592 0.646 0.646 0.673 0.673 0.777
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 00A9 00AA 00AC 00AD
Selection
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
Search
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 - 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7
Current Level
1
Speed
Parameter List
b3-08 Estimation - 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 s 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00
Filter Time 3
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 30.13 30.57 30.57 27.13 27.13 21.76 21.76 21.76
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 3.30 3.60 3.60 4.10 4.10 6.50 6.50 11.00
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-01 Motor Rated A 270 310 310 370 370 500 500 500
(E4-01) Current (FLA)
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 00A9 00AA 00AC 00AD
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 250 300 300 350 350 400 400 450
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (185) (220) (220) (260) (260) (300) (300) (335)
02)
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
(E4-06) Inductance
E2-10 Motor Iron W 2850 3200 3200 3700 3700 4700 4700 4700
(E4-10) Loss
PM Motor
E5-01 - 124A 124A 124A 124A 124A 124A 124A 124A
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 1.8 1.9 1.9 2 2 2.1 2.1 2.1
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 1 1 1.8 1.8 1.8 2 2 2
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.777 0.864 0.864 0.91 0.91 1.392 1.392 1.392
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 125 125 125 125 110 110 125 115
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 30 30 100 100 100 100 100 100
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.777 0.864 0.864 0.91 0.91 1.392 1.392 1.392
Time
HD ND HD ND
Normal / Heavy Duty
C6-01 -
Selection
0 1 0 1
Speed Estimation
b3-06 Current Level 1 - 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7
Direction Determination
b3-26 - 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 11.00 12.00 11.00 12.00
(C5-37)
Carrier Frequency
C6-02 - 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-02
Motor Rated Slip Hz 1.25 1 1.25 1
(E4-02)
E2-03
Motor No-Load Current A 130 130 130 130
(E4-03)
E2-10
Motor Iron Loss W 4700 5560 4700 5560
(E4-10)
PM Motor Code
E5-01 - FFFF FFFF FFFF FFFF
Selection
Parameter List
Undervoltage Detection
L2-05 - 380 380 380 380
Lvl (Uv1)
Carrier Frequency
L8-38 - 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting Prevention
n1-01 - 2 2 2 2
Selection
HD ND HD ND
Normal / Heavy Duty
C6-01 -
Selection
0 1 0 1
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration Time s 1.392 1.667 1.392 1.667
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 01A3 01A4 01A5 01A6
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 60 75 75 100 100 125 125 150
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (45) (55) (55) (75) (75) (90) (90) (110)
02)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 100 80 80 60 60 60 60 60
Search
Speed
b3-06 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7
Current Level
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
b8-03 Energy Saving s 0.50 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00
Filter Time
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 71.56 67.2 67.2 46.2 46.2 38.91 38.91 36.23
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 0.333 0.490 0.49 0.90 0.90 1.10 1.10 1.90
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 19.9 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
(E4-06) Inductance
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 01A3 01A4 01A5 01A6
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 60 75 75 100 100 125 125 150
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (45) (55) (55) (75) (75) (90) (90) (110)
02)
E5-01 PM Motor - 1244 1244 1245 1245 1246 1246 1247 1247
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 1.2 1.2 1.2 1.3 1.3 1.5 1.5 1.7
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 0.6 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.387 0.317 0.317 0.533 0.533 0.592 0.592 0.646
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 126 120 120 120 110 110 105 105
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 10 10 30 30 30 30 30 30
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.387 0.317 0.317 0.533 0.533 0.592 0.592 0.646
Time
Parameter List
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 01A7 01A8 01A9 01AA
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 150 200 200 250 250 300 300 350
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (110) (150) (150) (185) (185) (220) (220) (260)
02)
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
Search
Speed
b3-06 Estimation - 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7
Current Level
1
Speed
b3-08 Estimation - 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 Filter Time s 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 36.23 32.79 32.79 30.13 30.13 30.57 30.57 27.13
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 1.90 2.10 2.10 3.30 3.30 3.60 3.60 4.10
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
(E4-06) Inductance
E5-01 PM Motor - 1248 1248 1249 1249 124A 124A 124A 124A
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 1.7 1.7 1.7 1.8 1.8 1.9 1.9 2
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 1 1 1 1 1 1 1.8 1.8
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.646 0.673 0.673 0.777 0.777 0.864 0.864 0.91
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 120 120 120 120 125 125 125 125
Alarm Level
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 01A7 01A8 01A9 01AA
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 150 200 200 250 250 300 300 350
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (110) (150) (150) (185) (185) (220) (220) (260)
02)
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 30 30 30 30 30 30 100 100
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.646 0.673 0.673 0.777 0.777 0.864 0.864 0.91
Time
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 01AC 01AD 01AE 01AF
Selection
V/f Gain
b3-04 during Speed % 60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
Search
Speed
Estimation
b3-06 - 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7 0.7
Current Level
1
Speed
Parameter List
b3-08 Estimation - 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8 0.8
ACR P Gain
Direction
b3-26 Determination - 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000 1000
Level
Energy Saving
b8-03 s 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00 2.00
Filter Time 3
Energy Saving
b8-04 Coefficient - 27.13 21.76 21.76 21.76 21.76 23.84 21.76 23.84
Value
C5-17
Motor Inertia kgm2 4.10 6.50 6.50 11.00 11.00 12.00 11.00 12.00
(C5-37)
Carrier
C6-02 Frequency - 1 7 1 7 1 7 1 7
Selection
E2-01 Motor Rated A 370 500 500 500 500 650 500 650
(E4-01) Current (FLA)
Normal / HD ND HD ND HD ND HD ND
C6-01 Heavy Duty -
Selection 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
Drive Model
o2-04 (KVA) Hex. 01AC 01AD 01AE 01AF
Selection
E2-11
Motor Rated HP 350 400 400 450 450 500 500 600
(E4-11, E5- Power (kW) (260) (300) (300) (335) (335) (370) (370) (450)
02)
E2-06 Motor
Leakage % 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
(E4-06) Inductance
E2-10 Motor Iron W 3700 4700 4700 4700 4700 5560 4700 5560
(E4-10) Loss
PM Motor
E5-01 - 124A 124A 124A 124A FFFF FFFF FFFF FFFF
Code Selection
Power Loss
L2-02 Ride Through s 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Time
Minimum
L2-03 Baseblock s 2 2.1 2.1 2.1 2.1 2.3 2.1 2.3
Time
Powerloss V/f
L2-04 Recovery s 1.8 2 2 2 2 2.2 2 2.2
Ramp Time
Undervoltage
L2-05 Detection Lvl - 380 380 380 380 380 380 380 380
(Uv1)
Motor Accel
L3-24 Time @ Rated s 0.91 1.392 1.392 1.392 1.392 1.667 1.392 1.667
Torque
Overheat
L8-02 °C 110 110 125 115 133 133 125 125
Alarm Level
Output Ground
L8-09 Fault - 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Detection
Carrier
L8-38 Frequency - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Reduction
Hunting
n1-01 Prevention - 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2
Selection
Hunting
n1-03 Prevention ms 100 100 100 100 100 100 100 100
Time Constant
Hunting
n1-16 Prevention - 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50 0.50
High Fc Gain
Motor Inertia
n5-02 Acceleration s 0.91 1.392 1.392 1.392 1.392 1.667 1.392 1.667
Time
CAUTION
Crush Hazard
Tighten terminal cover screws and hold the case safely when you move the drive.
If the drive or covers fall, it can cause moderate injury.
NOTICE
Do not let unwanted objects, for example metal shavings or wire clippings, fall into the drive during
drive installation. Put a temporary cover over the drive during installation. Remove the temporary
cover before start-up.
Unwanted objects inside of the drive can cause damage to the drive.
Damage to Equipment
When you touch the drive and circuit boards, make sure that you observe correct electrostatic
discharge (ESD) procedures.
If you do not follow procedures, it can cause ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
NOTICE
Install vibration-proof rubber on the base of the motor or use the frequency jump function in the
drive to prevent specific frequencies that vibrate the motor.
Motor or system resonant vibration can occur in fixed speed machines that are converted to variable speed. Too
much vibration can cause damage to equipment.
You can use the drive with an explosion-proof motor, but the drive is not explosion-proof. Install
the drive only in the environment shown on the nameplate.
If you install the drive in a dangerous environment, it can cause damage to the drive.
Do not lift the drive with the covers removed.
If the drive does not have covers, you can easily cause damage to the internal parts of the drive.
Mechanical Installation
95%RH or less
Humidity
Do not let condensation form on the drive.
Storage Temperature -20 °C to +70 °C (-4 °F to +158 °F) (short-term temperature during transportation)
Installation Orientation Install the drive vertically for sufficient airflow to cool the drive.
NOTICE: Do not let unwanted objects, for example metal shavings or wire clippings, fall into the drive during drive installation. Put a
temporary cover over the drive during installation. Remove the temporary cover before start-up. Unwanted objects inside of the
drive can cause damage to the drive.
Note:
Do not put drive peripheral devices, transformers, or other electronics near the drive. Shield the drive from electrical interference if
components must be near the drive. Electrical interference can cause the drive or devices around the drive to function incorrectly.
Mechanical Installation
You can install drive models 2004xB to 2082xB and 4002xB to 4044xB side-by-side.
When you install other drives side-by-side, make sure that you keep the necessary clearances between the drives for
single drive installation.
The installation clearances shown in Figure 4.3 are necessary for side-by-side installation. Set L8-35 = 1 [Installation
Method Selection = Side-by-Side Mounting].
Derate the output current to align with the ambient temperature. Refer to Derating Depending on Ambient
Temperature on page 531 for more information.
4
Figure 4.3 Installation Clearances for More than One Drive (Side-by-Side)
Note:
• Align the tops of drives that have different dimensions to help when you replace cooling fans.
• Remove the top protective covers of all drives when you mount IP20/UL Type 1 drives side-by-side.
Refer to Using the Hanging Brackets to Move the Drive on page 311 for information about how to use suspension
systems, wires, or hanging metal brackets to move the drive.
2110 - 2415
Vertical Suspension
4075 - 4720, T103 - T720
2138 - 2415
Allows horizontal suspension
4089 - 4720, T103 - T720
■ Vertical Suspension
To vertically suspend the drive with the hanging brackets, lift the drive with this procedure:
Mechanical Installation
■ Horizontal Suspension
If a horizontal suspension is required in the installation environment, hang the drive through the following steps.
Put the drive on the ground horizontally. Connect wires to the 4 hanging brackets and use a crane to lift the drive.
NOTICE: When you attach a horizontal lifting cable or chain to the drive, use a jig or pad between the wire and the drive. The wire
can scratch the drive and cause damage to the drive.
2004 3.5 8 35 19 54
2006 5 8 37 26 63
2008 6.9 8 40 36 76
2010 8 8 44 43 87
2012 11 8 50 61 111
2018 14 8 47 82 129
2004 4.2 2 35 18 53
2006 6 2 38 25 63
2008 8 2 42 34 76
2010 9.6 2 49 46 95
Mechanical Installation
2012 12.2 2 56 62 118
The rated output current Carrier Frequency Interior Unit Loss Cooling Fin Loss Total Loss
Model
A kHz W W W
◆ 400 V Class
Table 4.3 Drive Watt Loss (Heavy Duty)
The rated output current Carrier Frequency Interior Unit Loss Cooling Fin Loss Total Loss
Model
A kHz W W W
4002 1.8 8 38 15 53
4004 3.4 8 42 28 70
4005 4.8 8 46 37 83
4007 5.5 8 48 45 93
4009 7.2 8 37 61 98
4002 2.1 2 39 16 55
4004 4.1 2 44 33 77
4005 5.4 2 48 31 79
4007 7.1 2 52 44 96
The rated output current Carrier Frequency Interior Unit Loss Cooling Fin Loss Total Loss
Model
A kHz W W W
Mechanical Installation
T302 260 5 616 1985 2601
Mechanical Installation
Installation Support Set A 900-192-933-001 To attach the keypad to the control panel. This option uses screws.
To attach the keypad to the control panel. This option uses nut clamps.
Installation Support Set B 900-192-933-002
Use this option when weld studs are located in the control panel.
Note:
Installation support sets are sold separately. If there are weld studs inside the control panel, use installation support set B. Contact Yaskawa
or your nearest sales representative to make an order.
NOTICE: Do not let unwanted objects, for example metal shavings or wire clippings, fall into the drive during drive installation. Put a
temporary cover over the drive during installation. Remove the temporary cover before start-up. Unwanted objects inside of the
drive can cause damage to the drive.
22 78 22 29 22 1 3.6
(0.89) (3.07) (0.89) (1.14) (0.89) (0.04) (0.14)
2. Remove the keypad and put the keypad connector in the holder on the front cover.
Note:
Insert the end of the keypad connector that has the tab.
A - Keypad C - Holder
B - Keypad connector
Mechanical Installation
Figure 4.12 Remove the Keypad
3. Put the keypad on the outside of the control panel.
Use M3 screws (6 mm (0.2 in) depth cross-recessed pan head screws) to attach the keypad from the inside.
Tighten the screws to a correct tightening torque:
• M3 screws: 0.49 N∙m to 0.73 N∙m (4.34 in∙lb to 6.46 in∙lb)
1. Use the panel cut-out dimensions in Figure 4.15 and Table 4.10 to cut an opening in the control panel for the
keypad.
2. Remove the keypad and put the keypad connector in the holder on the front cover.
Note:
Insert the end of the keypad connector that has the tab.
A - Keypad C - Holder
B - Keypad connector
Figure 4.16 Remove the Keypad
3. Use the screws included with the mounting bracket, and attach the keypad to the mounting bracket.
Use the screws included with the installation support set to attach it. Tighten the screws to a correct tightening
torque:
• M3 screws: 0.49 N∙m to 0.73 N∙m (4.34 in∙lb to 6.46 in∙lb)
Mechanical Installation
A - Keypad C - M3 screws
B - Mounting bracket A D - Screw mounting holes
Figure 4.17 Attach Keypad to Mounting Bracket
4. Put the mounting bracket that has the attached keypad in the control panel, and use the screws to attach it
from the outside.
Use the screws included with the installation support set to attach it. Tighten the screws to a correct tightening
torque:
• M4 screws: 0.98 N∙m to 1.33 N∙m (8.67 in∙lb to 11.77 in∙lb)
Figure 4.18 Mount Mounting Bracket to the Interior of the Control Panel
Figure 4.19 Connecting the Drive and Keypad with the Extension Cable
Mechanical Installation
2004 - 2211
Procedure A 324
4002 - 4168, T103 - T168
2257 - 2415
Procedure B 325
4208 - 4720, T208 - T720
A - Keypad C - Holder
B - Keypad connector
Figure 4.20 Remove the Keypad and Keypad Connector
2. Loosen the front cover screws.
3. Push on the tab in the side of the front cover then pull the front cover forward to remove it from the drive.
Mechanical Installation
Figure 4.24 Remove the Terminal Cover, Keypad, and Keypad Connector
2. Loosen the front cover screws.
A - Pull forward to remove the front cover. B - Unhook the tabs found on the sides of the front
cover.
Figure 4.26 Pull Forward to Remove the Front Cover
4. Remove the front cover from the drive.
1. Move the front cover to connect the hooks at the top of the front cover to the drive.
A - Hooks
Mechanical Installation
4
Figure 4.30 Loosen the Terminal Cover Mounting Screws
2056
900-192-121-002
4031, 4038
2070
900-192-121-003
4044, 4060
2082 900-192-121-004
2110
900-192-121-005
4075
2138
900-192-121-006
4089, 4103
2169
900-192-121-007
4140, 4168
2211 900-192-121-008
2257, 2313
900-192-121-009
4208, 4250, 4302
Mechanical Installation
◆ Standard Installation
Refer to Drive Exterior and Mounting Dimensions on page 534 for more information about external dimensions and
installation methods.
◆ External Heatsink
Refer to Table 4.14, Table 4.15, and Table 4.16 for the panel cut-out dimensions for external heatsink installations. An
attachment is necessary to install drive models smaller than 2082 (200 V class) and 4060 (400 V class) with the
heatsink outside of the panel.
Note:
• The exterior mounting dimensions and installation dimensions for a standard installation are different than the dimensions for an external
heatsink installation.
• The shaded parts of the panel cut-out dimensions are the gasket dimensions. Make sure that the gasket is not smaller than the specified
dimension.
Table 4.13 External Heatsink Attachment
Drive Model Model
2004 - 2042
900-193-209-001
4002 - 4023
2056
900-193-209-002
4031, 4038
2070, 2082
900-193-209-003
4044, 4060
2110 - 2415
4075 - 4720 -
T103 - T720
Mechanical Installation
Figure 4.33 Panel Cut-Out Dimensions
Table 4.14 Panel Cut-Out Dimensions (200 V Class)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
W H D1 D2 W1 W2 W3 W4 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 A B d1 4
140 294 138 38 102 102 16 3 282 23 6 26 6 134 233
2004 *1 M5
(5.51) (11.57) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (0.63) (0.12) (11.10) (0.91) (0.24) (1.02) (0.24) (5.28) (9.17)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
W H D1 D2 W1 W2 W3 W4 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 A B d1
180 329 134 68 140 140 17 3 318 23.5 5 24.5 6 174 270
2056 *1 M5
(7.09) (12.95) (5.28) (2.68) (5.51) (5.51) (0.67) (0.12) (12.52) (0.93) (0.20) (0.97) (0.24) (6.85) (10.63)
240 400 166 114 195 204 14.5 8 385 19.5 7.5 19.5 7.5 224 346
2110 M6
(9.45) (15.75) (6.54) (4.49) (7.68) (8.03) (0.57) (0.32) (15.16) (0.77) (0.30) (0.77) (0.30) (8.82) (13.62)
255 450 166 114 170 210 34.5 8 436 20 8 20 6 239 396
2138 M6
(10.04) (17.72) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (8.27) (1.36) (0.32) (17.17) (0.79) (0.32) (0.79) (0.24) (9.41) (15.59)
264 543 186 149 190 220 29 8 527 19.5 8.5 20.5 7.5 248 487
2169 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (8.66) (1.14) (0.32) (20.75) (0.77) (0.34) (0.81) (0.30) (9.76) (19.17)
264 543 186 149 190 220 29 8 527 19.5 8.5 20.5 7.5 248 487
2211 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (8.66) (1.14) (0.32) (20.75) (0.77) (0.34) (0.81) (0.30) (9.76) (19.17)
440 800 254 218 370 310 23 12 773 31.5 14 31.5 13 416 710
2360 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (12.20) (0.91) (0.47) (30.43) (1.24) (0.55) (1.24) (0.51) (16.38) (27.95)
440 800 254 218 370 310 23 12 773 31.5 14 31.5 13 416 710
2415 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (12.20) (0.91) (0.47) (30.43) (1.24) (0.55) (1.24) (0.51) (16.38) (27.95)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
W H D1 D2 W1 W2 W3 W4 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 A B d1
180 329 134 68 140 140 17 3 318 23.5 5 24.5 6 174 270
4031 *1 M5
(7.09) (12.95) (5.28) (2.68) (5.51) (5.51) (0.67) (0.12) (12.52) (0.93) (0.20) (0.97) (0.24) (6.85) (10.63)
180 329 134 68 140 140 17 3 318 23.5 5 24.5 6 174 270
4038 *1 M5
(7.09) (12.95) (5.28) (2.68) (5.51) (5.51) (0.67) (0.12) (12.52) (0.93) (0.20) (0.97) (0.24) (6.85) (10.63)
240 400 166 114 195 204 14.5 8 385 19.5 7.5 19.5 7.5 224 346
4075 M6
(9.45) (15.75) (6.54) (4.49) (7.68) (8.03) (0.57) (0.32) (15.16) (0.77) (0.30) (0.77) (0.30) (8.82) (13.62)
255 450 166 114 170 210 34.5 8 436 20 8 20 6 239 396
4089 M6
(10.04) (17.72) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (8.27) (1.36) (0.32) (17.17) (0.79) (0.32) (0.79) (0.24) (9.41) (15.59)
4103 255 450 166 114 170 210 34.5 8 436 20 8 20 6 239 396
M6
T103 (10.04) (17.72) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (8.27) (1.36) (0.32) (17.17) (0.79) (0.32) (0.79) (0.24) (9.41) (15.59)
4140 264 543 186 149 190 220 29 8 527 19.5 8.5 20.5 7.5 248 487
M8
T140 (10.39) (21.38) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (8.66) (1.14) (0.32) (20.75) (0.77) (0.34) (0.81) (0.30) (9.76) (19.17)
4168 264 543 186 149 190 220 29 8 527 19.5 8.5 20.5 7.5 248 487
M8
T168 (10.39) (21.38) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (8.66) (1.14) (0.32) (20.75) (0.77) (0.34) (0.81) (0.30) (9.76) (19.17)
4208 312 700 260 160 218 263 39 8 675 33 12 32 13 296 610
M10
T208 (12.28) (27.56) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (10.35) (1.54) (0.32) (26.56) (1.30) (0.47) (1.26) (0.51) (11.65) (24.02)
4250 312 700 260 160 218 263 39 8 675 33 12 32 13 296 610
M10
T250 (12.28) (27.56) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (10.35) (1.54) (0.32) (26.56) (1.30) (0.47) (1.26) (0.51) (11.65) (24.02)
4302 312 700 260 160 218 263 39 8 675 33 12 32 13 296 610
M10
T302 (12.28) (27.56) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (10.35) (1.54) (0.32) (26.56) (1.30) (0.47) (1.26) (0.51) (11.65) (24.02)
4371 440 800 254 218 370 310 23 12 773 31.5 14 31.5 13 416 710
M12
T371 (17.32) (31.50) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (12.20) (0.91) (0.47) (30.43) (1.24) (0.55) (1.24) (0.51) (16.38) (27.95)
4414 440 800 254 218 370 310 23 12 773 31.5 14 31.5 13 416 710
M12
T414 (17.32) (31.50) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (12.20) (0.91) (0.47) (30.43) (1.24) (0.55) (1.24) (0.51) (16.38) (27.95)
Mechanical Installation
4477 510 1136 260 220 450 404 18 12 179 225 1110 34 15 34 15 486 1042
M12
T477 (20.08) (44.72) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (15.91) (0.71) (0.47) (7.05) (8.86) (43.70) (1.34) (0.59) (1.34) (0.59) (19.13) (41.02)
4568 510 1136 260 220 450 404 18 12 179 225 1110 34 15 34 15 486 1042
M12
T568 (20.08) (44.72) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (15.91) (0.71) (0.47) (7.05) (8.86) (43.70) (1.34) (0.59) (1.34) (0.59) (19.13) (41.02)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
W H D1 D2 W1 W2 W3 W4 W5 W6 H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 A B d1
4605 510 1136 260 220 450 404 18 12 179 225 1110 34 15 34 15 486 1042
M12
T605 (20.08) (44.72) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (15.91) (0.71) (0.47) (7.05) (8.86) (43.70) (1.34) (0.59) (1.34) (0.59) (19.13) (41.02)
4720 510 1136 260 220 450 404 18 12 179 225 1110 34 15 34 15 486 1042
M12
T720 (20.08) (44.72) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (15.91) (0.71) (0.47) (7.05) (8.86) (43.70) (1.34) (0.59) (1.34) (0.59) (19.13) (41.02)
Mechanical Installation
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate the drive when covers are missing. Replace covers and shields before you operate
the drive. Use the drive only as specified by the instructions.
Some figures in this section include drives without covers or safety shields to more clearly show the inside of the
drive. If covers or safety shields are missing from the drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
Ground the neutral point on the power supply of drive models 2xxxB/C and 4xxxB/C to comply with
the EMC Directive before you turn on the EMC filter.
If you turn ON the EMC filter, but you do not ground the neutral point, it can cause serious injury or death.
Make sure that the protective ground wire complies with technical standards and local safety
regulations. The IEC/EN 61800-5-1:2007 standard specifies that you must wire the power supply to
automatically de-energize when the protective ground wire disconnects. You can also connect a
protective ground wire that has a minimum cross-sectional area of 10mm2 (copper wire) or 16 mm2
(aluminum wire). The leakage current of the drive will be more than 3.5 mA in drive models;
• 2xxxB
• 2xxxC
• 4002B to 4371B
• 4002C to 4371C (with built-in EMC filter turned ON)
• 4414 to 4720
• T414 to T720
If you do not obey the standards and regulations, it can cause serious injury or death.
When there is a DC component in the protective earthing conductor, the drive can cause a residual
current. When a residual current operated protective or monitoring device prevents direct or
indirect contact, always use a type B Ground Fault Circuit Interrupter (GFCI) as specified by IEC/EN
60755.
If you do not use the correct GFCI, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not wear loose clothing or jewelry when you do work on the drive. Tighten loose clothing and
remove all metal objects, for example watches or rings.
Loose clothing can catch on the drive and jewelry can conduct electricity and cause serious injury or death.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the drive is energized.
If you touch the internal components of an energized drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
Only let approved personnel install, wire, maintain, examine, replace parts, and repair the drive.
If personnel are not approved, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not modify the drive body or drive circuitry.
Modifications to drive body and circuitry can cause serious injury or death, will cause damage to the drive, and will
void the warranty. Yaskawa is not responsible for modifications of the product made by the user.
WARNING
Fire Hazard
Tighten all terminal screws to the correct tightening torque.
Connections that are too loose or too tight can cause incorrect operation and damage to the drive. Incorrect
connections can also cause death or serious injury from fire.
Tighten screws at an angle in the specified range shown in this manual.
If you tighten the screws at an angle not in the specified range, you can have loose connections that can cause
damage to the terminal block or start a fire and cause serious injury or death.
Damage to Equipment
Do not apply incorrect voltage to the main circuit of the drive. Operate the drive in the specified
range of the input voltage on the drive nameplate.
Voltages that are higher than the permitted nameplate tolerance can cause damage to the drive.
Fire Hazard
When you install a dynamic braking option, wire the components as specified by the wiring
diagrams.
Incorrect wiring can cause damage to braking components or serious injury or death.
NOTICE
Do not let unwanted objects, for example metal shavings or wire clippings, fall into the drive during
drive installation. Put a temporary cover over the drive during installation. Remove the temporary
cover before start-up.
Unwanted objects inside of the drive can cause damage to the drive.
Damage to Equipment
When you touch the drive and circuit boards, make sure that you observe correct electrostatic
discharge (ESD) procedures.
If you do not follow procedures, it can cause ESD damage to the drive circuitry.
Select a motor that is compatible with the load torque and speed range. When 100% continuous
torque is necessary at low speed, use an inverter-duty motor or vector-duty motor. When you use a
standard fan-cooled motor, decrease the motor torque in the low-speed range.
If you operate a standard fan-cooled motor at low speed and high torque, it will decrease the cooling effects and can
cause heat damage.
Obey the speed range specification of the motor as specified by the manufacturer. When you must
operate the motor outside of its specifications, contact the motor manufacturer.
If you continuously operate oil-lubricated motors outside of the manufacturer specifications, it can cause damage to
the motor bearings.
When the input voltage is 440 V or higher or the wiring distance is longer than 100 m (328 ft), make
sure that the motor insulation voltage is sufficient or use an inverter-duty motor or vector-duty
motor with reinforced insulation.
Electrical Installation
Motor winding and insulation failure can occur.
Before you connect a dynamic braking option to the drive, make sure that qualified personnel read
and obey the Braking Unit and Braking Resistor Unit Installation Manual (TOBPC72060001).
If you do not read and obey the manual or if personnel are not qualified, it can cause damage to the drive and braking
circuit.
Make sure that all connections are correct after you install the drive and connect peripheral
devices. 5
Incorrect connections can cause damage to the drive.
Note:
• Torque characteristics are different than when you operate the motor directly from line power. Make sure that you understand the load
torque characteristics for the application.
• The current rating of submersible motors is usually higher than the current rating of standard motors for a given motor power. Make sure
that the rated output current of the drive is equal to or more than the current rating of the motor. If the motor wire length is longer than 100
m (328 ft), select the correct wire gauge to adjust for a loss in voltage and prevent a loss of motor torque.
• Do not use unshielded wire for control wiring. Use shielded, twisted-pair wires and ground the shield to the ground terminal of the drive.
Unshielded wire can cause electrical interference and unsatisfactory system performance.
Electrical Installation
*2 When you install a DC link choke, you must remove the jumper between terminals +1 and +2. Ground the DC link choke (option) on the
back of the mounting base. Remove all paint from the mounting surface of the control panel.
*3 Models 2110 to 2415 and 4060 to 4720 have a DC link choke.
*4 When you use a regenerative converter, regenerative unit, or braking unit, set L8-55 = 0 [Internal DB TransistorProtection = Disable]. If
L8-55 = 1 [Protection Enabled], the drive will detect rF [Braking Resistor Fault].
*5 When you use a regenerative converter, regenerative unit, braking unit, braking resistor, or braking resistor unit, set L3-04 = 0 [Stall
Prevention during Decel = Disabled]. If L3-04 = 1 [General Purpose], the drive could possibly not stop in the specified deceleration
time.
*6 When you use an ERF-type braking resistor, set L8-01 = 1 [3% ERF DB Resistor Protection = Enabled] and set a wiring sequence to de-
energize the drive with the fault relay output.
*7 When you connect a braking unit (CDBR series) or a braking resistor unit (LKEB series) to drive models 2110, 2138, and 4103, make
sure that you use wires that are in the range of the applicable gauges for the drive. A junction terminal is necessary to connect wires that
are less than the applicable gauge to the drive. Contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative for more information about selection
and installation of the junction terminal.
*8 Cooling fan wiring is not necessary for self-cooling motors.
*9 The number of terminals is different for different models.
• Terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, U/T1, V/T2, W/T3: There are two screws for each terminal block on models 4477 to 4720.
• Terminal +3: Models 2169 to 2415 and 4208 to 4720 only. There are two screws for each terminal block on models 4477 to 4720.
• Terminal +2: Models 2004 to 2082 and 4002 to 4044 only.
• Terminals +1, -: There are two screws for each terminal block on models 2169, 2211, 4140, 4168, and 4477 to 4720.
• Terminal B1, B2: Models 2004 to 2138 and 4002 to 4168 only.
*10 Connect peripheral options to terminals -, +1, +2, B1, and B2.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Only connect factory-recommended devices or circuits to drive terminals B1, B2, -, +1, +2, and +3.
Do not connect an AC power supply lines to these terminals. Incorrect wiring can cause damage to the drive and serious injury
or death from fire.
*11 Encoder circuit wiring (wiring to PG-B3 option) is not necessary for applications that do not use motor speed feedback.
*12 Connect a 24 V power supply to terminals PS-AC to operate the control circuit while the main circuit power supply is OFF.
*13 To set the MFDI power supply (Sinking/Sourcing Mode or internal/external power supply), install or remove a jumper between terminals
SC-SP or SC-SN depending on the application.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SP-SN. If you close the circuits between terminals
SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• Sinking Mode, Internal power supply: Install the jumper to close the circuit between terminals SC-SP.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SC-SN. If you close the circuits between
terminals SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• Sourcing Mode, Internal power supply: Install the jumper to close the circuit between terminals SC-SN.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SC-SP. If you close the circuits between
terminals SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• External power supply: Remove the jumper from the MFDI terminals. It is not necessary to close the circuit between terminals SC-SP
and terminals SC-SN.
*14 The maximum output current capacity for terminals +V and -V on the control circuit is 20 mA.
NOTICE: Do not install a jumper between terminals +V, -V, and AC. A closed circuit between these terminals will cause
damage to the drive.
*15 DIP switches S1-1 to S1-3 set terminals A1 to A3 for voltage or current input. The default setting for S1-1 and S1-3 is voltage input (“V”
side). The default setting for S1-2 is current input (“I” side).
*16 DIP switch S4 sets terminal A3 for analog or PTC input. Set DIP switch S1-3 to the “V” side, and set H3-05 = 0 [Terminal A3 Signal
Level Select = 0 to 10V (Lower Limit at 0)] to set terminal A3 for PTC input with DIP switch S4.
*17 Do not ground the control circuit terminals AC or connect them to the drive chassis.
NOTICE: Do not ground the AC control circuit terminals and only connect the AC terminals according to the product
instructions. If you connect the AC terminals incorrectly, it can cause damage to the drive. Electrical Installation
*18 Connect the positive lead from an external 24 Vdc power supply to terminal PS and the negative lead to terminal AC.
NOTICE: Connect terminals PS and AC correctly for the 24 V power supply. If you connect the wires to the incorrect terminals,
it will cause damage to the drive.
*19 Use multi-function analog monitor outputs with analog frequency meters, ammeters, voltmeters, and wattmeters. Do not use monitor
outputs with feedback-type signal devices.
*20 Jumper switch S5 sets terminal FM and AM for voltage or current output. The default setting for S5 is voltage output (“V” side).
*21 Set DIP switch S2 to “ON” to enable the termination resistor in the last drive in a MEMOBUS/Modbus network.
*22 Use only Sourcing Mode for Safe Disable input. 5
*23 Disconnect the wire jumpers between H1 and HC and H2 and HC to use the Safe Disable input.
*1 Set the wiring sequence to de-energize the drive with the fault relay output. If the drive outputs a fault during fault restart when you use
the fault restart function, set L5-02 = 1 [Fault Contact at Restart Select = Always Active] to de-energize the drive. Be careful when you
use a cut-off sequence. The default setting for L5-02 is 0 [Active Only when Not Restarting].
*2 When you use a braking unit, set L8-55 = 0 [Internal DB TransistorProtection = Disable]. If L8-55 = 1 [Protection Enabled], the drive
will detect rF [Braking Resistor Fault].
*3 When you use a braking unit, set L3-04 = 0 [Stall Prevention during Decel = Disabled]. If L3-04 = 1 [General Purpose], the drive could
possibly not stop in the specified deceleration time.
*4 When you connect a braking unit (CDBR series) to drive models T140 and T168, make sure that you use wires that are in the range of the
applicable gauges for the drive. A junction terminal is necessary to connect wires that are less than the applicable gauge to the drive.
Contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative for more information about selection and installation of the junction terminal.
*5 Cooling fan wiring is not necessary for self-cooling motors.
*6 The number of terminals is different for different models.
• Terminals U/T1, V/T2, W/T3: There are 2 screws for each terminal on models T477 to T720.
• Terminals +3 and -: There are 2 screws for this terminal on models T477 to T720.
*7 Connect peripheral options to terminals - and +3.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Only connect factory-recommended devices or circuits to drive terminals - and +3. Do not connect
AC power supply lines to these terminals. Incorrect wiring can cause damage to the drive and serious injury or death from fire.
*8 Encoder circuit wiring (wiring to PG-B3 option) is not necessary for applications that do not use motor speed feedback.
*9 Connect a 24 V power supply to terminals PS-AC to operate the control circuit while the main circuit power supply is OFF.
*10 To set the MFDI power supply (Sinking/Sourcing Mode or internal/external power supply), install or remove a jumper between terminals
SC-SP or SC-SN depending on the application.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SP-SN. If you close the circuits between terminals
SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• Sinking Mode, Internal power supply: Install the jumper to close the circuit between terminals SC-SP.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SC-SN. If you close the circuits between
terminals SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• Sourcing Mode, Internal power supply: Install the jumper to close the circuit between terminals SC-SN.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SC-SP. If you close the circuits between
terminals SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• External power supply: Remove the jumper from the MFDI terminals. It is not necessary to close the circuit between terminals SC-SP
and terminals SC-SN.
*11 The maximum output current capacity for terminals +V and -V on the control circuit is 20 mA.
NOTICE: Do not install a jumper between terminals +V, -V, and AC. A closed circuit between these terminals will cause
damage to the drive.
*12 DIP switches S1-1 to S1-3 set terminals A1 to A3 for voltage or current input. The default setting for S1-1 and S1-3 is voltage input (“V”
side). The default setting for S1-2 is current input (“I” side).
*13 DIP switch S4 sets terminal A3 for analog or PTC input. Set DIP switch S1-3 to the “V” side, and set H3-05 = 0 [Terminal A3 Signal
Level Select = 0 to 10V (Lower Limit at 0)] to set terminal A3 for PTC input with DIP switch S4.
*14 Do not ground the control circuit terminals AC or connect them to the drive.
NOTICE: Do not ground the AC control circuit terminals and only connect the AC terminals according to the product
instructions. If you connect the AC terminals incorrectly, it can cause damage to the drive.
*15 Connect the positive lead from an external 24 Vdc power supply to terminal PS and the negative lead to terminal AC.
NOTICE: Connect terminals PS and AC correctly for the 24 V power supply. If you connect the wires to the incorrect terminals,
it will cause damage to the drive.
*16 Use multi-function analog monitor outputs with analog frequency meters, ammeters, voltmeters, and wattmeters. Do not use monitor
outputs with feedback-type signal devices.
*17 Jumper switch S5 sets terminal FM and AM for voltage or current output. The default setting for S5 is voltage output (“V” side).
*18 Set DIP switch S2 to “ON” to enable the termination resistor in the last drive in a MEMOBUS/Modbus network.
Electrical Installation
*19 Use only SOURCE Mode for Safe Disable input.
*20 Disconnect the jumper between H1 and HC and H2 and HC to use the Safe Disable input.
Note:
The location of terminals are different for different drive models.
Note:
The location of terminals are different for different drive models.
Figure 5.4 Wiring the Main Circuit and Motor: 6-Phase/12-Pulse Drives
Figure 5.5 Configuration of Main Circuit Terminal Block (2004 - 2042, 4002 - 4023)
Figure 5.6 Configuration of Main Circuit Terminal Block (2056, 4031, 4038)
Electrical Installation
Electrical Installation
Note:
The terminals are different for different models:
• 2169, 2211: You cannot use terminal B2. Terminal symbol display “+3/B1” shows terminal +3.
• 4140, 4168: Terminal symbol display “+3/B1” shows terminal B1.
Figure 5.14 Configuration of Main Circuit Terminal Block (2169, 2211, 4140, 4168) 5
Figure 5.15 Configuration of Main Circuit Terminal Block (2257, 2313, 4208 - 4302)
R/L1 T/L3
Figure 5.16 Configuration of Main Circuit Terminal Block (2360, 2415, 4371, 4414)
Electrical Installation
R/L1
U/T1
W/T3
B1
To connect a braking resistor
Braking resistor connection -
or braking resistor unit.
B2
+2 - To connect peripheral
• DC power supply input devices, for example:
(+1 and -)
+1 • DC power input
• DC reactor connection DC power supply input (+1
(+1 and +2) and -) • Braking Unit
-
• DC Link Choke
• DC power supply input (+1 and -)
Note:
• Braking unit connection (+3 and -)
Remove the jumper
+3 - between terminals +1
and +2 to connect a DC
link choke.
Note:
Use terminals - and B1 to connect a CDBR-type control unit to drive models 2004 to 2138 and 4002 to 4168 that have built-in braking
transistors.
R/L1, R1/L11
S/L2, S1/L21 Main circuit power supply input To connect a commercial power supply.
T/L3, T1/L31
U/T1
W/T3
-
Braking unit connection To connect a braking resistor unit (option).
+3
◆ Wire Selection
Select the correct wires for main circuit wiring.
Refer to Wire Gauge and Torque Specifications for UL Listing on page 357 for wire gauges and tightening torques as
specified by UL standards.
IP20 Applicable
Applicable Gauge Gauge *1 Wire Stripping Tightening
Recomm. Gauge Terminal Screw
Model Terminal AWG, kcmil Length *2 Torque
AWG, kcmil AWG, kcmil Size and Shape
(mm2) mm N∙m (lbf∙in)
(mm2)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2004 -, +1, +2 14 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
Electrical Installation
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2006 -, +1, +2 14 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2008 -, +1, +2 14 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 12 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2010 -, +1, +2 12 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 12 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2012 -, +1, +2 10 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2018 -, +1, +2 8 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 8 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2021 -, +1, +2 8 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
12 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(4.0 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 6 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 8 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2030 -, +1, +2 6 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 12 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
10 - 8 2.0 - 2.5
8 - - M5
(6.0 - 10) (17.7 - 22.1)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 6 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 6 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
2042 -, +1, +2 3 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
10 - 8 2.0 - 2.5
8 - - M5
(6.0 - 10) (17.7 - 22.1)
14 - 4 10 - 4 2.3 - 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 4 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 1 8-1 5 - 5.5
2056 -, +1, +2 1 20 M6
(2.5 - 50) (10 - 50) (45 - 49)
14 - 8 14 - 8 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 8 10 M4
(2.5 - 10) (2.5 - 10) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 1 6-1 5 - 5.5
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 1 20 M6
(2.5 - 50) (16 - 50) (45 - 49)
14 - 3 6-3 5 - 5.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 3 20 M6
(2.5 - 25) (16 - 25) (45 - 49)
14 - 8 14 - 8 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 8 10 M4
(2.5 - 10) (2.5 - 10) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 2 6-2 5 - 5.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2 20 M6
(2.5 - 35) (16 - 35) (45 - 49)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 6 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
5
6-4 5.4 - 6.0
6 - - M6
(16 - 25) (47.8 - 53.1)
2 - 2/0 2 - 2/0 10 - 12
2110 -, +1 2/0 27 M8
(35 - 70) (35 - 70) (89 - 107)
14 - 4 10 - 4 3 - 3.5
B1, B2 4 21 M6
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (27 - 31)
2 - 4/0 2 - 4/0 10 - 12
2138 -, +1 4/0 27 M8
(35 - 95) (35 - 95) (89 - 107)
14 - 3 10 - 3 3 - 3.5
B1, B2 3 21 M6
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (27 - 31)
4 5.4 - 6.0
4 - - M6
(25) (47.8 - 53.1)
4 - 1/0 9.0 - 11
4 - - M8
(25 - 50) (79.7 - 97.4)
4 - 1/0 9.0 - 11
4 - - M8
(25 - 50) (79.7 - 97.4)
4 - 1/0 × 2P 1/0 × 2P 20
+3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 50 × 2P) (50 × 2P) (177)
3 - 350 18 - 23
3 - - M10
(25 - 185) (159 - 204)
4 - 1/0 × 2P 1/0 × 2P 20
+3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 50 × 2P) (50 × 2P) (177)
2 - 350 18 - 23
2 - - M10
(35 - 150) (159 - 204)
1/0 - 4/0 × 2P 35
+3 3/0 × 2P - - M12
(50 - 95 × 2P) (310)
1 - 350 32 - 40
1 - - M12
(50 - 150) (283 - 354)
1/0 - 4/0 × 2P 35
+3 3/0 × 2P - - M12
(50 - 95 × 2P) (310)
1 - 350 32 - 40
1 - - M12
(50 - 150) (283 - 354)
*1 For IP20 protection, use wires that are in the range of applicable gauges.
*2 Remove insulation from the ends of wires to expose the length of wire shown.
*3 For wire gauges more than AWG 8, tighten to a tightening torque of 4.1 N∙m to 4.5 N∙m (36 lbf∙in to 40 lbf∙in).
*4 Terminals - and +1 have two screws. The Recommended Gauge is the wire gauge for one terminal.
*5 A junction terminal is necessary to connect a braking unit (CDBR-series) to terminals - and +3.
Electrical Installation
IP20 Applicable
Applicable Gauge Wire Stripping Tightening
Recomm. Gauge Gauge *1 Terminal Screw
Model Terminal AWG, kcmil Length *2 Torque
AWG, kcmil AWG, kcmil Size and Shape
(mm²) mm N∙m (lbf∙in)
(mm²)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4002 -, +1, +2 14 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
12 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4004 -, +1, +2 14 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
12 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4005 -, +1, +2 14 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4007 -, +1, +2 14 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4009 -, +1, +2 12 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 12 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4012 -, +1, +2 10 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 1.2 - 1.5
10 - - M4
(2.5 - 10) (10.6 - 13.3)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4018 -, +1, +2 8 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 14 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 8 2.0 - 2.5
10 - - M5
(2.5 - 10) (17.7 - 22.1)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 8 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 14 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4023 -, +1, +2 8 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (2.5 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 10 14 - 10 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 12 10 M4
(2.5 - 6.0) (2.5 - 6.0) (13.5 - 15)
12 - 8 2.0 - 2.5
10 - - M5
(4.0 - 10) (17.7 - 22.1)
14 - 4 10 - 4 2.3 - 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 8 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 1 8-1 5 - 5.5
4031 -, +1, +2 6 20 M6
(2.5 - 50) (10 - 50) (45 - 49)
14 - 8 14 - 8 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 10) (2.5 - 10) (13.5 - 15)
10 - 6 5.4 - 6.0
8 - - M6
(6.0 - 16) (47.8 - 53.1)
14 - 4 10 - 4 2.3 - 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 8 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 1 8-1 5 - 5.5
4038 -, +1, +2 4 20 M6
(2.5 - 50) (10 - 50) (45 - 49)
14 - 8 14 - 8 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 10 10 M4
(2.5 - 10) (2.5 - 10) (13.5 - 15)
5
10 - 6 5.4 - 6.0
6 - - M6
(6.0 - 16) (47.8 - 53.1)
14 - 4 10 - 4 2.3 - 2.5
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 4 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 6 10 - 6 2.3 - 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 6 18 M5
(2.5 - 16) (6.0 - 16) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 3 10 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4044 -, +1, +2 3 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 8 14 - 8 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 8 10 M4
(2.5 - 10) (2.5 - 10) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 4 10 - 4 2.3 - 2.5
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 4 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 4 10 - 4 2.3 - 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 4 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 3 10 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
4060 -, +1 3 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 8 14 - 8 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 8 10 M4
(2.5 - 10) (2.5 - 10) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 3 12 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 3 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (4.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 3 12 - 3 2.3 - 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 3 18 M5
(2.5 - 25) (4.0 - 25) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 2 10 - 2 2.3 - 2.5
4075 -, +1 2 18 M5
(2.5 - 35) (6.0 - 35) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 6 14 - 6 1.5 - 1.7
B1, B2 6 10 M4
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (13.5 - 15)
14 - 2 10 - 2 2.3 - 2.5
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 2 18 M5
(2.5 - 35) (6.0 - 35) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 2 10 - 2 2.3 - 2.5
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2 18 M5
(2.5 - 35) (6.0 - 35) (19.8 - 22) *3
14 - 6 14 - 6 2.3 - 2.5
B1, B2 6 18 M5
(2.5 - 16) (2.5 - 16) (19.8 - 22) *3
2 - 4/0 2 - 4/0 10 - 12
4103 -, +1 2/0 27 M8
(35 - 95) (35 - 95) (89 - 107)
14 - 3 10 - 3 3 - 3.5
B1, B2 3 21 M6
(2.5 - 25) (6.0 - 25) (27 - 31)
4 - 1/0 9.0 - 11
4 - - M8
(25 - 50) (79.7 - 97.4)
4 - 1/0 9.0 - 11
4 - - M8
(25 - 50) (79.7 - 97.4)
4 - 1/0 × 2P 1/0 × 2P 20
+3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 50 × 2P) (50 × 2P) (177)
4 - 350 18 - 23
4 - - M10
(25 - 150) (159 - 204)
4 - 1/0 × 2P 1/0 × 2P 20
+3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 50 × 2P) (50 × 2P) (177)
2 - 350 18 - 23
2 - - M10
(35 - 150) (159 - 204)
4 - 1/0 × 2P 1/0 × 2P 20
+3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 50 × 2P) (50 × 2P) (177)
5
2 - 350 18 - 23
2 - - M10
(35 - 185) (159 - 204)
1 - 4/0 × 2P 35
+3 3/0 × 2P - - M12
(50 - 95 × 2P) (310)
1 - 350 32 - 40
1 - - M12
(50 - 185) (283 - 354)
1 - 4/0 × 2P 35
+3 4/0 × 2P - - M12
(50 - 95 × 2P) (310)
1 - 350 32 - 40
1 - - M12
(35 - 185) (283 - 354)
2 - 4/0 × 4P 4/0 × 4P 35
+3 3/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 95 × 4P) (95 × 4P) (310)
1/0 - 300 32 - 40
1/0 - - M12
(50 - 150) (283 - 354)
2 - 4/0 × 4P 4/0 × 4P 35
+3 3/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 95 × 4P) (95 × 4P) (310)
2/0 - 300 32 - 40
2/0 - - M12
(70 - 150) (283 - 354)
2 - 4/0 × 4P 4/0 × 4P 35
+3 4/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 95 × 4P) (95 × 4P) (310)
2/0 - 300 32 - 40
2/0 - - M12
(70 - 150) (283 - 354)
2 - 4/0 × 4P 4/0 × 4P 35
+3 4/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 95 × 4P) (95 × 4P) (310)
2/0 - 300 32 - 40
2/0 - - M12
(70 - 150) (283 - 354)
*1 For IP20 protection, use wires that are in the range of applicable gauges.
*2 Remove insulation from the ends of wires to expose the length of wire shown.
*3 For wire gauges more than AWG 8, tighten to a tightening torque of 4.1 N∙m to 4.5 N∙m (36 lbf∙in to 40 lbf∙in).
*4 Terminals - and +1 have two screws. The Recommended Gauge is the wire gauge for one terminal.
*5 A junction terminal is necessary to connect a braking resistor unit (LKEB-series) to terminals B1 and B2.
6-Phase/12-Pulse 400 V Class
3 - 3/0 15.3
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 1 24 M8
(25 - 95) (135)
T103
14 - 1/0 3.1 - 3.8
-, +3 3 18 M6
(2.5 - 50) (28 - 33)
6-4 5.4 - 6
4 - M6
(16 - 25) (47.8 - 53.1)
1 - 4/0 20
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2/0 33 M8
(50 - 95) (175)
T140
6 - 3/0 15.3
-, +3 1 24 M8
(16 - 95) (135)
4 - 1/0 9 - 11
4 - M8
(25 - 50) (79.7 - 97.4)
2/0 - 4/0 20
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 4/0 33 M8
(70 - 95) (175)
T168
6 - 3/0 15.3
-, +3 1/0 24 M8 Electrical Installation
(16 - 95) (135)
4 - 1/0 9 - 11
4 - M8
(25 - 50) (79.7 - 97.4)
3 - 4/0 20
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 95) (177)
T208
4 - 2/0 20
5
-, +3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 70) (177)
4 - 350 18 - 23
4 - M10
(25 - 185) (159 - 204)
2 - 4/0 20
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 2/0 × 2P - M10
(35 - 95) (177)
T250
4 - 2/0 20
-, +3 1/0 × 2P - M10
(25 - 70) (177)
2 - 350 18 - 23
2 - M10
(35 - 185) (159 - 204)
2/0 - 4/0 20
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 4/0 × 1P (× 2) - M10
(70 - 95) (177)
2 - 350 18 - 23
2 - M10
(35 - 185) (159 - 204)
3/0 - 300 35
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 250 × 2P - M12
(95 - 150) (310)
T371
1 - 300 35
-, +3 3/0 × 2P - M12
(50 - 150) (310)
1 - 350 32 - 40
1 - M12
(50 - 185) (283 - 354)
4/0 - 300 35
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 300 × 2P - M12
(95 - 150) (310)
T414
1 - 300 35
-, +3 4/0 × 2P - M12
(50 - 150) (310)
1 - 350 32 - 40
1 - M12
(50 - 150) (283 - 354)
2/0 - 300 35
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 4/0 × 4P - M12
(70 - 150) (310)
T477
2 - 250 35
-, +3 3/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 120) (310)
1/0 - 300 32 - 40
1/0 - M12
(50 - 150) (283 - 354)
3/0 - 300 35
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 4/0 × 4P - M12
(95 - 150) (310)
T568
2 - 250 35
-, +3 3/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 120) (310)
2/0 - 300 32 - 40
2/0 - M12
(70 - 150) (283 - 354)
250 - 300 35
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 300 × 4P - M12
(120 - 150) (310)
T605
2 - 250 35
-, +3 4/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 120) (310)
2/0 - 300 32 - 40
2/0 - M12
(70 - 150) (283 - 354)
250 - 300 35
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 300 × 4P - M12
(120 - 150) (310)
T720
2 - 250 35
-, +3 4/0 × 4P - M12
(35 - 120) (310)
2/0 - 300 32 - 40
2/0 - M12
(70 - 150) (283 - 354)
*1 Remove insulation from the ends of wires to expose the length of wire shown.
Carrier Frequency 15 kHz or less 5 kHz or less 2 kHz or less Electrical Installation
Note:
• To set the carrier frequency in a drive that is operating more than one motor, calculate the cable length as the total distance of wiring to all
connected motors.
• When A1-02 = 5, 6 [OLV/PM, AOLV/PM], the maximum cable length is 100 m (328 ft).
• When you connect to a PM motor, it can be necessary to adjust the overcurrent detection.
■ Ground Wiring 5
Follow the precautions to wire the ground for one drive or a series of drives.
Model Figure
Electrical Installation
Electrical Installation
◆ 6-Phase/12-Pulse Rectification
■ Installing Transformer
Install a 6-Phase/12-Pulse isolation transformer with output windings phase-shifted by 30 electrical degrees or install
a Hybrid 6-Phase topology on the power supply.
Figure 5.32 Main Circuit Terminal Connections, Standard Hybrid 12-Pulse System
Note:
Refer to local codes for correct branch circuit protection (BCP) on the primary side of the 6-Phase/12-Pulse transformer.
2004 - 2211
Procedure A 377
4002 - 4168, T103 - T168
2257 - 2415
Procedure B 381
4208 - 4720, T208 - T720
A - Cable clamp
Figure 5.35 Strain Relief Example
Table 5.6 Recommended Wiring Tools
Bit Torque Driver Model
Screw Size Screw Shape Adapter Torque Wrench
Model Manufacturer (Tightening Torque)
TSD-M 3NM
M4 Bit SF-BIT-SL 1,0X4,0-70 PHOENIX CONTACT (1.2 - 3 N∙m -
(10.6 - 26.6 lbf∙in))
Wire Gauge ≤
25 mm2 Wire Gauge ≤
(AWG 10):
TSD-M 3NM 25 mm2
(AWG 10): -
(1.2 - 3 N∙m
M5 *1 Bit SF-BIT-SL 1,2X6,5-70 PHOENIX CONTACT (10.6 - 26.6 lbf∙in))
Wire Gauge ≥
Wire Gauge ≥ 30 mm2
30 mm2 (AWG 8):
(AWG 8): - 4.1 - 4.5 N∙m
(36.3 - 39.8 lbf∙in) *2 *3
5 - 9 N∙m
Bit SF-BIT-HEX 5-50 PHOENIX CONTACT -
(44.3 - 79.9 lbf∙in) *2 *3
M6
Bit SF-BIT-SL 1,2X6,5-70 PHOENIX CONTACT - 3 - 3.5 N∙m
(26.6 - 31.0 lbf∙in) *2 *3
8 - 12 N∙m
M8 Bit SF-BIT-HEX 6-50 PHOENIX CONTACT - (70.8 - 106.2 lbf∙in) *2
*3
12 - 14 N∙m
M10 Bit SF-BIT-HEX 8-50 PHOENIX CONTACT - (106.2 - 123.9 lbf∙in) *2
*3
*1 When wiring drive models 2056, 4089, and smaller, select the correct tools for the wire gauge.
*2 Use 6.35 mm (0.25 in) bit socket holder.
*3 Use a torque wrench that can apply this torque measurement range.
A - Wiring cover
Figure 5.36 Remove the Wiring Cover
2. Put the end of a prepared wire into the terminal block.
Electrical Installation
Figure 5.37 Install the Electrical Wire
Note:
If there is a jumper between terminals +1 and +2, loosen the terminal block screws and remove the jumper before wiring the
terminals.
A - Nut
Figure 5.42 Remove the Terminal Block Nut
Electrical Installation
3. Wire the closed-loop crimp terminal to the main circuit terminal block.
6. Attach the wiring cover and terminal block cover to their initial positions and tighten the screws on the terminal
block cover.
Note:
6-Phase/12-pulse drives (models: Txxx) do not have the wiring covers.
Electrical Installation
*2 To set the MFDI power supply (Sinking/Sourcing Mode or internal/external power supply), install or remove a jumper between terminals
SC-SP or SC-SN depending on the application.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SP-SN. If you close the circuits between terminals
SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• Sinking Mode, Internal power supply: Install the jumper to close the circuit between terminals SC-SP.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SC-SN. If you close the circuits between
terminals SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• Sourcing Mode, Internal power supply: Install the jumper to close the circuit between terminals SC-SN.
NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between terminals SC-SP. If you close the circuits between
terminals SC-SP and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
• External power supply: Remove the jumper from the MFDI terminals. It is not necessary to close the circuit between terminals SC-SP
and terminals SC-SN.
*3 The output current capacity of the +V and -V terminals on the control circuit is 20 mA.
NOTICE: Do not install a jumper between terminals +V, -V, and AC. A closed circuit between these terminals will cause
damage to the drive.
*4 Set DIP switches S1-1 to S1-3 to select between a voltage or current input signal to terminals A1 to A3. The default setting for S1-1 and
S1-3 is voltage input (“V” side). The default setting for S1-2 is current input (“I” side).
*5 Do not ground the control circuit terminals AC or connect them to the drive chassis.
NOTICE: Do not ground the AC control circuit terminals and only connect the AC terminals according to the product
instructions. If you connect the AC terminals incorrectly, it can cause damage to the drive.
*6 Do not connect terminals PS and AC inversely. If you connect the wires to the incorrect terminals, it will cause damage to the drive.
*7 Set DIP switch S2 to the ON position to enable the termination resistor in the last drive when you use MEMOBUS/Modbus
communications.
*8 To use the internal power supply with the Safe Disable input, use sourcing mode.
*9 Disconnect the wire jumpers between H1 and HC and H2 and HC to use the Safe Disable input.
*10 Use multi-function analog monitor outputs with analog frequency meters, ammeters, voltmeters, and wattmeters. Do not use monitor
outputs with feedback-type signal devices.
■ Input Terminals
Refer to Table 5.7 for a list of input terminals and functions.
Electrical Installation
MFDI selection 1
S1
(ON: Forward run OFF: Stop)
• Photocoupler
MFDI selection 2 • 24 V, 6 mA
S2
(ON: Reverse run OFF: Stop) Note:
MFDI selection 3 Install the wire jumpers between terminals SC-SP and SC-SN to set the MFDI power supply
S3 (sinking/sourcing mode or internal/external power supply).
(External fault (N.O.)) • Sinking Mode: Install a jumper between terminals SC and SP.
MFDI selection 4 NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between
S4
(Fault reset) terminals SC-SN. If you close the circuits between terminals SC-SP
and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the
MFDI selection 5 drive.
S5
(Multi-step speed reference 1)
Digital Inputs • Sourcing Mode: Install a jumper between terminals SC and SN.
MFDI selection 6
S6 NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between
(Multi-step speed reference 2) terminals SC-SP. If you close the circuits between terminals SC-SP
MFDI selection 7 and terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the
S7
(Jog command)
drive.
• External power supply: No jumper necessary between terminals SC-SN and terminals SC-SP.
MFDI selection 8
S8
(Baseblock command (N.O.))
SC MFDI selection common NOTICE: Damage to Equipment. Do not close the circuit between
terminals SP-SN. If you close the circuits between terminals SC-SP and
SP MFDI power supply +24 Vdc terminals SC-SN at the same time, it will cause damage to the drive.
H1 Safe Disable input 1 Remove the jumper between terminals H1-HC and H2-HC to use the Safe Disable input.
• 24 V, 6 mA
• ON: Normal operation
H2 Safe Disable input 2 • OFF: Coasting motor
Safe Disable • Internal impedance 4.7 kΩ
Input • OFF Minimum OFF time of 2 ms.
■ Output Terminals
Refer to Table 5.8 and Table 5.9 for a list of Output terminals and functions.
N.O. output
MA
(Fault) • Relay output
Fault Relay • 30 Vdc, 10 mA to 1 A
N.C. output
Output MB • 250 Vac, 10 mA to 1 A
(Fault)
• Minimum load: 5 V, 10 mA (Reference value)
MC Digital output common
M1 MFDO
• Relay output
M2 (During Run)
• 30 Vdc, 10 mA to 1 A
• 250 Vac, 10 mA to 1 A
M3 MFDO
MFDO • Minimum load: 5 V, 10 mA (Reference value)
M4 (Zero Speed) Note:
Do not set functions that frequently switch ON/OFF to MFDO (M1 to M6) because this will
M5 MFDO decrease the performance life of the relay contacts. Yaskawa estimates switching life at
200,000 times (assumes 1 A, resistive load).
M6 (Speed Agree 1)
AC Monitor common 0V
Supplies backup power to the drive control circuit, keypad, and option board.
PS External 24 V power supply input
External Power Supply Input 21.6 VDC to 26.4 VDC, 700 mA
Terminals
AC External 24 V power supply ground 0V
Electrical Installation
ON ON - - -
ON OFF 0 [Disabled] - -
Keypad The keypad operates the same as when the main circuit power supply is
-
ON. The drive will not detect oPr [Keypad Connection Fault].
Data Log The data log function operates the same as when the main circuit power
supply is ON. -
The operation is different for different drive software versions. *1
Communications by Communication Option or Communication operates the same as when the main circuit power
MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication supply is ON. -
Terminals
MFAI MFAI operates the same as when the main circuit power supply is ON. -
MFAO MFAO operates the same as when the main circuit power supply is ON. -
MFDI MFDI does not operate when the main circuit power supply of the drive Connect the external 24 V power supply to the MFDI
is OFF. selection common terminal (SC). *2
MFDO MFDO operates the same as when the main circuit power supply is ON.
Multi-Function Photocoupler Output The operations of MFDO terminals and fault relay output terminals set -
Fault Relay Output Terminal for H2-xx = E [Fault] are different for different drive software versions.
*3
Pulse Train Input Pulse train input operates the same as when the main circuit power
supply is ON. -
Pulse train output Pulse train output operates the same as when the main circuit power
-
supply is ON.
Encoder Option Speed Detection (PG-B3, PG- Encoder options do not operate when the main circuit power supply of When you use an encoder, make sure that the drive main
X3, PG-F3, PG-RT3) the drive is OFF. circuit power supply is ON. *4
The operation to detect encoder option-related faults is different for
different software versions.
Analog Input Option (AI-A3) Analog input options operate the same as when the main circuit power
-
supply is ON.
Analog Output Option (AO-A3) Analog output options operate the same as when the main circuit power
supply is ON. -
The operation is different for different drive software versions. *5
Digital Input Option (DI-A3) Digital input options do not operate when the main circuit power supply Connect the external 24 V power supply to the Input signal
of the drive is OFF. common terminal (SC). *2
Digital Output Option (DO-A3) Digital output options operate the same as when the main circuit power
-
supply is ON.
*1 When you use an external 24 V power supply, the operation of the data log function is different for different drive software versions. On
drives with software versions PRG: 09015 and later, you can continue the data log function.
Note:
The “PRG” column on the nameplate on the right side of the drive identifies the software version. You can also use U1-25 [SoftwareNumber
FLASH] to identify the software version.
*2 When you use MFDI and a Digital Input option (DI-A3), wire the terminals as shown in Wiring MFDI Terminals on page 389 or Wiring
Digital Input Option (DI-A3) on page 389.
*3 When you use an external 24 V power supply, the operation of the MFDO terminals are different for different drive software versions.
Note:
The “PRG” column on the nameplate on the right side of the drive identifies the software version. You can also use U1-25 [SoftwareNumber
FLASH] to identify the software version.
• Drive software versions PRG: 09012 and later
When the main circuit power supply of the drive turns off, and you remove the cause of a fault and do a fault reset from the keypad, the
fault relay output terminals and the MFDO terminals set for H2-xx = E, 10E [Fault] will change status.
• Drive software versions PRG: 09011 and earlier
When the main circuit power supply of the drive turns off, and you remove the cause of a fault and do a fault reset from the keypad, the
fault relay output terminals and the MFDO terminals set for H2-xx = E, 10E [Fault] will keep the same status as before the main circuit
power supply of the drive turned off, but the fault code shown on the keypad will disappear.
*4 If the motor shaft can rotate while the 24 V control power supply is energized and the main circuit power supply is de-energized, re-
energize the 24 V control power supply and energize the main circuit power supply.
*5 When you use an external 24 V power supply, the operation of the Analog Output option is different for different drive software versions.
On drives with software versions PRG:09015 and later, the Analog Output option (AO-A3) can output the analog signals.
Note:
The “PRG” column on the nameplate on the right side of the drive identifies the software version. You can also use U1-25 [SoftwareNumber
FLASH] to identify the software version.
When you use an external 24 V power supply, if you de-energize the main circuit power supply, the encoder option
will not operate, even when you connect the external 24 V power supply to terminals PS-AC. When you use an
encoder option, energize the drive main circuit power supply.
Note:
Yaskawa recommends that you use different external power supplies for the external power supply input terminals (PS-AC) and MFDI
selection common terminal (SC) / Input signal common terminal (SC).
Wiring MFDI Terminals
If you de-energize the main circuit power supply, the MFDI terminals will not operate, even when you connect the
external 24 V power supply to terminals PS-AC. When you set N.O. functions to H1-xx [MFDI Function Select],
MFDI terminals always deactivate. When you set N.C. functions, MFDI terminals always activate. Connect the
external 24 V power supply to the MFDI selection common terminal (SC).
AC Shield ground 0V
Figure 5.51 Tightening Torque Display Location (Reverse side of Front Cover)
Figure 5.52 Tightening Torque Display Location (Lower Front Side of Front Cover)
Crimp Ferrules
Attach an insulated sleeve when you use crimp ferrules. Refer to Table 5.14 for the recommended external 5
dimensions and model numbers of crimp ferrules.
Use the CRIMPFOX 6, a crimping tool made by PHOENIX CONTACT.
AI 0.5-8WH,
0.5 (20) 14 8 1.1 2.5
AI 0.5-8OG
Electrical Installation
A - Loosen the screws and put the wire into the D - When you do not use crimp ferrules, remove
opening on the terminal block. approximately 5.5 mm (0.21 in) of the covering at
B - Wire with a crimp ferrule attached, or unsoldered the end of the wire.
wire with the core wires lightly twisted E - Blade width of 2.5 mm (0.1 in) or less
C - Pull back the shielding and lightly twist the end F - Blade thickness of 0.4 mm (0.01 in) or less
with your fingers to keep the ends from fraying.
A - Connect the shield to terminal E (G) of the drive. C - Insulate with electrical tape or shrink tubing.
B - Sheath
Figure 5.58 Prepare the Ends of Shielded Wire
3. Put the cable through the clearance in the wiring cover.
DIP switch S1-1 A1 Sets the input signal type (voltage/current). V (voltage input)
C DIP switch S1-2 A2 Sets the input signal type (voltage/current). I (current input)
DIP switch S1-3 A3 Sets the input signal type (voltage/current). V (voltage input)
Electrical Installation
Sourcing Mode
(PNP)
10 kΩ or more 10 V or more
Note:
Use the formula in Figure 5.61 to calculate the necessary load resistance (kΩ) to increase output voltage VMP(V).
A - Load Impedance
Figure 5.61 Wiring to Use Pulse Train Output in Sourcing Mode
• Use in sinking mode
The external power supply changes the voltage level of the pulse train output signal. Keep the voltage from an
external source between 10.8 Vdc to 16.5 Vdc. Adjust the load impedance to keep the current at 16 mA or lower.
External Power Supply (V) Load Impedance (kΩ) Sinking current (mA)
Note:
• Set H3-02, H3-10 = 0 [Terminal A1 Function Selection, Terminal A2 Function Selection = Frequency Reference] to set A1 and A2 to
frequency reference. The drive will add the analog input values together to make the frequency reference.
• Use tweezers or a jig with a tip width of approximately 0.8 mm (0.03 in) to set DIP switches.
• Set DIP switch S4 to “AI” to use terminal A3 as an analog input (voltage/current) terminal. The default setting for DIP switch S4 is “AI”.
Parameter
Terminal Types of Output Signals Jumper Switch S5
No. Signal Level
Voltage output 0: 0 V to 10 V
(Default) 1: -10 V to +10 V
FM H4-07
Current output 2: 4 mA to 20 mA
Voltage output 0: 0 V to 10 V
(Default) 1: -10 V to +10 V
AM H4-08
Current output 2: 4 mA to 20 mA
Electrical Installation
C B
◆ Drive Ready
When the drive is operating or is prepared to accept a Run command, the MFDO terminal to which Drive Ready [H2-
xx = 6] is set will enter the ON status.
In these conditions, Drive Ready is OFF and the drive ignores Run commands:
• The drive is de-energized
• During a fault
• There is problem with the control power supply
• There is a parameter setting error that will not let the drive run, although a Run command is entered
• An overvoltage or undervoltage fault occurs when the Run command is entered
• The drive is in Programming Mode.
Electrical Installation
5
Figure 5.69 Interlock Circuit Example
2211 DTK-300N × 2P *1
Electrical Installation
*1 This is the applicable wire gauge when you use a braking unit other than Yaskawa braking unit (CDBR-type).
*2 This is the applicable wire gauge when you use the same wires for terminals - and +3.
Table 5.19 400 V Class
Braking Unit Recomm. Gauge Applicable Gauge
Drive Model Drive Terminals Ref.
(Qty) (AWG, kcmil) (AWG, kcmil)
*1 This is the applicable wire gauge when you use a braking unit other than Yaskawa braking unit (CDBR-type).
*2 This is the applicable wire gauge when you use the same wires for terminals - and +3.
Table 5.20 6-Phase/12-Pulse 400 V Class
Braking Unit Recomm. Gauge Applicable Gauge
Drive Model Drive Terminals
(Qty) (AWG, kcmil) (AWG, kcmil)
CDBR-4045D +3 10 10 - 4
(× 1)
Specified Wire Gauge - 10 10 - 4
T103
+3 3 14 - 1/0
Applicable Gauge *1
- 3 *2 14 - 1/0
CDBR-4030D +3 10 × 2P 10 - 4
Specified Wire Gauge - 10 × 2P 10 - 4
T140
+3 1 6 - 3/0
Applicable Gauge *1
- 1 *2 6 - 3/0
CDBR-4045D +3 10 × 2P 10 - 4
(× 2)
Specified Wire Gauge - 10 × 2P 10 - 4
T168
+3 1/0 6 - 3/0
Applicable Gauge *1
- 1/0 *2 6 - 3/0
*1 This is the applicable wire gauge when you use a braking unit other than Yaskawa braking unit (CDBR-type).
*2 This is the applicable wire gauge when you use the same wires for terminals - and +3.
Electrical Installation
5
A - Cutaway sections B - Use a diagonal-cutting pliers to clip this area.
Electrical Installation
Refer to Cutaway Section of the Wiring Cover on page 405 for more information.
Note:
• Different drive models have different wiring covers.
• Only clip the section of the wiring cover that applies to the wired terminal. If you clip areas that do not apply to wired terminals,
the protective enclosure will not keep its IP20 protective level.
• Make sure that you hold the cutaway section tightly when you remove pieces of the cutaway section. Pieces of the cutaway
section can fly out and cause injury.
• Make sure that the clipped section does not cause damage to the wires.
• If you use wires that are not specified by Yaskawa, the protective enclosure could lose its IP20 protective level, although the
wiring cover is correct. Contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative for more information.
• When you use the recommended gauge for the electrical wires, it is not necessary to attach the wiring cover of the main circuit
power input terminal and the drive output terminal. If you use the applicable gauge for the electrical wires, you must attach the
wiring cover.
A - Wire
Figure 5.81 Lead the Wire through the Wiring Cover
4. Crimp the closed-loop crimp terminal to the wire.
A - Nut
Figure 5.82 Remove the Terminal Block Nut
6. Wire the closed-loop crimp terminal to the main circuit terminal block.
Electrical Installation
The electronic thermal overload function uses the relation between the speed and heat characteristics in the variable
speed control range to simulate the cooling ability of general-purpose motors and forced-vented motors to prevent
damage to the motor.
When You Operate More than One Motor with One Drive
To disable the overload protection function of the electronic thermal protector of the drive, set L1-01 = 0 [Motor
Overload (oL1) Protection = Disabled].
Note:
If you operate more than one motor from one drive, you cannot use the electronic thermal protection of the drive.
Length of the Motor Cables
If you use long motor cables with a high carrier frequency, the increased leakage current can cause nuisance tripping
of the thermal relay. To prevent this, decrease the carrier frequency or increase the tripping level of the thermal
overload relay.
Nuisance Tripping Because of High Drive Carrier Frequency
High carrier frequency PWM drives make current waveforms that can increase the temperature in overload relays. It
may be necessary to increase the trip level setting when encountering nuisance triggering of the relay.
WARNING! Fire Hazard. Before you increase the detection level of the thermal relay, make sure that a secondary problem is not the
cause of the overload. Make sure that you know the local codes for electrical wiring, then adjust the electrothermal settings.
Incorrect thermal relay adjustment and incorrect wiring can cause serious injury or death.
■ Connect an AC Reactor
Note:
When you connect an AC reactor to the output side (secondary side) of the driver, set C6-02 = 1 [Carrier Frequency Selection = 2.0 kHz].
Electrical Installation
Figure 5.92 Example of Connecting the Noise Filter on the Output Side (Secondary Side) Electrical Installation
Note:
Glossary
• Radio frequency interference:
Electromagnetic waves radiated from the drive and cables make noise through the full radio bandwidth that can have an effect on nearby
devices.
• Inductive noise:
The noise from electromagnetic induction can have an effect on the signal line and can cause the controller to malfunction.
5
■ Prevent Inductive Noise
In addition to installing a noise filter, you can also run all wiring through a grounded metal conduit to decrease
inductive noise occurring at the output side. Put the cables a minimum of 30 cm (11.8 in) away from the signal line to
prevent induced noise. Ground the cables to metal conduits.
◆ UL Compliance
Install one of the types of short circuit protection devices in this section to comply with UL 508C. Semiconductor
protective type fuses are recommended, but the tables also show alternative short circuit protection devices.
FWH-50B
2012 20 20 20 4195
or FWH-80B
FWH-80B
2018 30 35 30 4195
or FWH-100B
FWH-80B
2021 35 40 35 4195
or FWH-100B
FWH-100B
2030 50 60 50 4195
or FWH-125B
FWH-200B
2070 110 125 110 4195
or FWH-225A
FWH-225A
2082 125 150 125 4195
or FWH-250A
FWH-225A
2110 175 200 175 10121
or FWH-250A
FWH-275A
2138 225 250 225 10121
or FWH-300A
FWH-275A
2169 250 300 250 10121
or FWH-350A
FWH-325A
2211 350 400 350 10121
or FWH-450A
FWH-700A
2313 500 600 500 14657
or FWH-800A
FWH-800A
2360 600 700 600 52800
or FWH-1000A
Table 5.22 Required Short Circuit Protection for GA800 AC Drives (408 V Class)
Protected Enclosure Not Required Ventilated Protected Enclosure Required
FWH-40B
4002 3.5 15 3.5 4195
or FWH-50B
FWH-125B
4031 50 60 50 4195
or FWH-150B
FWH-250A
4089 150 175 150 10121
or FWH-275A
FWH-250A
4103 175 200 175 10121
or FWH-275A
FWH-325A
4168 250 300 250 10121
or FWH-400A
FWH-800A
4414 700 800 n/a 52800
or FWH-1000A
FWH-1000A
4477 800 900 n/a 52800
or FWH-1200A
Ventilated Protected
FWH-1000A Enclosure Required
4568 900 1000 n/a 52800
or FWH-1200A
FWH-1200A
4720 1200 1400 n/a 52800
or FWH-1400A
Table 5.25 External EMC Noise Filter for Three-Phase 400 V Class
Model EMC Noise Filter Model Qty Manufacturer
Table 5.26 External EMC Noise Filter for 6-Phase/12-Pulse 400 V Class
Model EMC Noise Filter Model Qty Manufacturer
1 The power supply voltage must be in the input voltage specification range of the drive.
1 • Put the power supply through a molded-case circuit breaker (MCCB) before it gets to the drive input.
• Connect an applicable MCCB.
2 Correctly wire the power supply to drive main circuit terminals R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, R1/L11, S1/L21, and T1/L31.
4 Use 600 V heat resistant indoor PVC wire for the power supply and motor lines.
Note:
Wire gauge recommendations assume use of 600 V class 2 heat-resistant indoor PVC wire.
7 Tighten the main circuit and grounding terminal screws of the drive to a correct tightening torque.
8 When operating more than one motor from one drive, set up overload protection circuits.
9 When you use a braking resistor or a braking resistor unit, install an electromagnetic contactor (MC).
Correctly install the resistor and make sure that overload protection uses the MC to shut off the power supply.
10 Make sure you did not install phase advancing capacitors, input noise filters, or ELCBs, GFCIs, RCM/RCDs on the output side of the drive.
Electrical Installation
Table 5.29 Control Circuit Wiring
Checked No. Item to Check
3 For 3-Wire sequence, set parameters for MFDI terminals and wire control circuits.
6 Tighten the control circuit terminal screws of the drive to a correct tightening torque.
8 Make sure that none of the wires on the terminal block touch other terminals or connections.
9 Make sure that you isolate the control circuit wiring from main circuit wiring in the control panel or in a duct.
10 Make sure that control circuit wiring is not longer than 50 m (164 ft).
11 Make sure that Safe Disable input wiring is not longer than 30 m (98 ft).
■ High-Speed Operation
If you operate a motor more than its rated speed, you can have problems with the motor bearing durability and
dynamic balance of the machine. Contact the motor or machine manufacturer.
■ Torque Characteristics
When you operate a motor with a drive, the torque characteristics are different than when you operate the motor
directly from line power. Make sure that you know about the load torque characteristics for your application.
Use Closed Loop Vector Control when these applications have subsynchronous resonance problems.
■ Audible Noise
The audible noise of the motor changes when the carrier frequency setting changes. When you use a high carrier
frequency, audible noise from the motor is equivalent to the motor noise generated when you operate from line power.
If you operate at speeds that are more than the rated rotation speed, the unwanted motor noise increases.
■ Submersible Motors
The rated current of a submersible motor is more than the rated current of a standard motor. Use a sufficiently large
motor cable that will not let voltage drop decrease the maximum torque level.
■ Explosion-Proof Motors
You must test the motor and the drive together for explosion-proof certification. You must also test existing
installations of explosion-proof motors. The drive is not designed for explosion-proof areas. Install the drive in a safe
location.
The encoder used with pressure-resistant explosion-proof motors is intrinsically safe. When wiring between the drive
and encoder, always connect through a specialized pulse coupler.
■ Geared Motors
The continuous speed range is different for different lubricating methods and manufacturers. For oil lubrication,
continuous operation in the low-speed range can cause burnout. Contact the manufacturer for more information about
applications where operating at more than the rated frequency is necessary.
■ Single-Phase Motors
Variable speed drives are not designed to operate with single-phase motors. The drive is for use with three-phase
motors only. If you use capacitors to start the motor, it can cause a high frequency current to flow to the capacitors
and can damage the capacitors. A split-phase start or a repulsion start can burn out the starter coils because the
internal centrifugal switch is not activated.
Electrical Installation
WARNING
Electrical Shock Hazard
Do not operate the drive when covers are missing. Replace covers and shields before you operate
the drive. Use the drive only as specified by the instructions.
Some figures in this section include drives without covers or safety shields to more clearly show the inside of the
drive. If covers or safety shields are missing from the drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
Do not remove covers or touch circuit boards while the drive is energized.
If you touch the internal components of an energized drive, it can cause serious injury or death.
NOTICE
Sudden Movement Hazard
Deactivate the Run command before you switch from Programming Mode to Drive Mode.
If you switch from Programming Mode to Drive Mode and there is an active Run command, the motor will rotate
and the equipment can suddenly start.
• You pushed on the keypad while the drive is operating in REMOTE Mode.
• The drive is energized with an active Run command and b1-17 = 0 [Run Command at Power Up = Disregard Existing RUN Command].
Function Keys The menu shown on the keypad sets the functions for function keys.
D (F1, F2, F3) The name of each function is in the lower half of the display window.
Switches drive control for the Run command and frequency reference between the keypad (LOCAL) and an external source (REMOTE).
Note:
LO/RE Selection Key • The LOCAL/REMOTE Selection Key continuously stays enabled after the drive stops in Drive Mode. If the application must not
F switch from REMOTE to LOCAL because it will have a negative effect on system performance, set o2-01 = 0 [LO/RE Key Function
Selection = Disabled] to disable .
• The drive will not switch between LOCAL and REMOTE when it is receiving a Run command from an external source.
source. To disable priority, set o2-02 = 0 [STOP Key Function Selection = Disabled].
Up Arrow Key/Down Arrow • Scrolls up or down to show the next item or the previous item.
Key • Selects parameter numbers, and increments or decrements setting values.
/
H
• Moves the cursor to the right.
Right Arrow Key (RESET)
• Continues to the next screen.
• Resets the drive to clear a fault.
Before you use the keypad to operate the motor, push on the keypad to set the drive to LOCAL Mode.
J USB Terminal For factory adjustment
K RJ-45 Connector Connects to the drive using an RJ-45 8-pin straight through UTP CAT5e extension cable or keypad connector.
M Insulation Sheet An insulating sheet is attached to the keypad battery to prevent battery drain. Remove the insulation sheet before you use the keypad for the
first time.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. If you change the control source when b1-07 = 1 [LOCAL/REMOTE Run Selection = Accept
Existing RUN Command], the drive can start suddenly. Before you change the control source, remove all personnel from the area
around the drive, motor, and load. Sudden starts can cause serious injury or death.
◆ LCD Display
A Time display area Shows the current time. Set the time on the default settings screen.
D Mode display area Shows the name of the current mode or screen.
F Data display area Shows parameter values, monitor values, and details of the results of operations.
Function keys 1 to 3 (F1 to The function names shown in this area will change when the selected screen changes. Push one of the function keys
G F3)
to on the keypad to do the function.
• The drive received a Run command from the MFDI terminals and is switching to REMOTE Mode while the drive
is in LOCAL Mode.
• The drive received a Run command from an external source and the drive is not in Drive Ready (READY)
condition.
RUN LED • The drive received a Fast Stop command.
• The safety function shut off the drive output.
Flashing Quickly • You pushed on the keypad while the drive is operating in REMOTE Mode.
• The drive is energized with an active Run command and b1-17 = 0 [Run Command at Power Up = Disregard
Existing RUN Command].
• When b1-03 = 3 [Stopping Method Selection = Coast to Stop with Timer], the Run command is disabled then
enabled during the Run wait time.
• The drive received a DC Injection Braking command.
• The voltage of the main circuit power supply decreased, and the 24 V power supply is supplying power only the
the drive.
LO/RE LED Illuminated The keypad controls the Run command (LOCAL Mode).
OFF The control circuit terminal or serial transmission device controls the Run command (REMOTE Mode).
6
Figure 6.5 Keypad Functions and Display Levels
Note:
• Energize the drive with factory defaults to show the Initial Setup screen. Push [Home] to show the HOME screen.
–Select [No] from the [Show Initial Setup Screen] setting to not display the Initial Setup screen.
• Push from the Home screen to show drive monitors.
• Push to set d1-01 [Reference 1] when the Home screen shows U1-01 [Frequency Reference] in LOCAL Mode.
• The keypad will show [Rdy] when the drive is in Drive Mode. The drive is prepared to accept a Run command.
• Set b1-08 [Run Command Select in PRG Mode] to accept or reject a Run command from an external source while in Programming Mode.
–Set b1-08 = 0 [Disregard RUN while Programming] to reject the Run command from an external source while in Programming Mode
(default).
–Set b1-08 = 1 [Accept RUN while Programming] to accept the Run command from an external source while in Programming Mode.
–Set b1-08 = 2 [Allow Programming Only at Stop] to prevent changes from Drive Mode to Programming Mode while the drive is
operating.
Table 6.3 Drive Mode Screens and Functions
Mode Keypad Screen Function
Programming Mode Modified Parameters/Fault Log Shows modified parameters and fault history.
A - ALM/ERR C - RUN
B - Ready
The voltage of the main circuit power supply dropped, and only the external 24 V power supply provides the power to the
Flashing Quickly *1
drive.
B Ready
• The drive detects a fault.
• There is no fault and the drive received a Run command, but the drive cannot operate. For example, in Programming
OFF
• The drive received a Run command from the MFDI terminals and is switching to REMOTE Mode while the drive is in
LOCAL Mode.
• The drive received a Run command from the MFDI terminals when the drive is not in Drive Mode.
C RUN • The drive received a Fast Stop command.
• The safety function shuts off the drive output. Startup Procedure and Test Run
Flashing Quickly *1
• The user pushed on the keypad while the drive is operating in REMOTE Mode.
• The drive is energized with an active Run command and b1-17 = 0 [Run Command at Power Up = Disregard Existing
RUN Command].
• The drive is set to coast-to-stop with timer (b1-03 = 3 [Stopping Method Selection = Coast to Stop with Timer]), and the
Run command is disabled then enabled during the Run wait time.
*1 Refer to Figure 6.6 for the difference between “flashing” and “flashing quickly”.
◆ Flowchart A: Connect and Run the Motor with Minimum Setting Changes
Flowchart A shows a basic start-up sequence to connect and run a motor with a minimum of setting changes. Settings
can change when the application changes.
Use the drive default parameter settings for basic applications where high precision is not necessary.
*1 When A1-02 = 4 [Control Method Selection = AOLV], If you operate the drive at a frequency lower than n4-70 [Speed Command Comp
@ Low Freq] (default setting: 1.00 Hz), the motor can rotate at a frequency about 1/2 of n4-70. When you do a test run, set E1-09 > 0
[Minimum Output Frequency > 0]. The recommended setting for E1-09 is 0.5 Hz.
*2 Be sure to release the holding brake before doing Inertia Tuning.
*3 In ASR Tuning, the drive will automatically tune Feed Forward control and KEB Ride-Thru 2 parameters.
Figure 6.11 Procedure for Test Run of EZ Open Loop Vector Control Method
Connection between Drive Output Make sure that you connected drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 in the correct sequence to agree with motor terminals U, V,
Terminals and Motor Terminals and W without loosened screws.
Make sure that you connected the drive control circuit terminals in the correct sequence to agree with devices and switches without
Control Circuit Terminal Wiring loosened screws.
Control Circuit Terminal Status Turn OFF the inputs from all devices and switches connected to the drive control circuit terminals.
Connection between Machinery and Motor Disengage all couplings and belts that connect the motor and machinery.
• The data display area will show the Initial Setup screen or the HOME screen
• Energize the drive with factory defaults to show the Initial Setup screen. Select [No]
from the [Show Initial Setup Screen] settings to show the HOME screen without
showing the Initial Setup screen.
Note: 6
Make sure that you use a keypad that has a flash number of 1004 or later. Keypads that have a flash number of 1003 or earlier will not show
characters correctly.
• To change what the screen shows, change the setting for o1-40 [Home display selection].
• When o1-40 = 0 [Home Screen Display Selection = Custom Monitor], and there is more than one screen, use
or to switch between screens.
■ JOG Operation
Push to illuminate . Push and hold [JOG] to run the motor. Release [JOG] to stop the
motor.
• When there are a minimum of two screens, push or to switch between screens.
• If you registered only one custom monitor to [Custom Monitor 1], the screen will show only one monitor. If you
registered custom monitors only to [Custom Monitor 1] and [Custom Monitor 2], the screen will show only two
monitors.
6. Push .
5. Push .
Startup Procedure and Test Run
A - Monitor Parameter 1 (set with [Custom Monitor 1]) D - Trend Plot Time Scale
B - Monitor Parameter 2 (set with [Custom Monitor 2]) E - Trend Plot 1 Scale Maximum/Minimum Value
C - Trend Plot 2 Scale Maximum/Minimum Value
6. Push .
9. Push or to select the specified digit, then push or to select the correct number.
11. Push or to select [Trend Plot 1 Scale Maximum Value], then push .
12. Push or to select the specified digit, then push or to select the correct number.
6. Push or to select the specified digit, then push or to select the correct number.
Note:
Push [Hold] to switch between Pause and Restart for the monitor display. The “Hold (ENTER)” message flashes while you pause
monitoring.
7. Push or to select the specified digit, then push or to select the correct number.
9. Continue to change parameters, then push [Back], [Home] to go back to the home screen after
you change all the applicable parameters.
2. Push (Menu).
The keypad shows “End” when the backup procedure completes successfully.
The keypad will show the “End” message when the write process is complete.
Note:
The keypad display changes when the settings and conditions change.
A - A1-02 [Control Method Selection] settings D - Parameter backup data is not registered
B - o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection] settings (2 or E - Backup data does not contain the date
3 digits) Information
C - Presence of DriveWorksEZ parameter backup F - Backup date
The keypad shows “End” when the parameter settings backed up in the keypad agree with the parameter settings
copied to the drive.
Note:
The keypad shows vFyE [Parameters do not Match] when the parameter settings backed up in the keypad do not agree with the parameter
settings copied to the drive. Push one of the keys to return to the screen in Step 6.
The keypad will show the “End” message when the write process is complete.
5. Push .
5. Push .
6. Push or to select the parameters to return to their default settings, then push .
7. Push (Default).
8. Push .
4. Push .
6. Follow the messages shown on the keypad to input the necessary Auto-Tuning data.
Example: Push or to select the specified digit, then push or to change the number. Push
to save the change and move to the next entry field.
Auto-Tuning starts.
When doing Rotational Auto-Tuning, the motor will stay stopped for approximately one minute with power
energized and then the motor will start to rotate.
9. When the keypad shows this screen after Auto-Tuning is complete for 1 or 2 minutes, push or .
The keypad will show a list of the changed parameters as the result of Auto-Tuning.
10. Push or in the parameter change confirmation screen to check the changed parameters, then select
[Auto-Tuning Successful] at the bottom of the screen and push .
To change a parameter again, push or to select the parameter to change, then push to show the
parameter setting screen.
Auto-Tuning is complete.
Note:
If the drive detects an error or you push before Auto-Tuning is complete, Auto-Tuning will stop and the keypad will show an error
code. Endx identifies that Auto-Tuning was successful with calculation errors. Find and repair the cause of the error and do Auto-Tuning
again, or set the motor parameters manually. You can use the drive in the application if you cannot find the cause of the Endx error. Er-xx
identifies that Auto-Tuning was not successful. Find and repair the cause of the error and do Auto-Tuning again.
9. Push or to select the hour or minute, then push or to change the value.
7. For the next steps, follow the instructions shown on the keypad until the “Parameter Change Confirmation
Screen” is shown.
8. In the parameter change confirmation screen, push or to examine the changed parameter, then
select [Apply of each parameter] at the bottom of the screen and push .
Note:
To change a parameter again, push or to select the parameter to change, then push to show the parameter setting
screen.
• [No]: The keypad will not show the Initial Setup Screen when the drive is energized.
6
• [Yes]: The keypad will show the Initial Setup Screen when the drive is energized.
7. Push .
2. Push [Menu].
The keypad will show the “End” message when the write process is complete.
6.8 Auto-Tuning
Auto-Tuning uses motor characteristics to automatically set drive parameters for vector control. Think about the type
of motor, drive control method, and the motor installation environment and select the best Auto-Tuning method.
The keypad will show the messages with prompts to input the necessary parameter information. These prompts are
specified by the selected Auto-Tuning method and the control method setting in A1-02.
• When you can decouple the motor and load the motor
can rotate freely while Auto-Tuning.
• When operating motors that have fixed output
characteristics.
Rotational Auto-Tuning T1-01 = 0 x x x x x
• When it is necessary to use motors that have high-
precision control.
• When you cannot decouple the motor and load, but
the motor load is less than 30%.
Auto-Tuning Mode
(T1-01 Setting)
Input Data Parameter Unit
Rotational Auto-Tuning Stationary Auto-Tuning Line-to-Line Resistance
1
(0) (2)
(1)
*1 Input this value when A1-02 = 3 [Control Method Selection = Closed Loop Vector].
*2 Shows 0 Hz as the default value. If you do not know the Motor Rated Slip Frequency, keep the setting at 0 Hz.
*3 Input this value when A1-02 = 0 or 1 [Control Method Selection = V/f Control or V/f Control w/ PG].
*4 If T1-12 = 1 [Test Mode Selection = Yes], when you run the motor in Drive Mode for the first time after Auto-Tuning, the drive will
automatically set E2-02 [Motor Rated Slip] and E2-03 [Motor No-Load Current].
*5 Input this value when T1-10 [Motor Rated Slip Frequency] = 0 Hz.
*6 Set the same value to No-Load Voltage as T1-03 [Motor Rated Voltage] to get the same characteristics using Yaskawa 1000-Series drives
or other legacy models.
PM Motor Code
Selection T2-02 - - - - - -
PM Motor Base
Frequency T2-07 Hz - x - - -
Number of PM Motor
T2-08 - - x x x -
Poles
PM Motor d-Axis
Inductance T2-11 mH - - - - -
PM Motor q-Axis
T2-12 mH - - - - -
Inductance
Back-EMF Units
T2-13 - - - - - -
Selection
• After Auto-Tuning, the wiring distance between the drive and EZOLV
Line-to-Line Resistance T4-01 = 1 motor changed by 50 m or more.
• When the motor output and drive capacity are different. (8)
Table 6.12 Auto-Tuning Input Data in EZ Open Loop Vector Control Method
Auto-Tuning Mode
(T4-01 Setting)
Input Data Parameter Unit
Motor Parameter
Setting Line-to-Line Resistance
(0) (1)
◆ Control Tuning
To increase drive responsiveness and prevent hunting, use Auto-Tuning to automatically adjust the control-related
parameters.
These types of Auto-Tuning are available for the control system:
• Inertia Tuning
• ASR Tuning
• Deceleration Rate Tuning
• KEB Tuning
Note:
If you do Control Tuning, you cannot set H1-xx = 16 [Motor 2 Selection]. Do not do Control Tuning for applications that switch between
motor 1 and motor 2.
Table 6.13 Control Loop Tuning Selection
Applicable Control Method (A1-02 Value)
■ Inertia Tuning
Inertia Tuning uses the motor speed and torque reference to estimate the system inertia and automatically sets the
drive parameters related to the inertia ratio of the machinery and motor. Use Inertia Tuning for Feed Forward control
or when H1-xx = 7A [MFDI Function Select = KEB Ride-Thru 2 Activate (N.C.)].
Inertia tuning identifies the load inertia and optimizes the speed loop gain and feed forward gain to get a high level of
control capability. You can set the speed response without thinking about the load, which increases the precision when
synchronizing multiple drives. Since the motor can continue to operate during a power outage, Inertia Tuning keeps
the best ramp to stop deceleration curve for KEB Ride-Thru.
■ ASR Tuning
ASR Tuning estimates the motor load inertia and automatically sets the parameters. ASR Tuning also uses the
measured load inertia value to do an automatic adjustment after calculating the proportional gain of speed control
(ASR).
■ KEB Tuning
KEB Tuning automatically sets parameters used for the KEB Ride-Thru function and for the overvoltage suppression
function.
Control Tuning automatically sets the parameters in Table 6.15 to the best values.
Table 6.15 Parameters set in Control Tuning
Parameters Automatically Set Inertia Tuning ASR Tuning Deceleration Rate Tuning KEB Tuning
Parameters Automatically Set Inertia Tuning ASR Tuning Deceleration Rate Tuning KEB Tuning
*1 The drive automatically sets C1-08 [Deceleration Time 4] only when C1-11 [Accel/Decel Time Switchover Freq] ≠ 0.
*2 When L2-29 = 0 [Kinetic Energy Backup Method = Single Drive KEB Ride-Thru 1], the drive will automatically adjust C1-09 [Fast Stop
Time] and will not adjust L2-06 [Kinetic Energy Backup Decel Time]. If the Fast Stop time must not change, do not do KEB Tuning.
*3 When L2-29 = 1, 2, or 3 [Kinetic Energy Backup Method = Single Drive KEB Ride-Thru 2, System KEB Ride-Thru 1, or System KEB
Ride-Thru 2], the drive will automatically adjust L2-06 [Kinetic Energy Backup Decel Time].
WARNING! Crush Hazard. Wire a sequence that will not let a multi-function output terminal open the holding brake during
Stationary Auto-Tuning. If the holding brake is open during Stationary Auto-Tuning, it can cause serious injury or death.
WARNING! Sudden Movement Hazard. Before you do Rotational Auto-Tuning, disconnect the load from the motor. The load can
move suddenly and cause serious injury or death.
WARNING! Injury to Personnel. Rotational Auto-Tuning rotates the motor at 50% or more of the motor rated frequency. Make sure
that there are no issues related to safety in the area around the drive and motor. Increased motor frequency can cause serious
injury or death.
WARNING! Electrical Shock Hazard. During Auto-Tuning, the motor will receive high voltage when the motor is stopped. Do not
touch the motor until Auto-Tuning is complete. If you touch a motor that is energized, it can cause serious injury or death.
Note:
• If you cannot operate the motor with the conditions in step 2 for the first test run and if the values set in E2-02 and E2-03 are much different
than data in the official test report for the motor and the data listed in Defaults by Drive Model and Duty Rating ND/HD on page 282, these
problems can occur:
–Motor vibrations or hunting
–Not sufficient torque
–Overcurrent
In elevator applications, there is a risk of the cage falling and causing personal injury.
Do one of these precautions to decrease the risk:
–After doing Stationary Auto-Tuning, operate the drive as specified by the conditions and procedure above.
–Set T1-12 = 0 [Test Mode Selection = No].
–Do Rotational Auto-Tuning.
• If you initialize the drive after completing Step 1, do the procedure beginning from Step 1 again.
• For general-purpose motors, the target value for E2-02 is 1 Hz to 3 Hz, and the target rated current for E2-03 is 30% to 65%. Larger
capacity motors have a lower rated slip, and a smaller ratio for the no-load current rated current. Refer to Defaults by Drive Model and Duty
Rating ND/HD on page 282.
4. Push .
The RUN indicator illuminates, and the motor runs at 6.00 Hz in the forward direction.
5. Make sure that the motor is rotating in the correct direction and that the drive does not show a fault.
If the drive detects a fault, remove the cause.
A - Forward Rotation of Motor (Counter Clockwise Direction as Seen from Load Shaft)
6. Push to increase the frequency reference value.
Change the setting value in increments of 10 Hz if necessary and examine the response.
7. Each time you increase the setting value, use U1-03 [Output Current] to check the drive output current.
When the output current of the drive is not more than the motor rated current, the status is correct.
Ex.: 6 Hz → 20 Hz → 30 Hz → 40 Hz → 50 Hz → 60 Hz
8. Make sure that the motor rotates correctly, then push .
The RUN indicator will flash. When the motor stops, the indicator will go out.
4. Push .
The RUN indicator illuminates, and the motor runs at 6.00 Hz in the forward direction.
5. Make sure that the motor is rotating in the correct direction and that the drive does not show a fault.
If the drive detects a fault, remove the cause.
6. Push to increase the frequency reference value.
Change the setting value in increments of 10 Hz if necessary and examine the response.
7. Each time you increase the setting value, use U1-03 [Output Current] to check the drive output current.
When the output current of the drive is not more than the motor rated current, the status is correct.
Ex.: 6 Hz → 20 Hz → 30 Hz → 40 Hz → 50 Hz → 60 Hz
8. Make sure that the motor rotates correctly, then push .
The RUN indicator will flash. When the motor stops, the indicator will go out.
9. Change the frequency reference and direction of motor rotation, and make sure that there are no unusual
sounds or vibrations.
10. If there are hunting or oscillation errors caused by control function, adjust the settings to stop the errors.
Startup Procedure and Test Run
*1 The default setting changes when the settings for C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection] and o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection]
change.
*2 The default setting changes when the settings for A1-02 [Control Method Selection] and o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection] change.
*3 The default setting changes when the settings for A1-02 [Control Method Selection] and E1-03 [V/f Pattern Selection] change.
*4 Recommended settings are for 200 V class drives. Multiply the voltage by 2 for 400 V class drives.
*5 In Closed Loop V/f Control, ASR only controls the output frequency. You cannot make a high-gain as in Closed Loop Vector control.
*1 The default setting changes when the settings forA1-02 [Control Method Selection] and o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection] change.
*2 The default setting changes when the settings for A1-02 [Control Method Selection] and E1-03 [V/f Pattern Selection] change.
*3 The default setting changes when the settings for C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection] and o2-04 change.
*4 Recommended settings are for 200 V class drives. Multiply the voltage by 2 for 400 V class drives.
• High speed
C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain • If torque or speed response are
slow, increase the setting value
1]
in increments of 5.00. 20.00 10.00 - 50.00
• Low speed
• If hunting or oscillation occur,
• Unsatisfactory motor torque C5-03 [ASR Proportional Gain decrease the setting value.
and speed response 2 (P)] *1
• Hunting or oscillation • High speed
C5-02 [ASR Integral Time 1] • If torque or speed response are
slow, decrease the setting value.
• Low speed 0.500 s 0.300 s to 1.000 s
C5-04 [ASR Integral Time 2 • If hunting or oscillation occur,
increase the setting value.
(I)] *1
The drive cannot find ASR C5-07 [ASR Gain Switchover Change the ASR proportional gain 0.0 Hz to maximum output
proportional gain or integral time and ASR integral time to conform 0.0 Hz
for low speed or high speed. Frequency] *1 to the output frequency. frequency
*1 Refer to the section on C5-xx parameters for more information about speed control (ASR).
*2 The default setting changes when the settings for C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection] and o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection]
change.
• High speed
• If torque or speed response are
C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain slow, increase the setting value
1] • C5-01 = 10.00
in increments of 5.00. 10.00 to 50.00
• Low speed • C5-03 = 20.00
• If hunting or oscillation occur,
• Unsatisfactory motor torque C5-03 [ASR Proportional Gain
2 (P)] *3 decrease the setting value.
and speed response
• Hunting or oscillation • High speed • If torque or speed response are
C5-02 [ASR Integral Time 1] slow, decrease the setting
• Low speed value. 0.500 s 0.300 s to 1.000 s
C5-04 [ASR Proportional Gain • If hunting or oscillation occur,
2 (P)] *3 increase the setting value.
*1 The default setting changes when the settings for C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection] and o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection]
change.
*2 The default setting changes when the setting for o2-04 [Drive Model Selection] changes.
*3 Refer to the section on C5-xx parameters for more information about speed control (ASR).
*4 The best values for a no-load operation are different than the best values for actual loading operation.
50%
Note:
There is too much current during n8-79 [Pull-in Current at When n8-79 = 0, the drive will Decrease in increments of 5%.
deceleration. Deceleration] Set n8-79 < n8-51.
apply the n8-51 setting to the
pull-in current during
deceleration.
• Yaskawa motor
• E5-09 [PM Back-EMF Vpeak • Adjust the setting value. Set the motor code from the
The drive detects STPo [Motor • Examine the motor code on the motor nameplate.
(mV/(rad/s))]
Step-Out Detected] fault when the motor nameplate or the data *1 • Motor from another
load is not too high. • E5-24 [PM Back-EMF L-L
sheet, then set correct values for manufacturer
Vrms (mV/rpm)] E5-09 or E5-24. Set the values from the test
report.
*1 The default setting changes when the settings for E5-01 [Motor Code Selection] and o2-04 [Drive Model (KVA) Selection] change.
The drive cannot find ASR C5-07 [ASR Gain Switchover Change the ASR proportional gain
proportional gain or integral time and ASR integral time to conform 0.0% 0.0% to maximum rotation speed
Frequency]
for low speed or high speed. to the output frequency.
*1 The best values for a no-load operation are different than the best values for actual loading operation.
• High speed
C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain • If torque or speed response are
slow, increase the setting value
1]
in increments of 5.00. 20.00 10.00 to 50.00 *1
• Low speed
• Unsatisfactory motor torque • If hunting or oscillation occur,
C5-03 [ASR Proportional Gain
and speed response 2] decrease the setting value.
• Hunting or oscillation
• High speed • If torque or speed response are
C5-02 [ASR Integral Time 1] slow, decrease the setting value.
0.500 s 0.300 to 1.000 s *1
• Low speed • If hunting or oscillation occur,
C5-04 [ASR Integral Time 2] increase the setting value.
*1 The best values for a no-load operation are different than the best values for actual loading operation.
The drive cannot find ASR C5-07 [ASR Gain Switchover Change the ASR proportional gain
proportional gain or integral time and ASR integral time to conform 0.0% 0.0% to maximum rotation speed
Frequency]
for low speed or high speed. to the output frequency.
Motor stalls. L7-01 to L7-04 [Torque Limit] Increase the setting value. 200% Increase in increments of 10%.
*1 The best values for a no-load operation are different than the best values for actual loading operation.
3 Set the voltage for the power supply in E1-01 [Input AC Supply Voltage].
Select the best V/f pattern for your application and motor characteristics.
4 Example: For a motor with a rated frequency of 60 Hz, set E1-03 = 1 [V/f Pattern Selection = Const Trq, 60Hz base, 60Hz max] as a standard V/f
pattern.
5 Set F1-01 [Encoder 1 Pulse Count (PPR)] correctly and make sure that encoder pulse counting direction is correct.
6 Set C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1] and C5-02 [ASR Integral Time 1].
Table 6.27 Open Loop Vector Control [A1-02 = 2] or Closed Loop Vector Control [A1-02 = 3]
Checked No. Description
Refer to the information on the motor nameplate and set this data correctly:
• Motor rated power (kW) to T1-02
• Motor rated voltage (V) to T1-03
8 • Motor rated current (A) to T1-04
• Motor base frequency (Hz) to T1-05
• Number of motor poles to T1-06
• Motor base speed (min-1) to T1-07
9 Do Rotational Auto-Tuning.
10 Set F1-01 [Encoder 1 Pulse Count (PPR)] and F1-05 [Encoder 1 Rotation Selection].
11 Set C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1] and C5-02 [ASR Integral Time 1].
12 Set E5-01 through E5-24 [PM Motor Settings]. Startup Procedure and Test Run
14 Set C5-01 [ASR Proportional Gain 1] and C5-02 [ASR Integral Time 1].
17 Set F1-01 [Encoder 1 Pulse Count (PPR)] and F1-05 [Encoder 1 Rotation Selection].
19 The keypad will show “Rdy” after starting to operate the motor.
20 To give the Run command and frequency reference from the keypad, push to set to LOCAL Mode (when in LOCAL Mode, the LO/RE LED
illuminates).
21 If the motor rotates in the opposite direction during test run, switch two of the motor cables (U/T1, V/T2, W/T3).
22 Set Heavy Duty or Normal Duty Mode with C6-01 [Normal / Heavy Duty Selection] to conform to the load condition.
23 Set E2-01 [Motor Rated Current (FLA)] and L1-01 [Motor Overload Protection Select] correctly for motor thermal protection.
24 Set the drive for REMOTE Mode when the control circuit terminals supply the Run command and frequency reference (in REMOTE Mode, the LO/
RE LED turns OFF).
Make sure that the frequency reference reaches the necessary minimum and maximum values.
→ If drive operation is incorrect, make these adjustments:
28 Gain adjustment: Set the maximum voltage and current values, then adjust the analog input gain until the frequency reference reaches the necessary
value. (For terminal A1 input: H3-03, for terminal A2 input: H3-11, for terminal A3 input: H3-07)
Bias adjustment: Set the maximum voltage/current values, then adjust the analog input bias until the frequency reference reaches the necessary
minimum value. (For terminal A1 input: H3-04, for terminal A2 input: H3-12, for terminal A3 input: H3-08)
• Fan
110% of the rated output current for
Normal Duty Rating • Pump 60 seconds The permitted frequency
1 2 kHz Swing-PWM
(ND) • Blower of overload is one time each 10
minutes.
• Variable speed control
Specifications
HD (DC) 4.5 5.9 8.2 10.9 15.6 20.8 25.3 36.8 49.4
Rated Input
Input Current (A)
ND (AC) 4.8 6.7 8.9 12.7 17 20.7 30 40.3 52
ND (DC) 5.9 8.2 10.9 15.6 20.8 25.3 36.8 49.4 71.3
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 208 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output is based on 4-pole, general-purpose 220 V motor ratings. The rated output current of the drive
output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
Table 7.3 Rating (200 V Class)
Model 2056 2070 2082 2110 2138
HD *1 11 15 18.5 22 30
Maximum Applicable Motor Output (kW)
ND *2 15 18.5 22 30 37
HD *1 15 20 25 30 40
Maximum Applicable Motor Output (HP)
ND *2 20 25 30 40 50
HD 47 60 75 88 115
Output Rated Output
Current (A)
ND 56 70 82 110 138
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 208 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output is based on 4-pole, general-purpose 220 V motor ratings. The rated output current of the drive
output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
Table 7.4 Rating (200 V Class)
Model 2169 2211 2257 2313 2360 2415
HD *1 37 45 55 75 90 110
Maximum Applicable Motor Output
(kW)
ND *2 45 55 75 90 110 -
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 208 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current
of the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output is based on 4-pole, general-purpose 220 V motor ratings. The rated output current of the drive
output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
Specifications
Rated Input HD (DC) 2.3 4.3 5.8 8.2 10.9 14.3 19.4 26.0
Current (A) at
380 V Input ND (AC) 2.5 4.7 6.7 8.9 11.7 15.8 21.2 30.6
Rated Input HD (DC) 1.9 2.5 4.8 6.8 9.0 11.0 16.0 21.5
Current (A) at
460 V Input ND (AC) 2.1 3.9 5.5 7.4 9.0 13.1 17.5 25.3
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 380 V motor ratings as specified in Annex G of IEC 60947-4-1. The rated output
current of the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 460 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
Table 7.6 Rating (400 V Class)
Model Duty Rating 4031 4038 4044 4060 4075 4089 4103
HD 11 15 18.5 22 30 37 45
Maximum Applicable Motor
Output (kW) at 380 V Input *1
ND 15 18.5 22 30 37 45 55
HD 15 20 25 30 40 50 60
Maximum Applicable Motor
Output (HP) at 460 V Input *2
ND 20 25 30 40 50 60 75
Rated Input HD (DC) 37.5 50.5 61.9 52.8 71.4 87.5 106.0
Current (A) at
380 V Input ND (AC) 41.3 50.5 59.7 58.3 71.5 86.5 105
Rated Input HD (DC) 31.0 41.8 51.1 43.7 59.0 72.3 87.5
Current (A) at
460 V Input ND (AC) 34.1 41.7 49.4 48.1 59.0 71.4 86.9
HD 24 31 39 45 60 75 91
Output Rated Output
Current (A)
ND 31 38 44 59.6 74.9 89.2 103
Model Duty Rating 4031 4038 4044 4060 4075 4089 4103
Input Power HD 24 33 40 34 46 57 69
(kVA) at 380 V
Input ND 33 40 48 46 57 69 84
Power Supply
Input Power HD 21 28 35 30 40 49 59
(kVA) at 460 V
Input ND 28 35 41 40 49 59 72
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 380 V motor ratings as specified in Annex G of IEC 60947-4-1. The rated output
current of the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 460 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
Table 7.7 Rating (400 V Class)
Model Duty Rating 4140 4168 4208 4250 4302 4371 4414
The maximum applicable motor HD 75 100 125 150 200 250 300
output (HP) at 460 V Input *2
ND 100 125 150 200 250 300 350
Rated Input HD (DC) 129 174 209 254 304 367 457
Current (A) at
380 V Input ND (AC) 142 170 207 248 300 373 410
Rated Input HD (DC) 106.0 144 172 210 284 354 424
Current (A) at
460 V Input ND (AC) 118 141 171 232 289 346 403
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 380 V motor ratings as specified in Annex G of IEC 60947-4-1. The rated output
current of the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 460 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
Table 7.8 Rating (400 V Class)
Model Input Voltage Duty Rating 4477 4568 4605 4720
≥ 460 V *2
ND 400 450 500 600
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 380 V motor ratings as specified in Annex G of IEC 60947-4-1. The rated output
current of the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 460 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
HD 45 55 75 90 110 132
Maximum Applicable Motor Output
(kW) at 380 V Output *1
ND 55 75 90 110 132 160
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 380 V motor ratings as specified in Annex G of IEC 60947-4-1. The rated output
current of the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 460 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
Table 7.10 Ratings (6-Phase/12-Pulse 400 V Class)
Model Duty Rating T371 T414 T477 T568 T605 T720
*1 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 380 V motor ratings as specified in Annex G of IEC 60947-4-1. The rated output
current of the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
*2 The maximum applicable motor output complies with 460 V motor ratings as specified in NEC Table 430.250. The rated output current of
Specifications
the drive output amps must be equal to or more than the motor rated current.
• V/f Control
• V/f Control with Encoder
• Open Loop Vector
• Closed Loop Vector
Control Methods • Advanced Open Loop Vector
• PM Open Loop Vector
• PM Advanced Open Loop Vector
• PM Closed Loop Vector
• EZ Vector Control
Frequency Accuracy Digital inputs: ±0.01% of the maximum output frequency (-10 °C to +40 °C (14 °F to 104 °F))
(Temperature Analog inputs: In ±0.1% of the maximum output frequency (25 °C ±10 °C (77 °F ±18 °F))
Fluctuation)
Frequency Setting Main speed frequency reference: -10 Vdc to +10 Vdc (20 kΩ), 0 Vdc to 10 Vdc (20 kΩ), 4 mA to 20 mA (250 Ω), 0 mA to 20 mA (250 Ω)
Signal Main speed reference: Pulse train input (maximum 32 kHz)
• V/f: 150%/3 Hz
• CL-V/f: 150%/3 Hz
• OLV: 200%/0.3 Hz
• CLV: 200%/0 min-1 (r/min)
• AOLV: 200%/0.3 Hz
• OLV/PM: 100%/5% speed
• AOLV/PM: 200%/0 min-1 (r/min)
• CLV/PM: 200%/0 min-1 (r/min)
Starting Torque • EZOLV: 100%/1% speed
Note:
• Correctly select the drive and motor capacity for this starting torque in these control methods:
–OLV
–CLV
–AOLV
–AOLV/PM
–CLV/PM
• Set n8-57 = 1 [HFI Overlap Selection = Enabled] for this starting torque in AOLV/PM. When you use a non-Yaskawa PM motor, do Rotational Auto-
Tuning.
Item Specification
• V/f: 1:40
• CL-V/f: 1:40
• OLV: 1:200
• CLV: 1:1500
• AOLV: 1:200
• OLV/PM: 1:20
Speed Control Range • AOLV/PM: 1:100
• CLV/PM: 1:1500
• EZOLV: 1:100
Note:
• Set n8-57 = 1 [HFI Overlap Selection = Enabled] for this Speed Control Range in AOLV/PM. When you use a non-Yaskawa PM motor, do Rotational
Auto-Tuning.
• Speed control range of 1:100 for AOLV/PM is Instantaneous operation range. Correctly select the drive and motor capacity for continuous operation.
You can use parameter settings for different limits in four quadrants in these control methods:
• OLV
• CLV
Torque Limits • AOLV
• AOLV/PM
• CLV/PM
• EZOLV
Approximately 20%
Approximately 125% with a dynamic braking option
• Short-time average deceleration torque
Motor output 0.4/0.75 kW: over 100%
Motor output 1.5 kW: over 50%
Motor output 2.2 kW and larger: over 20%, Overexcitation Braking/High Slip Braking allow for approximately 40%
• Continuous regenerative torque: Approximately 20%. Dynamic braking option allows for approximately 125%, 10%ED, 10 s
WARNING!
Set L3-04 = 0 [Stall Prevention during Decel = Disabled] when you operate the drive with:
Braking Torque
• a regenerative converter
• regenerative unit
• braking unit
• braking resistor
• braking resistor unit.
If you set the parameter incorrectly, the drive can decelerate for too long and cause serious injury or death.
Note:
• Models 2004 to 2138 and 4002 to 4168 have a built-in braking transistor.
• Short-time average deceleration torque refers to the torque needed to decelerate the motor (uncoupled from the load) from the rated speed to zero. Motor
characteristics can change the actual specifications.
• Motor characteristics change the continuous regenerative torque and short-time average deceleration torque for motors 2.2 kW and larger.
V/f Characteristics Select from 15 pre-defined V/f patterns, or a user-set V/f pattern.
Torque Control, Droop Control, Speed/Torque Control Switching, Feed Forward Control, Zero Servo Function, Restart After Momentary Power Loss, Speed
Search, Overtorque/Undertorque Detection, Torque Limit, 17 Step Speed (maximum), Accel/Decel Switch, S-curve Acceleration/Deceleration, 3-wire
Sequence, Auto-Tuning (Rotational and Stationary), Dwell Function, Cooling Fan ON/OFF Switch, Slip Compensation, Torque Compensation, Frequency
Main Control Jump, Upper/Lower Limits for Frequency Reference, DC Injection Braking at Start and Stop, Overexcitation Braking, High Slip Braking, PID Control (with
Functions
Sleep Function), Energy Saving Control, MEMOBUS/Modbus Communication (RS-485 max, 115.2 kbps), Auto Restart, Application Presets, DriveWorksEZ
(customized functions), Removable Terminal Block with Parameter Backup Function, Online Tuning, KEB, Overexcitation Deceleration, Inertia (ASR)
Tuning, Overvoltage Suppression, High Frequency Injection
Momentary Drive stops when the output current is more than 200% of the HD output current.
Overcurrent
Specifications
Protection
Drive stops when the output current is more than these overload tolerances:
• HD: 150% of the rated output current for 60 seconds The permitted frequency of overload is one time each 10 minutes.
• ND: 110% of the rated output current for 60 seconds The permitted frequency of overload is one time each 10 minutes.
Overload Protection
Note:
• If output frequency < 6 Hz, the drive can trigger the overload protection function when the output current is in the overload tolerance range.
• Derating can be necessary for applications that start and stop frequently. 7
Item Specification
Overvoltage 200 V Class: Stops when the DC bus voltage is more than approximately 410 V
Protection 400 V Class: Stops when the DC bus voltage is more than approximately 820 V
Undervoltage 200 V Class: Stops when the DC bus voltage decreases to less than approximately 190 V
Protection 400 V Class: Stops when the DC bus voltage decreases to less than approximately 380 V
Braking Resistor Overheat detection for braking resistor (optional ERF-type, 3% ED)
Overheat Protection
Stall Prevention Stall prevention is available during acceleration, deceleration, and during run.
Braking Transistor Models 2004 to 2138 and 4002 to 4168 have a braking transistor.
DC Link Choke Models 2110 to 2415 and 4060 to 4720 have a DC link choke.
95% RH or less
Humidity
Do not let condensation form on the drive.
Storage Temperature -20 °C to +70 °C (-4 °F to +158 °F) (short-term temperature during transportation)
Item Specification
Installation Install the drive vertically for sufficient airflow to cool the drive.
Orientation
• UL61800-5-1
• EN61800-3
Harmonized Standard
• IEC/EN61800-5-1
• Two Safe Disable inputs and one EDM output according to EN ISO 13849-1:2015 (PL e (Cat.III)), IEC/EN61508 SIL3
Specifications
2004 3.5 8 35 19 54
2006 5 8 37 26 63
2008 6.9 8 40 36 76
2010 8 8 44 43 87
2012 11 8 50 61 111
2018 14 8 47 82 129
2004 4.2 2 35 18 53
2006 6 2 38 25 63
2008 8 2 42 34 76
2010 9.6 2 49 46 95
The rated output current Carrier Frequency Interior Unit Loss Cooling Fin Loss Total Loss
Model
A kHz W W W
◆ 400 V Class
Table 7.17 Drive Watt Loss (Heavy Duty)
The rated output current Carrier Frequency Interior Unit Loss Cooling Fin Loss Total Loss
Model
A kHz W W W
4002 1.8 8 38 15 53
4004 3.4 8 42 28 70
4005 4.8 8 46 37 83
4007 5.5 8 48 45 93
4009 7.2 8 37 61 98
4002 2.1 2 39 16 55
4004 4.1 2 44 33 77
4005 5.4 2 48 31 79
4007 7.1 2 52 44 96
7
The rated output current Carrier Frequency Interior Unit Loss Cooling Fin Loss Total Loss
Model
A kHz W W W
Specifications
■ 200 V Class
Table 7.21 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 7, 8
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz 15 kHz 2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz 15 kHz
2004 3.5 3.5 3.5 3.4 3.2 3.06 4.2 4.0 3.6 3.4 3.1 2.77
2006 5.0 5.0 5.0 4.8 4.6 4.3 6 5.6 5 4.6 4.1 3.6
2008 6.9 6.9 6.9 6.5 5.9 5.4 8 7.6 6.9 6.5 5.9 5.4
2010 8.0 8.0 8.0 7.4 6.6 5.8 9.6 9.0 8 7.4 6.6 5.8
2012 11.0 11.0 11.0 10.4 9.6 8.8 12 11.7 11 10.5 9.9 9.3
2018 14.0 14.0 14.0 12.6 10.8 9.1 17.5 16.1 14 12.6 10.8 9.1
2021 17.5 17.5 17.5 16.1 14.3 12.6 21 19.6 17 16.1 14.3 12.5
2030 25.0 25.0 25.0 23.0 20.5 18.0 30 28.0 25 23.0 20.5 18.0
2042 33.0 33.0 33.0 29.3 24.8 20.2 42 38.4 33 29.4 24.9 20.4
2056 47.0 47.0 47.0 43.4 38.9 34.4 56 52.4 47 43.4 38.9 34.4
2070 60.0 60.0 60.0 56.0 51.0 46 70 66.0 60 56.0 51.0 46.0
2082 75.0 75.0 75.0 68.6 60.5 53 82 82.0 75 68.8 61.0 53.1
2110 88.0 88.0 88.0 80.5 71.0 62 110 102.7 92 84.3 75.2 66.0
2138 115.0 115.0 115.0 105.1 92.8 81 138 128.8 115 105.8 94.3 82.8
Table 7.22 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 4 [AOLV]
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz 2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz
2004 3.5 3.5 3.2 3.1 2.8 4.2 3.7 3.1 2.8 2.3
2008 6.9 6.9 6.0 5.4 4.5 8 7.0 6.0 5.4 4.5
2010 8.0 8.0 6.7 5.8 4.5 9.6 8.2 7 5.8 4.6
2018 14.0 14.0 11.2 9.1 6.4 17.5 14.3 11 9.1 6.4
2110 88.0 88.0 72.9 61.6 47.5 110 93.5 77 66.0 52.3
2138 115.0 115.0 95.3 80.5 62.0 138 117.3 97 82.8 65.6
Table 7.23 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 6 [AOLV/ PM]
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz 2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz
2004 3.5 3.5 3.4 3.2 3.1 2.9 4.2 3.8 3.5 3.1 2.8 2.4
2006 5.0 5.0 4.9 4.6 4.3 4.1 6.0 5.4 4.8 4.2 3.6 3.0
2008 6.9 6.9 6.7 6.0 5.4 4.7 8.0 7.3 6.7 6.0 5.4 4.7
2010 8.0 8.0 7.7 6.7 5.8 4.8 9.6 8.6 7.7 6.7 5.8 4.8
2012 11.0 11.0 10.7 9.8 8.8 7.9 12.2 11.5 10.7 10.0 9.3 8.6
2018 14.0 14.0 13.3 11.2 9.1 6.9 17.5 15.4 13.3 11.2 9.1 6.9
2021 17.5 17.5 16.8 14.7 12.6 10.4 21.0 18.9 16.8 14.6 12.5 10.4
2030 25.0 25.0 24.0 21.0 18.0 15.0 30.0 27.0 24.0 21.0 18.0 15.0
2042 33.0 33.0 31.2 25.7 20.2 14.7 42.0 36.6 31.2 25.8 20.4 15.0
2056 47.0 47.0 45.2 39.8 34.4 29.0 56.0 50.6 45.2 39.8 34.4 29.0
2070 60.0 60.0 58.0 52.0 46.0 40.0 70.0 64.0 58.0 52.0 46.0 40.0
Specifications
2082 75.0 75.0 71.8 62.1 52.5 42.9 82.0 81.4 72.0 62.6 53.1 43.7
2110 88.0 88.0 84.2 72.9 61.6 50.3 110.0 99.0 88.0 77.0 66.0 55.0
2138 115.0 115.0 110.1 95.3 80.5 65.7 138.0 124.2 110.4 96.6 82.8 69.0
2169 145.0 138.4 118.6 98.8 78.9 - 169.0 144.6 120.1 95.7 71.2 -
7
2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz 2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz
2211 180.0 171.7 146.9 122.0 97.2 - 211.0 179.7 148.5 117.2 86.0 -
2257 215.0 204.9 174.7 144.5 114.3 - 257.0 217.1 177.2 137.3 97.4 -
2313 283.0 271.7 237.7 203.8 169.8 - 313.0 276.2 239.4 202.6 165.8 -
2360 346.0 328.8 277.0 225.3 173.6 - 359.6 316.4 273.2 230.0 186.8 -
■ 400 V Class
Table 7.24 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 0, 1, 2, 3, 5, 7, 8 (< 460 V)
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz 15 kHz 2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz 15 kHz
4002 1.8 1.8 1.8 1.6 1.3 1.0 2.1 2.0 1.8 1.7 1.5 1.4
4004 3.4 3.4 3.4 2.9 2.3 1.7 4.1 3.8 3.4 3.1 2.8 2.4
4005 4.8 4.8 4.8 4.3 3.7 3.0 5.4 5.2 4.8 4.6 4.3 3.9
4007 5.5 5.5 5.5 4.9 4.1 3.2 7.1 6.5 5.5 4.8 4.0 3.2
4009 7.2 7.2 7.2 6.5 5.6 4.8 8.9 8.2 7.2 6.5 5.6 4.8
4012 9.2 9.2 9.2 8.1 6.8 5.4 11.9 10.8 9.2 8.1 6.7 5.4
4018 14.8 14.8 14.8 13.1 11.0 8.9 17.5 17.3 14.8 13.1 11.0 8.9
4023 18.0 18.0 18.0 15.9 13.4 10.8 23 21.5 18.3 16.2 13.6 11.0
4031 24.0 24.0 24.0 21.2 17.7 14.1 31 28.2 24.0 21.1 17.6 14.1
4038 31.0 31.0 31.0 27.5 23.0 18.6 38 36.3 31.0 27.5 23.0 18.6
4044 39.0 39.0 39.0 34.5 29.0 23.4 44 43.6 37.5 33.5 28.4 23.4
4060 45.0 45.0 45.0 39.1 31.8 24.4 60 53.7 44.9 39.1 31.7 24
4075 60.0 60.0 60.0 53.1 44.6 36.0 75 73.8 62.9 55.6 46.5 37
4089 75.0 75.0 75.0 66.4 55.7 45.0 89 88.8 75.8 67.2 56.4 46
4103 91.0 91.0 91.0 80.6 67.6 54.6 103 103.0 90.3 80.1 67.3 55
Table 7.25 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 4 [AOLV] (< 460 V)
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz
4002 1.8 1.8 1.3 1.0 0.6 2.1 1.8 1.6 1.4 1.2
4004 3.4 3.4 2.4 1.7 0.8 4.1 3.5 2.8 2.4 1.9
4005 4.8 4.8 3.8 3.0 2.1 5.4 4.9 4.3 3.9 3.5
4007 5.5 5.5 4.2 3.2 2.0 7.1 5.7 4.2 3.2 2.0
4009 7.2 7.2 5.8 4.8 3.5 8.9 7.4 5.8 4.8 3.5
4012 9.2 9.2 7.0 5.4 3.3 11.9 9.5 7.0 5.4 3.3
4018 14.8 14.8 11.4 8.9 5.7 17.5 15.2 11.4 8.9 5.7
4023 18.0 18.0 13.9 10.8 6.9 23 18.8 14.1 11.0 7.1
4031 24.0 24.0 18.4 14.1 8.8 31 24.7 18.3 14.1 8.8
4038 31.0 31.0 23.9 18.6 12.0 38 31.9 23.9 18.6 12.0
4044 39.0 39.0 30.1 23.4 15.0 44 38.5 29.5 23.4 15.8
4060 45.0 45.0 33.3 24.4 13.4 60 46.4 33.2 24.4 13.4
4075 60.0 60.0 46.3 36.0 23.1 75 64.7 48.4 37.5 23.8
4089 75.0 75.0 57.9 45.0 28.9 89 78.0 58.6 45.6 29.4
4103 91.0 91.0 70.2 54.6 35.1 103 92.8 69.9 54.6 35.5
Table 7.26 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 6 [AOLV/ PM] (< 460 V)
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz 2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz
4002 1.8 1.8 1.7 1.3 1.0 0.6 2.1 1.9 1.7 1.6 1.4 1.2
4004 3.4 3.4 3.2 2.4 1.7 1.0 4.1 3.7 3.3 2.8 2.4 2.0
4005 4.8 4.8 4.5 3.8 3.0 2.3 5.4 5.0 4.7 4.3 3.9 3.6
4007 5.5 5.5 5.2 4.2 3.2 2.3 7.1 6.1 5.2 4.2 3.2 2.3
4009 7.2 7.2 6.9 5.8 4.8 3.8 8.9 7.9 6.8 5.8 4.8 3.7
Specifications
4012 9.2 9.2 8.7 7.0 5.4 3.8 11.9 10.3 8.6 7.0 5.4 3.8
4018 14.8 14.8 14.0 11.4 8.9 6.3 17.5 16.5 14.0 11.4 8.9 6.3
4023 18.0 18.0 17.0 13.9 10.8 7.7 23.4 20.4 17.3 14.1 11.0 7.8
4031 24.0 24.0 22.6 18.4 14.1 9.9 31.0 26.8 22.6 18.3 14.1 9.9 7
2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz 2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz
4038 31.0 31.0 29.2 23.9 18.6 13.3 38.0 34.5 29.2 23.9 18.6 13.3
4044 39.0 39.0 36.8 30.1 23.4 16.7 44.0 41.6 35.5 29.5 23.4 17.3
4060 45.0 45.0 42.1 33.3 24.4 15.6 59.6 50.8 42.0 33.2 24.4 15.6
4075 60.0 60.0 56.6 46.3 36.0 25.7 74.9 70.2 59.3 48.4 37.5 26.5
4089 75.0 75.0 70.7 57.9 45.0 32.1 89.2 84.5 71.5 58.6 45.6 32.7
4103 91.0 91.0 85.8 70.2 54.6 39.0 103.0 100.5 85.2 69.9 54.6 39.3
4140 112.0 105.3 85.1 65.0 44.8 - 140.0 114.1 88.1 62.0 36.0 -
4168 150.0 141.0 114.0 87.0 60.0 - 168.0 141.8 115.6 89.5 63.3 -
4208 180.0 169.2 136.8 104.4 72.0 - 208.0 165.5 123.1 80.6 38.1 -
4250 216.0 203.0 164.2 125.3 86.4 - 250.0 207.7 165.3 123.0 80.6 -
4302 260.0 244.4 197.6 150.8 104.0 - 302.0 252.2 202.3 152.5 102.6 -
4371 304.0 285.8 231.0 176.3 121.6 - 371.0 305.3 239.7 174.0 108.3 -
4414 371.0 348.7 282.0 215.2 148.4 - 414.0 348.6 282.8 216.9 151.1 -
2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz 15 kHz 2 kHz 5 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12.5 kHz 15 kHz
T103 91.0 91.0 91.0 80.6 67.6 54.6 103 103.0 90.3 80.1 67.3 55
Table 7.28 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 4 [AOLV] (< 460 V)
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz
T103 91.0 91.0 70.2 54.6 35.1 103 92.8 69.9 54.6 35.5
Table 7.29 Carrier Frequency and Rated Current Derating When A1-02 = 6 [AOLV/ PM] (< 460 V)
Rated Current (A)
2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz 2 kHz 4 kHz 6 kHz 8 kHz 10 kHz 12 kHz
T103 91.0 91.0 85.8 70.2 54.6 39.0 103.0 100.5 85.2 69.9 54.6 39.3
T140 112.0 105.3 85.1 65.0 44.8 - 140.0 114.1 88.1 62.0 36.0 -
T168 150.0 141.0 114.0 87.0 60.0 - 168.0 141.8 115.6 89.5 63.3 -
T208 180.0 169.2 136.8 104.4 72.0 - 208.0 165.5 123.1 80.6 38.1 -
T250 216.0 203.0 164.2 125.3 86.4 - 250.0 207.7 165.3 123.0 80.6 -
T302 260.0 244.4 197.6 150.8 104.0 - 302.0 252.2 202.3 152.5 102.6 -
T371 304.0 285.8 231.0 176.3 121.6 - 371.0 305.3 239.7 174.0 108.3 -
T414 371.0 348.7 282.0 215.2 148.4 - 414.0 348.6 282.8 216.9 151.1 -
A - L8-35 = 0 C - L8-35 = 1
B - L8-35 = 2, L8-35 = 3
L8-12 Ambient Temperature V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV 40 °C
(04B8) Setting Sets the ambient temperature of the drive installation area. (-10 °C - +50 °C)
The drive automatically adjusts the drive rated current to the best value as specified by the set temperature. Set the
ambient temperature of the area where you install the drive to a value that is more than the drive rating.
Refer to Derating Depending on Ambient Temperature on page 531 for information about derating depending on
ambient temperature.
L8-35 Installation Method V/f CL-V/f OLV CLV AOLV OLV/PM AOLV/PM CLV/PM EZOLV Determined by the drive
(04EC) Selection Sets the type of drive installation. (0 - 3)
Note:
• Parameter A1-03 [Initialize Parameters] does not initialize this parameter.
• This parameter is set to the correct value when the drive is shipped. Side-by-Side installation
–Change the value only in these conditions:
–When you install a UL Type 1 kit on an IP20/UL Open Type drive to convert the drive to an IP20/UL Type 1 drive.
The overload protection detection level for the drive is automatically adjusted to the optimal value in accordance with
the setting value. Refer to Derating Depending on Ambient Temperature on page 531 for information about derating
as specified by ambient temperature.
0 : IP20/UL Open Type/Ex Heatsink
Use this setting to install IP20/UL Open Type drives or when the heatsink (cooling fin) is outside the enclosure panel.
Make sure that there is 30 mm (1.18 in) minimum of space between drives or between the drive and side of the
enclosure panel.
1 : Side-by-Side Mounting
Use this setting to install more than one drive side-by-side.
Make sure that there is 2 mm (0.08 in) minimum of space between drives.
2 : IP20/UL Type 1
Use this setting to install IP20/UL Type 1 drives or IP55/UL Type 12 Heatsink External Mounting drives.
3 : Finless
Use this setting to install a finless drive.
◆ Altitude Derating
Install the drive in a location that has an altitude of 1000 m (3281 ft) or lower.
Derate the output current by 1% for each 100 m (328 ft) to install the drive in altitudes between 1000 to 4000 m (3281
to 13123 ft).
It is not necessary to derate the rated voltage in these conditions:
• Installing the drive at 2000 m (6562 ft) or lower
• Installing the drive between 2000 to 4000 m (6562 to 13123 ft) and grounding the neutral point on the power
supply.
If you do not ground the drive with a neutral network, contact Yaskawa or your nearest sales representative.
Specifications
2415 542 -
4414 542 -
T103 539
Model Weight
W H D D1 D2 W1 W2 H1 H2 t1 t2 d kg (lb)
220 350 227 140 87 192 192 335 8 2.3 2.3 8.5
2070 M6
(8.66) (13.78) (8.94) (5.51) (3.43) (7.56) (7.56) (13.19) (0.32) (0.09) (0.09) (18.74)
220 350 227 140 87 192 192 335 8 2.3 2.3 9.0
2082 M6
(8.66) (13.78) (8.94) (5.51) (3.43) (7.56) (7.56) (13.19) (0.32) (0.09) (0.09) (19.84)
220 350 227 140 87 192 192 335 8 2.3 2.3 7.5
4044 M6
(8.66) (13.78) (8.94) (5.51) (3.43) (7.56) (7.56) (13.19) (0.32) (0.09) (0.09) (16.53)
220 350 246 140 106 192 192 335 8 2.3 2.3 12
4060 M6
(8.66) (13.78) (9.69) (5.51) (4.17) (7.56) (7.56) (13.19) (0.32) (0.09) (0.09) (26.46)
Specifications
■ 2110, 4075
240 400 280 166 114 195 186 12 375 17.5 17.5 2.3 2.3 22
2110 M6
(9.45) (15.75) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (7.68) (7.32) (0.47) (14.76) (0.69) (0.69) (0.09) (0.09) (48.50)
240 400 280 166 114 195 186 12 375 17.5 17.5 2.3 2.3 17
4075 M6
(9.45) (15.75) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (7.68) (7.32) (0.47) (14.76) (0.69) (0.69) (0.09) (0.09) (37.48)
255 450 280 166 114 170 165 12 424 16 29 21 2.3 2.3 24
2138 M6
(10.04) (17.72) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (6.50) (0.47) (16.69) (0.63) (1.14) (0.83) (0.09) (0.09) (52.91)
255 450 280 166 114 170 165 12 424 16 29 21 2.3 2.3 22
4089 M6
(10.04) (17.72) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (6.50) (0.47) (16.69) (0.63) (1.14) (0.83) (0.09) (0.09) (48.50)
255 450 280 166 114 170 165 12 424 16 29 21 2.3 2.3 25
4103 M6
(10.04) (17.72) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (6.50) (0.47) (16.69) (0.63) (1.14) (0.83) (0.09) (0.09) (55.11)
255 450 280 166 114 170 165 12 424 16 29 21 2.3 2.3 20
T103 M6
(10.04) (17.72) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (6.50) (0.47) (16.69) (0.63) (1.14) (0.83) (0.09) (0.09) (44.10)
Specifications
264 543 335 186 149 190 182 12 516 17.5 28.5 20.5 2.3 2.3 39
2169 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.47) (20.31) (0.69) (1.12) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (85.98)
264 543 335 186 149 190 182 12 516 17.5 28.5 20.5 2.3 2.3 40
2211 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.47) (20.31) (0.69) (1.12) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (88.18)
264 543 335 186 149 190 182 12 516 17.5 28.5 20.5 2.3 2.3 38
4140 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.47) (20.31) (0.69) (1.12) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (83.77)
264 543 335 186 149 190 182 12 516 17.5 28.5 20.5 2.3 2.3 39
4168 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.47) (20.31) (0.69) (1.12) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (85.98)
264 543 335 186 149 190 182 12 516 17.5 28.5 20.5 2.3 2.3 31
T140 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.47) (20.31) (0.69) (1.12) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (68.30)
264 543 335 186 149 190 182 12 516 17.5 28.5 20.5 2.3 2.3 31
T168 M8
(10.39) (21.38) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.47) (20.31) (0.69) (1.12) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (68.30)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 67
2257 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (147.7)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 67
2313 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (147.7)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 71
4208 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (156.5)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 71
4250 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (156.5)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 71
4302 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (156.5)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 59
Specifications
T208 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (130.10)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 60
T250 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (132.30)
312 700 420 260 160 218 218 18 659 28 43.5 28.5 4.5 4.5 61
T302 M10
(12.28) (27.56) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.71) (25.94) (1.10) (1.71) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (134.50)
7
440 800 472 254 218 370 370 20 757 28 44 30 4.5 4.5 104
2360 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.79) (29.80) (1.10) (1.73) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (229.3)
440 800 472 254 218 370 370 20 757 28 44 30 4.5 4.5 119
2415 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.79) (29.80) (1.10) (1.73) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (262.3)
440 800 472 254 218 370 370 20 757 28 44 30 4.5 4.5 122
4371 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.79) (29.80) (1.10) (1.73) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (269.0)
440 800 472 254 218 370 370 20 757 28 44 30 4.5 4.5 126
4414 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.79) (29.80) (1.10) (1.73) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (277.8)
440 800 472 254 218 370 370 20 757 28 44 30 4.5 4.5 97
T371 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.79) (29.80) (1.10) (1.73) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (213.80)
440 800 472 254 218 370 370 20 757 28 44 30 4.5 4.5 100
T414 M12
(17.32) (31.50) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.79) (29.80) (1.10) (1.73) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (220.50)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 198
4477 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (436.5)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 198
4568 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (436.5)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 207
4605 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (456.3)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 205
4720 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (451.9)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 167
T477 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (368.20)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 167
T568 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (368.20)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 173
T605 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (381.40)
510 1136 480 260 220 450 450 225 225 20 1093 25.5 43.5 30.5 4.5 4.5 172
T720 M12
(20.08) (44.72) (18.90) (10.24) (8.66) (17.72) (17.72) (8.86) (8.86) (0.79) (43.03) (1.00) (1.71) (1.20) (0.18) (0.18) (379.20)
Specifications
◆ IP20/UL Type1
■ 2004 - 2042, 4002 - 4023
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
2004 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
2006 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
2008 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
2010 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
2012 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.5
2018 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.92)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.5
2021 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.92)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.8
2030 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (10.58)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.8
2042 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (10.58)
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
4002 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
4004 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 176 138 38 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.1
4005 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (6.93) (5.43) (1.50) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.04)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.5
4007 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.92)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.5
4009 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.92)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.5
4012 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (9.92)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.8
4018 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (10.58)
140 300 211 138 73 102 102 260 248 6 40 1.5 1.6 5 4.8
4023 M5
(5.51) (11.81) (8.31) (5.43) (2.87) (4.02) (4.02) (10.24) (9.76) (0.24) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.20) (10.58)
180 340 202 134 68 140 140 300 284 8 40 1.5 1.6 1.6 7
Specifications
2056 M5
(7.09) (13.39) (7.95) (5.28) (2.68) (5.51) (5.51) (11.81) (11.18) (0.32) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.06) (15.43)
180 340 202 134 68 140 140 300 284 8 40 1.5 1.6 1.6 7
4031 M5
(7.09) (13.39) (7.95) (5.28) (2.68) (5.51) (5.51) (11.81) (11.18) (0.32) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.06) (15.43)
180 340 202 134 68 140 140 300 284 8 40 1.5 1.6 1.6 7
4038 M5
(7.09) (13.39) (7.95) (5.28) (2.68) (5.51) (5.51) (11.81) (11.18) (0.32) (1.57) (0.06) (0.06) (0.06) (15.43)
220 400 227 140 87 192 192 350 335 8 50 1.5 2.3 2.3 9
2070 M6
(8.66) (15.75) (8.94) (5.51) (3.43) (7.56) (7.56) (13.78) (13.19) (0.32) (1.97) (0.06) (0.09) (0.09) (19.84)
220 435 227 140 87 192 192 350 335 8 85 1.5 2.3 2.3 10
2082 M6
(8.66) (17.13) (8.94) (5.51) (3.43) (7.56) (7.56) (13.78) (13.19) (0.32) (3.35) (0.06) (0.09) (0.09) (22.05)
220 400 227 140 87 192 192 350 335 8 50 1.5 2.3 2.3 8.5
4044 M6
(8.66) (15.75) (8.94) (5.51) (3.43) (7.56) (7.56) (13.78) (13.19) (0.32) (1.97) (0.06) (0.09) (0.09) (18.74)
220 400 246 140 106 192 192 350 335 8 50 1.5 2.3 2.3 13
4060 M6
(8.66) (15.75) (9.69) (5.51) (4.17) (7.56) (7.56) (13.78) (13.19) (0.32) (1.97) (0.06) (0.09) (0.09) (28.66)
■ 2110, 4075
244 500 280 166 114 195 186 10 400 375 17.5 100 17.5 2.3 2.3 24
2110 M6
(9.61) (19.69) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (7.68) (7.32) (0.39) (15.75) (14.76) (0.69) (3.94) (0.69) (0.09) (0.09) (52.91)
244 500 280 166 114 195 186 10 400 375 17.5 100 17.5 2.3 2.3 20
4075 M6
(9.61) (19.69) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (7.68) (7.32) (0.39) (15.75) (14.76) (0.69) (3.94) (0.69) (0.09) (0.09) (44.09)
Specifications
259 580 280 166 114 170 165 10 450 424 16 130 21 2.3 2.3 27
2138 M6
(10.20) (22.83) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (6.50) (0.39) (17.72) (16.69) (0.63) (5.12) (0.83) (0.09) (0.09) (59.52)
259 580 280 166 114 170 165 10 450 424 16 130 21 2.3 2.3 25
4089 M6
(10.20) (22.83) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (6.50) (0.39) (17.72) (16.69) (0.63) (5.12) (0.83) (0.09) (0.09) (55.11)
259 580 280 166 114 170 165 10 450 424 16 130 21 2.3 2.3 29
4103 M6
(10.20) (22.83) (11.02) (6.54) (4.49) (6.69) (6.50) (0.39) (17.72) (16.69) (0.63) (5.12) (0.83) (0.09) (0.09) (63.93)
268 700 335 186 149 190 182 10 543 516 17.5 157 20.5 2.3 2.3 44
2169 M8
(10.55) (27.56) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.39) (21.38) (20.31) (0.69) (6.18) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (97.00)
268 770 335 186 149 190 182 10 543 516 17.5 227 20.5 2.3 2.3 46
2211 M8
(10.55) (30.31) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.39) (21.38) (20.31) (0.69) (8.94) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (101.41)
268 700 335 186 149 190 182 10 543 516 17.5 157 20.5 2.3 2.3 43
4140 M8
(10.55) (27.56) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.39) (21.38) (20.31) (0.69) (6.18) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (94.80)
268 700 335 186 149 190 182 10 543 516 17.5 157 20.5 2.3 2.3 44
4168 M8
(10.55) (27.56) (13.19) (7.32) (5.87) (7.48) (7.17) (0.39) (21.38) (20.31) (0.69) (6.18) (0.81) (0.09) (0.09) (97.00)
Specifications
316 915 420 260 160 218 218 16 700 659 28 215 28.5 4.5 4.5 72
2257 M10
(12.44) (36.02) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.63) (27.56) (25.94) (1.10) (8.46) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (158.73)
316 915 420 260 160 218 218 16 700 659 28 215 28.5 4.5 4.5 72
2313 M10
(12.44) (36.02) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.63) (27.56) (25.94) (1.10) (8.46) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (158.73)
316 915 420 260 160 218 218 16 700 659 28 215 28.5 4.5 4.5 79
4208 M10
(12.44) (36.02) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.63) (27.56) (25.94) (1.10) (8.46) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (174.16)
316 915 420 260 160 218 218 16 700 659 28 215 28.5 4.5 4.5 79
4250 M10
(12.44) (36.02) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.63) (27.56) (25.94) (1.10) (8.46) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (174.16)
316 915 420 260 160 218 218 16 700 659 28 215 28.5 4.5 4.5 79
4302 M10
(12.44) (36.02) (16.54) (10.24) (6.30) (8.58) (8.58) (0.63) (27.56) (25.94) (1.10) (8.46) (1.12) (0.18) (0.18) (174.16)
■ 2360, 4371
444 1045 472 254 218 370 370 18 800 757 28 245 30 4.5 4.5 113
2360 M12
(17.48) (41.14) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.71) (31.50) (29.80) (1.10) (9.65) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (249.12)
444 1045 472 254 218 370 370 18 800 757 28 245 30 4.5 4.5 130
4371 M12
(17.48) (41.14) (18.58) (10.00) (8.58) (14.57) (14.57) (0.71) (31.50) (29.80) (1.10) (9.65) (1.18) (0.18) (0.18) (286.60)
Specifications
2004 to 2042
552
4002 to 4023
2056
553
4031, 4038
2070, 2082
553
4044, 4060
2110
554
4075
2138
554
4089, 4103
2169
555
4140, 4168
2211 555
2257, 2313
556
4208 - 4302
2360
556
4371
Figure 7.19 Knock-Out Dimensions Diagram 1 (Model: 2004 to 2042, 4002 to 4023)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 D3 W φd4
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 D3 W W1 φd4 φd5
Figure 7.21 Knock-Out Dimensions Diagram 3 (Model: 2070, 2082, 4044, 4060)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 W W1 φd4 φd5
■ 2110, 4075
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 W W1 φd4 φd5
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 W W1 φd4 φd5
Figure 7.24 Knock-Out Dimensions Diagram 6 (Models: 2169, 4140, and 4168)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 W W1 φd4 φd5 φd6
■ 2211
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 D3 W W1 φd4 φd5 φd6
Figure 7.26 Knock-Out Dimensions Diagram 8 (Model:2257, 2313, 4208, 4250, 4302)
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 D3 W W1 φd4 φd5
■ 2360, 4371
Dimensions mm (in)
Model
D D1 D2 W W1 W2 φd4 φd5
Specifications
Fault ................................................................... 83
Symbols Minor Fault.......................................................... 113
Numerics Braking Resistor
24 V power supply Wiring................................................................ 402
Power supply input terminals ..................................... 387 bUS
A Fault ................................................................... 83
AC reactor Minor Fault.......................................................... 113
Wiring................................................................ 415 bUSy ...................................................................... 114
Adjustment of control functionality .................................. 500 C
AEr ........................................................................ 113 CALL ..................................................................... 114
Alarm .................................................................76, 113 Carrier frequency
ALM indicator ..................................................... 433, 436 Derating.............................................................. 526
ALM/ERR CDBR type braking unit
LED status........................................................... 439 Connect multiple units ............................................. 410
Altitude Wiring................................................................ 403
Derating.............................................................. 533 CE
Environment......................................................... 308 Fault ................................................................... 83
Ambient humidity ....................................................... 308 Minor Fault.......................................................... 114
Ambient Temperature Setting ......................................... 308 CF .......................................................................... 84
Derating.............................................................. 531 Checklist
Parameter ............................................................ 532 Test run .............................................................. 507
Analog gauge Circulation Fan
Monitors ............................................................. 455 Replacement.......................................................... 28
Application Preset CoF......................................................................... 84
Operation ............................................................ 487 Control circuit terminal block
ASR tuning............................................................... 493 Replacement.......................................................... 63
Precautions .......................................................... 497 Control circuit terminals
Auto-Tuning ............................................................. 489 Configuration of terminal block .................................. 390
ASR tuning .......................................................... 493 I/O terminals function selection switches ....................... 394
Induction Motor .................................................... 489 Terminal functions ................................................. 385
Inertia Tuning ....................................................... 493 Wire gauge .......................................................... 391
PM Motors .......................................................... 490 Wiring................................................................ 384
Precautions .......................................................... 495 Wiring procedure for terminal block............................. 392
Precautions to Note before ASR Tuning ........................ 497 Cooling Fan
Precautions to Note before Inertia Tuning ...................... 497 Estimated Lifespan .................................................. 25
Procedure ............................................................ 472 Replacement.......................................................... 28
Rotational Auto-Tuning Precautions............................. 496 Copy Function Error ............................................... 76, 135
Stationary Auto-Tuning for Line-to-Line Resistance CP1
precautions.................................................... 497 Fault ................................................................... 84
Stationary Auto-Tuning Precautions............................. 496 Minor Fault.......................................................... 114
Stator resistance Auto-Tuning precautions...................... 497 CP2
Auto-Tuning Error ................................................. 76, 130 Fault ................................................................... 85
B Minor Fault.......................................................... 115
Backlight CPF00...................................................................... 85
Timing of shut-off .................................................. 483 CPF01...................................................................... 85
Backup CPF02...................................................................... 85
Parameters (drive to keypad) ..................................... 464 CPF03...................................................................... 85
Bar graph CPF06...................................................................... 85
Monitors ............................................................. 453 CPF07...................................................................... 85
Basic operation CPF08...................................................................... 86
Get started ........................................................... 441 CPF10...................................................................... 86
bAT CPF11...................................................................... 86
Fault ................................................................... 83 CPF12...................................................................... 86
Minor Fault.......................................................... 113 CPF13...................................................................... 86
Battery CPF14...................................................................... 86
Replacement.......................................................... 69 CPF16...................................................................... 86
Specifications ........................................................ 69 CPF17...................................................................... 86
bb .......................................................................... 113 CPF18...................................................................... 87
bCE CPF19...................................................................... 87
August 2021 <1> All Updated entire documentation to align with SIEPC71061737 C<2>
In the event that the end user of this product is to be the military and said product is to be employed in any weapons systems or the
manufacture thereof, the export will fall under the relevant regulations as stipulated in the Foreign Exchange and Foreign Trade
Regulations. Therefore, be sure to follow all procedures and submit all relevant documentation according to any and all rules, regulations
and laws that may apply.
Specifications are subject to change without notice for ongoing product modifications and improvements.
Original instructions.
© 2018 YASKAWA America, Inc.
TOEPYAIGA8001
YASKAWA America, Inc.
Revision: B <1>-0
August 2021
Published in U.S.A.
*TOEPYAIGA8001*